RAM 1500 (2014) - Car DODGE - Free user manual and instructions
Find the device manual for free RAM 1500 (2014) DODGE in PDF.
User questions about RAM 1500 (2014) DODGE
0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.
Ask a new question about this device
Download the instructions for your Car in PDF format for free! Find your manual RAM 1500 (2014) - DODGE and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. RAM 1500 (2014) by DODGE.
USER MANUAL RAM 1500 (2014) DODGE
natural_image
Stylized emblem of a ram's head with horns, enclosed in a shield shape (no text or symbols)RAM
2014
RAM TRUCK
1500/2500/3500
OWNER'S MANUAL

Information Provided by
□是√否
四、备查文件(复印件或盖章)
VEHICLESOLDINCANADA
WithrespecttoanyVehiclesSoldinCanada, thename ChryslerGroupLLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name ChryslerCanadaInc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVINGANDALCOHOL
Drunkendrivingisoneofthemostfrequentcausesof accidents.
Yourdrivingabilitycanbeseriouslyimpairedwithblood alcohollevelsfarbelowthelegalminimum.Ifyouare drinking,don'tdrive.Ridewithadesignatednon-drinking driver,callacab,afriend,orusepublictransportation.
WARNING!
Drivingafterdrinkingcanleadtoanaccident.Your perceptionsarelesssharp,yourreflexesareslower, andyourjudgmentisimpairedwhenyouhavebeen drinking.Neverdrinkandthendrive.
Thismanualillustratesanddescribestheoperationof featuresandequipmentthatareeitherstandardor optionalonthisvehicle. Thismanualmayalsoincludea descriptionoffeaturesandequipmentthatarenolonger availableorwerenotorderedonthisvehicle. Please disregardanyfeaturesandequipmentdescribedinthis manualthatarenotonthisvehicle.
ChryslerGroupLLCreservestherighttomakechanges indesignandspecifications,and/ormakeadditionstoor improvementstoitsproductswithoutimposingany obligationuponitselftoinstallthemonproductspreviouslymanufactured.
Copyright©2013ChryslerGroupLLC


SECTION PAGE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1 INTRODUCTION....3
2 THINGSTOKNOWBEFORESTARTINGYOURVEHICLE....9
3 UNDERSTANDINGTHEFEATURESOFYOURVEHICLE....125
4 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL. 279
5 STARTING AND OPERATING....383
6 WHATODOINEMERGENCIES....627
7 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE. 687
8 MAINTENANCESCHEDULES....763
9 IFYOUNEEDCONSUMERASSISTANCE....773
10 INDEX 783

Information Provided by
DEALER
电子邮箱:@zzb.com
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
■INTRODUCTION....4
■HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL....4
■WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS....6
■VAN CONVERSIONS/CAMPERS....6
■VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER....6
■VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS....7
4 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
Congratulations on selecting your new Chrysler Group LLC vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision workmanship, distinctive styling, and high quality - all essentials that are traditional to our vehicles.
This Owner's Manual has been prepared with the assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle. It is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to read these publications carefully. Following the instructions and recommendations in this manual will help assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it should bestored in the vehicle for convenient referencing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
When it comes to service, remember that your authorized dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained technicians and genuine parts, and cares about your satisfaction.
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section contains the information you desire.
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and illustrations may differ from your vehicle's equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner's Manual contains a complete listing of all subjects.
Consult the following table for a description of the symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout this Owner's Manual:


text_image
WATER IN FUEL REAR WINDOW WIPER WINDSHIELD WIPER INTERMITTENT EXTERIOR BILB FAILURE HIGH BEAM TURN SIGNALS UPPER AIR OUTLET HEATED BEAT LOW DOOR LOCK ADJUSTABLE PEDALS ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL ESP BAS ELECTRONIC STABILITY PROGRAM / BRAKE ASSIST SYSTEM FUEL REAR WINDOW INTERMITTENT WIPER WINDSHIELD WASHER MASTER LIGHTING SWITCH LOW BEAM KEY ACTIVATE (POWER OUTLET) UPPER AND LOWER AIR OUTLET HEATED BEAT HIGH WINDOW UFT TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR HILL/DESCENT CONTROL BRAKE FUEL FILL SOE REAR WINDOW WASHER WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUSE LEVEL DOME LIGHT FRONT FOG LIGHT HOOD RELEASE LOWER AIR OUTLET RECOLCULATION CONVERTIBLE 4 WINDOWN DOWN ELECTRONIC STABILITY CONTROL AWDI ABS FAILURE OF ANTI-LOCK STRADING SYSTEM ENGINE OIL REAR WINDOW DEFROST WINDSHIELD ELECTRICALLY HEATED PARK LIGHTS REAR FOG LAMP LIFTOATE RELEASE AND LIFTGATE OPEN DEFROST AND LOWER AIR OUTLET VENTILATING IAN WINDOW LOCK ELECTRONIC THIRCTITLE CONTROL FOUR WHEEL DRIVE BRAKE SYSTEM MARKING PARKING BRAKE BATTERY CHARGINS HEATED MIRROR WINDSHIELD DEFROST INSTRUMENT PANEL ILLMINATION SEAT BELT SLIDING DOOR TRUNK / DECK RELEASE AIR CONDITIONING CHILD BEAT TETHER ANCHOR VOICE RECOGNITION BUTTON WARNING TOW/HAUL GLOW FLUG POWER STEERING FLUID WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER SIDE AIRBAS AIRBAS SLIDING DOOR EMERGENCY RELEASE HANDLE LIGHTER LOWER ANCHORS AND TETHER FOR CHILDREN (LATCH) UCONNECT™ BUTTON HAZARD 4 LOW MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LIGHT TRAKS OIL TEMP ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SRS AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM PASSenger AIRSAG OFF DOOR AJAR CONVERTIBLE TOPDOWN CONVERTIBLE TOP UP HORN SEE OWNER'S MANUAL ISO A/C PUSH AIR CONDITIONERS OFF ELECTRONIC STABILITY CONTROL OFF010533317

Information Provided by
DEALER
法定代表人:王
The Ground Truth image displays a single, solid horizontal line. According to Rule 2 (UNDERSCORE & LINE RULES), this is a stylistic or background line, not a placeholder underscore. Therefore, the OCR result must ignore it and output nothing or only meaningful text. The provided OCR content is "____", which consists of four underscores. This is an incorrect interpretation of the line as a placeholder, violating the rule that stylistic lines must be ignored. The OCR has hallucinated underscores where none should exist based on the GT's visual context. Hence, the OCR result is inconsistent with the Ground Truth.
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
[Non-Text]
6 INTRODUCTION
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
This Owners Manual contains WARNINGS against operating procedures that could result in a collision or bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you do not read this entire Owners Manual, you may miss important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VAN CONVERSIONS/CAMPERS
The New Vehicle Limited Warranty does not apply to body modifications or special equipment installed by van conversion/camper manufacturers/body builders. Refer to the Warranty Information book, Section 2.1.C. Such equipment includes video monitors, VCRs, heaters, stoves, refrigerators, etc. For warranty coverage and service on these items, contact the applicable manufacturer.
Operating instructions for the special equipment installed by the conversion/camper manufacturer should also be supplied with your vehicle. If these instructions are missing, please contact your authorized dealer for assistance in obtaining replacement documents from the applicable manufacturer.
For information on the Body Builders Guide refer to: www.rambodybuilder.com. This website contains dimensional and technical specifications for your vehicle. It is intended for Second Stage Manufacturer's technical support. For service issues, contact your authorized dealer.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is found on the left front corner of the instrument panel, visible through the windshield. This number also appears on the vehicle

frame and underbody as well as the Automobile Information Disclosure Label affixed to a window on your vehicle, the vehicle registration and title.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side profile showing a curved seat and dashboard, with a black arrow pointing to the seat area (no text or symbols)VehicleIdentificationNumber
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Anymodificationsoralterationstothisvehiclecould seriouslyaffectitsroadworthinessandsafetyand mayleadtoacollisionresultinginseriousinjuryor death.

Information Provided by
DEALER
电(开) 01 二矿管管
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
■A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS....12
□Wireless Ignition Node (WIN)....12
☐Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) — If Equipped . . .13
□Key Fob....
□Removing Key Fob From Ignition....16
□Key-In-Ignition Reminder....19
■SENTRY KEY®....19
□Replacement Keys....20
□Customer Key Programming....2 1
□ General Information .....21
■VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM....22
□Rearming Of The System....2 2
□To Arm The System....2 2
4 □To Disarm The System....2 3
□Security System Manual Override....23
■ILLUMINATED ENTRY....23
■REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) ..... 2 4
□Remote Unlock The Doors....26
□To Lock The Doors....27
□ Sound Horn With Remote Key Lock....27

10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
□Using The Panic Alarm....28
☐RKE Air Suspension (Remote Lowering Of The Vehicle) — If Equipped ..... 2 9
□Programming Additional Transmitters. . . . . . . 2 9
□Transmitter Battery Replacement....30
□General Information....3 3
■ REMOTE STARTING SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED . .33
□How To Use Remote Start....3 4
■DOOR LOCKS 37
□Manual Door Locks....37
□Power Door Locks — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 3 9
□Child-Protection Door Lock....40
■KEYLESS ENTER-N-GO™ 42
■WINDOWS....46
□Power Windows — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . 4 6
□Wind Buffeting....50
■OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS....50
□Lap/Shoulder Belts 54
□Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure ..... 6 2
□ Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage . . .63
□Center Lap Belts....63
□ Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions .....64
□Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode — If Equipped....6 5
□Energy Management Feature....6 6
□Seat Belt Pretensioners....6 6
□Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System (BeltAlert®) 67
□Seat Belts And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . 6 8
□Seat Belt Extender....68
□Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) — Air Bags .... 6 8
□Air Bag System Components ..... 7 0
□Advanced Front Air Bag Features....7 1
□Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls . . . . 7 5
□Event Data Recorder (EDR) 8 2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
□Child Restraints....83
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . .119
SAFETY TIPS....120
□Transporting Passengers....120
□Exhaust Gas....121
□Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The Vehicle....122
☐Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside The Vehicle....124
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
Your vehicle uses either a key start ignition system or keyless ignition system. The key start ignition system consists of a either a bladed key with an immobilizer chip in it, or a Key Fob with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter and an Ignition Node Module (IGNM). The keyless ignition system consists of a Key Fob with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter and a Keyless Ignition Node (KIN).
Wireless Ignition Node (WIN)
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) operates similar to an ignition switch. It has four operating positions, three with detents and one that is spring-loaded. The detent positions are OFF, ACC, and ON/RUN. The START position is a spring-loaded momentary contact position. When released from the START position, the switch automatically returns to the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go™, the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display the ignition switch position (OFF/ACC/RUN). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) — If Equipped" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

text_image
1 2 3 4 020205345WirelessIgnitionNode(WIN)
1—OFF
2 — ACCESSORY (ACCESSORY)
3—ON/RUN
4 — START
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) — If Equipped
This feature allows the driver to operate the ignition switch with the push of a button, as long as the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is in the passenger compartment.
The Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) has four operating positions, three of which are labeled and will illuminate when in position. The three positions are OFF, ACC, and ON/RUN. The fourth position is START, during start RUN will illuminate.
NOTE: In case the ignition switch does not change with the push of a button, the RKE transmitter (Key Fob) may have a low or dead battery. In this situation a back up method can be used to operate the ignition switch. Put the nose side (side opposite of the emergency key) of the Key Fob against the ENGINE START/STOP button and push to operate the ignition switch.
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

text_image
1 OFF ACC RUN START STOP O/R ENGINE 2 3 020236152KeylessIgnitionNode(KIN)
1—OFF
2 — ACC (ACCESSORY)
3—ON/RUN
Key Fob
WINKeyFob—IfEquipped
The Key Fob operates the ignition switch. Insert the square end of the key fob into the ignition switch located on the instrument panel and rotate to the desired position. It also contains the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter and an emergency key, which stores in the rear of the Key Fob.
The emergency key allows for entry into the vehicle should the battery in the vehicle or the RKE transmitter go dead. You can keep the emergency key with you when valet parking.
To remove the emergency key, slide the mechanical latch at the top of the Key Fob sideways with your thumb and then pull the key out with your other hand.


natural_image
Illustration of a car keychain with a separate key inserted into a slot (no text or symbols)EmergencyKeyRemoval(WIN)
020207436
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
KINKeyFob—Ifequipped
This KIN Key Fob allows the driver to operate the ignition switch with the push of a button, as long as the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is in the passenger compartment. The Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) has four operating positions, three of which are labeled and will illuminate when in position. The three positions are OFF, ACC, and ON/RUN. The fourth position is START, during start RUN will illuminate. It also contains the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter and an emergency key, which stores in the rear of the Key Fob.
The emergency key allows for entry into the vehicle should the battery in the vehicle or the RKE transmitter go dead. You can keep the emergency key with you when valet parking.
To remove the emergency key, slide the mechanical latch on the backside of the Key Fob sideways with your thumb and then pull the key out with your other hand.

16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Two grayscale automotive control buttons: a flat tool and a closed control panel with a play button (no text or symbols visible)0202006333
NOTE: You can insert the double-sided emergency key into the lock cylinder with either side up once the Start/Stop button has been removed.
Removing Key Fob From Ignition
Place the shift lever in PARK (if equipped with an automatic transmission). Turn the Key Fob to the OFF position and then remove the Key Fob.
EmergencyKeyRemovalKeylessEnter-N-Go™Fob (KIN)

Information Provided by DEALER
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
NOTE:
- The power window switches, radio, power sunroof (if equipped), and power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position. Opening either front door will cancel this feature. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” (Engine Off Options) in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
- For vehicles not equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/ Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- For vehicles equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
CAUTION!
- If your vehicle battery becomes slow or dead, your KeyFob will become locked in the ignition.
- DonotattempttoremovetheKeyFobwhileinthis condition,damagecouldoccurtotheKeyFobor ignitionmodule.Onlyremovetheemergencykey forlockingandunlockingthedoors.
- LeavetheKeyFobintheignitionandeither:
- JumpStartthevehicle.
- Chargethebattery.
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
- Beforeexitingvehicle,alwaysapplytheparking brake,shiftthetransmissionintoPARK,andpush ignitionbuttontoplaceignitioninOFFposition. Whenleavingthevehicle,alwayslockyourvehicle.
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoanunlockedvehicle.
- Allowingchildrentobeinavehicleunattendedis dangerousforanumberofreasons.Achildor otherscouldbeseriouslyorfatallyinjured.Childrenshouldbewarnednottotouchtheparking brake,brakepedalortheshiftlever.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- DonotleavetheKeyFobinornearthevehicle,or inalocationaccessibletochildren,anddonot leavetheignitionofavehicleequipped with KeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUN mode.Achildcouldoperatepowerwindows,other controls,ormovethevehicle.
- Donotleavechildrenoranimalsinsideparked vehiclesinhotweather.Interiorheatbuild-upmay causeseriousinjuryordeath.
CAUTION!
An unlocked carisan invitation to thieves. Always removethe key from the ignition and lockalldoors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
Opening the driver's door when the Key Fob is in the ignition and the ignition switch position is OFF or ACC, a chime will sound to remind you to remove the Key Fob.
NOTE:
- "Keyed" Ignition systems will chime in OFF or ACC when the driver door is open.
- "Keyless" Ignition systems will chime in ACC or RUN when the driver door is open.
- If equipped with Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC), the EVIC will display "Key In Ignition".
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
SENTRY KEY®
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer System prevents unauthorized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked or unlocked.
The system uses a Key Fob with a factory-mated Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, a Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) and a RF receiver to prevent unauthorized vehicle operation. Therefore, only Key Fobs that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate the vehicle. The system will not allow the engine to crank if an invalid Key Fob is used to start and operate the vehicle. The system will shut the engine off in two seconds if an invalid Key Fob is used to start the engine.
NOTE: A Key Fob that has not been programmed is also considered an invalid key.

20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
During normal operation, after turning on the ignition switch, the Vehicle Security Light will turn on for three seconds for a bulb check. If the light remains on after the bulb check, it indicates that there is a problem with the electronics. In addition, if the light begins to flash after the bulb check, it indicates that someone used an invalid Key Fob to try to start the engine. Either of these conditions will result in the engine being shut off after two seconds.
If the Vehicle Security Light turns on during normal vehicle operation (vehicle running for longer than 10 seconds), it indicates that there is a fault in the electronics. Should this occur, have the vehicle serviced as soon as possible by an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
The SentryKey® Immobilizersystemis not compatible with some aftermarket remotestartingsystems. Useofthesesystemsmayresultinvehiclestarting problemsandlossofsecurityprotection.
All of the Key Fobs provided with your new vehicle have been programmed to the vehicle electronics.
Replacement Keys
NOTE: Only Key Fobs that are programmed to the vehicle electronics can be used to start and operate the vehicle. Once a Key Fob is programmed to a vehicle, it cannot be programmed to any other vehicle.
CAUTION!
- AlwaysremovetheKeyFobsfromthevehicleand lockalldoorswhenleavingthevehicleunattended.
- ForvehiclesequippedwithKeylessEnter-N-Go™, alwaysremembertoplacetheignitionintheOFF position.
At the time of purchase, the original owner is provided with a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN). Keep the PIN in a secure location. This number is required for authorized dealer replacement of Key Fobs. Duplication of Key Fobs may be performed at an authorized dealer. This procedure consists of programming a blank Key Fob to the vehicle electronics. A blank Key Fob is one that has never been programmed.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
NOTE: When having the Sentry Key® Immobilizer System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to an authorized dealer.
Customer Key Programming
Programming Key Fobs or RKE transmitters may be performed at an authorized dealer.
General Information
The Sentry Key® system complies with FCC rules part 15 and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following conditions:
- This device may not cause harmful interference.
- This device must accept any interference that may be received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the vehicle doors and ignition for unauthorized operation. When the Vehicle Security Alarm is activated, interior switches for door locks are disabled. The system provides both audible and visible signals for the first three minutes the horn will sound and the headlights will turn on, the park lamps and/or turn signals will flash and Vehicle Security Light will flash repeatedly. For an additional 15 minutes only, the headlights will turn on, the park lamps and/or turn signals and Vehicle Security Light will flash.
Rearming Of The System
The Vehicle Security Alarm will rearm itself after the 15 additional minutes of headlights and Vehicle Security Light flashing, if the system has not been disabled. If the condition which initiated the alarm is still present, the system will ignore that condition and monitor the remaining doors and ignition.
To Arm The System
The Vehicle Security Alarm will set when you use the power door locks, or use the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to lock the doors. After all the doors are locked and closed, the Vehicle Security Light, in the instrument panel cluster, will flash rapidly for about 16 seconds to indicate that the alarm is being set. After the alarm is set, the Vehicle Security Light will flash at a slower rate to indicate that the system is armed.

To Disarm The System
Use the RKE transmitter to unlock the door. If something has triggered the Vehicle Security Alarm in your absence, the horn will sound three times when you unlock the doors and the exterior lights will blink three times. Check the vehicle for tampering.
The Vehicle Security Alarm will also disarm if a programmed Sentry Key® is inserted into the ignition switch. To exit the alarming mode, press the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button, or insert a programmed Sentry Key® into the ignition switch.
The Vehicle Security Alarm is designed to protect your vehicle; however, you can create conditions where the system will give you a false alarm. If one of the previously described arming sequences has occurred, the Vehicle Security Alarm will arm regardless of whether you are in the vehicle or not. If you remain in the vehicle and open a door, the alarm will sound. If th is occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
Security System Manual Override
The Vehicle Security Alarm will not arm if you lock the doors using the manual door lock plunger.
ILLUMINATED ENTRY
The courtesy lights will turn on when you use the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to unlock the doors or open any door.
This feature also turns on the approach lighting in the outside mirrors (if equipped). Refer to "Mirrors" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for further information.
The lights will fade to off after approximately 30 seconds, or they will immediately fade to off once the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN from the OFF position.

24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
- The front courtesy overhead console and door courtesy lights will not turn off if the dimmer control is in the "Dome ON" position (rotate horizontal thumb wheel on the bottom of the switch to the far right detent position).
- The illuminated entry system will not operate if the dimmer control is in the "Dome OFF" position (rotate horizontal thumb wheel on the bottom of the switch to the far left detent position).
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The RKE system allows you to lock or unlock all doors, tailgate, and the RamBox® (if equipped) as well as activate the Panic Alarm from distances up to approximately 66 ft (20 m) using a hand-held radio transmitter with integrated key. The transmitter does not need to be pointed at the vehicle to activate the system. Press and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter to lock all doors, the tailgate and the RamBox® (if equipped). The turn signal lights will flash and the horn will chirp to acknowledge the signal.
NOTE: Inserting the Key Fob with RKE transmitter into the ignition switch disables the system from responding to any button presses from that RKE transmitter. Driving at speeds 5 mph (8 km/h) and above disables the system from responding to all RKE transmitter buttons for all RKE transmitters.


natural_image
Top-down view of a car's internal compartmental seat with no visible text or symbols020207434
KeyFobWithRemoteKeylessEntry(RKE)Transmitter (IGNM)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25

text_image
PANIC0202005004
KeyFobWithRKETransmitterKeylessEnter-N-Go™
Fob(KIN)

Information Provided by
DEALER
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Remote Unlock The Doors
Push and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter once to unlock the driver's door. Push the unlock button twice within five seconds to unlock all doors, the tailgate and the RamBox® (if equipped). The turn signal lights will flash to acknowledge the unlock signal. The illuminated entry system will also turn on.
NOTE: The EVIC or Uconnect® Settings are setup for driver door first, otherwise this will unlock all doors.
RemoteKeyUnlock, DriverDoor/AllDoorsFirst
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either the driver's door or all doors on the first press of the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter. To change the current setting, proceed as follows:
- For vehicles not equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/ Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- For vehicles equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE: Pushing the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are inside the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm System. Opening a door with the Vehicle Security Alarm System activated will cause the alarm to sound. Push the UNLOCK button to deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm System.

FlashLampsWithRemoteKeyLock
This feature will cause the turn signal lights to flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the RKE transmitter. This feature can be turned on or turned off. To change the current setting, proceed as follows:
- For vehicles not equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
- For vehicles equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
To Lock The Doors
Push and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter to lock all doors, the tailgate and the RamBox® (if equipped). The turn signal lights will flash and the horn will chirp to acknowledge the signal.
Sound Horn With Remote Key Lock
This feature will cause the horn to chirp when the doors are locked with the RKE transmitter. This feature can be turned on or turned off. To change the current setting, proceed as follows:
- For vehicles not equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- For vehicles equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Pushing the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are in the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm System. Opening a door with the Vehicle Security Alarm System activated will cause the alarm to sound. Push the UNLOCK button to deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm System.
Using The Panic Alarm
To turn the Panic Alarm feature ON or OFF, press and hold the PANIC button on the RKE transmitter for at least one second and release. When the Panic Alarm is on, the headlights will turn on, the park lights will flash, the horn will pulse on and off, and the interior lights will turn on.
The Panic Alarm will stay on for three minutes unless you turn it off by either pressing the PANIC button a second time or drive the vehicle at a speed of 5 mph (8 km/h) or greater.
NOTE:
- The interior lights will turn off if you turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON/RUN position while the Panic Alarm is activated. However, the exterior lights and horn will remain on.
- You may need to be less than 35 ft (11 m) from the vehicle when using the RKE transmitter to turn off the Panic Alarm due to the radio frequency noises emitted by the system.
RKE Air Suspension (Remote Lowering Of The Vehicle) — If Equipped

For easy entry and loading, your vehicle can be lowered by pressing the Key Fob air suspension lowering button two times. When Remote key FOB lowering is requested, the vehicle will send a series of chirps and flashes to alert the customer that the operation has begun and will continue these alerts until it successfully lowers.
The following conditions must be met for the vehicle to lower remotely:
- The vehicle must not already be in Entry/Exit (Park) ride height.
- The vehicle battery must be fully charged.
- All doors must be closed.
• The ignition key must be out of the vehicle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
CancellingRemoteLowering
Vehicle lowering can be cancelled at anytime. When vehicle lowering is cancelled, the vehicle will raise up to the next defined level and lock out the remote lowering feature until the ignition has been cycled ON/OFF.
To cancel vehicle lowering, press the Key Fob air suspension lowering button one time during the lowering process. When vehicle lowering is cancelled the horn will chirp two times and the hazard lights will flash four times. Once raising is completed, the horn will chirp one time.
NOTE: For further information, refer to "Air Suspension System" in "Starting And Operating".
Programming Additional Transmitters
If you do not have a programmed RKE transmitter, contact your authorized dealer for details.

30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE Transmitter Battery Replacement
The recommended replacement battery is one CR2032 battery.
NOTE:
- Perchlorate Material — special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
- Do not touch the battery terminals that are on the back housing or the printed circuit board.
- Remove the emergency key by sliding the mechanical latch on the back of the RKE transmitter sideways with your thumb and then pull the key out with your other hand.

natural_image
Illustration of a car's keychain and its blade (no text or symbols)020207436
IgnitionNodeModule(IGNM)EmergencyKeyRemoval
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31

natural_image
Two car key components shown: a single key and a black rectangular device with control buttons (no text or symbols visible)0202005021

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with internal channels and a small circular feature (no text or symbols visible)KeylessIgnitionNode(KIN)EmergencyKeyRemovalRemoveScrewFromTransmitterCase
- Separating RKE halves requires screw removal – if equipped, and gently prying the two halves of the RKE transmitter apart. Make sure not to damage the seal during removal.
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Illustration of a handheld device with a pointed tip and handle, no text or symbols present021334199
SeparatingIgnitionNodeModule(IGNM)Transmitter Case

natural_image
Illustration of a knife inserted into a car key (no text or symbols)0213004940
SeparatingKeylessIgnitionNode(KIN)Transmitter Case
- Remove the battery by turning the back cover over (battery facing downward) and tapping it lightly on a solid surface such as a table or similar, then replace the battery. When replacing the battery, match the + sign on the battery to the + sign on the inside of the battery
clip, located on the back cover. Avoid touching the new battery with your fingers. Skin oils may cause battery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it with rubbing alcohol.
- To assemble the RKE transmitter case, snap the two halves together, reposition and secure the screw as shown in step #2 for removal.
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following conditions:
- This device may not cause harmful interference.
- This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal distance, check for these two conditions:
- A weak battery in the transmitter. The expected life of the battery is a minimum of three years.
- Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station tower, airport transmitter, and some mobile or CB radios.
REMOTE STARTING SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED

This system uses the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to start the engine conveniently from outside the vehicle while still maintaining security. The system has a range of
approximately 300 ft (91 m).
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
- The vehicle must be equipped with an automatic transmission to be equipped with Remote Start.
- Obstructions between the vehicle and the RKE transmitter may reduce this range.
How To Use Remote Start
All of the following conditions must be met before the engine will remote start:
- Shift lever in PARK
- Doors closed
- Hood closed
•HAZARD switch off - BRAKE switch inactive (brake pedal not pressed)
-
Ignition key removed from ignition switch
-
Battery at an acceptable charge level
•RKE PANIC button not pressed - Fuel meets minimum requirement
- System not disabled from previous remote start event
• Vehicle security alarm not active
WARNING!
- Donotstartorrunanengineinaclosedgarageor confinedarea.ExhaustgascontainsCarbonMonoxide(CO)whichisodorlessandcolorless.Carbon Monoxideispoisonousandcancauseseriousinjuryordeathwheninhaled.
- KeepRemoteKeylessEntry(RKE)transmitters awayfromchildren.OperationoftheRemoteStart System,windows,doorlocksorothercontrols couldcauseseriousinjuryordeath.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
RemoteStartAbortMessageOnElectronicVehicle InformationCenter(EVIC)—IfEquipped
The following messages will display in the EVIC if the vehicle fails to remote start or exits remote start prematurely:
- Remote Start Aborted — Door Ajar
- Remote Start Aborted — Hood Ajar
- Remote Start Aborted — Fuel Low
- Remote Start Aborted — System Fault
- Remote Start Disabled — Start Vehicle to Reset
The EVIC message stays active until the ignition is turned to the ON/RUN position.
ToEnterRemoteStartMode

Press and release the REMOTE START button on the RKE transmitter twice within five seconds. The parking lights will flash, vehicle doors will lock, and the horn will chirp twice (if programmed). Once the vehicle has started, the engine will run for 15 minutes.
NOTE:
- If your power door locks were unlocked, Remote Start will automatically lock the doors.
- If an engine fault is present or fuel level is low, the vehicle will start and then shut down in 10 seconds.
- The park lamps will turn on and remain on during Remote Start mode.
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
- For security, power window and power sunroof operation (if equipped) are disabled when the vehicle is in the Remote Start mode.
- The engine can be started two consecutive times (two 15-minute cycles) with the RKE transmitter. However, the ignition switch must be cycled to the ON/RUN position before you can repeat the start sequence for a third cycle.
ToExitRemoteStartModeWithoutDrivingThe Vehicle
Press and release the REMOTE START button one time or allow the engine to run for the entire 15-minute cycle.
NOTE: To avoid unintentional shut downs, the system will disable the one time press of the REMOTE START button for two seconds after receiving a valid Remote Start request.
ToExitRemoteStartModeAndDriveTheVehicle
Before the end of the 15-minute cycle, press and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter to unlock the doors and disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm System (if equipped). Then, prior to the end of the 15 minute cycle, cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
RemoteStartComfortSystems—IfEquipped
When remote start is activated, the heated steering wheel and driver heated seat features will automatically turn on in cold weather. In warm weather, the driver vented seat feature will automatically turn on when the remote start is activated. These features will stay on through the duration of remote start or until the ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position.

The Remote Start Comfort System can be activated and deactivated through the Uconnect® System. For more information on Remote Start Comfort System operation refer to "Customer Programmable Features" in "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel".
DOOR LOCKS
Manual Door Locks
Front and rear doors may be locked by moving the lock knob down or unlocked by moving the lock knob up.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with no visible text or symbols on the dashboard itselfDoorLockKnob
Front doors may be opened with the inside door handle without lifting the lock knob.
Doors locked before closing will remain locked when closed.
The emergency key will unlock the driver door lock on your vehicle.

38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
- Donotleavechildrenoranimalsinsideparked vehiclesinhotweather.Interiorheatbuild-upmay causeseriousinjuryordeath.
- Forpersonalsecurityandsafetyintheeventofan collision,lockthevehicledoorsasyoudriveas wellaswhenyouparkandleavethevehicle.
- Beforeexitingavehicle, alwaysturnthevehicle OFF, applytheparkingbrake, shifttheautomatic transmissionintoPARKorthemanualtransmissionintoREVERSE, andremovetheKeyFobfrom theignition. Whenleavingthevehicle, alwayslock yourvehicle.
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoanunlockedvehicle.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Allowingchildrentobeinavehicleunattendedis dangerousforanumberofreasons.Achildor otherscouldbeseriouslyorfatallyinjured.Childrenshouldbewarnednottotouchtheparking brake,brakepedalortheshiftlever.
- DonotleavetheKeyFobinornearthevehicle, or inalocationaccessibletochildren, and donot leavetheignitionofavehiclee equipped with KeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUN mode. Achildcouldoperatepowerwindows, other controls, ormovethevehicle.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
Power Door Locks — If Equipped
A power door LOCK switch is on each front door trim panel. Use this switch to lock or unlock the doors.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a control panel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)PowerDoorLockSwitchLocation
If you press the power door LOCK switch while the Key Fob is in the ignition, and any front door is open, the power locks will not operate. This prevents you from
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
accidentally locking your Key Fob in the vehicle. Removing the Key Fob or closing the door will allow the locks to operate. A chime will sound if the Key Fob is in the ignition switch and a door is open, as a reminder to remove the Key Fob.
AutomaticDoorLocks—IfEquipped
The auto door lock feature default condition is enabled. When enabled, the door locks will lock automatically when the vehicle's speed exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h). The auto door lock feature can be enabled or disabled by your authorized dealer per written request of the customer. Please see your authorized dealer for service.
AutomaticDoorsUnlock—IfEquipped
This feature unlocks all of the doors of the vehicle when either front door is opened. This will occur only after the vehicle has been shifted into the PARK position after the vehicle has been driven (shifted out of PARK and all doors closed).

40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
AutomaticDoorsUnlockProgramming—If Equipped
The Automatic Doors Unlock feature can be enabled or disabled as follows:
- For vehicles not equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- For vehicles equipped with a touchscreen radio, refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE: Use the Auto Unlock Doors feature in accordance with local laws.
Child-Protection Door Lock
To provide a safer environment for children riding in the rear seat, the rear doors (if equipped) of your vehicle have the Child-Protection Door Lock system.

natural_image
Close-up of a car door panel with a black arrow pointing to a small circular detail (no text or symbols visible)Child-ProtectionDoorLockLocation

To use the system, open each rear door, use a flat blade screwdriver (or emergency key) and rotate the dial to engage and disengage the Child-Protection locks. When the system on a door is engaged, that door can only be opened by using the outside door handle even if the inside door lock is in the unlocked position.

natural_image
Close-up of a car seatbelt with icons for cleaning, lifting, and adjusting (no text or symbols visible)ChildLockControl
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
WARNING!
Avoidtrappinganyoneinvehicleinacollision. Rememberthatthereardoorscanonlybeopened fromtheoutsidewhentheChild-Protectionlocksare engaged.
NOTE:
• After setting the Child-Protection Door Lock system, always test the door from the inside to make certain it is in the desired position.
- For emergency exit with the system engaged, move the door lock switch to the UNLOCK position, roll down the window and open the door with the outside door handle.
022605852

Information Provided by DEALER
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
KEYLESS ENTER-N-GO™
The Passive Entry system is an enhancement to the vehicle's Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system and a feature of Keyless Enter-N-Go™. For further information, refer to "Keyless Enter-N-Go™" in "Starting And Operating". This feature allows you to lock and unlock the vehicle's door(s) without having to press the RKE transmitter lock or unlock buttons.
NOTE:
- Passive Entry may be programmed ON/OFF; refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
-
If wearing gloves on your hands, or if it has been raining on the Passive Entry door handle, the unlock sensitivity can be affected, resulting in a slower response time.
-
If the vehicle is unlocked by the Passive Entry Door Handle, and no door goes ajar within 60 seconds, the vehicle will re-lock and if equipped will arm the security alarm.
- The vehicles security alarm can be armed/disarmed by pressing the passive entry key fob lock/unlock buttons (if equipped).
ToUnlockFromTheDriver'sSide:
With a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the driver door handle, grab the front driver door handle to unlock the driver's door automatically. The interior door panel lock knob will raise when the door is unlocked.


natural_image
Hand holding a car door clip, no visible text or symbols on the object itselfGrabTheDoorHandleToUnlock
NOTE: If "Unlock All Doors 1st Press" is programmed, all doors will unlock when you grab hold of the front driver's door handle. To select between "Unlock Driver Door 1st Press" and "Unlock All Doors 1st Press", refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
ToUnlockFromThePassengerSide:
With a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the passenger door handle, grab the front passenger door handle to unlock all doors automatically. The interior door panel lock knob will raise when the door is unlocked.
NOTE: All doors will unlock when the front passenger door handle is grabbed regardless of the driver's door unlock preference setting ("Unlock Driver Door 1st Press" or "Unlock All Doors 1st Press").
PreventingInadvertentLockingOfPassiveEntryRKE TransmitterInVehicle
To minimize the possibility of unintentionally locking a Passive Entry RKE transmitter inside your vehicle, the Passive Entry system is equipped with an automatic door unlock feature which will function if the ignition switch is in the OFF position.

44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If one of the vehicle doors is open and the door panel switch is used to lock the vehicle, once all open doors have been closed the vehicle checks the inside and outside of the vehicle for any valid Passive Entry RKE transmitters. If one of the vehicle's Passive Entry RKE transmitters is detected inside the vehicle, and no other valid Passive Entry RKE transmitters are detected outside the vehicle, the Passive Entry System automatically unlocks all vehicle doors and chirps the horn three times (on the third attempt ALL doors will lock and the Passive Entry RKE transmitter can be locked in the vehicle).
ToLockTheVehicle'sDoors
With one of the vehicle's Passive Entry RKE transmitters within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the driver or passenger front door handles, press the door handle LOCK button to lock all doors.

natural_image
Hand pointing at a car door handle (no text or symbols visible)PressTheDoorHandleButtonToLock
Do NOT grab the door handle when pressing the door handle lock button. This could unlock the door(s).

natural_image
Black-and-white illustration of a hand holding a tool inside a circular device, no text or symbols visibleDoNOTGrabTheDoorHandleWhenLocking
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
NOTE:
- After pressing the door handle LOCK button, you must wait two seconds before you can lock or unlock the doors, using either Passive Entry door handle. This is done to allow you to check if the vehicle is locked by pulling the door handle, without the vehicle reacting and unlocking.
- The Passive Entry system will not operate if the RKE transmitter battery is dead.
The vehicle doors can also be locked by using the RKE transmitter lock button or the lock button located on the vehicle's interior door panel.
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE WINDOWS
Power Windows — If Equipped

natural_image
Interior view of a car's dashboard showing the left side with a control panel and a white arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols visible)PowerWindowSwitches
The control on the left front door panel has UP-DOWN switches that give you fingertip control of all power windows. There is a single opening and closing switch on the front passenger door for passenger window control and on the rear doors of the Quad Cab and Crew Cab models. The windows will operate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN or ACC position, and for up to 10 minutes after the ignition is turned OFF or until a front door is opened.
NOTE: The Key Off Power Delay feature will allow the power windows to operate for up to 10 minutes after the ignition is turned OFF. This feature is cancelled when either front door is opened.
WARNING!
Neverleavechildrenunattendedinavehicle.Donot leavetheKeyFobinornearthevehicleorina locationaccessibletochildren, and donotleavethe ignitionofavehicleequippedwithKeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUNmode.Occupants,
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the window while operating the power window switches. Such entrapment may result in serious injury or death.
Auto-Down
Both the driver and front passenger window switch have an Auto-Down feature. Press the window switch past the first detent, release, and the window will go down automatically. To cancel the Auto-Down movement, operate the switch in either the up or down direction and release the switch.
To stop the window from going all the way down during the Auto-Down operation, pull up on the switch briefly.
To open the window part way, press to the first detent and release it when you want the window to stop.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
Auto-UpFeatureWithAnti-PinchProtection (4-DoorModelsDriverAndFrontPassengerDoor Only)—IfEquipped
Lift the window switch fully upward to the second detent, release, and the window will go up automatically.
To stop the window from going all the way up during the Auto Up operation, push down on the switch briefly.
To close the window part way, lift the window switch to the first detent and release when you want the window to stop.
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If the window runs into any obstacle during the auto-closure, it will reverse direction and then go back down. Remove the obstacle and use the window switch again to close the window. Any impact due to rough road conditions may trigger the auto reverse function unexpectedly during auto closure. If this happens, pull the switch lightly to the first detent and hold to close the window manually.
WARNING!
Thereisnoanti-pinchprotectionwhenthewindow isalmostclosed.Besuretoclearalobjectsfromthe windowbeforeclosing.
ResetAuto-Up
Should the Auto Up feature stop working, the window may need to be reset. To reset Auto Up:
- Make sure the door is fully closed.
- Pull the window switch up to close the window completely and continue to hold the switch up for an additional two seconds after the window is closed.
- Push the window switch down firmly to the second detent to open the window completely and continue to hold the switch down for an additional two seconds after the window is fully open.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
WindowLOCKOUTSwitch(4-DoorModelsOnly)
The window LOCKOUT switch on the driver's door allows you to disable the window control on the rear passenger doors. To disable the window controls on the rear passenger doors, press the window LOCK button into the latched or down position. To enable the window controls, press the window LOCK button again and return the switch to the released or up position.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a control panel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)WindowLockoutSwitch

Information Provided by: DEALER
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with the rear windows open, then open the front and rear windows together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting.
OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS
Some of the most important safety features in your vehicle are the restraint systems:
- Three-point lap and shoulder belts for the driver and all passengers
- Front seat belts may incorporate pretensioners that may enhance occupant protection by managing occupant energy during an impact event
- Advanced Front Air Bags for driver and front passenger
- Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) — if equipped
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) - An energy-absorbing steering column and steering wheel
- Knee bolsters/blockers for front seat occupants
- All seat belt systems (except driver's, front center and second row center position) include Automatic Locking Retractors (ALRs), which lock the seat belt webbing into position by extending the belt all the way out and then adjusting the belt to the desired length to restrain a child seat or secure a large item in a seat — if equipped

Please pay close attention to the information in this section. It tells you how to use your restraint system properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as possible.
If you will be carrying children too small for adult-sized seat belts, the seat belts or the Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren (LATCH) feature also can be used to hold infant and child restraint systems. For more information on LATCH, refer to Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren (LATCH).
NOTE: The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage inflator design. This allows the air bag to have different rates of inflation based on several factors, including the severity and type of collision.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
- Children12yearsoldandundershouldalwaysride buckledupinarearseat.
WARNING!
- Neverplacearearfacinginfantseatinfrontofan airbag.AdeployingPassengerAdvancedFrontAir Bagcancausedeathorseriousinjurytoachild12 yearsoryounger,includingachildinarearward facinginfantseat.
- Onlyusearearward-facingchildrestraintina vehiclewitharearseat.
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle seat belt properly (see section on Child Restraints) should be secured in the rear seat in child restraints or belt-positioning booster seats. Older children who do not use child restraints or belt-positioning booster seats should ride properly buckled up in the rear seat. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind them or under their arm.
If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear facing child seat) must ride in the front passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible and use the proper child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”).
You should read the instructions provided with your child restraint to make sure that you are using it properly.
- Alloccupantsshouldalwaysweartheirlapand shoulderbeltsproperly.
- Thedriverandfrontpassengerseatsshouldbe movedbackasfaraspracticaltoallowtheAdvanced FrontAirBagsroomtoinflate.
- Donotleanagainstthedoororwindow.If your vehiclehassideairbags,anddeploymentoccurs,the sideairbagswillinflateforcefullyintothespace betweenyouandthedoor.
- If the air bagsystem in this vehicle need to be modified to accommodate disabled person, contact the Customer Center. Phonenumbers are provided under "If You Need Assistance".

WARNING!
- Relyingontheairbagsalonecouldleadtomore severeinjuriesinacollision.Theairbagswork withyourseatbelttorestrainyouproperly.In somecollisions,theairbagswon'tdeployatall. Alwayswearyourseatbeltseventhoughyouhave airbags.
- Beingtooclosetothesteeringwheelorinstrument panelduringAdvancedFrontAirBagdeployment couldcauseseriousinjury,includingdeath.Air bagsneedroomtoinflate.Sitback,comfortably extendingyourarmstoreachthesteeringwheelor instrumentpanel.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- SupplementalSideAirBagInflatableCurtain (SABIC)andSeat-MountedSideAirBags(SAB)alsoneedroomtoinflate.Donotleanagainstthe doororwindow.Situprightinthecenterofthe seat.
- Inacollision, you and your passengers can suffer much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strik the interior of your vehicle or other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the vehicle. Always besure you and others in your vehicle are buckled up properly.
- BeingtooclosetotheSupplementalSideAirBag InflatableCurtain(SABIC)and/orSeat-Mounted SideAirBag(SAB)duringdeploymentcouldcause youtobeseverelyinjuredorkilled.
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver and cause a collision that includes you. This can happen far away from home or on your own street.
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should be belted at all times.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions except the Quad Cab®, Mega Cab® and Crew Cab front center seating position have combination lap/shoulder belts. The belt webbing retractor is designed to lock during very sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the belt to move freely with you under normal conditions. However, in a collision the belt will lock and reduce the risk of you striking the inside of the vehicle or being thrown out.

Information Provided by. DEALER
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
WARNING!
- Itisdangeroustorideinacargoarea, insideor outsideofavehicle. Inacollision, peopleriding in theseareasaremorelikelytobeseriouslyinjured orkilled.
- Donotallowpeopleorideinanyareaofyour vehiclethatisnotequippedwithseatsandseat belts.
- Besureeveryoneinyourvehicleisinaseatusing aseatbeltproperly.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Wearingaseatbeltincorrectlyisdangerous.Seat beltsaredesignedtogoaroundthelargebonesof yourbody.Thesearethestrongestpartsofyour bodyandtaketheforcesofacollisionthebest.
Wearingyourbeltinthewrongplacecouldmake yourinjuriesinacollisionmuchworse.Youmight sufferinternalinjuries,oryoucouldevenslideout ofpartofthebelt.Followtheseinstructionstowear yourseatbeltsafelyandtokeepyourpassengers safe,too. - Twopeopleshouldneverbebeltedintoasingle seatbelt.Peoplebeltedtogethercancrashintoone anotherinacollision,hurtingoneanotherbadly. Neverusealap/shoulderbeltoralapbeltformore thanoneperson,nomatterwhattheirsize.
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE Lap/ShoulderBeltOperatingInstructions
- Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and adjust the seat.
- The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front seat, next to your arm in the rear seat. Grasp the latch plate and pull out the belt. Slide the latch plate up the webbing as far as necessary to allow the belt to go around your lap.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing seatbelt and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)PullingOutLatchPlateAndWebbing
- When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a "click."

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seat, dashboard, and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)LatchPlateToBuckle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
WARNING!
- Abeltbuckledintothewrongbucklewillnot protectyouproperly. Thelapportioncouldridetoo highonyourbody,possiblycausinginternalinjuries. Alwaysbuckleyourbeltintothebuckle nearestyou.
- Abelthtatistooloosewillnotprotectyouproperly.Inasuddenstopyoucouldmovetoofar forward,increasingthepossibilityofinjury.Wear yourseatbeltsnugly.
(Continued)
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!(Continued)
- Abeltthatiswornunderyourarmisdangerous. Yourbodycouldstriketheinsidesurfacesofthe vehicleinacollision,increasingheadandneck injury.Abeltwornunderthearmcancauseinternalinjuries.Ribsaren'tasstrongasshoulder bones.Wearthebeltoveryourshouldersothat yourstrongestboneswilltaketheforceinacollision.
-
Ashoulderbeltplacedbehindyouwillnotprotect youfrominjuryduringacollision.Youaremore likelytohityourheadinacollisionifyoudonot wearyourshoulderbelt.Thelapandshoulderbelt aremeanttobeusedtogether.
-
Position the lap belt across your thighs, below your abdomen. To remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight, tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug belt reduces the risk of sliding under the belt in a collision.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seat, dashboard, and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)RemovingSlackFromBelt

WARNING!
- Alapbeltworntoohighcanincreasetheriskof internalinjuryinacollision.Thebeltforceswon't beatthestronghipandpelvicbones,butacross yourabdomen.Alwayswearthelapbeltaslowas possibleandkeepitsnug.
-
Atwistedbeltmaynotprotectyouproperly.Ina collision,itcouldevencutintoyou.Besurethebelt isstraight.Ifyoucan'tstraightenabeltinavehicle, takeittoyourauthorizeddealerimmediately and haveitfixed.
-
Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it is comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor will withdraw any slack in the belt.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
- To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle. The belt will automatically retract to its stowed position. If necessary, slide the latch plate down the webbing to allow the belt to retract fully.
WARNING!
Afrayedortornbeltcouldripapartinacollisionand leaveyouwithnoprotection.Inspectthebeltsystem periodically,checkingforcuts,frays,orlooseparts. Damagedpartsmustbereplacedimmediately.Do notdisassembleormodifythesystem.Seatbelt assembliesmustbereplacedafteracollisionifthey havebeendamaged(bentretractor,tornwebbing, etc.)oriftheairbagdeployed.
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
RegularCabFrontCenterThreePointBelt
- The front center seat belt on the Regular Cab may be disconnected to open up utilization of the storage areas behind the front seats. The black latch plate can be detached from the black keyed seat belt buckle located on the inboard side of the passenger seat. Insert the seat belt tongue into the center red slot on the black buckle. The black buckle latch plate can be removed when the seat belt tongue is pressed into the buckle. Allow the retractor to take up the extra webbing, and the buckles will hang vertically from the cab back exit bezel, thus freeing up all the area behind the front seats.

natural_image
Close-up of a hand using a tool to adjust or install a car seatbelt, with a black arrow pointing to the button (no text or symbols visible)DetachingBuckleWithSeatBeltTongue
- To reattach the seat belt to the front center seat, pull the black buckle latch plate forward from the cab back panel and insert it into the black keyed buckle until there is an audible "click". For proper seat belt usage, refer "Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions".


THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt buckle assembly (no text or symbols visible)InsertingLatchPlateInUsePosition

natural_image
Medical procedure image showing a car seatbelt with two arrows indicating specific positioning (no text or symbols present)62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
- Iftheblacklatchandblackbucklearenotproperly connectedwhentheseatbeltisusedbyanoccupant,theseatbeltwillnotbeabletoprovide properrestraintandwillincreasetheriskofinjury inacollision.
- Whenreattachingtheblacklatchandblackbuckle, ensuretheseatbeltwebbingisnottwisted. If the webbingistwisted, followtheprecedingproceduretodetachtheblacklatchandblackbuckle, untwistthewebbing, andreattachtheblacklatch andblackbuckle.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/shoulder belt.
- Position the latch plate as close as possible to the anchor point.
- At about 6 to 12 in (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate, grasp and twist the belt webbing 180 degrees to create a fold that begins immediately above the latch plate.
- Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing. The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of the latch plate.
- Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the folded webbing.
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage
In the front row outboard seats, the shoulder belt can be adjusted upward or downward to help position the belt away from your neck. Press the button located on the upper belt guide, and then move it up or down to the position that fits you best.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing seatbelt and door, with a double-headed arrow indicating vertical motion (no text or symbols)AdjustingUpperShoulderBelt
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
As a guide, if you are shorter than average you will prefer a lower position, and if you are taller than average you will prefer a higher position. When you release the anchorage, try to move it up or down to make sure that it is locked in position.
Center Lap Belts
The center seating position for the Quad Cab®, Mega Cab® and Crew Cab front seat has a lap belt only. To fasten the lap belt, slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a "click". To lengthen the lap belt, tilt the latch plate and pull. To remove slack, pull the loose end of the webbing. Wear the lap belt snug against the hips. Sit back and erect in the seat, then adjust the belt as tightly as is comfortable.

WARNING!
- Alapbeltworntoolooseortoohighisdangerous.
- Abeltworntooloosecanallowyoutoslipdown andunderthebeltinacollision.
- Abelththatistoolooseortoohighwillapplycrash forcestotheabdomen,nottothestrongerhip bones.Ineithercase,theriskofinternalinjuriesis greater.Wearalapbeltlowandsnug.
Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are equipped with either a switchable Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR) or with a Cinching Latchplate which is used to secure a child restraint system. For additional information, refer to “Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child Restraints” section. The chart below defines the type of feature for each seating position.
ForQuadCab®, MegaCab® and CrewCab Only
| DriverCenterPassenger | |||
| First Row N/A | Cinch | ALR | |
| Second Row | ALR | Cinch | ALR |
•N/A — Not Applicable
• ALR — Automatic Locking Retractor
ForStandardCabOnly
| DriverCenter | Passenger | ||
| First Row | N/A | ALR | ALR |
| Second Row | N/A | N/A | N/A |
•N/A — Not Applicable
- ALR — Automatic Locking Retactor
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an ALR and is being used for normal usage:
Only pull the belt webbing out far enough to comfortably wrap around the occupant's mid-section so as to not activate the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a ratcheting sound as the belt retracts. Allow the webbing to retract completely in this case and then carefully pull out only the amount of webbing necessary to comfortably wrap around the occupant's mid-section. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a "click."
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode — If Equipped
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
WhenToUseTheAutomaticLockingMode
Use the Automatic Locking Mode anytime a child safety seat is installed in a seating position that has a belt with this feature. Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained in the rear seat.
HowToEngageTheAutomaticLockingMode
- Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
- Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until the entire belt is extracted.
- Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
HowToDisengageTheAutomaticLockingMode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.

66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
- Thebeltandretractorassemblymustbereplacedif theseatbeltassemblyAutomaticLockingRetractor (ALR)featureoranyotherseatbeltfunctionisnot workingproperlywhencheckedaccordingtothe proceduresintheServiceManual.
- Failuretoreplacethebeltandretractorassembly couldincreaseetheriskofinjuryincollisions.
Energy Management Feature
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an Energy Management feature in the front seating positions to help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.
This safety belt system has a retractor assembly that is designed to release webbing in a controlled manner. This feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on the occupant's chest.
Seat Belt Pretensioners
The seat belts for both front seating positions are equipped with pretensioning devices that are designed to remove slack from the seat belt in the event of a collision. These devices may improve the performance of the seat belt by assuring that the belt is tight around the occupant early in a collision. Pretensioners work for all size occupants, including those in child restraints.
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be worn snugly and positioned properly.
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the pretensioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.

Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System (BeltAlert®)
BeltAlert® is a feature intended to remind the driver and front passenger (if equipped with front passenger BeltAlert®) to fasten their seat belts. The feature is active whenever the ignition is on. If the driver or front seat passenger is unbelted, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn on and remain on until both front seat belts are fastened.
The BeltAlert® warning sequence begins after the vehicle speed is over 5 mph (8 km/h), by blinking the Seat Belt Reminder Light and sounding an intermittent chime. Once the sequence starts, it will continue for the entire duration or until the respective seatbelts are fastened. After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt Reminder Light remains illuminated until the respective seat belts are fastened. The driver should instruct all other occupants to fasten their seat belts. If a front seat belt is
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
unbuckled while traveling at speeds greater than 5 mph (8 km/h), BeltAlert® will provide both audio and visual notification.
The front passenger seat BeltAlert® is not active when the front passenger seat is unoccupied. BeltAlert® may be triggered when an animal or heavy object is on the front passenger seat or when the seat is folded flat (if equipped). It is recommended that pets be restrained in the rear seat (if equipped) in pet harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts, and cargo is properly stowed.
BeltAlert® can be enabled or disabled by your authorized dealer. Chrysler Group LLC does not recommend deactivating BeltAlert®.
NOTE: Although BeltAlert® has been deactivated, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will continue to illuminate while the driver's or front passenger (if equipped with BeltAlert®) seat belt remains unfastened.

68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
We recommend that pregnant women use seat belts throughout their pregnancies. Keeping the mother safe is the best way to keep the baby safe.
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the belt across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible. Keep the belt low so that it does not come across the abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take the force if there is a collision.
Seat Belt Extender
If a seat belt is too short even when fully extended and when the adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage (if equipped) is in its lowest position, your authorized dealer can provide you with a seat belt extender. This extender should be used only if the existing belt is not long enough. When it is not required, remove the extender and store it.
WARNING!
Usingaseatbeltextenderwhennotneededcan increasetheriskofinjuryinacollision.Onlyuse whentheseatbeltisnotlongenoughwhenitisworn lowandsnugandintherecommendedseatingpositions.Removeandstoretheextenderwhennot needed.
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) — Air Bags
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat belt restraint systems. The driver's Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The passenger's Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The words SRS AIRBAG are embossed on the air bag covers.


text_image
Diagram of a car interior showing dashboard, steering wheel, and dashboard controls with numbered labelsAdvancedFrontAirBagAndKneeBolsterLocations
1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags 2 — Knee Bolster
NOTE: The Driver and Front Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags are certified to the new Federal regulations for Advanced Air Bags.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage inflator design. This allows the air bag to have different rates of inflation based on several factors, including the severity and type of collision.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether the driver or front passenger seat belt is fastened. The seat belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags.
This vehicle may also be equipped with Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) to protect the driver, front, and rear passengers sitting next to a window. If the vehicle is equipped with SABIC air bags, they are located above the side windows and their covers are labeled: SRS AIRBAG.

70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) to provide enhanced protection for an occupant during a side impact. The Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags are located in the outboard side of the front seats.
NOTE:
- Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim, but they will open during air bag deployment.
- After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an authorized dealer immediately.
Air Bag System Components
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag system components:
•Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
• Air Bag Warning Light
•Steering Wheel and Column
- Instrument Panel
- Knee Impact Bolsters
- Driver Advanced Front Air Bag
- Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
- Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) — if equipped
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
- Seat Belt Buckle Switch
- Seat Belt Pretensioners
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC), which may receive information from the front impact sensors (if equipped).
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an impact that requires air bag deployment. This low output is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy output is used for more severe collisions.
WARNING!
- Noobjectsshouldbeplacedoverorneartheair bagontheinstrumentpanel, becauseanysuch objectscouldcauseharmifthevehicleisina collisionsevereenoughtocausetheairbagto inflate.
- Donotputanythingonoraroundtheairbag coversorattempttoopenthemmanually.Youmay damagetheairbagsandyoucouldbeinjured because the airbags may no longer be functional. The protective covers for the airbag cushions are designed to open only when the airbags are inflating.
- Donotdrill, cutortamperwiththekneebolsterin anyway.
- Donotmountanyaccessoriestothekneebolster suchasalarmlights, stereos, citizenbandradios, etc.
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
SupplementalSeat-MountedSideAirBags(SAB)
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags may provide enhanced protection to help protect an occupant during a side impact. The Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag is marked with an air bag label sewn into the outboard side of the front seats.

text_image
SRS AIR BAG 022610242SupplementalSeat-MountedSideAirBag
Label

Information Provident by: DEALER
When the air bag deploys, it opens the seam between the front and side of the seat's trim cover. Each air bag deploys independently; a left side impact deploys the left air bag only and a right-side impact deploys the right air bag only.
SupplementalSideAirBagInflatableCurtain (SABIC)—IfEquipped
SABIC air bags may offer side-impact and vehicle roll-over protection to front and rear seat outboard occupants in addition to that provided by the body structure. Each air bag features inflated chambers placed adjacent to the head of each outboard occupant that reduce the potential for side-impact head injuries. The curtains deploy downward, covering both windows on the impact side.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with a black arrow pointing to the SRS (985) button, no text or symbols present.SupplementalSideAirBagInflatableCurtain(SABIC) LabelLocation
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
NOTE:
- Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim, but they will open during air bag deployment.
- Being too close to the SAB and SABIC air bags during deployment could cause you to be severely injured or killed.
- Should a vehicle rollover occur, the pretensioners (if equipped) and/or SAB and SABIC air bags on both sides of the vehicle may deploy.
The system includes side impact sensors that are calibrated to deploy the side air bags during impacts that require air bag occupant protection.
WARNING!
- If your vehicle is equipped with left and right Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain (SABIC), donot stack luggage or other cargroup highenought block the location of the SABIC. The are a where the SABIC is located should remain free from any obstructions.
- Donotuseaccessoryseatcoversorplaceobjects betweenyouandthesideairbags;theperformance couldbeadverselyaffectedand/orobjectscouldbe pushedintoyou,causingseriousinjury.
- If your vehicle is equipped with SABICairbags, donothave any accessory items installed which will alter the roof, including adding as unroof to your vehicle. Donot addroof rack that require permanent attachments (boltsorscrews) for installation on the vehicler of. Donot drill into a thereof of the vehicle for any reason.
SAB and SABIC air bags are a supplement to the seat belt restraint system. Occupants, including children who are up against or very close to SAB or SABIC air bags can be seriously injured or killed. Occupants, especially children, should not lean on or sleep against the door, side windows, or area where the SAB or SABIC air bags inflate, even if they are in an infant or child restraint.
Always sit upright as possible with your back against the seat back, use the seat belts properly, and use the appropriate sized child restraint, infant restraint or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child.
KneeImpactBolsters
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the driver and front passengers, and position front occupants for the best interaction with the Advanced Front Air Bags.
Along with seat belts and pretensioners, Advanced Front Air Bags work with the knee impact bolsters to provide improved protection for the driver and front passenger.
Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls
OccupantRestraintController(ORC)
The ORC is part of a Federally regulated safety system required for this vehicle.
The ORC determines if deployment of the front and/or side air bags in a frontal or side collision is required. A central electronic ORC deploys the Advanced Front Air Bags, SABIC air bags — if equipped, SAB air bags, and front seat belt pretensioners, as required, depending on several factors, including the severity and type of impact.
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional protection by supplementing the seat belts in certain frontal collisions depending on several factors,
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
including the severity and type of collision. Advanced Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk of injury in rear, rollover, or side collisions.
The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all frontal collisions, including some that may produce substantial vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions, truck underrides, and angle offset collisions. On the other hand, depending on the type and location of impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a severe initial deceleration.
The side air bags will not deploy in all side collisions. Side air bag deployment will depend on the severity and type of collision.
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should have deployed.

76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in position, away from an inflating air bag.
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of the air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the START or ON/RUN position. If the key is in the LOCK position, in the ACC position, or not in the ignition, the air bag system is not on and the air bags will not inflate.
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.

Also, the ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds for a self-check when the ignition is first turned on. After the self-check, the Air Bag Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it
turns on the Air Bag Warning Light, either momentarily or continuously. A single chime will sound if the light comes on again after initial startup.
It also includes diagnostics that will illuminate the instrument cluster Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunction is noted that could affect the air bag system. The diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
WARNING!
IgnoringtheAirBagWarningLightinyourinstrumentpanelcouldmeanyouwon'thavetheairbags toprotectyouinacollision.Ifthelightdoesnotcome onasabulbcheckwhentheignitionisfirstturned on,staysonafteryoustartthevehicle,orifitcomes onasyoudrive,haveanauthorizeddealerservicethe airbagsystemimmediately.

DriverAndPassengerAdvancedFrontAirBag InflatorUnits
The Driver and Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag Inflator Units are located in the center of the steering wheel and on the right side of the instrument panel. When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the Advanced Front Air Bags. Different air bag inflation rates are possible, based on several factors, including the collision type and severity. The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper right side of the instrument panel separate and fold out of the way as the air bags inflate to their full size. The air bags fully inflate in about 50 to 70 milliseconds. This is about half of the time it takes to blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The Advanced Front Air Bag gas is vented through the vent holes in the sides of the air bag. In this way, the air bags do not interfere with your control of the vehicle.
SupplementalSeat-MountedSideAirBag(SAB) InflatorUnits
The Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags are designed to activate only in certain side collisions.
The ORC determines if a side collision requires the side air bags to inflate, based on the severity and type of collision.
Based on the severity and type of collision, the side air bag inflator on the crash side of the vehicle may be triggered, releasing a quantity of non-toxic gas. The inflating SAB exits through the seat seam into the space between the occupant and the door. The SAB fully inflate in about 10 milliseconds. The side air bag moves at a very high speed and with such a high force that it could injure

78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
you if you are not seated properly, or if items are positioned in the area where the side air bag inflates. This especially applies to children.
SupplementalSideAirBagInflatableCurtain (SABIC)InflatorUnits—IfEquipped
During collisions where the impact is confined to a particular area of the side of the vehicle, the ORC may deploy the SABIC air bags, depending on the severity and type of collision. In these events, the ORC will deploy the SABIC only on the impact side of the vehicle.
A quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the side curtain air bag. The inflating side curtain air bag pushes the outside edge of the headliner out of the way and covers the window. The air bag inflates in about 30 milliseconds (about one-quarter of the time that it takes to blink your eyes) with enough force to injure you if you are not belted and seated properly, or if items are positioned in the area where the side curtain air bag inflates. This especially applies to children. The side curtain air bag is only about 3-1/2 in (9 cm) thick when it is inflated.
Because air bag sensors estimate deceleration over time, vehicle speed and damage are not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should have deployed.
NOTE: In a rollover the pretensioners, and/or SAB and SABIC air bags may deploy on both sides of the vehicle.
FrontAndSideImpactSensorsAndVehicle Rollover
In front and side impacts, impact sensors can aid the ORC in determining appropriate response to impact events.
FrontAndSideImpactSensors
In front and side impacts, impact sensors can aid the ORC indetermining appropriate response to impact events.

EnhancedAccidentResponseSystem
In the event of an impact causing air bag deployment, if the communication network remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending on the nature of the event the ORC will determine whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
- Cut off fuel to the engine.
- Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or until the ignition key is turned off.
- Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as the battery has power or until the ignition key is removed.
- Unlock the doors automatically.
In order to reset the Enhanced Accident Response System functions after an event, the ignition switch must be changed from IGN ON/RUN to IGN OFF.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 79
IfADeploymentOccurs
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate immediately after deployment.
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with the air bag system.
If you do have a collision which deploys the air bags, any or all of the following may occur:
- The nylon air bag material may sometimes cause abrasions and/or skin reddening to the driver and front passenger as the air bags deploy and unfold. The abrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those you might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium floor. They are not caused by contact with chemicals. They are not permanent and normally heal quickly.

80 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
However, if you haven't healed significantly within a few days, or if you have any blistering, see your doctor immediately.
- As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer's instructions for cleaning.
Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have deployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air bags will not be in place to protect you.
WARNING!
Deployedairbagsandseatbeltpretensionerscannot protectyouinanothercollision.Havetheairbags, seatbeltpretensioners,andthefrontseatbeltretractorassembliesreplacedbyanauthorizeddealerimmediately.Also,havetheOccupantRestraintController(ORC)systemservicedaswell.
MaintainingYourAirBagSystem
WARNING!
- Modificationstoanypartoftheairbagsystem couldcauseittofailwhenyouneedit.Youcould beinjurediftheairbagsystemisnotthereto protectyou.Donotmodifythecomponentsor wiring,includingaddinganykindofbadgesor stickerstothesteeringwheelhubtrimcoverorthe upperrightsideoftheinstrumentpanel.Donot modifythefrontbumper,vehiclebodystructure,or addaftermarketsidestepsorrunningboards.
- Itisdangeroustotrytorepairanypartoftheair bagsystemyourself.Besuretotellanyonewho worksonyourvehiclethatithasanairbagsystem.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 81
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotattempttomodifyanypartofyourairbag system. The airbag may inflate accidentally or may not function properly if modifications are made. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any air bags systems service. If your seat, including your trim cover and cushion, need to be serviced in any way (including removal or loosening / tightening of seat attachment bolts), tak the vehicle to your authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved seat accessories maybe used. If it is necessary to modify the airbag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
82 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
AirBagWarningLight

You will want to have the air bags ready to inflate for your protection in a collision. The Air Bag Warning Light monitors the internal circuits and interconnecting wiring associated with air bag system electrical components. While the air bag system is designed to be maintenance free, if any of the following occurs, have an authorized dealer service the air bag system immediately.
- The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is first turned to the ON/RUN position.
- The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to eight second interval.
- The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or remains on while driving.
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. The air bags may not be ready to inflate for your protection. Promptly check the fuse block for blown fuses. Refer to the label located on the inside of the fuse block cover for the proper air bag fuses. See your authorized dealer if the fuse is good.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:

- How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
- Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;
- How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
- How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
NOTE:EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 83
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR.
Child Restraints
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all times, including babies and children. Every state in the United States, and every Canadian province, requires that small children ride in proper restraint systems. This is the law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.
Children 12 years or younger should ride properly buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seats rather than in the front.

84 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
There are different sizes and types of restraints for children from newborn size to the child almost large enough for an adult safety belt. Always check the child seat Owner's Manual to make sure you have the correct seat for your child. Carefully read and follow all the instructions and warnings in the child restraint Owner's Manual and on all the labels attached to the car seat.
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety Standards. You should also make sure that you can install it in the vehicle where you will use it.
NOTE:
- For additional information, refer to www.seatcheck.org or call 1–866–SEATCHECK. Canadian residents should refer to Transport Canada's website for additional information:
- http://www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/safedrivers-childsafety-index-53.htm
WARNING!
Inacollision, an unrestrained child can become a projectile inside the vehicle. The forcerequired to holdevenan infant your lap could become so great that you could no hold the child, no matter how strongly you are. The child and others could be badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle should be in proper restraint for the child's size.
SummaryOfRecommendationsForRestrainingChildrenInVehicles
| ChildSize,Height,WeightOrAgeRecommendedTypeOfChildRestraint | ||
| Infants and Toddlers | Children who are two years old or younger and who have not reached the height or weight limits of their child restraint | Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible Child Restraint, facing rearward in the rear seat of the vehicle |
| Small Children Children who are at least two years old or who have out-grown the height or weight limit of their rear-facing child restraint | Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a five-point Harness, facing forward in the rear seat of the vehicle | |
| Larger Children Children who have out-grown their forward-facing child restraint, but are too small to properly fit the vehicle's seat belt | Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat of the vehicle | |
| Children Too Large for Child Restraints | Children 12 years old or younger, who have out-grown the height or weight limit of their booster seat | Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat of the vehicle |
86 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
InfantsAndChildRestraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rearward-facing in the vehicle until they are two years old or until they reach either the height or weight limit of their rear facing child safety seat. Two types of child restraints can be used rearward-facing: infant carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rearward-facing in the vehicle. It is recommended for children from birth until they reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier. Convertible child seats can be used either rearward-facing or forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child seats often have a higher weight limit in the rearward-facing direction than infant carriers do, so they can be used rearward-facing by children who have outgrown their infant carrier but are still less than at least two years old. Children should remain rearward-facing until they reach the highest weight or height allowed by their convertible child seat.
WARNING!
- Neverplacearearfacinginfantseatinfrontofan airbag.AdeployingPassengerAdvancedFrontAir Bagcancausedeathorseriousinjurytoachild12 yearsoryounger,includingachildinarearward facinginfantseat.
- Onlyusearearward-facingchildrestraintina vehiclewitharearseat.
OlderChildrenAndChildRestraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forward-facing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height allowed by the child seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
All children whose weight or height is above the forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle's seat belts fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over the vehicle's seat cushion while the child's back is against the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
- Improperinstallationcanleadtofailureofan infantorchildrestraint.Itcouldcomelooseina collision.Thechildcouldbebadlyinjuredor killed.Followthechildrestraintmanufacturer's directionsexactlywheninstallinganinfantor childrestraint.
(Continued)
88 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!(Continued)
- Afterachildrestraintisinstalledinthevehicle,do notmovethevehicleseatforwardorrearward becauseitcanloosenthechildrestraintattachments.Removethechildrestraintbeforeadjusting thevehicleseatposition.Whenthevehicleseathas beenadjusted,reinstallthechildrestraint.
- When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in the vehicle with these seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Don't leave it loose in the vehicle. In sudden stop or accident, it could strike the occupants or seat backs and cause serious personal injury.
ChildrenTooLargeForBoosterSeats
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend over the front of the seat when their back is against the seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the vehicle's seat belt alone:
- Can the child sit all the way back against the back of the vehicle seat?
- Do the child's knees bend comfortably over the front of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the way back?
- Does the shoulder belt cross the child's shoulder between their neck and arm?
- Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching the child's thighs and not their stomach?
- Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 89
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check belt fit periodically and make sure the seat belt buckle is latched. A child’s squirming or slouching can move the belt out of position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or use a booster seat to position the seat belt on the child correctly.
WARNING!
Neverallowachildtoputtheshoulderbeltunderan armorbehindtheirback.Inacrash,theshoulderbelt willnotprotectachildproperly,whichmayresultin seriousinjuryordeath.Achildmustalwayswear boththelapandshoulderportionsoftheseatbelt correctly.
RecommendationsForAttachingChildRestraints—QuadCab®/CrewCab
| RestraintTypeCombined | Weightofthe Child+Child Restraint | Useanyattachmentmethodshownwithan“X”Below | |||
| LATCH-LowerAnchors Only | SeatBeltOnlyLATCH-LowerAnchors +TopTether Anchor | SeatBelt+Top TetherAnchor | |||
| Rear-Facing Child Restraint | Up to 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | X | ||
| Rear-Facing Child Restraint | More than 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | |||
| Forward-Facing Child Restraint | Up to 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | X | ||
| Forward-Facing Child Restraint | More than 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | |||
RecommendationsForAttachingChildRestraints—StandardCab,MegaCab®
| RestraintTypeCombined | Weightofthe Child+Child Restraint | Useanyattachmentmethodshownwithan“X”Below | |||
| LATCH-LowerAnchors Only | SeatBeltOnlyLATCH-LowerAnchors +TopTether Anchor | SeatBelt+Top TetherAnchor | |||
| Rear-Facing Child Restraint | Up to 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | X | ||
| Rear-Facing Child Restraint | More than 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | |||
| Forward-Facing Child Restraint | Up to 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | X | ||
| Forward-Facing Child Restraint | More than 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | X | |||
92 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LowerAnchorsAndTethersForChildren(LATCH) RestraintSystem

Anchor. Tether. LATCH
The next generation of child safety.
022668173
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCH-equipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the seating position. These anchorages are used to install LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle's seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the following table for more information.

Information Provided by DEALER
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 93
LATCHPositionsForInstallingChildRestraintsInThisVehicle

natural_image
Top-down view of a car showing its front and rear views with no visible text or symbols0226003585
StandardCab
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol

natural_image
Top-down architectural rendering of a car showing front, rear, and side views with no visible text or symbols0226003587
QuadCab®/CrewCabFullBench
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol

Information Provided by: DEALER
94 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Top-down architectural rendering of a pickup truck showing front, rear, and side views with no visible text or symbols.0226003588
QuadCab®/MegaCab®/CrewCabSplitBench
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol

Information Provided by. DEALER
QuadCab®/CrewCab
| What is the weight limit (child's weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the LATCH anchorage system to attach the child restraint? | 65 lbs (29.5 kg) Use | the LATCH anchorage system until the combined weight of the child and the child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt and tether anchor instead of the LATCH system once the combined weight is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg). |
| Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat belt be used together to attach a rear-facing or forward-facing child restraint? | No Do not use | the seat belt when you use the LATCH anchorage system to attach a rear-facing or forward-facing child restraint. |
| Can a child seat be installed in the center position using the inner LATCH lower anchorages (Full Bench Only)? | No Use the seat belt and tether anchor to install a child seat in the center seating position in vehicles equipped with a Full Bench rear seat. | |
96 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
| Can two child restraints be attached using a common lower LATCH anchorage? | No Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with two or more child restraints. If the center position does not have dedicated LATCH lower anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child seat in the center position next to a child seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position. |
| Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the back of the front passenger seat? | Yes The child seat may touch the back of the front passenger seat if the child restraint manufacturer also allows contact. See your child restraint owner’s manual for more information. |
| Can the head restraints be removed? No |
MegaCab®/StandardCab
| What is the weight limit (child's weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the LATCH anchorage system to attach the child restraint? | 65 lbs (29.5 kg) Use the LATCH anchorage system until the combined weight of the child and the child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt alone instead of the LATCH anchorage system once the combined weight is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg). |
| Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat belt be used together to attach a rear-facing or forward-facing child restraint? | No Do not use the seat belt when you use the LATCH anchorage system to attach a rear-facing or forward-facing child restraint. |
98 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
| Can two child restraints be attached using a common lower LATCH anchorage? | No Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with two or more child restraints. If the center position does not have dedicated LATCH lower anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child seat in the center position next to a child seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position. |
| Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the back of the front passenger seat? | Yes The child seat may touch the back of the front passenger seat if the child restraint manufacturer also allows contact. See your child restraint owner’s manual for more information. |
| Can the head restraints be removed? | No |
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 99
LocatingTheLATCHAnchorage—Quad Cab®/MegaCab®/CrewCab

The lower anchorages are round bars that are found at the rear of the seat cushion where it meets the seatback. They are just visible when you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint. You will easily feel them if you run your finger along the gap between the seatback and seat cushion.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seat with visible seatbelt and two black arrows pointing to the seat area (no text or symbols)QuadCab®/MegaCab®/CrewCabRearOutboardSeats DriverSide

Information Provided by: DEALER
100 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE LocatingTheLATCHAnchorage

In addition, Regular Cab models have tether strap anchorages behind the front center and right seats. Quad Cab®, Mega Cab® and Crew
Cab models have tether strap anchorages located behind each of the rear seats.

text_image
Diagram of car interior showing seatbelt and seatbelt connector with numbered labelsRegularCabTetherStrapMounting
1 — Tether Strap Hook
2 — Tether Strap to Child Restraint
3 — Tether Anchor

Information Provided by
DEALER
第七节 以二轮安排

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing multiple car door lockers with arrows pointing to them (no text or symbols on the lockers themselves)MegaCab®TetherStrapMounting(BehindCovers) LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side. Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some rear-facing infant restraints will also be equipped with a
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 101
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
CenterSeatLATCH—StandardCab/Quad Cab®/CrewCabFullBench
Do not install a child restraint in the center position using the LATCH system. Use the seat belt and tether anchor to install a child seat in the center seating position.
WARNING!
Neverusethesameloweranchoragetoattachmore thanonechildrestraint.Pleasereferto"Installing TheLATCHChildRestraintSystem"fortypical installationinstructions.
Always follow the directions of the child restraint manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child restraint systems will be installed as described here.

102 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CenterSeatLATCH—QuadCab®/Mega Cab®/CrewCabSplitBench
If a child restraint installed in the center position blocks the seat belt webbing or buckle for the outboard position, do not use that outboard position. If a child seat in the center position blocks the outboard LATCH anchors or seat belt, do not install a child seat in that outboard position.
WARNING!
Neverusethesameloweranchoragetoattachmore thanonechildrestraint.Pleasereferto"Installing TheLATCHChildRestraintSystem"fortypical installationinstructions.
Always follow the directions of the child restraint manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child restraint systems will be installed as described here.
ToInstallALATCH-compatibleChildRestraint
- If the selected seating position has a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat belt following the instructions below. See the section "Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat Belt" to check what type of seat belt each seating position has.
- Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the tether strap of the child seat so that you can more easily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle anchorages.
-
Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for that seating position. For some second row seats, you may need to recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its rear-most position to make room for the child seat. You may also move the front seat forward to allow more room for the child seat.
-
Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child restraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seating position.
- If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the top tether anchorage. See the section "Installing Child Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage" for directions to attach a tether anchor.
- Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack in the straps according to the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
- Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm) in any direction.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
103
HowToStowAnUnusedALRSeatbelt
When using the LATCH attaching system to install a child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being used by other occupants or being used to secure child restraints. An unused belt could injure a child if they play with it and accidentally lock the seatbelt retractor. Before installing a child restraint using the LATCH system, buckle the seat belt behind the child restraint and out of the child's reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with the child restraint installation, instead of buckling it behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the child restraint belt path and then buckle it. Do not lock the seatbelt. Remind all children in the vehicle that the seat belts are not toys and that they should not play with them.

104 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
- Improperinstallationofachildrestrainttothe LATCHanchoragescanleadtofailureofaninfant orchildrestraint.Thechildcouldbebadlyinjured orkilled.Followthemanufacturer'sdirectionsexactlywheninstallinganinfantorchildrestraint.
- Childrestraintanchoragesaredesignedtowith-standonlythoseloadsimposedbycorrectly-fitted childrestraints.Undernocircumstancesaretheyto beusedforadultseatbelts,harnesses,orfor attachingotheritemsorequipmenttothevehicle.
InstallingChildRestraintsUsingTheVehicleSeat Belt
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) that is designed to keep the lap portion of the seat belt tight around the child restraint so that it is not necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can be “switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back into the retractor. For additional information on ALR, refer to the “Automatic Locking Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints.”
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 105
Lap/ShoulderBeltSystemsforInstallingChildRestraintsinthisVehicle

text_image
ALR° ALR°022670224
StandardCab

text_image
ALR Cruching Latchplate ALR Cruching Latchplate ALR022670220
QuadCab®/MegaCab®/CrewCab

Information Provided by: DEALER
106 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
QuadCab®/CrewCab
| What is the weight limit (child's weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the Tether Anchor with the seat belt to attach a forward facing child restraint? | Weight limit of the Child Restraint | Always use the tether anchor when using the seat belt to install a forward facing child restraint, up to the recommended weight limit of the child restraint. |
| Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the back of the front passenger seat? | Yes Contact between the front passenger seat and the child restraint is allowed, if the child restraint manufacturer also allows contact. | |
| Can the head restraints be removed? No | ||
| Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten the seat belt against the belt path of the child restraint? | Yes In positions with cinching latch plates (CINCH), the buckle stalk may be twisted up to 3 full turns. Do not twist the buckle stalk in a seating position with an ALR retractor. | |
MegaCab®/StandardCab
| What is the weight limit (child's weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the Tether Anchor with the seat belt to attach a forward facing child restraint? | 65 lbs (29.5 kg) | The Tether Anchor can be used with the seat belt until the combined weight of the child and the child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt without the Tether Anchor once the combined weight is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg). |
| Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the back of the front passenger seat? | Yes Contact between the front passenger seat and the child restraint is allowed, if the child restraint manufacturer also allows contact. | |
| Can the head restraints be removed? No | ||
| Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten the seat belt against the belt path of the child restraint? | Yes In positions with cinching latch plates (CINCH), the buckle stalk may be twisted up to 3 full turns. Do not twist the buckle stalk in a seating position with an ALR retractor. | |
108 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
InstallingAChildRestraintWithASwitchable AutomaticLockingRetractor(ALR)
- Place the child seat in the center of the seating position. For some second row seats, you may need to recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its rear-most position to make room for the child seat. You may also move the front seat forward to allow more room for the child seat.
- Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor to pass it through the seat belt path of the child restraint. Do not twist the belt webbing in the seat belt path.
-
Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a "click".
-
Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight against the child seat.
- To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of the seat belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is now in the Automatic Locking mode.
- Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is locked, you should not be able to pull out any webbing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
-
Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the lap portion around the child restraint while you push the child restraint rearward and downward into the vehicle seat.
-
If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether strap. See the section "Installing Child Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage" for directions to attach a tether anchor.
- Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by pulling back and forth on the child seat at the seat belt path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm) in any direction.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the seat belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 109
Installing AChildRestraintWithACinching LatchPlate(CINCH)—IfEquipped
- Place the child seat in the center of the seating position. For some second row seats, you may need to recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its rear-most position to make room for the child seat. You may also move the front seat forward to allow more room for the car seat.
- Next, pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint. Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
- Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a "click".
110 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
- Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the lap portion around the child restraint while you push the child restraint rearward and downward into the vehicle seat.
- If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether strap. Refer to "Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether Anchorage" for directions to attach a tether anchor.
- Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm) in any direction.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
If the buckle or the cinching latch plate is too close to the belt path opening of the child restraint, you may have trouble tightening the seat belt. If this happens, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle and twist the short buckle-end belt up to three full turns to shorten it. Insert the latch plate into the buckle with the release button facing out, away from the child restraint. Repeat steps 4 to 6, above, to complete the installation of the child restraint.
If the belt still cannot be tightened after you shorten the buckle, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle, turn the buckle around one half turn, and insert the latch plate into the buckle again. If you still cannot make the child restraint installation tight, try a different seating position.

InstallingChildRestraintsUsingTheTopTether Anchorage
RegularandMegaCab®Trucks: In the regular cab truck, the top tether anchorages are located behind the center and right passenger seats. In the mega cab truck, the top tether anchorages are located behind each rear seating position. There is a plastic cover over each anchorage. To attach the tether strap of the child restraint:
- Place the child restraint on the seat and adjust the tether strap so that it will reach over the seat back, under the head restraint and to the tether anchor directly behind the seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 111

text_image
Diagram of car interior showing seatbelt and seatbelt connector with numbered labelsRegularCabTetherStrapMounting
1 — Tether Strap Hook
2 — Tether Strap to Child Restraint
3 — Tether Anchor
112 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
- Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path between the anchorage and the child seat. The tether strap should go between the head restraint posts underneath the head restraint. You may need to adjust the head restraint to the upward position to pass the tether strap underneath the head restraint and between its posts.
- Lift the cover (if so equipped), and attach the hook to the square opening in the sheet metal. Tighten the tether strap according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing multiple car door lockers with arrows pointing to the door (no text or symbols visible)MegaCab®TetherStrapMounting
WARNING!
Neverplacearearfacinginfantseatinfrontofanair bag.AdeployingPassengerAdvancedFrontAirBag cancausedeathorseriousinjurytoachild12yearsor younger,includingachildinarearwardfacinginfant seat.
QuadCab®orCrewCabTrucks: The top tether anchorages in this vehicle are tether strap loops located between the rear glass and the back of the rear seat. There is a tether strap loop located behind each seating position. Follow the steps below to attach the tether strap of the child restraint.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 113
RightorLeftOutboardSeats:
- Raise the head restraint and reach between the rear seat and rear glass to access the tether strap loop.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest, seat, and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)HeadRestraintInRaisedPosition
114 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and seatbelt, with a black arrow pointing to the backrest (no text or symbols)TetherStrapLoopWithCenterHeadRestraintInRaised Position
-
Place a child restraint on the seat and adjust the tether strap so that it will reach over the seat back, under the head restraint, through the tether strap loop behind the seat and over to the tether strap loop behind the center seat.
-
Pass the tether strap hook under the head restraint behind the child seat, though the tether strap loop behind the seat and over to the center tether strap loop.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest seat and seatbelt, with a black arrow pointing to the seat (no text or symbols on the main body)TetherStrapThroughOutboardTetherStrapLoop

- Attach the hook to the center tether strap loop (see diagram). Tighten the tether strap according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and seatbelt, with two arrows pointing to the side of the seat (no text or symbols present)TetherStrapThroughOutboardTetherStrapLoopAnd AttachedToCenterTetherStrapLoop
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 115
NOTE: If there are child seats in both of the outboard (left and right) seating positions, the tether strap hooks of both child seats should be connected to the center tether strap loop. This is the correct way to tether two outboard child seats.

Information Provident by: DEALER
116 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CenterSeat:
- Raise the head restraint and reach between the rear seat and rear glass to access the tether strap loop.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and seatbelt, with a black arrow pointing to the backrest (no text or symbols on the main body)TetherStrapLoopWithHeadRestraintInRaised Position
-
Place a child restraint on the seat and adjust the tether strap so that it will reach over the seat back, under the head restraint, through the tether strap loop behind the seat and over to the tether strap loop behind either the right or left outboard seat.
-
Pass the tether strap hook under the head restraint behind the child seat, though the tether strap loop behind the seat and over to the right or left outboard tether strap loop.


natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seat, driver's seat, and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 117

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and headrests with two arrows pointing to the seat (no text or symbols)TetherStrapThroughCenterTetherStrapLoopTetherStrapThroughCenterTetherStrapLoopAnd
4. Attach the hook to the outboard tether strap loop (see diagram). Tighten the tether strap according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions.
AttachedToOutboardTetherStrapLoop
118 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE InstallingThreeChildRestraints:
- Place a child restraint on each outboard rear seat. Route the tether straps following the directions for right and left seating positions, above.
- Attach both hooks to the center tether strap loop, but do not tighten the straps yet.
- Place a child restraint on the center rear seat. Route the tether strap following the directions for the center seating position, above.
- Attach the hook to the outboard tether strap loop.
- Tighten the tether straps according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions, tightening the right and left tether straps before the center tether strap.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and seatbelt, with three arrows pointing to the backrest (no text or symbols on the car itself)LeftOutboardAndCenterSeatingPositionShown
WARNING!
- Anincorrectlyanchoredtetherstrapcouldleadto increasedheadmotionandpossibleinjurytothe child.Useonlytheanchoragepositiondirectly behindthechildseattosecureachildrestrainttop tetherstrap.
- If your vehicle is equipped with a split rearseat, makes sure the ether strap does not slip into the opening between these at backs as you remove slack in the strap.
TransportingPets
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet. An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly injured, or injure a passenger during panic braking or in a collision.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 119
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
A long break-in period is not required for the engine and drivetrain (transmission and axle) in your vehicle.
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km). After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or 55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable.
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within the limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good break-in. Wide-open throttle acceleration in low gear can be detrimental and should be avoided.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil changes should be consistent with anticipated climate conditions under which vehicle operations will occur. For the recommended viscosity and quality grades, refer to "Maintenance Procedures" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle".
CAUTION!
NeveruseNon-DetergentOilorStraightMineralOil intheengineordamagemayresult.
NOTE:A new engine may consume some oil during its first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This should be considered a normal part of the break-in and not interpreted as an indication of difficulty.
SAFETY TIPS
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO AREA.
WARNING!
- Donotleavechildrenoranimalsinsideparked vehiclesinhotweather.Interiorheatbuild-upmay causeseriousinjuryordeath.
- Itisextremelydangeroustorideinacargoarea, insideoroutsideofvehicle.Inacollision,people ridingintheseareasaremorelikelytobeseriously injuredorkilled.
- Donotallowpeopleorideinanyareaofyour vehiclethatisnotequippedwithseatsandseat belts.
- Besureeveryoneinyourvehicleisinaseatand usingaseatbeltproperly.
Exhaust Gas
WARNING!
Exhaustgasescaninjureorkill. They contain carbon monoxide(CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathingitcanmakeyouunconsciousandcan eventuallypoisonyou.Toavoidbreathing(CO), followthesesafetytips:
- Donotruntheengineinaclosedgarageorin confinedareasanylongerthanneededtomove yourvehicleinoroutofthearea.
- If you are required to drivewith the trunk/lift gate/reardors open, makes sure that all windows are closed and the climate control BLOWER switch this set at high speed. DONOT usethere circulation mode.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 121
WARNING!(Continued)
- Ifitisnecessarytositinaparkedvehiclewiththe engineerunning,adjustyourheatingorcooling controlstoforceoutsideairintothevehicle.Setthe blowerathighspeed.
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust system.
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition, inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.

122 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The Vehicle
SeatBelts
Inspect the seat belt system periodically, checking for cuts, frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system.
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding seat belt or retractor condition, replace the seat belt.
AirBagWarningLight

The light should come on and remain on for four to eight seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first turned ON. If the light is not lit during starting, see your authorized dealer. If the light stays on, flickers, or comes on while driving, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
Defroster
Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place the blower control on high speed. You should be able to feel the air directed against the windshield. See your authorized dealer for service if your defroster is inoperable.
FloorMatSafetyInformation
Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 123
WARNING!
Pedalsthatcannotmovefreelycancauselossof vehiclecontrolandincreasetheriskofseriouspersonalinjury.
- Alwaysmakesurethatfloormatsareproperly attachedtothefloormatfasteners.
- Neverplaceorinstallfloormatsorotherfloor coveringsinthevehiclethatcannotbeproperly securedtopreventthemfrommovingandinterferingwiththepedalsortheabilitytocontrolthe vehicle.
- Neverputfloormatsorotherfloorcoveringsontop ofalreadyinstalledfloormats.Additionalfloor matsandothercoveringswillreducethesizeofthe pedalareaandinterferewiththepedals.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Checkmountingofmatsonaregularbasis.Always properlyreinstallandsecurefloormatsthathave beenremovedforcleaning.
- Alwaysmakesurethatobjectscannotfallintothe driverfootwellwhilethevehicleismoving.Objectscanbecometrappedunderthebrakepedal andacceleratorpedalcausingalossofvehicle control.
- Ifrequired,mountingpostsmustbeproperlyinstalled,ifnotequippedfromthefactory. Failuretoproperlyfollowfloormatinstallationor mountingcancauseinterferencewiththebrake pedalandacceleratorpedaloperationcausinglossof controlofthevehicle.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
124 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside The Vehicle
Tires
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and bulges. Check the wheel nuts for tightness. Check the tires (including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument panel.
DoorLatches
Check for positive closing, latching, and locking.
FluidLeaks
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel, engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid (if equipped), or brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause should be located and corrected immediately.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
■MIRRORS....132
□Inside Day/Night Mirror — If Equipped . . . 132
□Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .132
□Automatic Dimming Mirror With Rear View Camera Display — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
□Outside Mirrors....139
□ Outside Mirrors Folding Feature .....140
□Tilt Mirrors In Reverse — If Equipped . . . . . . .140
□Power Folding Outside Mirrors — If Equipped....141
□Power Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
□Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .144
□Driver's Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped .....144
□Illuminated Vanity Mirror — If Equipped . . . .144
□“Slide-On-Rod” Features Of Sun Visor — If Equipped....145
□Trailer Towing Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . .146
■ SEATS .....147
□Driver's Power Seat — If Equipped . . . . . . . .147
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
□Passenger's Power Seat — If Equipped . . . . . .149
□Power Lumbar — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
□Heated Seats — If Equipped .....150
□Ventilated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
□Manual Seat Adjuster — If Equipped. . . . . . . .154
☐40-20-40 Front Bench Seat — If Equipped . . . .156
□Mega Cab® Rear Seat Features .....156
□Head Restraints....160
■DRIVER MEMORY SEAT — IF EQUIPPED ....162
□Programming The Memory Feature .....163
□Linking And Unlinking The Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter To Memory....164
□Memory Position Recall....165
□Easy Entry/Exit Seat....166
■TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD .....168
■LIGHTS....169
□Headlights....170
□Automatic Headlights — If Equipped . . . . . . .170
□Headlights On With Wipers (Available With Automatic Headlights Only)....171
□Daytime Running Lights
(DRL) — If Equipped .....172
□Headlight Delay....172
□Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control — If Equipped....173
□Parking Lights And Panel Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
□ Fog Lights — If Equipped .....174
□Lights-On Reminder....175
□Battery Saver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
□Interior Lights....175
□Cargo Light....178
□Multifunction Lever....179
□Turn Signals....179
□Lane Change Assist....180
□Flash-To-Pass....180
□High/Low Beam Switch....180
■WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS .....180
□Windshield Wipers....180
□Windshield Wiper Operation .....181
□ Intermittent Wiper System .....181
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
□Windshield Washers....181
□Mist Feature....182
□Rain Sensing Wipers — If Equipped .....183
■TILT STEERING COLUMN....184
■ HEATED STEERING WHEEL — IF EQUIPPED ..185
■DRIVER ADJUSTABLE PEDALS — IF EQUIPPED....187
■ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL .....189
□To Activate....190
□ To Set A Desired Speed .....190
□To Deactivate .191
□To Resume Speed....191
□To Vary The Speed Setting .....191
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
□To Accelerate For Passing....192
■PARKSENSE® REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED....193
□ParkSense® Sensors....193
□ParkSense® Warning Display .....194
□ParkSense® Display....194
□Enabling And Disabling ParkSense®. . . . . . .198
□Service The ParkSense® Rear Park Assist System....198
□Cleaning The ParkSense® System . . . . . . . . . . .199
□ParkSense® System Usage Precautions. . . . . . .199
■PARKSENSE® FRONT AND REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED....202
□ ParkSense® Sensors....202
□ParkSense® Warning Display .....203
□ParkSense® Display .....203
□Enabling And Disabling Front And/Or Rear ParkSense®. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
□Service The ParkSense® Park Assist System . . .206
□Cleaning The ParkSense® System .....207
□ParkSense® System Usage Precautions. . . . . . .207
■PARKVIEW® REAR BACK UP CAMERA — IF EQUIPPED....210
■OVERHEAD CONSOLE — IF EQUIPPED . . . .212
□Courtesy/Reading Lights....213
■GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED . . .214
□Before You Begin Programming HomeLink® .215
□ Programming A Rolling Code .....216
□Programming A Non-Rolling Code....218
□Canadian/Gate Operator Programming . . . . .219
□Using HomeLink®. .221
□Security....221
□Troubleshooting Tips....221
□General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
■POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED .....224
□Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode .....225
□Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode .....225
□Opening Sunroof — Express .....225
□Closing Sunroof — Express. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
□Pinch Protect Feature .....226
□ Venting Sunroof — Express .....226
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
□Sunshade Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
□Wind Buffeting....226
□Sunroof Maintenance....227
□Ignition Off Operation....227
■ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS .....227
■CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF EQUIPPED....231
■POWER INVERTER — IF EQUIPPED .....232
■CUPHOLDERS....233
□Front Seat Cupholders (40–20–40 Seats) . . . . . .233
□Front Instrument Panel Cupholders — Floor Mounted Shifter....234
□Rear Cupholder — Quad Cab®. . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
□ Rear Cupholder — Crew Cab .....235
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
■STORAGE....236
□Glove Compartment....236
□Door Storage. 238
□Center Storage Compartment — If Equipped . .239
☐Second Row In-Floor Storage Bin — If Equipped .....241
□Seatback Storage....242
□Storage (Regular Cab) .....242
□Storage and Seats (Crew Cab) .....243
□Plastic Grocery Bag Retainers (Regular Cab Models)....244
■REAR WINDOW FEATURES .....244
□Rear Window Defroster....244
□Power Sliding Rear Window — If Equipped ..245
□ Manual Sliding Rear Window — If Equipped .246
■FOLD FLAT LOAD FLOOR — IF EQUIPPED . .246
■PICKUP BOX....248
□Cargo Camera — If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
□Turning Cargo Camera On Or Off — With Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN....250
■RAMBOX® — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
□RamBox® Integrated Box Side Storage Bins . . .251
□Locking And Unlocking RamBox® . . . . . . . . .254
□RamBox® Safety Warning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
□Bed Extender — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
□Bed Rail Tie-Down System....262
■SLIDE-IN CAMPERS .....264
□Camper Applications .....264

■EASY-OFF TAILGATE....265
□Disconnecting the Rear Camera or Remote Keyless Entry — If Equipped .....265
□Removing The Tailgate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
□Locking Tailgate....267
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
■ TRI-FOLD TONNEAU COVER — IF EQUIPPED. . . . .268
□Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Removal .....268
□Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Installation. . . . . . . . .272
□Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Cleaning .....278
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
MIRRORS
Inside Day/Night Mirror — If Equipped
A single ball joint mirror is provided in the vehicle. It is a twist on mirror that has a fixed position at the windshield. The mirror installs on the windshield button with a counterclockwise rotation and requires no tools for mounting. The mirror head can be adjusted up, down, left, and right for various drivers. The mirror should be adjusted to center on the view through the rear window.
Headlight glare from vehicles behind you can be reduced by moving the small control under the mirror to the night position (toward the rear of the vehicle). The mirror should be adjusted while the small control under the mirror is set in the day position (toward the windshield).

natural_image
Simple illustration of a car rear mirror with an arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols)030407085
AdjustingRearviewMirror
Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
A single ball joint mirror is provided in the vehicle. It is a twist on mirror that has a fixed position at the windshield. The mirror installs on the windshield button with a counterclockwise rotation and requires no tools for mounting. The mirror head can be adjusted up, down,

Information Provided by: DEALER
left, and right for various drivers. The mirror should be adjusted to center on the view through the rear window.
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare from vehicles behind you.
NOTE:
- The Automatic Dimming Mirror feature is disabled when the vehicle is in reverse gear to improve rear view viewing.
- The Automatic Dimming Mirror feature can be turned on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133

natural_image
Front view of a modern car dashboard with a circular vent and control buttons (no text or symbols on the dashboard itself)030471112
AutomaticDimmingMirror
The mirror contains an Assist button and a 9–1–1 button located on the bottom of the mirror.
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
AssistCall
The rear view mirror contains an ASSIST push button which automatically connects the vehicle occupants to one of several predefined locations for immediate support:
- Roadside Assistance – If you get a flat tire, or need a tow, just press the Assist button and you'll be connected to someone who can help. Roadside Assistance will know what vehicle you're driving and its location. Additional fees may apply for roadside Assistance.
- Uconnect® Access Customer Care – In-vehicle support for Uconnect® Access and Uconnect® Access via Mobile features.
- Vehicle Customer Care – Total support for all other vehicle issues.
9-1-1Call
- Press the 9-1-1 Call button on the Rearview Mirror.
NOTE: In case the 9-1-1 Call button is pushed in error, there will be a 10 second delay before the 9-1-1 Call system initiates a call to a 9-1-1 operator. To cancel the 9-1-1 Call connection, press the 9-1-1 Call button on the Rearview Mirror or press the cancellation button on the Phone Screen. Termination of the 9-1-1 Call will turn the green LED light on the Rearview Mirror off.
- The LED light located between the Assist and 9-1-1 buttons on the Rearview Mirror will turn green once a connection to a 9-1-1 operator has been made.
- Once a connection between the vehicle and a 9-1-1 operator is made, the 9-1-1 Call system may transmit the following important vehicle information to a 9-1-1 operator:

- Indication that the occupant placed a 9-1-1 Call.
• The vehicle brand. -
The last known GPS coordinates of the vehicle.
-
You should be able to speak with the 9-1-1 operator through the vehicle audio system to determine if additional help is needed.
NOTE: Once a connection is made between the vehicle's 9-1-1 Call system and the 9-1-1 operator, the 9-1-1 operator may be able to open a voice connection with the vehicle to determine if additional help is needed. Once the 9-1-1 operator opens a voice connection with the vehicle's 9-1-1 Call system, the operator should be able to speak with you or other vehicle occupants and hear sounds occurring in the vehicle. The vehicle's 9-1-1 Call system will attempt to remain connected with the 9-1-1 operator until the 9-1-1 operator terminates the connection.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
- The 9-1-1 operator may attempt to contact appropriate emergency responders and provide them with important vehicle information and GPS coordinates.
WARNING!
- Ifanyoneinthevehiclecouldbeindanger(e.g., fireorsmokeisvisible,dangerousroadconditions orlocation),donotwaitforvoicecontactfroma 9-1-1operator.Alloccupantsshouldexitthevehicle immediatelyandmovetoasafelocation.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- The9-1-1Callsystemisembeddedintothevehicle'selectricalsystem.Donotaddaftermarketelectricalequipmenttothevehicle'selectricalsystem.Thismaypreventyourvehiclefromsendinga signaltoinitiateanemergencycall.Toavoidinterferencethatcancausethe9-1-1Callsystemtofail,neveraddaftermarketequipment(e.g.,two-way mobileradio,CBradio,datarecorder,etc.)toyour vehicle'selectricalsystemormodifytheantennas onyourvehicle.
- Modificationstoanypartofthe9-1-1Callsystem couldcausetheairbagsystemtofailwhenyou needit.Youcouldbeinjurediftheairbagsystem isnottheretohelpprotectyou.
9-1-1CallSystemLimitations
Vehicles sold in Canada and Mexico DO NOT have 9-1-1 Call system capabilities.
9-1-1 or other emergency line operators in Canada and Mexico may not answer or respond to 9-1-1 system calls.
If the 9-1-1 Call system detects a malfunction, any of the following may occur at the time the malfunction is detected, and at the beginning of each ignition cycle:
- The Rearview Mirror light located between the Assist and 9-1-1 buttons will continuously be illuminated red.
- The Phone Screen will display the following message "Vehicle phone requires service. Please contact your dealer."
- An In-Vehicle Audio message will state "Vehicle phone requires service. Please contact your dealer."
WARNING!
- IgnoringtheRearviewMirrorlightcouldmeanyou willnothave9-1-1Callservices.IftheRearview Mirrorlightisilluminated,haveanaauthorized dealerservicethe9-1-1Callsystemimmediately.
- TheORCturnsontheairbagWarningLightonthe instrumentpanelifamalfunctioninanypartofthe systemisdetected.IftheairbagWarningLightis illuminated,haveanauthorizeddealerservicethe ORCsystemimmediately.
Even if the 9-1-1 Call system is fully functional, factors beyond Chrysler Group LLC's control may prevent or stop the 9-1-1 Call system operation. These include, but are not limited to, the following factors:
- The ignition key has been removed from the ignition and the delayed accessories mode is active.
- The ignition key is in OFF position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 137
- The vehicle's electrical systems are not intact.
- The 9-1-1 Call system software and/or hardware are damaged during a crash.
- The vehicle battery loses power or becomes disconnected during a vehicle crash.
- Wireless and/or Global Positioning Satellite signals are unavailable or obstructed.
• Equipment malfunction at the 9-1-1 operator facility. - Operator error by the 9-1-1 operator.
- Wireless network congestion.
- Weather.
• Buildings, structures, geographic terrain, or tunnels.

138 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Never place anything on or near the vehicle's wireless and GPS antennas. You could prevent wireless and GPS signal reception, which can prevent your vehicle from placing an emergency call. Wireless and GPS signal reception is required for the 9-1-1 Call system to function properly.
GeneralInformation
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
CAUTION!
Toavoidamagetothemirrorduringcleaning,never sprayanycleaningsolutiondirectlyontothemirror. Applythesolutionontoacleanclothandwipethe mirrorclean.
Automatic Dimming Mirror With Rear View Camera Display — If Equipped
A single ball joint mirror is provided in the vehicle. It is a twist on mirror that has a fixed position at the windshield. The mirror installs on the windshield button with a counterclockwise rotation and requires no tools for mounting. The mirror head can be adjusted up, down, left, and right for various drivers. The mirror should be adjusted to center on the view through the rear window.
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare from vehicles behind you.
When the vehicle is placed into reverse gear a video display illuminates to display the image generated by the rear view camera located on the tailgate handle. The auto dimming feature is also disabled to improve rear view viewing.


text_image
Check Entire Surroundings! ASSIST 9-1-1 030471113AutomaticDimmingMirrorWithRearViewCamera
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 139
Outside Mirrors
To receive maximum benefit, adjust the outside mirrors to center on the adjacent lane of traffic with a slight overlap of the view obtained on the inside mirror.
WARNING!
Vehiclesandotherobjectsseeninthepassengerside convexmirrorwilllooksmallerandfartheraway thantheyreallyare.Relyingtoomuchonyour passengersideconvexmirrorcouldcauseyouto collidewithanothervehicleorotherobject.Useyour insidemirrorwhenjudgingthesizeordistanceofa vehicleseeninthepassengersideconvexmirror. Somevehicleswillnothaveaconvexpassengerside mirror.
140 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Outside Mirrors Folding Feature
All outside mirrors are designed to be able to be manually folded both forward and rearward to prevent damage.

natural_image
Side view of a car's front dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)FoldingMirror
CAUTION!
Itisrecommendedtofoldthemirrorsintothefull rearwardpositiontoresistdamagewhenenteringa carwashoranarrowlocation.
Tilt Mirrors In Reverse — If Equipped
Tilt Mirrors in Reverse provides automatic outside mirror positioning which will aid the driver's view of the ground rearward of the front doors. The outside mirrors will move slightly downward from the present position when the vehicle is shifted into REVERSE. The outside mirrors will then return to the original position when the vehicle is shifted out of the REVERSE position. Each stored memory setting will have an associated Tilt Mirrors in Reverse position.
NOTE: The Tilt Mirrors in Reverse feature is not turned on when delivered from the factory.

If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
Power Folding Outside Mirrors — If Equipped
If equipped with power folding mirrors, they can be electrically folded rearward and unfolded into the drive position.
The switch for the power folding mirrors is located between the power mirror switches L (left) and R (right). Press the switch once and the mirrors will fold in, press the switch a second time and the mirrors will return to the normal driving position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 141
If the mirror is manually folded after electrically cycled, a potential extra button push is required to get the mirrors back to the home position. If the mirror does not electrically fold check for ice or dirt build up at the pivot area which can cause excessive drag.

natural_image
Interior view of a car's dashboard with a black arrow pointing to the left side of the control panel (no text or symbols visible)PowerFoldingMirrorSwitch

142 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ResettingthePowerFoldingOutsideMirrors
You may need to reset the power folding mirrors if the following occurs:
• The mirrors are accidentally blocked while folding.
- The mirrors are accidentally manually folded/unfolded.
• The mirrors come out of the unfolded position.
- The mirrors shake and vibrate at normal driving speeds.
To reset the power folding mirrors: Fold and unfold them by pressing the button (this may require multiple button pushes). This resets them to their normal position.
Power Mirrors — If Equipped
The controls for the power mirrors are located on the driver's door trim panel.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with a control panel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)PowerMirrorControlsLocation
The power mirror controls consist of mirror select buttons and a four-way mirror control switch.


text_image
Car interior control panel with labeled buttons and arrows indicating navigation or movementPowerMirrorControls
1 — Mirror Select Buttons
2 — Four-Way Mirror Control Switch
To adjust a mirror, press either the L (left) or R (right) button to select the mirror that you want to adjust.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 143
Using the mirror control switch, press on any of the four arrows for the direction that you want the mirror to move

natural_image
Side view of a car's front dashboard and steering wheel, showing a directional sign with cross symbol (no text or numbers on the car itself)PowerMirrorMovement

Information Provided by: DEALER
144 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This feature can be activated whenever you turn on the rear window defroster (if equipped). Refer to "Rear Window Features" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for further information.
Driver's Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
The driver's outside mirror will automatically adjust for glare from vehicles behind you. This feature is controlled by the inside automatic dimming mirror and will automatically adjust for headlight glare when the inside mirror adjusts.
Illuminated Vanity Mirror — If Equipped
Illuminated vanity mirrors are located on each sun visor. To use the mirror, rotate the sun visor down and swing the mirror cover upward. The lights will turn on automatically. Closing the mirror cover turns off the light.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest door and side panel with an arrow pointing to a window (no text or symbols)Illuminated VanityMirror

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 145
"Slide-On-Rod" Features Of Sun Visor — If Equipped
The sun visor "Slide-On-Rod" feature allows for additional flexibility in positioning the visor to block out the sun.
To use the "Slide-On-Rod" feature, rotate the sun visor downward and unclip it. Pull the sun visor along the "Slide-On-Rod" until the sun visor is in the desired position.

natural_image
Interior view of a car's seatbelt with a directional arrow and label (no text or symbols on the main subject)"Slide-On-Rod"Extender

Information Provided by: DEALER
146 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Trailer Towing Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are designed with an adjustable mirror head to provide a greater vision range when towing extra-wide loads. To change position inboard or outboard, the mirror head should be rotated (flipped in or out).
NOTE: Fold the trailer towing mirrors rearward prior to entering an automated car wash.
A small blindspot mirror is located next to main mirror and can be adjusted separately.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side mirror and dashboard, showing a black arrow pointing to the front wheel (no text or symbols visible)TrailerTowingPosition

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side mirror showing a black arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols on the object itself)BlindspotMirror

SEATS
Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the vehicle.
WARNING!
- Itisdangeroustorideinacargoarea,insideor outsideofavehicle.Inacollision,peopleridingin theseareasaremorelikelytobeseriouslyinjured orkilled.
- Donotallowpeopletorideinanyareaofyour vehiclethatisnotequippedwithseatsandseat belts.Inacollision,peopleridingintheseareasare morelikelytobeseriouslyinjuredorkilled.
- Besureeveryoneinyourvehicleisinaseatand usingaseatbeltproperly.
Driver's Power Seat — If Equipped
Some models may be equipped with an eight-way power driver's seat. The power seat switches are located on the
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 147
outboard side of the driver's seat cushion. There are two power seat switches that are used to control the movement of the seat cushion and the seatback.

text_image
Diagram of car seatbelt panel with numbered labels pointing to the interior and side panelsPowerSeatSwitches
1 — Power Seat Switch
2 — Power Seatback Switch

148 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
AdjustingTheSeatForwardOrRearward
The seat can be adjusted both forward and rearward. Push the seat switch forward or rearward, the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch when the desired position has been reached.
AdjustingTheSeatUpUpDown
The height of the seats can be adjusted up or down. Pull upward or push downward on the seat switch, the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch when the desired position is reached.
TiltingTheSeatUpUpDown
The angle of the seat cushion can be adjusted in four directions. Pull upward or push downward on the front or rear of the seat switch, the front or rear of the seat cushion will move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch when the desired position is reached.
RecliningTheSeatback
The angle of the seatback can be adjusted forward or rearward. Push the seatback switch forward or rearward, the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch when the desired position is reached.
WARNING!
- Adjustingaseatwhiledrivingmaybedangerous. Movingaseatwhiledrivingcouldresultinlossof controlwhichcouldcauseacollisionandserious injuryordeath.
- Seatsshouldbeadjustedbeforefasteningtheseat beltsandwhilethevehicleisparked.Serious injuryordeathcouldresultfromapoorlyadjusted seatbelt.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 149
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotridewiththeseatbackreclinedsothatthe shoulderbeltisnolongerrestingagainstyour chest.Inacollisionyoucouldslideundertheseat belt,whichcouldresultinseriousinjuryordeath.
CAUTION!
Donotplaceanyarticleunderapowerseator impedeitsabilitytomoveasitmaycausedamageto theseatcontrols.Seattravelmaybecomelimitedif movementisstoppedbyanobstructionintheseat's path.
Passenger's Power Seat — If Equipped
Some models are equipped with a six-way power passenger seat. The power seat switch is located on the outboard side of the seat. The switch is used to control the movement of the seat and seat cushion.
AdjustingTheSeatForwardOrRearward
The seat can be adjusted both forward and rearward. Push the seat switch forward or rearward, the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch when the desired position has been reached.
150 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Power Lumbar — If Equipped
Vehicles equipped with power driver or passenger seats may be also be equipped with power lumbar. The power lumbar switch is located on the outboard side of the power seat. Push the switch forward to increase the lumbar support. Push the switch rearward to decrease the lumbar support.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seat with a control panel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)LumbarControlSwitch
Heated Seats — If Equipped
On some models, the front and rear seats may be equipped with heaters located in the seat cushions.
WARNING!
- Personswhoareunabletofeelpaintotheskin becauseofadvancedage,chronicillness,diabetes, spinalcordinjury,medication,alcoholuse,exhaustionorotherphysicalconditionmustexercisecare whenusingtheseatheater.Itmaycauseburns evenatlowtemperatures,especiallyifusedfor longperiodsoftime.
- Donotplaceanythingontheseatorseatbackthat insulatesagainstheat,suchasablanketorcushion. Thismaycausetheseatheatertooverheat.Sitting inaseatthathasbeenoverheatedcouldcause seriousburnsduetotheincreasedsurfacetemperature oftheseat.
FrontHeatedSeats
The front heated seats control buttons are located on the center instrument panel below the climate controls.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, the front heated seats control buttons are located within the climate or controls screen of the touchscreen.
- Press the heated seat button 📋 once to turn the High setting On.
- Press the heated seat button ⚙/ a second time to turn the Low setting On.
- Press the heated seat button a third time to turn the heating elements Off.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 151
When the HI-level setting is selected, the heater will provide a boosted heat level during the first four minutes of operation. Then, the heat output will drop to the normal HI-level. If the HI-level setting is selected, the system will automatically switch to LO-level after a maximum of 60 minutes of continuous operation. At that time, the display will change from HI to LO, indicating the change. The LO-level setting will turn OFF automatically after a maximum of 45 minutes.
NOTE: The engine must be running for the heated seats to operate.
152 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
VehiclesEquippedWithRemoteStart
On models that are equipped with remote start, the heated seats can be programmed to come on during a remote start.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
RearHeatedSeats
On some models, the two outboard seats are equipped with heated seats. The heated seat switches for these seats are located on the rear of the center console.
There are two heated seat switches that allow the rear passengers to operate the seats independently. You can choose from HIGH, LOW or OFF heat settings. Amber indicator lights in each switch indicate the level of heat in use. Two indicator lights will illuminate for HIGH, one for LOW and none for OFF.

Press the switch once to select HIGH-level heating. Press the switch a second time to select LOW-level heating. Press the switch a third time to shut the heating elements OFF.

Information Provided by: DEALER
NOTE:
- Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt within two to five minutes.
- The engine must be running for the heated seats to operate.
When the HIGH-level setting is selected, the heater will provide a boosted heat level during the first four minutes of operation. Then, the heat output will drop to the normal HIGH-level. If the HIGH-level setting is selected, the system will automatically switch to LOW-level after a maximum of 60 minutes of continuous operation. At that time, the number of illuminated LEDs changes from two to one, indicating the change. The LOW-level setting will turn OFF automatically after a maximum of 45 minutes.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 153
Ventilated Seats — If Equipped
Located in the seat cushion are small fans that draw the air from the passenger compartment and pull air through fine perforations in the seat cover to help keep the driver and front passenger cooler in higher ambient temperatures. The fans operate at two speeds, HIGH and LOW.
The front ventilated seats control buttons are located on the center instrument panel below the climate controls.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, the front ventilated seats control buttons are located within the climate or controls screen of the touchscreen.
- Press the ventilated seat button HIGH.
* once to choose
- Press the ventilated seat button choose LOW.
* a second time to
- Press the ventilated seat button turn the ventilated seat OFF.
a third time to

154 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The engine must be running for the ventilated seats to operate.
VehiclesEquippedWithRemoteStart
On models that are equipped with remote start, the ventilated seats can be programmed to come on during a remote start.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
Manual Seat Adjuster — If Equipped
Both front seats are adjustable forward or rearward. The manual seat adjustment handle is located under the seat cushion at the front edge of each seat.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel showing the wheel and seatbelt, with a white arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols on the main subject)ManualSeatAdjuster

While sitting in the seat, pull up on the handle and slide the seat forward or backward. Release the bar once you have reached the desired position. Then, using body pressure, move forward and rearward on the seat to be sure that the seat adjusters have latched.
WARNING!
- Adjustingaseatwhiledrivingmaybedangerous. Movingaseatwhiledrivingcouldresultinlossof controlwhichcouldcauseacollisionandserious injuryordeath.
- Seatsshouldbeadjustedbeforefasteningtheseat beltsandwhilethevehicleisparked.Serious injuryordeathcouldresultfromapoorlyadjusted seatbelt.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 155
DumpFeature(ManualReclineSeatOnly)—StandardCab
Actuating the recliner handle will allow the seatback to swing (dump) forward on manual recliner seats. This "dump" feature allows access to the storage bin behind the seat.
WARNING!
- Donotstandorleaninfrontoftheseatwhile actuatingthehandle.Theseatbackmayswing forwardandhityoucausinginjury.
- To avoid injury, place your hand on these seat back and actuat the handle, then position these seat back in the desired position.
156 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 40-20-40 Front Bench Seat — If Equipped
The seat is divided into three segments. The outboard seat portions are each 40% of the total width of the seat. On some models the back of the center portion (20%) easily folds down to provide an armrest/center storage compartment.
Mega Cab® Rear Seat Features
RecliningRearSeats—IfEquipped
The recliner handle is located on the outside of the seat cushion. To adjust the seatback, lift upward on the handle, lean back on the seatback and when you reach the desired position, release the handle.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seat with a black arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols present)RearSeatReclinerHandle
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 157
WARNING!
Donotridewiththeseatbackreclinedsothatthe shoulderbeltisnolongerrestingagainstyourchest. Inacollisionyoucouldslideundertheseatbelt, whichcouldresultinseriousinjuryordeath.
FoldingRearSeat(TableMode)—IfEquipped
Both the left and right rear seatbacks can be folded down and used as a table.
To fold down either rear seatback:
- Lift the handle, located next to the head restraint.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt buckle with a hand inserting a black arrow (no text or symbols)TableModeHandle
- Fold the seatback forward.
158 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt and backrest area showing seat, seatbelt, and dashboard (no text or symbols)TableMode
- Lift the seatback, to return the seat to the upright position. Be sure the seatback is locked in place.
FoldingRearSeat—IfEquipped
Both the outboard rear seats will drop and move forward when the seatback is folded flat.
WARNING!
- Itisdangeroustorideinacargoarea,insideor outsideofavehicle.Inacollision,peopleridingin theseareasaremorelikelytobeseriouslyinjured orkilled.
- Donotallowpeopleorideinanyareaofyour vehiclethatisnotequippedwithseatsandseat belts.
- Besureeveryoneinyourvehicleisinaseatand usingaseatbeltproperly.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Cargomustbesecurelytieddownbeforedriving yourvehicle.Improperlysecuredcargocanfly aroundinasuddenstoporcollisionandstrike someoneinthevehicle,causingseriousinjuryor death.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 159
To fold either rear seat flat:
- Lift the handle, located on the outboard side of either of the rear seats.

natural_image
Close-up of a car seatbelt buckle component with an arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols visible)FoldingRearSeatHandle
- Fold the seatback down and push the seat forward.
160 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seat and side panel with a circular arrow indicating rotation (no text or symbols)RearPassengerFold-FlatSeats
- Lift the seatback, to return the seat to the upright position. Be sure the seat is locked in place.
WARNING!
Animproperlylatchedseatcouldcauseseriousinjuryordeath.Makesurethattheseatbackissecurely lockedintoposition.Iftheseatbackinnotsecurely lockedintopositiontheseatwillnotprovidethe properstabilityforchildseatsand/orpassengers.
Head Restraints
Head restraints are designed to reduce the risk of injury by restricting head movement in the event of a rear impact. Head restraints should be adjusted so that the top of the head restraint is located above the top of your ear.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 161
WARNING!
Theheadrestraintsforalloccupantsmustbeproperlyadjustedpriortooperatingthevehicleoroccupyingaseat.Headrestraintsshouldneverbeadjustedwhilethevehicleisinmotion.Drivinga vehiclewiththeheadrestraintsimproperlyadjusted orremovedcouldcauseseriousinjuryordeathinthe eventofacollision.
FrontHeadRestraints
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the adjustment button, located on the base of the head restraint, and push downward on the head restraint.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with two base plates and a black arrow pointing to a specific part (no text or symbols visible)AdjustmentButton
RearHeadRestraints
The rear seats are equipped with adjustable head restraints. To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the adjustment button, located on the base of the head restraint, and push downward on the head restraint.

162 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with two base legs and a black arrow pointing to a specific part (no text or symbols visible)AdjustmentButton
NOTE:
- The rear center head restraint (Crew Cab and Quad Cab) has only one adjustment position that is used to aid in the routing of a tether. Refer to "Occupant Restraints" in "Things to Know Before Starting Your Vehicle" for further information.
- The head restraints should only be removed by qualified technicians, for service purposes only. If either of the head restraints require removal, see your authorized dealer.
DRIVER MEMORY SEAT — IF EQUIPPED
This feature allows the driver to store up to two different memory profiles for easy recall through a memory switch. Each memory profile contains desired position settings for the driver seat, side mirrors, adjustable pedals (if equipped) and a set of desired radio station presets. Your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter can also be programmed to recall the same positions when the UNLOCK button is pressed.
NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with two RKE transmitters. One RKE transmitter can be linked to memory position 1 and the other transmitter can be linked to memory position 2.

The memory seat buttons are located on the outboard side of the drivers seat cushion.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seat with a black arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)MemorySeatButtons
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 163
Programming The Memory Feature
NOTE: To create a new memory profile, perform the following:
VehiclesEquippedWithKeylessEnter-N-Go
- Without pressing the brake pedal, push the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine).
- Adjust all memory profile settings to desired preferences (seat, side mirrors, adjustable pedals and radio station presets).
- Press and release the S (Set) button on the memory switch.
- Within five seconds, press and release either of the memory buttons (1) or (2). The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display which memory position has been set.

164 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
VehiclesNotEquippedWithKeylessEnter-N-Go
- Insert the ignition Key Fob, and turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
- Adjust all memory profile settings to desired preferences (seat, side mirrors, adjustable pedals [if equipped], power tilt and telescopic steering column [if equipped], and radio station presets).
- Press and release the S (Set) button on the memory switch.
- Within five seconds, press and release either of the memory buttons (1) or (2). The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display which memory position has been set.
NOTE: Memory profiles can be set without the vehicle in PARK, but the vehicle must be in PARK to recall a memory profile.
Linking And Unlinking The Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter To Memory
Your RKE transmitters can be programmed to recall one of two pre-programmed memory profiles by pressing the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter.
NOTE: Before programming your RKE transmitters to memory and If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, you must select the "Memory To FOB" feature through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, you must select the "Key Fob Linked To Memory" feature through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
To program your RKE transmitters, perform the following:
- Cycle the vehicles ignition to the Off position.
- Select desired memory profile (1) or (2).
NOTE: If a memory profile has not already been set, refer to "Programming The Memory Feature" for instructions on how to set a memory profile.
- Once the profile has been recalled, press and release the SET (S) button on the memory switch, then press and release button (1) or (2) accordingly. "Memory Profile Set" (1 or 2) will display in the instrument cluster on vehicles equipped with the EVIC.
- Press and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter within 10 seconds.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 165
NOTE: Your RKE transmitters can be unlinked to your memory settings by following steps 1-4 above and pressing the UNLOCK button (instead of LOCK) on the RKE transmitter in step 4.
Memory Position Recall
NOTE: The vehicle must be in PARK to recall memory positions. If a recall is attempted when the vehicle is not in PARK, a message will be displayed in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC).
DriverOneMemoryPositionRecall
- To recall the memory settings for driver one using the memory switch, press MEMORY button number 1 on the memory switch.
- To recall the memory settings for driver one using the RKE transmitter, press the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter linked to memory position 1.

166 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
DriverTwoMemoryPositionRecall
- To recall the memory setting for driver two using the memory switch, press MEMORY button number 2 on the memory switch.
- To recall the memory settings for driver two using the RKE transmitter, press the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter linked to memory position 2.
A recall can be cancelled by pressing any of the MEMORY buttons during a recall (S, 1, or 2). When a recall is cancelled, the driver's seat, and the pedals stop moving. A delay of one second will occur before another recall can be selected.
Easy Entry/Exit Seat
This feature provides automatic driver seat positioning to enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the vehicle.
The distance the driver seat moves depends on where you have the driver seat positioned when you remove the Key Fob from the ignition (or change the ignition to OFF, for vehicles equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go ^TM ).
- When you remove the Key Fob from the ignition (or change the ignition to OFF, for vehicles equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go™), the driver seat will move about 2.4 in (60 mm) rearward if the driver seat position is greater than or equal to 2.7 in (67.7 mm) forward of the rear stop. The seat will return to its previously set position when you place the ignition into the ACC or RUN position.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 167
- When you remove the Key Fob from the ignition (or change the ignition to OFF, for vehicles equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go™), the driver seat will move to a position 0.3 in (7.7 mm) forward of the rear stop if the driver seat position is between 0.9 in and 2.7 in (22.7 mm and 67.7 mm) forward of the rear stop. The seat will return to its previously set position when you place the ignition to the ACC or RUN position.
- The Easy Entry/Easy Exit feature is disabled when the driver seat position is less than 0.9 in (22.7 mm) forward of the rear stop. At this position, there is no benefit to the driver by moving the seat for Easy Exit or Easy Entry.
Each stored memory setting will have an associated Easy Entry and Easy Exit position.
NOTE: The Easy Entry/Exit feature is not enabled when the vehicle is delivered from the factory. The Easy Entry/Exit feature is enabled (or later disabled) through the programmable features in the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings/Customer Programmable Features" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
168 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
To open the hood, two latches must be released.
- Pull the hood release lever located below the steering wheel at the base of the instrument panel.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's dashboard and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)HoodRelease
- Reach into the opening beneath the center of the hood and push the safety latch lever to the left to release it, before raising the hood.

natural_image
Front view of a black SUV with a white arrow pointing downward on the windshield (no text or symbols)SafetyLatchLocation(1500SeriesShown)
031305529

Information Provided by: DEALER
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 169
CAUTION!
Topreventpossibledamage, donotslamthehoodto closeit. Useafirmdownwardpushatthefrontcenter ofthehoodtoensurethatbothlatchesengage.
WARNING!
Besurethehoodisfullylatchedbeforedrivingyour vehicle.Ifthehoodisnotfullylatched,itcouldopen whenthevehicleisinmotionandblockyourvision. Failuretofollowthiswarningcouldresultinserious injuryordeath.
LIGHTS
The headlight switch is located on the left side of the instrument panel, next to the steering wheel. The headlight switch controls the operation of the headlights, parking lights, instrument panel lights, cargo lights and fog lights (if equipped).

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)HeadlightSwitchLocation

Information Provided by: DEALER
170 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlight and fog light (if equipped) lenses that are lighter and less susceptible to stone breakage than glass lights. Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution followed by rinsing.
CAUTION!
Donotuseabrasivecleaningcomponents,solvents,steelwoolorotherabrasivematerialstocleanthe lenses.
Headlights

To turn on the headlights, rotate the headlight switch clockwise to the headlight position. When the headlight switch is on, the parking lights, taillights, license plate light and instrument panel lights are also turned on. To turn off the headlights, rotate the headlight switch back to the O (Off) position.
Automatic Headlights — If Equipped
This system automatically turns the headlights on or off according to ambient light levels. To turn the system on, rotate the headlight switch to the AUTO position.

text_image
AUTO 30ΩE 转 PUSHAutomaticHeadlightPosition
When the system is on, the Headlight Delay feature is also on. This means the headlights will stay on for up to 90 seconds after you turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. To turn the automatic headlights off, turn the headlight switch out of the AUTO position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 171
NOTE: The engine must be running before the headlights will turn on in the Automatic Mode.
Headlights On With Wipers (Available With Automatic Headlights Only)
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on if the headlight switch is placed in the AUTO position. In addition, the headlights will turn off when the wipers are turned off, if they were turned on by this feature.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

172 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) — If Equipped
The headlights on your vehicle will illuminate when the engine is started and the transmission is in any gear except PARK. This provides a constant "Lights ON" condition until the ignition is turned OFF. The lights illuminate at less than 50% of normal intensity. If the parking brake is applied, the Daytime Running Lights (DRL) will turn OFF. Also, if a turn signal is activated, the DRL lamp on the same side of the vehicle may turn off for the duration of the turn signal activation. Once the turn signal is no longer active, the DRL lamp will illuminate.
Headlight Delay
To aid in your exit, your vehicle is equipped with a headlight delay that will leave the headlights on for approximately up to 90 seconds. This delay is initiated when the ignition is turned OFF while the headlight switch is on, and then the headlight switch is cycled off. Headlight delay can be cancelled by either turning the headlight switch on then off, or by turning the ignition ON.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.

Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control — If Equipped
The Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control system provides increased forward lighting at night by automating high beam control through the use of a digital camera mounted on the inside rearview mirror. This camera detects vehicle specific light and automatically switches from high beams to low beams until the approaching vehicle is out of view.
NOTE:
- If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen the Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control can be turned on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen the Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control can be
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 173
turned on or off using the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) or Driver Information Display (DID). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" or "Driver Information Display (DID)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- Broken, muddy, or obstructed headlights and taillights of vehicles in the field of view will cause headlights to remain on longer (closer to the vehicle). Also, dirt, film, and other obstructions on the windshield or camera lens will cause the system to function improperly.
If the windshield or Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control mirror is replaced, the mirror must be re-aimed to ensure proper performance. See your local authorized dealer.

174 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Parking Lights And Panel Lights
To turn on the parking lights and instrument panel lights, rotate the headlight switch clockwise. To turn off the parking lights, rotate the headlight switch back to the O (Off) position.
Fog Lights — If Equipped
The fog lights are turned on by rotating the headlight switch to the parking light or headlight position and pushing in the headlight rotary control.

text_image
AUTO 3kΩ5 AUTO AUTO PUSH031464205
FogLightSwitch
The fog lights will operate only when the parking lights are on or when the vehicle headlights are on low beam. An indicator light located in the instrument cluster will illuminate when the fog lights are on. The fog lights will

turn off when the switch is pushed a second time, when the headlight switch is rotated to the off position, or the high beam is selected.
Lights-On Reminder
If the headlights, parking lights, or cargo lights are left on after the ignition is turned OFF, a chime will sound when the driver's door is opened.
Battery Saver
To protect the life of your vehicle's battery, load shedding is provided for both the interior and exterior lights.
If the ignition is OFF and any door is left ajar for 10 minutes or the dimmer control is rotated all the way up to the dome ON position for 10 minutes, the interior lights will automatically turn off.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 175
If the headlights remain on while the ignition is cycled OFF, the exterior lights will automatically turn off after eight minutes. If the headlights are turned on and left on for eight minutes while the ignition is OFF, the exterior lights will automatically turn off.
NOTE: Battery saver mode is cancelled if the ignition is ON.
Interior Lights
Courtesy and dome lights are turned on when the front doors are opened, when the dimmer control (rotating wheel on the bottom of the switch) is rotated to the far right detent position. If your vehicle is equipped with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) and the UNLOCK button is pressed on the RKE transmitter the courtesy and dome lights will turn on. When a door is open and the interior lights are on, rotating the dimmer control all the way left, to the OFF detent, will cause all the interior lights to go out. This is also known as the "Party" mode because it

176 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
allows the doors to stay open for extended periods of time without discharging the vehicle's battery.
The brightness of the instrument panel as well as the ambient lighting can be regulated by rotating the dimmer control right (brighter) or left (dimmer). When the headlights are on you can supplement the brightness of the odometer, trip odometer, radio and overhead console by rotating the control to the right until you hear a click. This feature is termed the "Parade" mode and is useful when headlights are required during the day.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, the dimming of the touchscreen is programmable through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further details.

text_image
AUTO 300E ADD ADD PUSH031464206
DimmerControl
Courtesy/ReadingLights
Both lights in the overhead console and rear passenger compartment will illuminate as courtesy lights when a door is opened, when the dimmer control is rotated to the courtesy light position (full right position), or when the UNLOCK button is pressed on the Remote Keyless Entry

(RKE) transmitter, if equipped. These lights are also operated individually as reading lights by pressing on the corresponding lens.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional arrows (no text or symbols)FrontCourtesy/ReadingLights
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 177

natural_image
Close-up of a metallic cylindrical device with a textured surface and a circular button, marked with an arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols on the device itself)RearPassengerCourtesy/ReadingLight
NOTE: The courtesy/reading lights will remain on until the switch is pressed a second time, so be sure they have been turned off before leaving the vehicle. If the interior lights are left on after the ignition is turned OFF, they will automatically turn off after 15 minutes.
178 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
AmbientLight
The overhead console is equipped with an ambient light feature. This light casts illumination for improved visibility of the floor console area.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional indicator (no text or symbols on main subject)AmbientLight
Cargo Light
The cargo lights are turned on by pressing on the cargo button.

text_image
AUTO 卸 PUSH031464207
CargoLightSwitch
The cargo lights will also turn on for approximately 30 seconds when a RKE transmitter UNLOCK button is pressed, as part of the Illuminated Entry feature.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 179
Multifunction Lever
The multifunction lever is located on the left side of the steering column.
Turn Signals
Move the multifunction lever up or down and the arrows on each side of the instrument cluster flash to show proper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with gauges and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)TurnSignalLever
NOTE: If either light remains on and does not flash, or there is a very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside light bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is moved, it would suggest that the indicator bulb is defective.

180 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Lane Change Assist
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash three times then automatically turn off.
Flash-To-Pass
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by partially pulling the multifunction lever toward the steering wheel. This will cause the high beam headlights to turn on until the lever is released.
High/Low Beam Switch
Push the multifunction lever toward the instrument panel to switch the headlights to high beam. Pulling the multifunction lever back toward the steering wheel will turn the low beams back on, or shut the high beams off.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with gauges and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)High/LowBeamSwitch
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Windshield Wipers
The wipers and washers are operated by a switch in the multifunction lever. Turn the end of the handle to select the desired wiper speed.


natural_image
Interior view of a car showing a black handheld device with directional arrows and control buttons, no readable text or symbols.WindshieldWiper/WasherSwitch
Windshield Wiper Operation
Rotate the end of the lever upward, to the first detent past the intermittent settings for low-speed wiper operation. Rotate the end of the lever upward to the second detent past the intermittent settings for high-speed wiper operation.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 181
Intermittent Wiper System
The intermittent feature of this system was designed for use when weather conditions make a single wiping cycle, with a variable pause between cycles, desirable. For maximum delay between cycles, rotate the control knob into the upper end of the delay range.
The delay interval decreases as you rotate the knob until it enters the low continual speed position. The delay can be regulated from a maximum of about 18 seconds between cycles, to a cycle every one second. The delay intervals will double in duration when the vehicle speed is 10 mph (16 km/h) or less.
Windshield Washers
To use the windshield washer, push the washer knob, located on the end of the multifunction lever, inward to the second detent. Washer fluid will be sprayed and the wiper will operate for two to three cycles after the washer knob is released from this position. If the washer knob is

182 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
depressed while in the delay range, the wiper will operate for several seconds after the washer knob is released. It will then resume the intermittent interval previously selected. If the washer knob is pushed while in the off position, the wiper will turn on and cycle approximately three times after the wash knob is released.
To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system in cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets or exceeds the temperature range of your climate. This rating information can be found on most washer fluid containers.
WARNING!
Suddenlossofvisibilitythroughthewindshield couldleadtoacollision.Youmightnotseeother vehiclesorotherobstacles.Toavoidsuddenicingof
WARNING!(Continued)
thewindshieldduringfreezingweather,warmthe windshieldwiththedefrosterbeforeandduring windshieldwasheruse.
Mist Feature
When a single wipe to clear off road mist or spray from a passing vehicle is needed, push the washer knob, located on the end of the multifunction lever, inward to the first detent and release. The wipers will cycle one time and automatically shut off.
NOTE: The mist feature does not activate the washer pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on the windshield. The wash function must be used in order to spray the windshield with washer fluid.
Rain Sensing Wipers — If Equipped
This feature senses moisture on the windshield and automatically activates the wipers for the driver. The feature is especially useful for road splash or overspray from the windshield washers of the vehicle ahead. Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to one of five settings to activate this feature.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 183
The sensitivity of the system can be adjusted with the multifunction lever. Wiper delay position 1 is the least sensitive, and wiper delay position 5 is the most sensitive. Setting 3 should be used for normal rain conditions. Settings 1 and 2 can be used if the driver desires less wiper sensitivity. Setting 4 and 5 can be used if the driver desires more sensitivity. Place the wiper switch in the OFF position when not using the system.
NOTE:
- The Rain Sensing feature will not operate when the wiper switch is in the low or high-speed position.
- The Rain Sensing feature may not function properly when ice, or dried salt water is present on the windshield.
- Use of Rain-X® or products containing wax or silicone may reduce Rain Sensing performance.

184 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The Rain Sensing system has protection features for the wiper blades and arms, and will not operate under the following conditions:
- LowAmbientTemperature— When the ignition is first turned ON, the Rain Sensing system will not operate until the wiper switch is moved, vehicle speed is greater than 0 mph (0 km/h), or the outside temperature is greater than 32^ (0°C).
- TransmissionInNEUTRALPosition—When the ignition is ON, and the transmission is in the NEUTRAL position, the Rain Sensing system will not operate until the wiper switch is moved, vehicle speed is greater than 5 mph (8 km/h), or the shift lever is moved out of the NEUTRAL position.
RemoteStartModeInhibit— On vehicles equipped with Remote Starting system, Rain Sensing wipers are not operational when the vehicle is in the remote start mode. Once the operator is in the vehicle and has placed the ignition switch in the RUN position, rain sensing wiper operation can resume, if it has been selected, and no other inhibit conditions (mentioned previously) exist.
TILT STEERING COLUMN
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column upward or downward. The tilt lever is located on the steering column, below the multifunction lever.
Pull the lever toward the steering wheel to unlock the steering column. With one hand firmly on the steering wheel, move the steering column up or down, as desired. Release the lever to lock the steering column firmly in place.


natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)TiltSteeringLever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 185
WARNING!
Donotadjustthesteeringcolumnwhiledriving. Adjustingthesteeringcolumnwhiledrivingordrivingwiththesteeringcolumnunlocked,couldcause thedrivertolosecontrolofthevehicle.Failureto followthiswarningmayresultinseriousinjuryor death.
HEATED STEERING WHEEL — IF EQUIPPED
The steering wheel contains a heating element that helps warm your hands in cold weather. The heated steering wheel has only one temperature setting. Once the heated steering wheel has been turned on it will operate for approximately 30 to 80 minutes before automatically shutting off. The heated steering wheel can shut off early or may not turn on when the steering wheel is already warm.

186 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The heated steering wheel control button is located on the center of the instrument panel below the climate controls.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, the heated steering wheel control button is located within the climate or controls screen of the touchscreen.
- Press the heated steering wheel button turn the heating element On.
once to
- Press the heated steering wheel button time to turn the heating element Off.
a second
NOTE: The engine must be running for the heated steering wheel to operate.
VehiclesEquippedWithRemoteStart
On models that are equipped with remote start, the heated steering wheel can be programmed to come on during a remote start.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
WARNING!
- Persons who are unable to feel painted the skin because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical conditions must exercise care when using the steering wheel heater. It may cause burn seven at low temperatures, especially if used for long periods.
- Donotplaceanythingonthesteeringwheelthat insulatesagainstheat,suchasablanketorsteering wheelcoversofanytypeandmaterial.Thismay causethesteeringwheelheatertooverheat.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 187
DRIVER ADJUSTABLE PEDALS — IF EQUIPPED
The adjustable pedals system is designed to allow a greater range of driver comfort for steering wheel tilt and seat position. This feature allows the brake, accelerator, and clutch pedals (if equipped) to move toward or away from the driver to provide improved position with the steering wheel.
The adjustable pedal switch is located to the left side of the steering column.
188 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)AdjustablePedalsSwitch
• The pedals can be adjusted with the ignition OFF.
- The pedals cannot be adjusted when the vehicle is in REVERSE or when the Electronic Speed Control System is on. The following messages will be displayed on vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle Information System (EVIC) if the pedals are attempted to be
adjusted when the system is locked out ("Adjustable Pedal Disabled — Cruise Control Engaged" or "Adjustable Pedal Disabled — Vehicle In Reverse".
NOTE:
• Always adjust the pedals to a position that allows full pedal travel.
• Further small adjustments may be necessary to find the best possible seat/pedal position.
- For vehicles equipped with Driver Memory Seat, you can use your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or the memory switch on the driver's door trim panel to return the adjustable pedals to pre-programmed positions. Refer to "Driver Memory Seat" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for further information.

CAUTION!
Donotplaceanyarticleundertheadjustablepedals orimpedeitsabilitytomoveasitmaycauseddamage tothepedalcontrols.Pedaltravelmaybecomelimitedifmovementisstoppedbyanobstructioninthe adjustablepedal'spath.
WARNING!
Donotadjustthepedalswhilethevehicleismoving. Youcouldlosecontrolandhaveanaccident.Always adjustthepedalswhilethevehicleisparked.
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph (40 km/h).
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 189
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the right side of the steering wheel.

text_image
1 ON/OFF RES + CANCEL SET - 2 3 4 032209541ElectronicSpeedControlSwitches
1—ON/OFF 3—SET-
2—RES+4—CANCEL

Information Provider Syc. DEALER
190 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control System has been designed to shut down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control System can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired vehicle set speed.
To Activate
Push the ON/OFF button. The Cruise Indicator Light in the instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system off, push the ON/OFF button a second time. The Cruise Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be turned off when not in use.
WARNING!
LeavingtheElectronicSpeedControlsystemon whennotinuseisdangerous.Youcouldaccidentally setthesystemorcauseittogofasterthanyouwant. Youcouldlosecontrolandhaveanaccident.Always leavethesystemOFFwhenyouarenotusingit.
To Set A Desired Speed
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle has reached the desired speed, press the SET (-) button and release. Release the accelerator and the vehicle will operate at the selected speed.
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed and on level ground before pressing the SET (-) button.

To Deactivate
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANCEL button, or normal brake pressure while slowing the vehicle will deactivate the Electronic Speed Control without erasing the set speed memory.
Pressing the ON/OFF button or turning the ignition switch OFF erases the set speed memory.
To Resume Speed
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+) button and release. Resume can be used at any speed above 20 mph (32 km/h).
To Vary The Speed Setting
ToIncreaseSpeed
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can increase speed by pushing the RES (+) button.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 191
The speed increment shown is dependant on the speed of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
U.S.Speed(mph)
- Pressing the RES (+) button once will result in a 1 mph increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the button results in an increase of 1 mph.
- If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to increase until the button is released, then the new set speed will be established.
MetricSpeed(km/h)
- Pressing the RES (+) button once will result in a 2 km/h increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the button results in an increase of 2 km/h.
- If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to increase until the button is released, then the new set speed will be established.

192 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ToDecreaseSpeed
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can decrease speed by pushing the SET (-) button.
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the speed of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
U.S.Speed(mph)
- Pressing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 mph decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
- If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to decrease until the button is released, then the new set speed will be established.
MetricSpeed(km/h)
- Pressing the SET (-) button once will result in a 2 km/h decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the button results in a decrease of 2 km/h.
- If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to decrease until the button is released, then the new set speed will be established.
To Accelerate For Passing
Press the accelerator as you would normally. When the pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
UsingElectronicSpeedControlOnHills
The transmission may downshift on hills to maintain the vehicle set speed.
NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on moderate hills is normal.
On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed Control.

WARNING!
ElectronicSpeedControlcanbedangerouswherethe systemcannotmaintainaconstantspeed.Yourvehiclecouldgotoofastfortheconditions,andyou couldlosecontrolandhaveanaccident.Donotuse ElectronicSpeedControlinheavytrafficoronroads thatarewinding,icy,snow-coveredorslippery.
PARKSENSE® REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED
The ParkSense® Rear Park Assist system provides visual and audible indications of the distance between the rear fascia and a detected obstacle when backing up, e.g. during a parking maneuver. Refer to ParkSense® System Usage Precautions for limitations of this system and recommendations.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 193
ParkSense® will retain the last system state (enabled or disabled) from the last ignition cycle when the ignition is changed to the ON/RUN position.
ParkSense® can be active only when the shift lever/gear selector is in REVERSE. If ParkSense® is enabled at this shift lever/gear selector position, the system will remain active until the vehicle speed is increased to approximately 7 mph (11 km/h) or above. When in REVERSE and above the system's operating speed, a warning will appear in the EVIC indicating the vehicle speed is too fast. The system will become active again if the vehicle speed is decreased to speeds less than approximately 6 mph (9 km/h).
ParkSense® Sensors
The four ParkSense® sensors, located in the rear fascia/bumper, monitor the area behind the vehicle that is within the sensors' field of view. The sensors can detect obstacles from approximately 12 in (30 cm) up to 59 in

194 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
(150 cm) from the rear fascia/bumper in the horizontal direction, depending on the location, type and orientation of the obstacle.
ParkSense® Warning Display
The ParkSense® Warning screen is located within the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). It provides visual warnings to indicate the distance between the rear fascia/bumper and the detected obstacle. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Settings” in Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
The ParkSense® Warning screen will only be displayed if Sound and Display is selected.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information. If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
ParkSense® Display
When the vehicle is in REVERSE, the warning display will turn ON indicating the system status.
The system will indicate a detected obstacle by showing a single arc in the left and/or right rear regions based on the object's distance and location relative to the vehicle.
If an object is detected in the left and/or right rear region, the display will show a single solid arc in the left and/or right rear region and the system will produce a tone. As the vehicle moves closer to the object, the display will show the single arc moving closer to the vehicle and the tone will change from a single 1/2 second tone to slow, to fast, to continuous.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 195

natural_image
Top-down diagram of a car with sensor waves, labeled 'PRND' below (no other text or symbols)032771343

natural_image
Top-down diagram of a car with sensor waves, labeled 'PRND' below (no other text or symbols)032771342
Single1/2SecondToneSlowTone

Information Provident by. DEALER
196 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Top-down diagram of a car with sensor waves, labeled 'PRND' below (no other text or symbols)032771344

text_image
PRND032771345
FastToneContinuousTone

Information Provided by: DEALER
The vehicle is close to the obstacle when the warning display shows one flashing arc and sounds a continuous tone. The following chart shows the warning alert operation when the system is detecting an obstacle:
| WARNINGALERTS | |||||
| Rear Distance (in/cm) | Greater than 79 in (200 cm) | 79-45 in (200-115 cm) | 45-31 in (115-80 cm) | 31-18 in (80-45 cm) | Less than 12 in (30 cm) |
| Audible Alert Chime | None Single | 1/2 Second Tone | Slow Fast Continuous | ||
| Arc None 4th Solid 3rd | Solid | 2nd Flashing | 1st Flashing | ||
| Radio Volume Reduced | No Yes Yes | Yes Yes | |||
NOTE: ParkSense® will reduce the volume of the radio, if on, when the system is sounding an audio tone.
Enabling And Disabling ParkSense®
ParkSense® can be enabled and disabled with the ParkSense® switch.

When the ParkSense switch is pressed to disable the system, the instrument cluster will display the "PARKSENSE OFF" message for approximately five seconds. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information. When the shift lever is moved to REVERSE and the system is disabled, the EVIC will display the "PARKSENSE OFF" message for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE.
NOTE: The ParkSense® system will automatically disable when the system detects that a trailer with trailer brakes has been connected to the Integrated Trailer Brake Module. The EVIC will display "PARKSENSE OFF" message for as long as the vehicle is in revers e.
The ParkSense® switch LED will be ON when ParkSense® is disabled or defective. The ParkSense® switch LED will be OFF when the system is enabled.
If the ParkSense switch is pressed, and the system is disabled or requires service, the ParkSense switch LED will blink momentarily, and then the LED will be ON.
Service The ParkSense® Rear Park Assist System
During vehicle start up, when the ParkSense® Rear Park Assist System has detected a faulted condition, the instrument cluster will actuate a single chime, once per ignition cycle, and it will display the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS" or the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information. When the shift lever is moved to

REVERSE and the system has detected a faulted condition, the EVIC will display the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS" or the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE. Under this condition, ParkSense® will not operate.
If "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS" appears in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) make sure the outer surface and the underside of the rear fascia/bumper is clean and clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt or other obstruction, and then cycle the ignition. If the message continues to appear, see an authorized dealer.
If "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" appears in the EVIC, see your authorized dealer.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 199
Cleaning The ParkSense® System
Clean the ParkSense® sensors with water, car wash soap and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard cloths. Do not scratch or poke the sensors. Otherwise, you could damage the sensors.
ParkSense® System Usage Precautions
NOTE:
- Ensure that the rear bumper is free of snow, ice, mud, dirt and debris to keep the ParkSense® system operating properly.
- Jackhammers, large trucks, and other vibrations could affect the performance of ParkSense®.
- When you turn ParkSense® off, the instrument cluster will display "PARKSENSE OFF". Furthermore, once you turn ParkSense® off, it remains off until you turn it on again, even if you cycle the ignition key.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- When you move the shift lever to the REVERSE position and ParkSense® is turned off, the instrument cluster will display "PARKSENSE OFF" message for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE.
- ParkSense®, when on, will reduce the volume of the radio when it is sounding a tone.
- Clean the ParkSense® sensors regularly, taking care not to scratch or damage them. The sensors must not be covered with ice, snow, slush, mud, dirt or debris. Failure to do so can result in the system not working properly. The ParkSense® system might not detect an obstacle behind the fascia/bumper, or it could provide a false indication that an obstacle is behind the fascia/bumper.
- Ensure the ParkSense® system is OFF if objects such as bicycle carriers, trailer hitches, etc., are placed within 18 in (45 cm) from the rear fascia/bumper while driving the vehicle. Failure to do so can result in the
system misinterpreting a close obstacle as a sensor problem, causing the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message to be displayed in the instrument cluster.
- On vehicles equipped with a tailgate, ParkSense® should be disabled when the tailgate is in the lowered or open position and the vehicle is in REVERSE. A lowered tailgate could provide a false indication that an obstacle is behind the vehicle.
CAUTION!
- ParkSense® is only a parking aid and it is unable to recognize every obstacle, including small obstacles. Parking curbs might be temporarily detected or not detected at all. Obstacles located above or below the sensors will not be detected when they are in close proximity.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 201
CAUTION!(Continued)
- The vehicle must bedrivenslowly when using ParkSense® inordertobeabletostopintime when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended that the driver looks over his/her shoulder when using ParkSense®.
WARNING!
- Driversmustbecarefulwhenbackingupeven whenusingParkSense®.Alwayscheckcarefully behindyourvehicle,lookbehindyou,andbesure tocheckforpedestrians,animals,othervehicles, obstructions,andblindspotsbeforebackingup. Youareresponsibleforsafetyandmustcontinueto payattentiontoyoursurroundings.Failurertodoso canresultinseriousinjuryordeath.
WARNING!(Continued)
- BeforeusingParkSense®,itisstronglyrecommendedthattheballmountandhitchballassemblyisdisconnectedfromthevehiclewhenthe vehicleisnotusedfortowing.Failureretodosocan resultininjuryordamagetovehiclesorobstacles because the hitchballwillbemuchclosertothe obstacle thantherearfasciawhentheloudspeaker soundsthecontinuoustone.Also,thesensors could detect the ballmountandhitchballassembly,dependingonitssizeandshape,givingafalse indication that anobstacle is behind the vehicle.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
202 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
PARKSENSE® FRONT AND REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED
The ParkSense® Park Assist system provides visual and audible indications of the distance between the rear and/or front fascia and a detected obstacle when backing up or moving forward, e.g. during a parking maneuver. Refer to ParkSense® System Usage Precautions for limitations of this system and recommendations.
ParkSense® will retain the last system state (enabled or disabled) from the last ignition cycle when the ignition is changed to the ON/RUN position.
ParkSense® can be active only when the shift lever is in REVERSE or DRIVE. If ParkSense® is enabled at one of these shift lever positions, the system will remain active until the vehicle speed is increased to approximately 7 mph (11 km/h) or above. A display warning will appear in the EVIC indicating the vehicle is above
ParkSense® operating speed. The system will become active again if the vehicle speed is decreased to speeds less than approximately 6 mph (9 km/h).
ParkSense® Sensors
The four ParkSense® sensors, located in the rear fascia/bumper, monitor the area behind the vehicle that is within the sensors' field of view. The sensors can detect obstacles from approximately 18 in (45 cm) up to 79 in (200 cm) from the rear fascia/bumper in the horizontal direction, depending on the location, type and orientation of the obstacle.
The six ParkSense® sensors, located in the front fascia/bumper, monitor the area in front of the vehicle that is within the sensors' field of view. The sensors can detect obstacles from approximately 12 in (30 cm) up to 47 in (120 cm) from the front fascia/bumper in the horizontal direction, depending on the location, type and orientation of the obstacle.

ParkSense® Warning Display
The ParkSense® Warning screen is located within the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). It provides visual warnings to indicate the distance between the rear fascia/bumper and/or front fascia/bumper and the detected obstacle. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Settings” in Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
The ParkSense® Warning screen will only be displayed if Sound and Display is selected.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be programmed through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to “Electronic
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 203
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
ParkSense® Display
The warning display will turn ON indicating the system status when the vehicle is in REVERSE or when the vehicle is in DRIVE and an obstacle has been detected.
The system will indicate a detected obstacle by showing a single arc in the left and/or right rear regions based on the obstacle's distance and location relative to the vehicle.
If an obstacle is detected in the left and/or right rear region, the display will show a single arc in the left and/or right rear region and the system will produce a tone. As the vehicle moves closer to the obstacle, the display will show the single arc moving closer to the vehicle and the tone will change from a single 1/2 second tone to slow, to fast, to continuous.

204 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The vehicle is close to the obstacle when the EVIC display shows one flashing arc and sounds a continuous tone.
The following chart shows the warning alert operation when the system is detecting an obstacle:
| WARNINGALERTS | |||||
| Rear Distance (in/cm) | Greater than 79 in (200 cm) | 79-45 in (200-115 cm) | 45-31 in (115-80 cm) | 31-18 in (80-45 cm) | Less than 18 in (45 cm) |
| Front Distance (in/cm) | Greater than 47 in (120 cm) | 47-39 in (120-100 cm) | 39-25 in (100-65 cm) | 25-12 in (65-30 cm) | Less than 12 in (30 cm) |
| Audible Alert (Chime) | None Single | 1/2 Second Tone (for rear only) | Slow (for rear only) | Fast Continuous | |
| Arcs None 4th Solid 3rd Solid 2nd Flashing 1st Flashing | |||||
| Radio Volume Reduced | No Yes Yes | Yes | Yes | ||
NOTE: ParkSense® will reduce the volume of the radio, if on, when the system is sounding an audio t one.

DEALER
FrontParkAssistAudibleAlerts
ParkSense® will turn off the Front Park Assist audible alert (chime) after approximately three seconds when an obstacle has been detected, the vehicle is stationary, and brake pedal is applied.
AdjustableChimeVolumeSettings
Front and Rear chime volume settings can be selected from the EVIC or Uconnect® System — if equipped.
If Uconnect® System is equipped, chime volume settings will not be accessible from the EVIC.
The chime volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and HIGH. The factory default volume setting is MEDIUM.
ParkSense® will retain its last known configuration state through ignition cycles.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 205
Enabling And Disabling Front And/Or Rear ParkSense®
Front ParkSense® can be enabled and disabled with the Front ParkSense® switch.
Rear ParkSense® can be enabled and disabled with the Rear ParkSense® switch.

When the Front or Rear ParkSense® switch is pressed to disable the system, the instrument cluster will display the "PARKSENSE OFF" message for approximately five seconds. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
When the shift lever is moved to REVERSE and the Front or Rear system is disabled, the EVIC will display the "FRONT PARKSENSE OFF" or "REAR PARKSENSE OFF" message for five seconds, followed by a car graphic with "OFF" in the corresponding side. This car graphic will be displayed for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE.
NOTE: Arc alerts from the enabled ParkSense® system, will interrupt the five second messages, and the EVIC will display the car graphic with the corresponding arcs and "OFF" message.
The Front or Rear ParkSense® switch LED will be ON when Front or Rear ParkSense® is disabled or requires service. The Front or Rear ParkSense® switch LED will be OFF when the Front or Rear system is enabled. If the Front or Rear ParkSense® switch is pressed, and the system requires service, the Front or Rear ParkSense® switch LED will blink momentarily, and then the LED will be ON.
Service The ParkSense® Park Assist System
During vehicle start up, when the ParkSense® System has detected a faulted condition, the instrument cluster will actuate a single chime, once per ignition cycle, and it will display the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS", "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS", or the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message for five seconds. When the shift lever is moved to Reverse and the system has detected a faulted condition, the EVIC will display a "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS", "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS" or "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" pop up message for five seconds. After five seconds, a car graphic will be displayed with "UNAVAILABLE" at either the front or rear sensor location depending on where the fault is detected. The system will continue to provide arc alerts for the side that is functioning properly. These

arc alerts will interrupt the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS", "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS", or "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" messages if an object is detected within the five second pop-up duration. The car graphic will remain displayed for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS" or "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS" appears in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) make sure the outer surface and the underside of the rear fascia/bumper and/or front fascia/bumper is clean and clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt or other obstruction and then cycle the ignition. If the message continues to appear see an authorized dealer.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 207
If the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message appears in the EVIC, see an authorized dealer.
Cleaning The ParkSense® System
Clean the ParkSense® sensors with water, car wash soap and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard cloths. Do not scratch or poke the sensors. Otherwise, you could damage the sensors.
ParkSense® System Usage Precautions
NOTE:
- Ensure that the front and rear bumper are free of snow, ice, mud, dirt and debris to keep the ParkSense® system operating properly.
- Jackhammers, large trucks, and other vibrations could affect the performance of ParkSense®.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- When you turn Front or Rear ParkSense® off, the instrument cluster will display "FRONT PARKSENSE OFF" or "REAR PARKSENSE OFF." Furthermore, once you turn Front or Rear ParkSense® off, it remains off until you turn it on again, even if you cycle the ignition key.
- When you move the shift lever to the REVERSE position and Front or Rear ParkSense® is turned off, the instrument cluster will display "FRONT PARKSENSE OFF" or "REAR PARKSENSE OFF" message for five seconds, followed by a car graphic with "OFF" in the corresponding side. This car graphic will be displayed for as long as the vehicle is in REVERSE.
- ParkSense®, when on, will reduce the volume of the radio when it is sounding a tone.
- Clean the ParkSense® sensors regularly, taking care not to scratch or damage them. The sensors must not be covered with ice, snow, slush, mud, dirt or debris.
Failure to do so can result in the system not working properly. The ParkSense® system might not detect an obstacle behind or in front of the fascia/bumper, or it could provide a false indication that an obstacle is behind or in front of the fascia/bumper.
- Use the ParkSense® switch to turn the ParkSense® system off if obstacles such as bicycle carriers, trailer hitches, etc. are placed within 18 in (45 cm) from the rear fascia/bumper. Failure to do so can result in the system misinterpreting a close obstacle as a sensor problem, causing the "PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED" message to be displayed in the instrument cluster.
- On vehicles equipped with a tailgate, ParkSense® should be disabled when the tailgate is in the lowered or open position. A lowered tailgate could provide a false indication that an obstacle is behind the vehicle.
CAUTION!
- ParkSense®isonlyaparkingaidanditisunableto recognizeeveryobstacle, includingsmallobstacles. Parkingcurbsmightbetemporarilydetectedornot detectedatall.Obstacleslocatedaboveorbelow thesensorswillnotbedetectedwhentheyarein closeproximity.
- The vehicle must bedrivenslowly when using ParkSense® inordertobeabletostopintime when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended that the driver overlooks over his/her shoulder when using ParkSense®.
WARNING!
- Driversmustbecarefulwhenbackingupeven whenusingParkSense®.Alwayscheckcarefully behindyourvehicle,lookbehindyou,andbesure tocheckforpedestrians,animals,othervehicles, obstructions,andblindspotsbeforebackingup. Youareresponsibleforsafetyandmustcontinueto payattentiontoyoursurroundings.Failureretodoso canresultinseriousinjuryordeath.
(Continued)
210 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!(Continued)
- BeforeusingParkSense®,itisstronglyrecommendedthattheballmountandhitchballassemblyisdisconnectedfromthevehiclewhenthe vehicleisnotusedfortowing.Failureretodosocan resultininjuryordamagetovehiclesorobstacles because the hitchballwillbemuchclosertothe obstacle thantherearfasciawhentheloudspeaker soundsthecontinuoustone.Also,thesensors could detect the ballmountandhitchballassembly,dependingonitssizeandshape,givingafalse indication that an obstacle is behind the vehicle.
PARKVIEW® REAR BACK UP CAMERA — IF EQUIPPED
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera that allows you to see a image of the rear surroundings of your vehicle whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE. The image will be displayed in the rearview mirror display (if equipped) or Uconnect® screen (if equipped) along with a caution note to "check entire surroundings" across the top of the screen. After five seconds this note will disappear.
The ParkView® camera is located to the left of the tailgate handle.
When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE (with camera delay turned OFF), the rear camera mode is exited and the navigation or audio screen appears again.
When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE (with camera delay turned ON), The rear camera image will be displayed for up to 10 seconds after shifting out of ◆REVERSE◆ unless the forward vehicle speed exceeds 8 mph (13 km/h), the transmission is shifted into ◆PARK◆ or the ignition is switched to the OFF position.
When enabled, active guide lines are overlaid on the image to illustrate the width of the vehicle and its projected backup path based on the steering wheel position. The active guide lines will show separate zones that will help indicate the distance to the rear of the vehicle.
For further information about how to access and change the programmable features of the Parkview® Rear Backup Camera, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
The following table shows the approximate distances for each zone:
| ZonesDistancetotherearofthevehicle | |
| Red 0 - 1 ft (0 - 30 cm) | |
| Yellow 1 ft - 3 ft (30 cm - 1 m ) | |
| Green | 3 ft or greater (1 m orgreater) |
212 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Driversmustbecarefulwhenbackingupevenwhen usingtheParkView®RearBackUpCamera.Always checkcarefullybehindyourvehicle,andbesureto checkforpedestrians,animals,othervehicles,obstructions,orblindspotsbeforebackingup.Youare responsibleforthesafetyofyoursurroundingsand mustcontinuetopayattentionwhilebackingup. Failuretodosocanresultinseriousinjuryordeath.
CAUTION!
- To avoid vehicle damage, ParkView® should only be used as a parking aid. The ParkView® camera is unable to view every obstacle or object in your drivepath.
(Continued)
CAUTION!(Continued)
- To avoid vehicle damage, the vehicle must be drivenslowly when using ParkView® to be able to stop in tim when an obstacle is seen. It is recommended that the driver look frequently over his/her shoulder when using ParkView®.
NOTE: If snow, ice, mud, or any foreign substance builds up on the camera lens, clean the lens, rinse with water, and dry with a soft cloth. Do not cover the lens.
OVERHEAD CONSOLE — IF EQUIPPED
The overhead console is located on the headliner above the review mirror. The overhead console contains the following features:
•Courtesy/Reading Lights
- Power Sunroof Switch — If Equipped

•Power Sliding Rear Window Switch — If Equipped
•Universal Garage Door Opener — If Equipped

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional arrows (no text or symbols)OverheadConsole
Courtesy/Reading Lights
Both lights in the overhead console and rear passenger compartment will illuminate as courtesy lights when a
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 213
door is opened, when the dimmer control is rotated to the courtesy light position (full right position), or when the UNLOCK button is pressed on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, if equipped. These lights are also operated individually as reading lights by pressing on the corresponding lens.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with two directional buttons and a central control panel (no text or symbols visible)FrontCourtesy/ReadingLights

214 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Microscopic view of a rectangular biological cell with a labeled arrow pointing to its interior (no text or symbols on the cell itself)RearPassengerCourtesy/ReadingLight
NOTE: The courtesy/reading lights will remain on until the switch is pressed a second time, so be sure they have been turned off before leaving the vehicle. If the interior lights are left on after the ignition is turned OFF, they will automatically turn off after 15 minutes.
GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED
HomeLink® replaces up to three hand-held transmitters that operate devices such as garage door openers, motorized gates, lighting or home security systems. The HomeLink® unit is powered by your vehicles 12 Volt battery.
The HomeLink® buttons that are located in the overhead console designate the three different HomeLink® channels.


natural_image
Close-up of a metallic control panel with three vertical slots and three rectangular buttons, no text or symbols visible.HomeLink®Buttons
NOTE: HomeLink® is disabled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 215
Before You Begin Programming HomeLink®
Ensure your vehicle is parked outside of the garage before you begin programming.
For efficient programming and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal it is recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of the device that is being programmed to the HomeLink® system.
Erase all channels before you begin programming. To erase the channels place the ignition in the ON/RUN position and press and hold the two outside HomeLink® buttons (I and III) for up to 20 seconds. The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display "CLEARING CHANNELS." Release the buttons when the EVIC displays "CHANNELS CLEARED."

216 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
- Erasing all channels should only be performed when programming HomeLink® for the first time. Do not erase channels when programming additional buttons.
- If you have any problems, or require assistance, please call toll-free 1-800-355-3515 or, on the Internet at www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
Programming A Rolling Code
For programming garage door openers that were manufactured after 1995. These garage door openers can be identified by the "LEARN" or "TRAIN" button located where the hanging antenna is attached to the garage door opener. It is NOT the button that is normally used to open and close the door. The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer.

text_image
Technical diagram showing installation of a device with labeled components and a close-up view of the assembly.TrainingTheGarageDoorOpener
1 — Door Opener
2 — Training Button
- Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
- Place the hand - held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to 8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program.
- Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink® button you want to program and the hand - held transmitter button.
- Continue to hold buttons until the EVIC display changes from "CHANNEL # TRAINING" to "CHANNEL # TRAINED," then release both buttons.
NOTE:
- It may take up to 30 seconds or longer in some cases for the channel to train.
- If the EVIC displays "DID NOT TRAIN" repeat from Step 2.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
217
- At the garage door opener motor (in the garage), locate the "LEARN" or "TRAINING" button. This can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the garage door opener/device motor.
Firmly press and release the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. On some garage door openers/devices there may be a light that blinks when the garage door opener/device is in the LEARN/TRAIN mode.
NOTE: You have 30 seconds in which to initiate the next step after the LEARN button has been pressed.
- Return to the vehicle and press the programmed HomeLink® button twice (holding the button for two seconds each time). The EVIC will display "CHANNEL # TRANSMIT." If the garage door opener/device activates, programming is complete.
NOTE: If the garage door opener/device does not activate, press the button a third time (for two seconds) to complete the training.

218 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons, repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT erase the channels.
ReprogrammingASingleHomeLink®Button
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, follow these steps:
-
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
-
Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until the EVIC displays "CHANNEL # TRAINING" Do not releasethebutton.
-
Withoutreleasingthebuttonproceed with "Programming A Rolling Code" Step 2 and follow all remaining steps.
Programming A Non-Rolling Code
For programming Garage Door Openers manufactured before 1995.
-
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
-
Place the hand - held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to 8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program.
-
Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink® button you want to program and the hand - held transmitter button.
-
Continue to hold buttons until the EVIC display changes from "CHANNEL # TRAINING" to "CHANNEL # TRAINED," then release both buttons.
NOTE:
- It may take up to 30 seconds or longer in some cases for the channel to train.
-
If the EVIC displays "DID NOT TRAIN" repeat from Step 2.
-
Press and hold the programmed HomeLink® button. The EVIC will display "CHANNEL # TRANSMIT." If the garage door opener/device activates, programming is complete.
To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons, repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT erase the channels.
ReprogrammingASingleHomeLink®Button
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, follow these steps:
- Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 219
- Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do not releasethebutton.
- Withoutreleasingthebuttonproceed with "Programming A Non-Rolling Code" step 2 and follow all remaining steps.
Canadian/Gate Operator Programming
For programming transmitters in Canada/United States that require the transmitter signals to "time-out" after several seconds of transmission.
Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds of transmission – which may not be long enough for HomeLink® to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to time-out in the same manner.

220 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
It may be helpful to unplug the device during the cycling process to prevent possible overheating of the garage door or gate motor.
- Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
- Place the hand - held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to 8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program.
- Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink® button while you press and release ("cycle"), your hand - held transmitter every two seconds.
- Continue to hold buttons until the EVIC display changes from "CHANNEL # TRAINING" to "CHANNEL # TRAINED," then release both buttons.
NOTE:
- It may take up to 30 seconds or longer in some cases for the channel to train.
-
If the EVIC displays "DID NOT TRAIN" repeat from Step 2.
-
Press and hold the programmed HomeLink® button. The EVIC will display "CHANNEL # TRANSMIT." If the device is plugged in and activates, programming is complete.
If you unplugged the garage door opener/device for programming, plug it back in at this time.
ReprogrammingASingleHomeLink®Button
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, follow these steps:
- Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
- Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until the EVIC displays "CHANNEL # TRAINING" Do not releasethebutton.
- Withoutreleasingthebuttonproceed with "Canadian/Gate Operator Programming" Step 2 and follow all remaining steps.
Using HomeLink®
To operate, press and release the programmed HomeLink® button. Activation will now occur for the programmed device (i.e., garage door opener, gate operator, security system, entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.). The hand-held transmitter of the device may also be used at any time.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 221
Security
It is advised to erase all channels before you sell or turn in your vehicle.
To erase the channels press and hold the two outside HomeLink® buttons (I and III) for up 20 seconds. The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display "CLEARING CHANNELS." Release the buttons when the EVIC displays "CHANNELS CLEARED."
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is disabled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
Troubleshooting Tips
If you are having trouble programming HomeLink®, here are some of the most common solutions:
- Replace the battery in the original hand-held transmitter.

222 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- Press the LEARN button on the Garage Door Opener to complete the training for a Rolling Code.
- Did you unplug the device for programming and remember to plug it back in?
If you have any problems, or require assistance, please call toll-free 1-800-355-3515 or, on the Internet at www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
WARNING!
Vehicleexhaustcontainscarbonmonoxide,adangerousgas.Donotrunyourvehicleinthegaragewhile programmingthetransceiver.Exhaustgascancause seriousinjuryordeath.
WARNING!
Yourmotorizeddoororgatewillopenandclose whileyouareprogrammingtheuniversaltransceiver.Donotprogramthetransceiverifpeople,pets orotherobjectsareinthepathofthedoororgate. Onlyusethistransceiverwithagaragedooropener thathasa"stopandreverse"featureasrequiredby Federalsafetystandards.Thisincludesmostgarage dooropenermodelsmanufacturedafter1982.Donot useagaragedooropenerwithoutthesesafetyfeatures.Calltoll-free1-800-355-3515or,ontheInternet atwww.HomeLink.comforsafetyinformationor assistance.
General Information
This device complies with FCC rules Part 15 and Industry Canada RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
- This device may not cause harmful interference.
- This device must accept any interference that may be received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 223
NOTE:
- The transmitter has been tested and it complies with FCC and IC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the device.
- The term IC before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.

Information Provided by. DEALER
224 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED
The power sunroof switch is located on the overhead console between the courtesy/reading lights.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional arrow indicator (no readable text or symbols)PowerSunroofSwitch
WARNING!
- Neverleavechildrenunattendedinvehicle,or withaccesstoanunlockedvehicle.Neverleavethe KeyFobinornethevehicle,orinalocation accessibletochildren.Donotleavetheignitionof avehicleequippedwithKeylessEnter-N-Go™in theACCorON/RUNmode.Occupants,particularlyunattendedchildren,canbecomeentrapped bythepowersunroofwhileoperatingthepower sunroofswitch.Suchentrapmentmayresultin seriousinjuryordeath.
- Inacollision, thereisagreatarriskofbeingthrown fromavehiclewithanopensunroof. Youcould alsobeseriouslyinjuredorkilled. Alwaysfasten yourseatbeltproperlyandmakesureallpassengersarealsoproperlysecured.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotallowsmallchildrentooperatethesunroof. Neverallowyourfingers,otherbodyparts,orany object,toprojectthroughthesunroofopening. Injurymayresult.
Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode
To open the sunroof, press and hold the switch rearward to full open. Any release of the switch will stop the movement. The sunroof and sunshade will remain in a partially opened condition until the switch is pushed and held rearward again.
Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode
To close the sunroof, press and hold the switch in the forward position. Any release of the switch will stop the movement and the sunroof will remain in a partially closed condition until the switch is pushed and held forward again.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 225
Opening Sunroof — Express
Press the switch rearward and release it within one-half second and the sunroof will open automatically from any position. The sunroof will open fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Open”. During Express Open operation, any movement of the sunroof switch will stop the sunroof.
Closing Sunroof — Express
Press the switch forward and release it within one-half second and the sunroof will close automatically from any position. The sunroof will close fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Close”. During Express Close operation, any movement of the switch will stop the sunroof.

226 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Pinch Protect Feature
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obstruction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs. Next, press the switch forward and release to Express Close.
NOTE: If three consecutive sunroof close attempts result in Pinch Protect reversals, the fourth close attempt will be a Manual Close movement with Pinch Protect disabled. Press and hold close switch to fully close sunroof.
Venting Sunroof — Express
Press and release the Vent button within one half second and the sunroof will open to the vent position. This is called "Express Vent", and it will occur regardless of sunroof position. During Express Vent operation, any movement of the switch will stop the sunroof.
Sunshade Operation
The sunshade can be opened manually. However, the sunshade will open automatically as the sunroof opens.
NOTE: The sunshade cannot be closed if the sunroof is open.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting or open any window.

Sunroof Maintenance
Use only a nonabrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to clean the glass panel.
Ignition Off Operation
The power sunroof switch will remain active for up to approximately ten minutes after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door will cancel this feature.
NOTE:Ignition Off time is programmable through the Uconnect® System. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings/Customer Programmable Features" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 227
ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS
The auxiliary 12 Volt (13 Amp) power outlets can provide power for in-cab accessories designed for use with the standard "cigar lighter" plug. The 12 Volt power outlets have a cap attached to the outlet indicating "12V DC," together with either a key symbol or a battery symbol.
A key symbol indicates that the key must be in the ON/RUN or ACC positions for the outlet to provide power. The battery symbol indicates that the outlet is connected to the battery, and can provide power at all times.
NOTE: To ensure proper operation, a MOPAR® knob and element must be used.
228 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The auxiliary power outlets can be found in the following locations:
CAUTION!
- Donotexceedthemaximumpowerof160Watts(13Amps)at12Volts.Ifthe160Watts(13Amps)power ratingisexceeded,thefuseprotectingthesystem willneedtobereplaced.
- Poweroutletsaredesignedforaccessoryplugs only.Donotinsertanyotherobjectinthepower outletsasthiswilldamagetheoutletandblowthe fuse.Improperuseofthepoweroutletcancause damagenotcoveredbyyourNewVehicleLimited Warranty.
- Lower left and lower right of the center stack when equipped with a bench seat.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panels and directional arrows indicating movement (no readable text or symbols)PowerOutlets—CenterStack

Information Provider Syc. DEALER
- Center console when equipped with bucket seats.

text_image
UV DC D 034771464PowerOutlet—CenterConsole
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 229
- Inside the upper lid of the center storage compartment — if equipped.

text_image
12V DC AUX 034771465PowerOutlet—UpperLid

Information Provided by: DEALER
230 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- Rear of the center console storage compartment — Quad Cab® or Crew Cab.

natural_image
Close-up of a car air conditioner panel with a black arrow pointing to the control panel (no text or symbols visible)PowerOutlet—RearCenterConsole
The key symbol indicates that this outlet can supply power when the key is in the ON/RUN or ACC positions.
All accessories connected to the outlet(s) should be removed or turned off when the vehicle is not in use to protect the battery against discharge.
WARNING!
Toavoidseriousinjuryordeath:
- Onlydevicesdesignedforuseinthistypeofoutlet shouldbeinsertedintoany12Voltoutlet.
- Donottouchwithwethands.
- Closethelidwhennotinuseandwhiledrivingthe vehicle.
- If this outletismishandled, it may cause an electric shock and failure.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 231
CAUTION!
- Manyaccessories that can be plugged in draw power from the vehicle's battery, even when not in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if plugged in longenough, the vehicle's battery will discharges sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or prevent the engine from starting.
- Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers, vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.), will discharge the battery even more quickly. Only us these intermittently and with greater caution.
- Aftertheuseofhighpowerdrawaccessories,or longperiodsofthevehiclenotbeingstarted(with accessoriesstillpluggedin),thevehiclemustbe drivenasufficientlengthoftimetoallowthe generatortorechargethevehicle'sbattery.
CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF EQUIPPED
A removable ash receiver and cigar lighter are available. For vehicles with a bench seat the cupholder tray can be used to hold the ash receiver.
232 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

text_image
Technical diagram of a mechanical assembly with labeled parts and directional arrows indicating process flowOptionalFloorShifter
1 — Cigar Lighter
2 — Ash Receiver
POWER INVERTER — IF EQUIPPED
A 115 Volt (150 Watts Maximum) outlet is located on the center stack of the instrument panel, to the right of the radio. This outlet can power cellular phones, electronics and other low power devices requiring power up to 150 Watts. Certain high-end video games, such as PlayStation3 and XBox360 will exceed this power limit, as will most power tools.
The power inverter is designed with built-in overload protection. If the power rating of 150 Watts is exceeded, the power inverter will automatically shut down. Once the electrical device has been removed from the outlet the inverter should automatically reset.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 233

text_image
TUNO BROWSE ENTER SCROLL FRONT 15V AC 15V W 0456009854PowerInverterOutlet
To turn on the power outlet, simply plug in the device. The outlet automatically turns off when the device is unplugged.
NOTE: Due to built-in overload protection, the power inverter will shut down if the power rating is exceeded.
WARNING!
Toavoidseriousinjuryordeath:
- Donotinsertanyobjectsintothereceptacles.
- Donottouchwithwethands.
• Closethelidwhennotinuse. - If this outletismishandled, it may cause an electric shock and failure.
CUPHOLDERS
Front Seat Cupholders (40–20–40 Seats)
The cupholders are located on the backside of the center portion of the front seat (20). Fold down the center section of the front seat to gain access to the cupholders.

234 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Front Instrument Panel Cupholders — Floor Mounted Shifter
For vehicles equipped with bucket seats there are two cupholders located in the floor console.

natural_image
Interior view of a car gear shift lever with two white arrows indicating direction (no text or symbols)CupholdersRearCupWells
Rear Cupholder — Quad Cab®
Quad Cab® vehicles may be equipped with a rear cupholder that consists of two cup wells for rear passenger convenience.

natural_image
Close-up of a car gear with a highlighted opening and arrow indicator (no text or symbols)
Information Provided by: DEALER
Rear Cupholder — Crew Cab
Crew Cab vehicles are equipped with rear cupholders located in the center armrest.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing rear seats and seatbelt, with a black arrow pointing to the seat (no text or symbols on the main body)CrewCabRearArmrestCupholder
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 235
Crew Cab vehicles may be equipped with a rear cup-holder that consists of two cup wells for rear passenger convenience.

natural_image
Close-up of a car intake canal with a white arrow pointing to the opening area (no text or symbols)RearCupWells

Information Provider Pty. DEALER
236 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
STORAGE
Glove Compartment
The glove compartment is located on the passenger side of the instrument panel and features both an upper and lower storage area.

text_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with labeled parts and directional arrows indicating movement or flow.GloveCompartment
1 — Upper Glove Compartment
2 — Lower Glove Compartment

Information Provided by: DEALER
To open the upper glove compartment push upward on the handle release. The glove compartment door will automatically open.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and air intake unit (no visible text or symbols)UpperGloveCompartment
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 237
To open the lower glove compartment, pull on the handle to release the latch and lower the glove compartment door.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the front and rear seats with a vehicle inside (no visible text or symbols)LowerGloveCompartment

Information Provided by: DEALER
238 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Door Storage
FrontDoorStorage—IfEquipped
Storage areas and bottle holders (drivers side only) are located in the door trim panels.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating movement or flow (no text or symbols)FrontDoorStorage
RearDoorStorage—CrewCab
Storage compartments are located in both the driver and passenger door trim panels.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest door and side panel with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)RearDoorStorage

Information Provident By: DEALER
Center Storage Compartment — If Equipped
The center storage compartment is located between the driver and passenger seats. The storage compartment provides an armrest and contains both and upper and lower storage area.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with seatbelt and dashboard controls (no visible text or symbols)CenterStorageCompartment
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 239
WARNING!
- Thisarmrestisnotaseat.Anyoneseatedonthe armrestcouldbeseriouslyinjuredduringvehicle operation,oracollision.Onlyusethecenterseatingpositionwhenthearmrestisfullyupright.
- Inacollision, the latch may open if the total weight of the items stored exceeds about 10 lbs (4.5 kg). These items could be thrown about endangering occupants of the vehicle. Items stored should not exceed at total of 10 lbs (4.5 kg).
Pull on the upper handle on the front of the armrest to raise the cover. The upper storage area contains a 12 Volt power outlet that can be used to power small electrical devices, refer to “Electrical Power Outlets” for further information.
240 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with seat compartments and a white arrow pointing to the backrest area (no text or symbols visible)UpperStorageCompartmentLowerStorageBin
With the upper lid closed, pull on the lower handle to open the lower storage bin.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle's backrest seat and dashboard compartment, showing no text or symbols on the seats or surroundings.WARNING!
Donotoperatethisvehiclewithaconsolecompartmentlidintheopenposition.Drivingwiththeconsolecompartmentlidopenmayresultininjuryin a collision.

Information Provided by: DEALER
Second Row In-Floor Storage Bin — If Equipped
In-floor storage bins are located in front of the second row seats and can be used for extra storage. The storage bins have removable liners that can be easily removed for cleaning.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 241
To open in-floor storage bin, lift upward on the handle of the latch and open the lid.
NOTE: The front seat may have to be moved forward to fully open the lid.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seatbelt with a black arrow pointing to a button (no text or symbols visible)In-FloorStorageBinAndLatch

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seat, dashboard, and side panel (no text or symbols visible)OpenedStorageBin

242 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Seatback Storage
Located in the back of both the driver and passenger front seats are pockets that can be used for storage.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the backrest seat, rear seats, and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)DriversSideSeatbackStorageStorageBin
Storage (Regular Cab)
The storage bin is located behind the front seats and runs the length of the cab.

natural_image
Interior view of a car door with lock icons and a black arrow pointing to the door panel (no text or symbols)
Information Provider by DEALER
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 243
Storage and Seats (Crew Cab)
The Crew Cab models provide additional storage under the rear seats. Lift the seats to access the storage compartment.
To open the storage compartments, lift upward on the handle of the latch and open the lid.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing two white arrows pointing to a mechanical component (no text or symbols visible)CrewCabStorage
CAUTION!
Alwaysliftthestoragecompartmentlidsbyusing thehandle.Failureuretoliftthelidsbyusingthehandle canresultindamagetothelids.

Information Provider Syc. DEALER
244 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Plastic Grocery Bag Retainers (Regular Cab Models)
Retainer hooks which will hold plastic grocery bag handles are built into the back panel of the cab, behind the rear seat.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing three directional arrows pointing to the door panel (no text or symbols present)GroceryBagHooks
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
Rear Window Defroster
The rear window defroster button is located on the climate control panel. Press this button to turn on the rear window defroster and the heated outside mirrors (if equipped). An indicator in the button will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 10 minutes. For an additional five minutes of operation, press the button a second time.
NOTE: To prevent excessive battery drain, use the rear window defroster only when the engine is operating.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 245
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to the heating elements:
- Usecarewhenwashingtheinsideoftherear window.Donotuseabrasivewindowcleanerson theinteriorsurfaceofthewindow.Useasoftcloth andamildwashingsolution,wipingparalleltothe heatingelements.Labelscanbepeeledoffafter soakingwithwarmwater.
- Donotusescrapers, sharpinstruments, or abrasive windowcleanersontheinteriorsurfaceofthe window.
- Keepallobjectsasafedistancefromthewindow.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)RearWindowSwitch
Push the switch to the right to open the glass. Pull the switch to the left to close the glass.
Power Sliding Rear Window — If Equipped
The switch for the power sliding rear window is located on the overhead console.

Information Provided by: DEALER
246 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Manual Sliding Rear Window — If Equipped
A locking device in the center of the window helps to prevent entry from the rear of the vehicle. Squeeze the lock to release the window.
FOLD FLAT LOAD FLOOR — IF EQUIPPED
Quad Cab® and Crew Cab models with a 60/40 rear seat may be equipped with a folding load floor.
WARNING!
Donotoperatethevehiclewithlooseitemsstoredon theloadfloor. Whiledrivingorinanaccidentyou mayexperienceabruptstopping,rapidacceleration, orsharpturns. Looseobjectsstoredontheloadfloor maymovearoundwithforceandstrikeoccupants, resultinginseriousorfatalinjury.
UnfoldingtheLoadFloor
- Lift the 60/40 seat cushion(s) to the upward position.

natural_image
Interior view of a car seat and dashboard with a directional arrow indicating movement (no text or symbols)UnfoldingTheLoadFloor
- Grasp the knob on the load floor and lift the knob until the load floor unfolds into position.


natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the rear seats and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)LoadFloorInOpenPosition
- Reverse the procedure to store the load floor.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 247
PositioningtheLoadFloorforStorageAccessUnderthe Seat
- Lift the 60/40 seat cushion(s) to the upward position.
- Unsnap the securing snap located at either side of the load floor.
- Lift the load floor up to access storage under the load floor.
WARNING!
Donotdrivewiththeloadfloorintheupposition. Whenstoppingfastorinanaccident,theloadfloor couldmovetothedownpositioncausingserious injury.
248 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the dashboard, seatbelt, and door (no text or symbols visible)LoadFloorSecuringStraps
- Reverse the procedure to put the load floor back in the secured down position before you operate the vehicle.
PICKUP BOX
The pickup box has many features designed for utility and convenience.

flowchart
graph TD
A["1"] --> B["2"]
B --> C["3"]
C --> A
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
PickUpBoxFeatures
1 — Upper Load Floor Indents
2 — Bulk Head Dividers
3 — Cleats

Information Provided by
DEALER
第1-3月内累计发生额
NOTE: If you are installing a Toolbox, Ladder Rack or Headache Rack at the front of the Pickup Box, you must use Mopar Box Reinforcement Brackets that are available from your authorized dealer.
You can carry wide building materials (sheets of plywood, etc.) by building a raised load floor. Place lumber across the box in the indentations provided above the wheel housings and in the bulkhead dividers to form the floor.
WARNING!
- Thepickupboxisintendedforloadcarryingpurposesonly,notforpassengers,whoshouldsitin seatsanduseseatbelts.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Careshouldalwaysbeexercisedwhenoperatinga vehiclewithunrestrainedcargo.Vehiclespeeds mayneedtobereduced.Severeturnsorrough roadsmaycauseshiftingorbouncingofthecargo thatmayresultinvehicledamage.Ifwidebuilding materialsaretobefrequentlycarried,theinstallationofasupportisrecommended.Thiswillre-strainthecargoandtransfertheloadtothepickup boxfloor.
- If you wish to carry more than 600 lbs (272 kg) of materials suspended above the wheel house, support must be installed to transfer the weight of the load to the pickup box floor or vehicle damage may result. The use of propers supports will permit loading up to the rated payload.
- Unrestrainedcargomaybethrownforwardinan accidentcausingseriousorfatalinjury.
250 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
There are stampings in the sheet metal on the inner side bulkheads of the box in front of and behind both wheel housings. Place wooden boards across the box from side to side to create separate load compartments in the pickup box.
There are four tie-down cleats bolted to the lower sides of the pickup box that can sustain loads up to 1000 lbs (450 kg) total.
Cargo Camera — If Equipped
Your vehicle may be equipped with the Cargo Camera that allows you to see a image of the inside of the pickup box. The image will be displayed in the Uconnect® screen.
A display timer is initiated when the cargo camera image is displayed. The image will continue to be displayed until the display timer exceeds 10 seconds and the vehicle speed is above 8 mph (13 km/h) or the image is deactivated by touching the Uconnect® display.
NOTE: If the vehicle speed remains below 8 mph (13 km/h), the cargo camera image will be displayed continuously until deactivated by touching the Uconnect® display.
The Cargo Camera is located in the bottom center area of the center high-mounted stoplamp (CHMSL).
NOTE: If snow, ice, mud, or any foreign substance builds up on the camera lens, clean the lens, rinse with water, and dry with a soft cloth. Do not cover the lens.
Turning Cargo Camera On Or Off — With Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN
- Press the "Controls" soft-key located on the bottom of the Uconnect® display.
- Press the "Cargo Camera" soft-key to turn the Cargo Camera system ON.


text_image
68° A Moment of... 10:10 54° out. 72° Controls Driver Heated Seat Mirror Dinner Vented Seat Cargo Camera Heated Wheel Settings Passenger Heated Seat Hi LO Vented Seat Lo Radio Media Controls Climate Nav Phone Apps0331016806
CargoCameraSoft-Key
NOTE: The Cargo Camera image may be deactivated by touching the Uconnect® display. The previous selected screen will appear.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 251
RAMBOX® — IF EQUIPPED
The RamBox® system is an integrated pickup box storage and cargo management system consisting of three features:
- Integrated box side storage bins
- Cargo extender/divider
• Bed rail tie-down system
RamBox® Integrated Box Side Storage Bins
Cargo storage bins are located on both sides of the pickup box. The cargo storage bins provide watertight, lockable, illuminated storage for up to 150 lbs (68 kg) for 1500 series vehicles or 300 lbs (136 kg) for 2500 and 3500 series vehicles of evenly distributed cargo.
252 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Technical illustration of a vehicle's rear compartment showing structural components and engine (no text or symbols)RamBox®CargoStorageBins
CAUTION!
Failure to follow the following items could cause damage to the vehicle:
• Assurethatallcargoinsidethestoragebinsis properlysecured.
- Donotexceedcargoweightratingof150lb(68kg) 1500seriesvehiclesor300lbs(136kg)for2500and 3500seriesvehiclesperbin.
To open a storage bin with the RamBox® unlocked, press and release the button located on the lid. The RamBox® lid will open upward to allow hand access. Lift the lid to fully open.
NOTE:RamBox® will not open when the pushbutton is pressed if the RamBox® is locked.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 253

natural_image
Side view of a pickup truck's side panel showing the wheel and exhaust pipe (no text or symbols)
natural_image
Close-up of a car door panel with a black arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols on the panel itself)RamBox®PushbuttonAndLockRamBox®LightSwitch
The interior of the RamBox® will automatically illuminate when the lid is opened. In addition to the automatic illumination switch, there is a manual on/off switch located at the rear of each storage bin. Pushing the switch once will turn off the bin lights, pushing the switch again will turn the lights back on.
CAUTION!
Leavingthelidopenforextendedperiodsoftime couldcausethevehiclebatterytodischarge.Ifthelid isrequiredtostayopenforextendedperiodsoftime,

Information Provided by: DEALER
(Continued)
254 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!(Continued)
itisrecommendedthatthebinlightsbeturnedoff manuallyusingtheon/offswitch.
Cargo bins feature two removable drain plugs (to allow water to drain from bins). To remove plug, pull up on the edge. To install push plug downward into drain hole.
NOTE:Provisions are provided in the bins for cargo dividers and shelf supports. These accessories (in addition to other RamBox® accessories) are available from MOPAR®.
Locking And Unlocking RamBox®
Press and release the LOCK or UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter to lock and unlock all doors, the tailgate and the RamBox® (if equipped). Refer to "Remote Keyless Entry" for further details. The RamBox® storage bins can be locked using the vehicle key. To lock a nd unlock the storage bin, insert the key into the keyhole on the pushbutton and turn clockwise to lock or counterclockwise to unlock. Always return the key to the upright (vertical) position before removing the key from the pushbutton.
CAUTION!
- Ensurecargobinlidsareclosedandlatchedbefore movingordrivingvehicle.
- Loadsappliedtothetopofthebinlidshouldbe minimizedtopreventdamagethelidand latching/hingingmechanisms.
- DamagetotheRamBox®binmayoccurdueto heavy/sharpobjectsplacedinbinthatshiftdueto vehiclemotion.Inordertominimizepotentialfor damage,secureallcargotopreventmovementand protectinsidesurfacesofbinfromheavy/sharp objectswithappropriatepadding.
RamBox® Safety Warning
Carefully follow these warnings to help prevent personal injury or damage to your vehicle:
WARNING!
• Alwaysclosethestoragebincoverswhenyour vehicleisunattended.
- Donotallowchildrentohaveaccesstothestorage bins.Onceinthestoragebin,youngchildrenmay notbeabletoescape.Iftrappedinthestoragebin, childrencandiefromsuffocationorheatstroke.
- Inanaccident,seriousinjurycouldresultifthe storagebincoversarenotproperlylatched.
- Donotdrivethevehiclewiththestoragebincovers open.
- Keepthestoragebincoversclosedandlatched whilethevehicleisinmotion.
- Donotuseastoragebinlatchasatiedo wn.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 255
RamBox®StorageBinCoverEmergencyRelease Lever—IfEquipped
As a security measure, a Storage Bin Cover Emergency Release is built into the storage bin cover latching mechanism.

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing a valve assembly with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols present)StorageBinCoverEmergencyReleaseLever

256 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: In the event of an individual being locked inside the storage bin, the storage bin cover can be opened from inside of the bin by pulling on the glow-in-the-dark lever attached to the storage bin cover latching mechanism.
Bed Extender — If Equipped
The bed extender has three functional positions:
- Storage Position
- Divider Position
- Extender Position
StoragePosition
The storage position for the bed extender is at the front of the truck bed which maximizes the bed cargo area when not in use.
To install the bed extender into the storage position, perform the following:
- Make sure the center handle is unlocked using the vehicle key and rotate the center handle vertically to release the extender side gates.

text_image
1 2 036706565CenterHandleAndLock
1 — Center Handle Lock
2 — Handle

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 257
- With the side gates open, position the extender fully forward in the bed against the front panel.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle dashboard with structural panels and a directional arrow indicating orientation (no text or symbols)StoragePosition
- Rotate the side gates closed allowing the outboard ends to be positioned in front of the cargo tie down loops.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing seatbelt and dashboard components with an arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols)CargoTieDownLoop
- Rotate the center handle horizontally to secure the side gates in the closed position.
258 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Top-down view of a vehicle's front panel showing the wheel and keyway (no text or symbols)SideGatesClosed
- Lock the center handle using the vehicle key to secure the panel into place.
DividerPosition
The divider position is intended for managing your cargo and assisting in keeping cargo from moving around the bed. There are 11 divider slots along the bed inner panels which allow for various positions to assist in managing your cargo.
To install the bed extender into a divider position perform the following:
- Make sure the center handle is unlocked using the vehicle key and rotate the center handle vertically to release the extender side gates.


text_image
1 2 036706565CenterHandleAndLock
1 — Center Handle Lock
2 — Handle
- With the side gates open, position the extender so the outboard ends align with the intended slots in the sides of the bed.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 259

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a lever mechanism with a downward arrow indicating force or motion (no text or symbols present)AligningGateToSlots
- Rotate the side gates closed so that the outboard ends are secured into the intended slots of the bed.
- Rotate the center handle horizontally to secure the side gates in the closed position.
260 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Top-down view of a vehicle door panel with a black arrow pointing to the center (no text or symbols)SideGatesClosed
- Lock the center handle to secure the panel into place.
ExtenderPosition
The extender position allows you to load the bed of the truck beyond the tail gate. The bed extender will add an additional 15 in (38 cm) in the back of the truck when additional cargo room is needed. The extender position utilizes a locating pin and rotating handle located on both sides of the truck bed near the tailgate.

natural_image
Technical illustration of a vehicle's front bumper and side panel assembly (no text or symbols)ExtenderPosition
To install the bed extender into the extender position perform the following:
- Lowerthe tailgate.

- Make sure the center handle is unlocked and rotate the center handle vertically in order to release the extender side gates.
- Fit the end of the side gate ends onto the pin and handle.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with two arrows pointing to a detail (no text or symbols visible)ExtenderInstallation
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 261
- Rotate the handles to the horizontal position to secure into place.

natural_image
Close-up of a vehicle's front panel showing structural components and a directional arrow (no text or symbols)LockingTab

Information Provided by: DEALER
262 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Toreducetheriskofpotentialinjuryorproperty damage:
• Cargomustbesecured.
- Donotexceedcargoloadratingofyourvehicle.
- Secureallloadstotruckutilizingcargotiedowns.
- Extendershouldnotbeusedascargotiedown.
- When vehicle is in motion on the not exceed 150 lbs (68 kg) load on the tail gate.
• Thebedextenderisnotintendedforoffroaduse.
- Whennotinuse, theextender/dividershouldbeinstowedordividerpositionwiththetailgateclosed.
- Wheninuseallhandlesaretobeinthelocked position.
Bed Rail Tie-Down System
CAUTION!
Themaximumloadpercleatshouldnotexceed 250lbs(113kg)andtheangleoftheloadoneachcleat shouldnotexceed45degreesabovehorizontal,or damagetothecleatorcleatrailmayoccur.
There are two adjustable cleats on each side of the bed that can be used to assist in securing cargo.

natural_image
Diagram of a vehicle's side panel with heat exchanger and door, showing two upward arrows indicating heating or ventilation zones (no text or symbols present)AdjustableCleats
Each cleat must be located and tightened down in one of the detents, along either rail, in order to keep cargo properly secure.
To move the cleat to any position on the rail, turn the nut counterclockwise, approximately three turns. Then pull
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 263
out on the cleat and slide it to the detent nearest the desired location. Make sure the cleat is seated in the detent and tighten the nut.

text_image
1 2 3 0381065321 — Utility Rail Detent
2 — Cleat Retainer Nut
3 — Utility Rail Cleat
264 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To remove the cleats from the utility rail, remove the end cap screw located in the center of the end cap, using a #T30 Torx® head driver. Remove the end cap and slide the cleat off the end of the rail.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a sliding door with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols present)UtilityRailEndCap
SLIDE-IN CAMPERS
Camper Applications
Certain truck models are not recommended for slide-in campers. To determine if your vehicle is excluded, please refer to the "Consumer Information Truck-Camper Loading" document available from your authorized dealer. For safety reasons, follow all instructions in this important document.
NOTE: When a cap or pickup camper is installed on a vehicle, an alternate Center High-Mounted Stop Light (CHMSL) must be provided.

EASY-OFF TAILGATE
To simplify mounting of a camper unit with an overhang, the tailgate can be removed.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a rear camera or RKE the electrical connector must be disconnected prior to removing the tailgate.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 265
Disconnecting the Rear Camera or Remote Keyless Entry — If Equipped
- Open the tailgate to access the rear camera or RKE connector bracket located on the rear sill.

natural_image
Microscopic view of a microfluidic channel with a black arrow pointing to a specific feature (no text or symbols present)ConnectorBracket
- Remove the connector bracket from the sill by pressing inward in the locking tab.

266 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Close-up of a USB flash drive with a curved cable and indicator light (no text or symbols visible)036906362
LockingTab
-
Disconnect the chassis wiring harness, ensuring the connector bracket does not fall into the sill.
-
Connect the chassis plug and bracket (provided in the glove box) to the chassis wiring harness and insert the bracket back into the sill.
-
Connect the tailgate plug (provided in the glove box) to the tailgate wiring harness to ensure that the terminals do not corrode.
- Tape the tailgate harness and bracket against the forward-facing surface of the tailgate. This will prevent damaging the connector and bracket when storing or reinstalling the tailgate.
Removing The Tailgate
- Disconnect the wiring harness for the rear camera and or power locks (if equipped), refer to "Disconnecting the Rear Camera — If Equipped" in this section.
- Unlatch the tailgate and remove the support cables by releasing the lock tang from the pivot.
NOTE: Make sure tailgate is supported when removing support cables.


natural_image
Close-up of a car door panel with a cable inserted, showing a black arrow pointing to the connector (no text or symbols visible)LockingTang
- Raise the tailgate to a 45 degree angle.
- Raise the right side of the tailgate until the right side pivot clears the hanger bracket.
- Slide the entire tailgate to the right to free the left side pivot.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 267
- Remove the tailgate from the vehicle.
NOTE: Do not carry the tailgate loose in the truck pickup box.
WARNING!
To avoid inhaling carbon monoxide, which is deadly, the exhaust system on vehicle equipped with "Cap or Slide-In Campers" should extend beyond the overhanging camper compartment and be free of leaks.
Locking Tailgate
The lock is located next to the tailgate handle. The tailgate can be locked using the vehicle key or by locking the truck with the key-fob if equipped with remote keyless entry.

268 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE TRI-FOLD TONNEAU COVER — IF EQUIPPED
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover which consists of different features:
- Easy Tri-Fold cover
• Tonneau fore aft locator
•Crosscar inside bed locator - Front and rear clamps
- Stowage strap
- Locking Capability
NOTE: The Tonneau Cover can be folded up and secured at the front of the box without removing completely.
Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Removal
To remove the Tonneau Cover follow the following steps:
- Lower the tailgate to gain access to the first set of two tonneau cover clamps located on the driver and passengers bottom side of the tonneau cover.

natural_image
Technical illustration of a mechanical clamp or bracket assembly (no text or symbols visible)ClampedPosition
NOTE: If clamp wire is damaged replace immediately.

- Pull down on the first set of clamps on both driver and passenger sides to the semi clamped position.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing suspension lock and mounting bracket (no text or symbols visible)SemiClampedPosition
- Pull down on the clamp wire and push the clamp up into the proper released position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 269

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing mechanical components and structural elements (no text or symbols visible)ProperReleasedPosition
NOTE: Be sure the clamp and clamp wire is in the proper released position.
270 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical device with a circular symbol indicating no prohibition (no text or labels present)ImproperClampWireReleasedPosition
CAUTION!
Makesurethetonneaucoverclampandclampwire isintheproperreleasedposition.Iftheclampand clampwireisnotproperlyreleased,damagetothe tonneaucovermaterialwillresult.
-
Pick up on the tonneau cover and fold it back into the second panel.
-
Pick up on the cover and fold it back into the third panel.
-
Once in the third panel position pull down on the second set of clamps on both driver and passenger sides to the semi clamped position.


UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 271

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing mechanical components and wiring (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle suspension system showing mechanical components and wiring (no text or symbols visible)SemiClampedPositionProperReleasedPosition
-
Pull down on the clamp wire and push the clamp up into the proper released position.
-
Be sure to clip both stowage straps together to insure the cover stays together.

Information Provident by: DEALER
272 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Black-and-white illustration of a curved mechanical component or tool, possibly a valve or clamp, against a dark background with diagonal lines (no text or symbols visible)StowageStrap
- With two people remove the cover.
NOTE: Be sure the Tonneau Cover has been folded completely before removing.
Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Installation
To install the Tonneau Cover follow the following steps:
-
Position the folded Tonneau Cover on the truck bed and push the Cover forward against the front of the truck bed. The Tonneau Cover centers itself when placed on the vehicle.
-
Pull down on the first set of clamp handles to release the clamps from the stowed position.


natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing mechanical components and structural elements (no visible text or symbols)StowedPosition
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 273
- Push clamp wires up and under the flange of box (or flange of Ram Box rail, if equipped) to the semi clamped position.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing mechanical components and wiring (no text or symbols visible)SemiClampedPosition

Information Provident By: DEALER
274 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- Push clamp handles upward to the clamped position to properly engage the clamps.

natural_image
Technical illustration of a mechanical clamp or bracket assembly (no text or symbols visible)ClampedPosition
NOTE: Once clamped, be sure the clamps are not partially clamped to the truck bed flange.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical device with a no-smoking symbol (no readable text or symbols)ImproperClampPosition

Information Provident By: DEALER
- Disengage the stowage straps.
- Unfold Tonneau Cover to the intermediate position.
NOTE: The vehicle cannot be driven when the Tonneau Cover is in this position.

natural_image
Side view of a pickup truck's front bumper with a black arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols on the vehicle itself)IntermediatePosition(VehicleCannotBeD riven)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 275
- Completely unfold the Tonneau Cover.

natural_image
Top-down view of a white pickup truck with a red emblem on the side (no text or symbols visible)FullyUnfoldedPosition

Information Provided by: DEALER
276 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
- Pull down on the second set of clamp handles to release the clamps from the stowed position.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle suspension lock mechanism (no text or symbols visible)StowedPosition
- Push clamp wires up and under the flange of box (or flange of Ram Box rail, if equipped) to the semi clamped position.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing mechanical components and wiring (no text or symbols visible)SemiClampedPosition

Information Provident by: DEALER
- Push clamp handles upward to the clamped position to properly engage the clamps.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a bracket with attached clamping device and wiring (no text or symbols)UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 277
NOTE: Once clamped, be sure the clamps are not partially clamped to the truck bed flange.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical device with a circular no-smoking symbol (no text or labels visible)ClampedPositionImproperClampPosition

Information Provident By: DEALER
278 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The Tonneau Cover clamps can be locked when in the clamped position by placing a lock through the locking hole.

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing a bracket with a highlighted connection point and an arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols present)LockingHole
CAUTION!
Itisthedriver's responsibility to ensure the Tonneau Coveris properly installed on the vehicle. Failure to follow this procedure can result in detachment of the Tonneau Cover from the vehicle and ordamageto the vehicle/Tonneau Cover.
Tri-Fold Tonneau Cover Cleaning
For proper cleaning of the Tonneau Cover use MOPAR® Whitewall & Vinyl Top Cleaner and MOPAR® Leather & Vinyl Conditioner/Protectant.

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
■INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES .....281
■INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — MIDLINE .....282
■INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — PREMIUM .....283
■INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . .284
■ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)....297
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Displays — 3.5" Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
□Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Displays — 7" Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
□Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Messages....318
□EVIC Selectable Menu Items .....323
☐Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)....327
□Screen Setup Driver Selectable Items .....335
■Uconnect® SETTINGS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
□Hard-Keys. .338
□Soft-Keys. .338
■Uconnect® RADIOS — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .357
280 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
■iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED ..357
■STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS — IF EQUIPPED....358
□Radio Operation....359
□CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
■CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE....359
□Summer Operation....379
□Winter Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
□Vacation/Storage....379
□Window Fogging and Frosting....380
□Outside Air Intake....380
□Operating Tips Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES

text_image
Labeled diagram of a car dashboard with numbered parts for identification040170078
1 — Headlight Switch 7 — 115v Power Inverter Outlet 13 — Gear Selector/Transfer Case Position
Switch — If Equipped
2 — Instrument Cluster 8 — Power Outlet — If Equipped 14 — Ignition Switch
3 — Radio 9 — Lower Switch Bank 15 — Hood Release
4 — Hazard Switch 10 — Instrument Panel Drawer 16 — Parking Brake Release
5 — Upper Glove Compartment 11 — Climate Controls
6 — Lower Glove Compartment
12 — Power Outlet/Cigar Lighter — If Equipped

DEALER
282 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Information Provided by
DEALER
按:广义、西、口、二、废、废、废
Information Provided by: DEALER
284 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
1.Tachometer
The tachometer indicates engine speed in Revolutions Per Minute (RPM x 1000).
CAUTION!
Donotoperatetheenginewiththetachometer pointerathighRPMforextendedperiods.Engine operationover3200RPM(Redline)canresultin significantdamagethatwillnotbecoveredunderthe NewVehicleLimitedWarranty.
2. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light

This light monitors the Anti-lock Brake System (ABS). The light will turn on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position and may stay on for as long as four seconds.
If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving, it indicates that the anti-lock portion of the brake system is not functioning and that service is required. However, the conventional brake system will continue to operate normally if the BRAKE warning light is not on.
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced as soon as possible to restore the benefits of anti-lock brakes. If the ABS light does not turn on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position, have the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
3. MalfunctionIndicatorLight(MIL)

The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part of an onboard diagnostic (OBDII) system which monitors the emissions and engine control system. If the vehicle is ready for emissions testing, the light will come on when the ignition is first turned on and remain on, as a bulb check, until the engine is started. If the vehicle is not ready for emissions

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 285
testing the light will come on when the ignition is first turned on and remain on for 15 seconds, then blink for 5 seconds, and remain on until the vehicle is started. If the bulb does not come on during starting, have the condition investigated promptly.
If this light comes on and remains on while driving, it suggests a potential engine control problem and the need for system service.
Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as soon as possible.
CAUTION!
ProlongeddrivingwiththeMalfunctionIndicator Light(MIL)oncouldcausedamagetotheengine controlsystem.Italsocouldaffectfueleconomyand driveability.IftheMILisflashing,severecatalytic
CAUTION!(Continued)
converterdamageandpowerlosswillsoonoccur. Immediateserviceisrequired.
WARNING!
Amalfunctioningcatalyticconverter, as referenced above, can reach high temperature than innormal operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you drive slowly or park over flammable substances such as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result in deathor serious injury to the driver, occupants or others.
4. TurnSignalIndicators

The arrow will flash with the exterior turn signal when the turn signal lever is operated.
(Continued)

286 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:
- A continuous chime will sound if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile (1.6 km) with either turn signal on.
- Check for an inoperative outside light bulb if either indicator remains on and does not flash, or flashes at a rapid rate.
5.Voltmeter

When the engine is running, the gauge indicates the electrical system voltage. The pointer should within the normal range if the battery is charged. If inter moves to either extreme left or right and as there during normal driving, the electrical sys-ould be serviced.
NOTE: The voltmeter may show a gauge fluctuation at various engine temperatures. This cycling operation is caused by the post-heat cycle of the intake manifold heater system. The number of cycles and the length of the cycling operation is controlled by the engine control module. Post-heat operation can run for several minutes, and then the electrical system and voltmeter needle will stabilize.
6.BrakeWarningLight
BRAKE This light monitors various brake functions, including brake fluid level and parking brake application. If the brake light turns on it may indicate that the parking brake is applied, that the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with the Anti-lock Brake System reservoir.
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark on the master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake

hydraulic system malfunction or that a problem with the Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) / Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. In this case, the light will remain on until the condition has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake and a brake pedal pulsation may be felt during each stop.
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has dropped below a specified level.
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level conditions. The vehicle should have service performed, and the brake fluid level checked.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
WARNING!
Drivingvehiclewiththeredbrakelightonis dangerous.Partofthebrakesystemmayhavefailed. Itwilltakelongertostopthevehicle.Youcouldhave acollision.Havethevehiclecheckedimmediately.
Vehicles equipped with the ABS, are also equipped with Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD failure, the Brake Warning Light will turn on along with the ABS Light. Immediate repair to the ABS system is required.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
288 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
7. HighBeamIndicator

This light shows that the high beam headlights are on. Push the multifunction control lever away from you to switch the headlights to high beam. Pull the lever toward you to switch the headlights back to low beam. If the driver's door is open, and the headlights or park lights are left on, the high beam indicator light will remain illuminated and a chime will sound.
8.SeatBeltReminderLight

When the ignition switch is first turned to ON/RUN, this light will turn on for four to eight seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb check, if the driver's seat belt is unbuckled, a chime will sound. After the bulb check or when driving, if the driver's seat belt remains unbuckled, the seat belt reminder light will flash or remain on continuously. Refer to "Occupant Restraints" in "Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle" for further information.
9. AirBagWarningLight

This light will turn on for four to eight seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on during starting, stays on, or turns on while driving, have the system inspected at an authorized dealer as soon as possible. Refer to "Occupant Restraints" in "Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle" for further information.

10.OilPressureGauge—IfEquipped
The pointer should always indicate some oil pressure when the engine is running. A continuous high or low reading under normal driving conditions may indicate a lubrication system malfunction. Immediate service should be obtained from an authorized dealer.
11.Speedometer
The speedometer shows the vehicle speed in miles per hour and/or kilometers per hour (mph/km/h).
12. Park/HeadlightONIndicator—IfEquipped

This indicator will illuminate when the park lights or headlights are turned on.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 289
13.CargoLight—IfEquipped

The cargo light will illuminate when the cargo light is activated by pressing the cargo light button on the headlight switch.
14.FuelGauge
Shows level of fuel in tank when ignition switch is in the ON/RUN position.
15. VehicleSecurityLight—IfEquipped

This light will flash at a fast rate for approximately 15 seconds, when the vehicle security alarm is arming, and then will flash slowly until the vehicle is disarmed.

Information Provided by: DEALER E-ENOCES
290 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
16. TirePressureMonitoringTelltaleLight—If Equipped

Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety

of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.
CAUTION!
TheTPMShasbeenoptimizedfortheoriginal equipmenttiresandwheels.TPMSpressuresand warninghavebeenestablishforthetiresize equippedonyourvehicle.Undesirablesystemoperationorsensordamagemayresultwhenusingreplacementequipmentthatisnotofthesamesize, type,and/orstyle.Aftermarketwheelscancause sensordamage.Donotusetiresealantfromacanor balancebeadsifyourvehicleisequippedwitha TPMS,asdamagetothesensorsmayresult .
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The TPMS telltale is also accompanied by a "Low Tire" message in the odometer (Base Cluster), or in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) screen indicating "Low Tire" for EVIC enabled clusters.
17.FrontFogLightIndicator—IfEquipped

This indicator will illuminate when the front fog lights are on.
- Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the instrument cluster. For further information, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)".
19.ShiftLeverIndicator
The Shift Lever Indicator is self-contained within the instrument cluster. It displays the gear position of the automatic transmission.

292 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The highest available transmission gear is displayed in the lower right corner of the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) whenever the Electronic Range Select (ERS) feature is active. Use the +/- selector on the shift lever to activate ERS. Refer to "Automatic Transmission" in "Starting And Operating" for further information.
20.ElectronicVehicleInformationCenter(EVIC)Menu
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the instrument cluster. For further information, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)".
21. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator Light—If Equipped

This light indicates the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is off.
22.TOW/HAUL
TOW/HAUL
The TOW HAUL button is located on the center stack upper switch bank. This light will illuminate when TOW HAUL mode is selected.
23.ElectronicStabilityControl(ESC)Activation/MalfunctionIndicatorLight—IfEquipped

The "ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light" in the instrument cluster will come on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position. It should go out with the engine running. If the "ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light" comes on continuously with the engine running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this light remains on after several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.

NOTE:
- The "ESC Off Indicator Light" and the "ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light" come on momentarily each time the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN.
- Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the ESC system will be ON, even if it was turned off previously.
- The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver that caused the ESC activation.
24. Temperature Gauge
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant temperature. Any reading within the normal range indicates that the engine cooling system is operating satisfactorily.
The gauge pointer will likely indicate a higher temperature when driving in hot weather, up mountain grades, or when towing a trailer. It should not be allowed to exceed the upper limits of the normal operating range.
CAUTION!
Drivingwithahotenginecoolingsystemcould damageyourvehicle.Ifthetemperaturegaugereads "H"pulloverandstopthevehicle.Idlethevehicle withtheairconditionerturnedoffuntilthepointer dropsbackintothenormalrange.Ifthepointer remainsonthe"H"andyouhearcontinuouschimes, turntheengineoffimmediatelyandcallanaauthorizeddealerforservice.
294 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING!
Ahotenginecoolingsystemisdangerous. Youor otherscouldbebadlyburnedbysteamorboiling coolant. Youmaywanttocallanauthorizeddealer forserviceifyourvehicleoverheats. If youdecideto lookunderthehoodyourself, see "Maintaining Your Vehicle." Followthewarningsunderthe "Cooling SystemPressureCap" paragraph.
25. Stop/Start-IfEquipped

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Stop/Start icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to display the Stop/Start status.
26. Electric Power Steering Malfunction Warning Light

This telltale is on when the Electric Power Steering is not operating and needs service.
27. Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Light

This light informs you of a problem with the Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. The light will come on when the ignition is first turned ON and remain on briefly as a bulb check. If the light does not come on during starting, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
If a problem is detected, the light will come on while the engine is running. Cycle the ignition key when the vehicle has completely stopped and the shift lever is placed in the PARK position. The light should turn off.

If the light remains lit with the engine running, your vehicle will usually be drivable. However, see an authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. If the light is flashing when the engine is running, immediate service is required. You may experience reduced performance, an elevated/rough idle or engine stall and your vehicle may require towing.
28. AirSuspensionNormalRideHeightIndicatorLamp - IfEquipped
This light will illuminate when the air suspension system is set to the Normal Ride Height setting. For further information, refer to "Air Suspension System" in "Starting And Operating".
29. AirSuspensionOff-Road1IndicatorLamp-If Equipped
This light will illuminate when the air suspension system is set to the Off-Road 1 setting. For further information, refer to "Air Suspension System" in "Starting And Operating".
30. AirSuspensionOff-Road2IndicatorLamp-If Equipped
This light will illuminate when the air suspension system is set to the Off-Road 2 setting. For further information, refer to “Air Suspension System” in “Starting And Operating”.
31.4LOW
4 LOW
This light alerts the driver that the vehicle is in the four-wheel drive LOW mode. The front and rear driveshafts are mechanically locked together forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. Low range provides a greater gear reduction ratio to provide increased torque at the wheels.
For further information on four-wheel drive operation and proper use, refer to "Four-Wheel Drive Operation — If Equipped" in "Starting And Operating".

296 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
32.4WDAUTOIndicatorLight—IfEquipped
4WD AUTO
This light alerts the driver that the vehicle is in the four-wheel drive auto mode, and the front axle is engaged, but the vehicle's power is sent to the rear wheels. Four-wheel drive will be automatically engaged when the vehicle senses a loss of traction.
For further information on four-wheel drive operation and proper use, refer to "Four-Wheel Drive Operation — If Equipped" in "Starting And Operating".
33.4WDIndicatorLight—IfEquipped
4WD This light alerts the driver that the vehicle is in the four-wheel drive mode, and the front and rear driveshafts are mechanically locked together forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed.
For further information on four-wheel drive operation and proper use, refer to "Four-Wheel Drive Operation — If Equipped" in "Starting And Operating".

ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the instrument cluster.

text_image
IPOD / USB 85°F SANGE 450 mm 12567 m 12567 m P B N D T O F 040971462ElectronicVehicleInformationCenter(EVIC)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 297
The EVIC Menu items consists of the following:
• Digital Speedometer
- Vehicle Info
• Fuel Economy Info
- Trip A
- Trip B
- Stop/Start Info (If Equipped)
- Trailer Tow
•Audio
- Stored Messages
- Screen Setup
- Vehicle Settings (Not Equipped with a Uconnect® 5.0 & 8.4 radio)
298 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The system allows the driver to select information by pressing the following buttons mounted on the steering wheel:

text_image
VR Δ Δ ▼ ◀040971549
EVICSteeringWheelsButtons
-UPArrowButton

Press and release the UP arrow button to scroll upward through the main menu and sub-menus (Fuel Economy, Trip A, Trip B, Audio, Stored Messages, Screen Set Up).
- DOWNArrowButton

Press and release the DOWN arrow button to scroll downward through the main menu and sub-menus (Fuel Economy, Trip A, Trip B, Audio, Stored Messages, Screen Set Up).


UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 299
- SELECT/RIGHTArrowButton

Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to access/select the information screens or sub-menu screens of a main menu item.
Press and hold the SELECT/RIGHT arrow
button for two seconds to reset displayed/selected features that can be reset.
- LEFTArrowButton

Press the LEFT arrow button to return to the main menu from an info screen or sub-menu item.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Displays — 3.5" Display

flowchart
graph TD
1 --> 2
2 --> 3
3 --> 4
4 --> 5
5 --> 6
6 --> 7
7 --> 1
1 --> 8
8 --> 9
9 --> 10
10 --> 11
11 --> 12
12 --> 13
13 --> 14
14 --> 15
15 --> 16
16 --> 17
17 --> 18
18 --> 19
19 --> 20
20 --> 21
21 --> 22
22 --> 23
23 --> 24
24 --> 25
25 --> 26
26 --> 27
27 --> 28
28 --> 29
29 --> 30
30 --> 31
31 --> 32
32 --> 33
33 --> 34
34 --> 35
35 --> 36
36 --> 37
37 --> 38
38 --> 39
39 --> 40
40 --> 41
41 --> 42
42 --> 43
43 --> 44
44 --> 45
45 --> 46
46 --> 47
47 --> 48
48 --> 49
49 --> 50
50 --> 51
51 --> 52
52 --> 53
53 --> 54
54 --> 55
55 --> 56
56 --> 57
57 --> 58
58 --> 59
59 --> 60
60 --> 61
61 --> 62
62 --> 63
63 --> 64
64 --> 65
65 --> 66
66 --> 67
67 --> 68
68 --> 69
69 --> 70
70 --> 71
71 --> 72
72 --> 73
73 --> 74
74 --> 75
75 --> 76
76 --> 77
77 --> 78
78 --> 79
79 --> 80
80 --> 81
81 --> 82
82 --> 83
83 --> 84
84 --> 85
85 --> 86
86 --> 87
87 --> 88
88 --> 89
89 --> 90
0409021772

Information Provided by: DEALER
300 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The EVIC displays are located in the center portion of the cluster and consists of seven sections:
1. CompassDisplay
Displays the current direction. For further information, refer to "Compass Settings" under "Customer Programmable Features — Uconnect® 5.0/8.4 Settings".
2.TemperatureDisplay
Displays the temperature in degrees Celsius or degrees Fahrenheit.
3.MainScreen
Displays main menu, sub-menus, settings.
4.EVICWhiteTelltales
•ElectronicSpeedControlReady

This light will turn on when the electronic speed control is ON. For further information, refer to "Electronic Speed Control" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle."
•ElectronicSpeedControlSET

This light will turn on when the electronic speed control is SET. For further information, refer to “Electronic Speed Control” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle.”
- ShiftLeverStatus
The highest available transmission gear is displayed in the lower right corner of the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) whenever the Electronic Range Select (ERS) feature is active. Use the +/- selector on the shift lever to activate ERS. Refer to “Automatic Transmission” in “Starting And Operating” for further information.
5.EVICAmberTelltales
- LowFuelTelltale

When the fuel level reaches approximately 3.0 gal (11.0 L) this light will turn on, and remain on until fuel is added.

•WindshieldWasherFluidLowIndicator

This telltale will turn on to indicate the wind-shield washer fluid is low.
- LowCoolantLevelIndicator

This telltale will turn on to indicate the vehicle coolant level is low.
• Transmission Temperature Warning Telltale

This telltale indicates that the transmission fluid temperature is running hot. This may occur with severe usage, such as trailer towing. If this telltale turns on, safely pull over and
stop the vehicle. Then, shift the transmission into NEU-TRAL and run the engine at idle or faster until the light turns off.
CAUTION!
ContinuousdrivingwiththeTransmissionTemperatureWarningLightilluminatedwilleventuallycauseseveretransmissiondamageortransmissionfailure.
WARNING!
If you continue operating the vehicle when the Transmission Temperature Warning Light is illuminated you could cause the fluid to oil over, come in contact with hot engine exhaust components and cause a fire.
• AirSuspensionPayloadProtectionTelltale—If Equipped

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the maximum payload may have been exceeded or load leveling cannot be achieved at its current ride height.

Protection Mode will automatically be selected in order to "protect" the air suspension system, air suspension adjustment is limited due to payload.
• ServiceStop/StartSystemTelltale—IfEquipped

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the Stop/Start is Unavailable, service Stop/Start system.
- LooseFuelFillerCap

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the fuel filler cap may be loose.
• WaterInFuelIndicatorLight—DieselOnly

The "Water In Fuel Indicator Light" will illuminate when there is water detected in the fuel filters. If this light remains on, DO NOT start the vehicle before you drain the water from the fuel filters to prevent engine damage. Refer to "Maintenance Procedures/Draining Fuel/Water Separator Filters" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.
- WaitToStartLight—DieselOnly
The "Wait To Start" telltale will illuminate for approximately two seconds when the ignition is turned to the RUN position. It's duration may be longer based on colder operating conditions. Vehicle will not initiate start until telltale is out. Refer to "Starting Procedures" in "Starting And Operating" for further information.
NOTE: The "Wait To Start" telltale may not illuminate if the intake manifold temperature is warm enough.
- LowDieselExhaustFluidLight—DieselOnly This telltale will turn on to indicate the Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF) is low.


6.EVICRedTelltales
•DoorAjar

This light will turn on to indicate that one or more doors may be ajar.
• OilPressureWarningLight
This telltale indicates low engine oil pressure. If the light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shut off the engine as soon as possible. A chime will sound when this light turns on.
Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is corrected. This light does not show how much oil is in the engine. The engine oil level must be checked under the hood.
• OilTemperatureWarningLight

This telltale indicates engine oil temperature is high. If the light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shut off the engine as soon as possible.
- ChargingSystemLight
This light shows the status of the electrical charging system. If the light stays on or comes on while driving, turn off some of the vehicle's non-essential electrical devices or increase engine speed (if at idle). If the charging system light remains on, it means that the vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See an authorized dealer.
If jump starting is required, refer to "Jump Starting Procedures" in "What To Do In Emergencies".
• ElectronicThrottleControl(ETC)Light

This light informs you of a problem with the Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. The light will come on when the ignition is first turned ON and remain on briefly as a bulb
check. If the light does not come on during starting, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
304 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
If a problem is detected, the light will come on while the engine is running. Cycle the ignition key when the vehicle has completely stopped and the shift lever is placed in the PARK position. The light should turn off.
If the light remains lit with the engine running, your vehicle will usually be drivable. However, see an authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. If the light is flashing when the engine is running, immediate service is required. You may experience reduced performance, an elevated/rough idle or engine stall and your vehicle may require towing.
• EngineTemperatureWarningLight

This light warns of an overheated engine condition. As temperatures rise and the gauge approaches H, this indicator will illuminate and a
single chime will sound after reaching a set threshold.
Further overheating will cause the temperature gauge to pass H, a continuous chime will occur until the engine is allowed to cool.
If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over and stop the vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it off. Also, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and idle the vehicle. If the temperature reading does not return to normal, turn the engine off immediately and call for service. Refer to "If Your Engine Overheats" in "What To Do In Emergencies" for further information.
•ElectricPowerSteeringMalfunctionWarningLight
This telltale is on when the Electric Power Steering is not operating and needs service.

Information Provided by. DEALER
• TrailerBrakeDisconnectedWarningLight

This telltale is on when the Trailer Brake has been disconnected.
7. Audio/PhoneInformationAndSub-menuInformation
Whenever there are sub-menus available, the position within the sub-menu is shown here.
The main display area will normally display the main menu or the screens of a selected feature of the main menu. The main display area also displays "pop up" messages that consist of approximately 60 possible warning or information messages. These pop up messages fall into several categories:
- FiveSecondStoredMessages
When the appropriate conditions occur, this type of message takes control of the main display area for five seconds and then returns to the previous screen. Most of
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 305
the messages of this type are then stored (as long as the condition that activated it remains active) and can be reviewed from the "Messages" main menu item. As long as there is a stored message, an "i" will be displayed in the EVIC's compass/outside temp line. Examples of this message type are "Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out" and "Low Tire Pressure".
- UnstoredMessages
This message type is displayed indefinitely or until the condition that activated the message is cleared. Examples of this message type are "Turn Signal On" (if a turn signal is left on) and "Lights On" (if driver leaves the vehicle).
- UnstoredMessagesUntilRUN
These messages deal primarily with the Remote Start feature. This message type is displayed until the ignition is in the RUN state. Examples of this message type are "Remote Start Aborted - Door Ajar" and "Press Brake Pedal and Push Button to Start".

306 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- FiveSecondUnstoredMessages
When the appropriate conditions occur, this type of message takes control of the main display area for five seconds and then returns to the previous screen. An example of this message type is “Automatic High Beams On”.
FuelFilterLifeReset
The cluster will display the "Fuel System Service Required – See Dealer" or "Service Fuel Filter" message when the fuel filter maintenance life is less than 5%. To verify if this is a fuel filter change event, go to the "Fuel Filter Life" screen in the "Vehicle Info" menu. When this message appears, dealers should replace both frame mounted and engine mounted fuel filters.
NOTE: Use the steering wheel EVIC controls for the following procedure(s)
VehiclesEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, press the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Fuel Filter Life" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Reset", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Fuel Filter Life to 100%.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
VehiclesNotEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 307
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Fuel Filter Life" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Reset", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Fuel Filter Life to 100%.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
OilLifeReset
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The "Oil Change Required" message will flash in the EVIC display for approximately 10 seconds after a single chime has sounded, to indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate, dependent upon your personal driving style.
NOTE: Use the steering wheel EVIC controls for the following procedure(s)
VehiclesEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, press the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Oil Life" screen.

308 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Reset", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Oil Life to 100%.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
VehiclesNotEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, press the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
-
Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Oil Life" screen.
-
Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Reset", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Oil Life to 100%.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Displays — 7" Display

text_image
1 2 3 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 Diesel Glow Plug Wait to Start Press OK to Hide 12057 min. P R N D 1-30409021771
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 309
The EVIC displays are located in the center portion of the cluster and consists of eight sections:
- Main Screen — The inner ring of the display will illuminate in grey under normal conditions, yellow for non critical warnings, red for critical warnings and white for on demand information.
- Audio/Phone Information and Sub-menu Information — Whenever there are sub-menus available, the position within the sub-menus is shown here.
- Selectable Information (Compass, Temp, Range to Empty, Trip A, Trip B, Average MPG, Trailer Trip (distance only), Trailer Brake Gain).
- Telltales/Indicators
- Shift Lever Status (PRNDL)
- Selectable Menu Icons
- Air Suspension Status – If Equipped

310 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- 4WD Status
- Selectable Gauge 2
- Selectable Gauge 1
- Selectable Gauge 1
The main display area will normally display the main menu or the screens of a selected feature of the main menu. The main display area also displays "pop up" messages that consist of approximately 60 possible warning or information messages. These pop up messages fall into several categories:
- FiveSecondStoredMessages
When the appropriate conditions occur, this type of message takes control of the main display area for five seconds and then returns to the previous screen. Most of the messages of this type are then stored (as long as the condition that activated it remains active) and can be reviewed from the "Messages" main menu item. As long
as there is a stored message, an "i" will be displayed in the EVIC's compass/outside temp line. Examples of this message type are "Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out" and "Low Tire Pressure".
- UnstoredMessages
This message type is displayed indefinitely or until the condition that activated the message is cleared. Examples of this message type are “Turn Signal On” (if a turn signal is left on) and “Lights On” (if driver leaves the vehicle).
• UnstoredMessagesUntilRUN
These messages deal primarily with the Remote Start feature. This message type is displayed until the ignition is in the RUN state. Examples of this message type are "Remote Start Aborted - Door Ajar" and "Press Brake Pedal and Push Button to Start".
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 311
- FiveSecondUnstoredMessages
When the appropriate conditions occur, this type of message takes control of the main display area for five seconds and then returns to the previous screen. An example of this message type is “Automatic High Beams On”.
EVICAmberTelltales
This area will show reconfigurable amber caution tell-tales. These telltales include:
- LowFuelTelltale

When the fuel level reaches approximately 3.0 gal (11.0 L) this light will turn on, and remain on until added.
•WindshieldWasherFluidLowIndicator

This telltale will turn on to indicate the wind-shield washer fluid is low.
- LowCoolantLevelIndicator

This telltale will turn on to indicate the vehicle coolant level is low.
• Transmission Temperature Warning Telltale

This telltale indicates that the transmission fluid temperature is running hot. This may occur with severe usage, such as trailer towing. If this telltale turns on, safely pull over and stop the vehicle. Then, shift the transmission into NEU-TRAL and run the engine at idle or faster until the light turns off.

312 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CAUTION!
ContinuousdrivingwiththeTransmissionTemperatureWarningLightilluminatedwilleventuallycauseseveretransmissiondamageortransmissionfailure.
WARNING!
If you continue operating the vehicle when the Transmission Temperature Warning Light is illuminated you could cause the fluid to oil over, come in contact with hot engine exhaust components and cause a fire.
• AirSuspensionPayloadProtectionTelltale—If Equipped

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the maximum payload may have been exceeded or load leveling cannot be achieved at its current ride height.
Protection Mode will automatically be selected in order to "protect" the air suspension system, air suspension adjustment is limited due to payload.
• ServiceStop/StartSystemTelltale—IfEquipped

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the Stop/Start is Unavailable, service Stop/Start system.
- LooseFuelFillerCap

This telltale will turn on to indicate that the fuel filler cap may be loose.

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 313
EVICWhiteTelltales
•ElectronicSpeedControlReady

This light will turn on when the electronic speed control is ON. For further information, refer to "Electronic Speed Control" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle."
EVICRedTelltales
This area will show reconfigurable red telltales. These telltales include:
•DoorAjar

This light will turn on to indicate that one or more doors may be ajar.
• OilPressureWarningLight
This telltale indicates low engine oil pressure. If the light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shut off the engine as soon as possible. A chime will sound when this light turns on.
Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is corrected. This light does not show how much oil is in the engine. The engine oil level must be checked under the hood.
• OilTemperatureWarningLight

This telltale indicates engine oil temperature is high. If the light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shut off the engine as soon as possible.
- ChargingSystemLight
This light shows the status of the electrical charging system. If the light stays on or comes on while driving, turn off some of the vehicle's non-essential

314 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
electrical devices or increase engine speed (if at idle). If the charging system light remains on, it means that the vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See an authorized dealer.
If jump starting is required, refer to "Jump Starting Procedures" in "What To Do In Emergencies".
• ElectronicThrottleControl(ETC)Light

This light informs you of a problem with the Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. The light will come on when the ignition is first turned ON and remain on briefly as a bulb check. If the light does not come on during starting, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
If a problem is detected, the light will come on while the engine is running. Cycle the ignition key when the
vehicle has completely stopped and the shift lever is placed in the PARK position. The light should turn off.
If the light remains lit with the engine running, your vehicle will usually be drivable. However, see an authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. If the light is flashing when the engine is running, immediate service is required. You may experience reduced performance, an elevated/rough idle or engine stall and your vehicle may require towing.
•EngineTemperatureWarningLight
This light warns of an overheated engine condition. As temperatures rise and the gauge approaches H, this indicator will illuminate and a single chime will sound after reaching a set threshold. Further overheating will cause the temperature gauge to pass H, a continuous chime will occur until the engine is allowed to cool.

If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over and stop the vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it off. Also, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and idle the vehicle. If the temperature reading does not return to normal, turn the engine off immediately and call for service. Refer to "If Your Engine Overheats" in "What To Do In Emergencies" for more information.
• ElectricPowerSteeringMalfunctionWarningLight

This telltale is on when the Electric Power Steering is not operating and needs service.
• TrailerBrakeDisconnectedWarningLight

This telltale is on when the Trailer Brake has been disconnected.
EVICGreenTelltales
•ElectronicSpeedControlSET

This telltale will illuminate green when the electronic speed control is SET. For further information, refer to "Electronic Speed Control" in "Understanding The Features Of Your
Vehicle."
FuelFilterLifeReset
The cluster will display the "Fuel System Service Required – See Dealer" or "Service Fuel Filter" message when the fuel filter maintenance life is less than 5%. To verify if this is a fuel filter change event, go to the "Fuel Filter Life" screen in the "Vehicle Info" menu. When this message appears, dealers should replace both frame mounted and engine mounted fuel filters.
NOTE: Use the steering wheel EVIC controls for the following procedure(s)

316 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
VehiclesEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, press the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Fuel Filter Life" screen.
- Press and hold the RIGHTarrow button for one second to access the "Fuel Filter Life Reset" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Yes", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Fuel Filter Life.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
VehiclesNotEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Fuel Filter Life" screen.
- Press and hold the RIGHTarrow button for one second to access the "Fuel Filter Life Reset" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Yes", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Fuel Filter Life.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
OilLifeReset
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The “Oil Change Required” message will flash in the EVIC display for approximately 10 seconds after a single chime has sounded, to indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate, dependent upon your personal driving style.
NOTE: Use the steering wheel EVIC controls for the following procedure(s)
VehiclesEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, press the ENGINE START/STOP button and cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "Oil Life" screen.
- Press and hold the RIGHTarrow button for one second to access the "Oil Life Reset" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Yes", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Oil Life.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.

318 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
VehiclesNotEquippedWithPassiveEntry
- Without pressing the brake pedal, cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine.)
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to scroll downward through the main menu to "Vehicle Info".
- Press and release the RIGHTarrow button to access the "OilLife" screen.
- Press and hold the RIGHTarrow button for one second to access the "OilLifeReset" screen.
- Press and release the DOWNarrow button to select "Yes", then press and release the Right arrow button to select reset of the Oil Life.
- Press and release the Up arrow button to exit the EVIC screen.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Messages
• Front Seatbelts Unbuckled
- Driver Seatbelt Unbuckled
- Passenger Seatbelt Unbuckled
•Service Airbag System
- Traction Control Off
- Washer Fluid Low
- Oil Pressure Low
- Oil Change Due
- Fuel Low

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 319
•Service Antilock Brake System
•Service Electronic Throttle Control
•Service Power Steering
• Cruise Off
•Cruise Ready
•Cruise Set To XXX MPH
•Service Tire Pressure System
- Parking Brake Engaged
- Brake Fluid Low
•Service Electronic Braking System
•Engine Temperature Hot
- Tire Pressure Screen With Low Tire(s) "Inflate Tire to XX"
- Battery Voltage Low
•Service Electronic Throttle Control
•Lights On
• Right Turn Signal Light Out
• Left Turn Signal Light Out - Turn Signal On
- Vehicle Not in Park
•Key in Ignition
•Key in Ignition Lights On - Remote Start Active Key to Run
- Remote Start Active Push Start Button
- Remote Start Aborted Fuel Low
• Remote Start Aborted Too Cold
320 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- Remote Start Aborted Door Open
- Remote Start Aborted Hood Open
- Remote Start Aborted Trunk Open
- Remote Start Aborted Time Expired
- Remote Start Disabled Start to Reset
•Service Airbag System
•Service Airbag Warning Light - Driver Seatbelt Unbuckled
• Passenger Seatbelt Unbuckled
• Front Seatbelts Unbuckled - Door Open
-
Doors Open
•Gear Not Available -
Shift Not Allowed
- Shift to Neutral then Drive or Reverse
• Autostick Unavailable Service Required
• Automatic Unavailable Use Autostick Service Req.
• Transmission Getting Hot Press Brake
• Trans. Hot Stop Safely Shift to Park Wait to Cool
• Transmission Cool Ready to Drive
• Trailer Brake Disconnected
•Service Transmission
•Service Shifter - Engage Park Brake to Prevent Rolling
• Transmission Too cold Idle with Engine On - Washer Fluid Low
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 321
•Service Air Suspension System
•Normal Ride Height Achieved
•Aerodynamic Ride Height Achieved
- Off Road 1 Ride Height Achieved
- Off Road 2 Ride Height Achieved
- Entry/Exit Ride Height Achieved
- Selected Ride Height Not Permitted
•Service Air Suspension System Immediately
- Reduce Speed To Maintain Selected Ride Height
• Air Suspension System Cooling Down Please Wait
• Vehicle Cannot Be Lowered Door Open
- Off Road 2 Watch For Clearance
- Entry/Exit Watch For Clearance
• Air Suspension Temporarily Disabled For Jacking And Tire Change
- Battery Low Start Engine To Change Ride Height
- Stop/Start Ready – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Hood Open – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Battery Charging – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Trailer Tow/Haul Selected – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready 4WD/Low Range Selected – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Fuel Level Low – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Steep Incline – If Equipped
322 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- Stop/Start Not Ready Extreme Outside Temperature – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Engine Temperature Too High – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Engine Temperature Too Low – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Driver Seatbelt Unbuckled – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Driver Door Open – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Cabin Cooling Or Heating – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Not Ready Max Cooling Or Heating – If Equipped
-
Stop/Start Not Ready Max Cooling Or Heating Selected – If Equipped
-
Stop/Start Not Ready Front Defrost Selected – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Not Ready Steering Wheel Turned – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Autostop Active – If Equipped
- Stop/Start To Restart Press Clutch Or Shift To Neutral – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Req'd Fault Detected – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Cannot Autostart Hood Open – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Unavailable Service Battery – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Unavailable Service Stop/Start System – If Equipped
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 323
- Stop/Start To Restart Shift Out Of Park – If Equipped
- Stop/Start Off – If Equipped
- Autostop Duration – If Equipped
The Reconfigurable Telltales section is divided into the white telltales area on the right, amber telltales in the middle, and red telltales on the left.
EVIC Selectable Menu Items
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow buttons until the desired Selectable Menu icon is highlighted in the EVIC.
DigitalSpeedometer

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Digital display icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to change the display between km/h and mph.
VehicleInfo(CustomerInformationFeatures)

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Vehicle Info icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button and Coolant Temp will be displayed. Press the LEFT or SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to scroll through the following information submenus:
AirSuspension-IfEquipped
Transmission Temperature-Automatic Transmission Only
OilTemp
OilLife
Multimeter

324 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TirePressureMonitoringSystem(1500&2500Series)
Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until "Tire Pressure" is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button and one of the following will be displayed:
A vehicle ICON is displayed with tire pressure values in each corner of the ICON.
TirePressureInformationSystem(3500SeriesHeavy DutyRamTrucks)
Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until "Tire Pressure" is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button and one of the following will be displayed:
A vehicle ICON is displayed with the tire pressure values in each corner of the ICON.
If the Tire Pressure system requires service, "Service Tire Pressure System" is displayed.
Tire PSI is an information only function and cannot be reset. Press and release the LEFT arrow button to return to the main menu.
Refer to the "Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS) under "Starting and Operating" for further information.
TripA

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Trip A icon is highlighted in the EVIC. The Trip A information will display the following:
- Distance
• Average Fuel Economy
• Average Speed - Elapsed Time

Hold the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to reset all the information.
TripB

Press and release Up & Down arrow button until the Trip B icon is highlighted in the EVIC. The Trip B information will display the following:
• Distance
•Average Fuel Economy
• Average Speed
- Elapsed Time
Hold the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to reset all the information.
FuelEconomy

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Fuel Economy icon is highlighted.
- Average Fuel Economy/Miles Per Gallon (MPG or L/100 km with Bargraph)
- Range To Empty (RTE)
- Current Fuel Economy (MPG or L/100 km)
Stop/Start-IfEquipped

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Stop/Start icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to display the Stop/Start status.

326 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TrailerTow

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Trailer Tow icon is highlighted. Press the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button and the next screen will display the following
trailer trip information:
- Trailer Trip
- Trailer Brake
Audio

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Audio display icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to display the active source.
ScreenSetup

Press and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until the Screen Setup display icon is highlighted in the EVIC. Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to enter the
Screen Setup sub-menu. The Screen Setup feature allows you to change what information is displayed in the instrument cluster as well as the location that information is displayed.
StoredMessages

Press and release the UP arrow button until the Messages display icon is highlighted in the EVIC. This feature shows the number of stored warning messages. Pressing the RIGHT arrow ll allow you to see what the stored messages

Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)
Forvehiclesequippeda3.5"EVICscreen
Personal Settings allows the driver to set and recall features when the transmission is in PARK.
Press and release the UP and DOWN button until Personal Settings displays in the EVIC.
Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to display one of the following choices.
Forvehiclesequippedwitha7"EVICscreenandnot equippedwithaUconnect®8.4radio.
Personal Settings allows the driver to set and recall features when the transmission is in PARK.
Use the UP or DOWN button until Personal Settings displays in the EVIC.
Press and release the SELECT/RIGHT arrow button to Enter Vehicle Settings
Use the UP or DOWN button to display one of the following choices.
NOTE: Your vehicle may or may not be equipped with the following settings.
Language
When in this display you may select one of three languages for all display screens, including the trip functions and the navigation system (if equipped). Press the UP or DOWN button while in this display and scroll through the language choices. Press the SELECT button to select English, Spanish (Español), French (Français). Then, as you continue, the information will display in the selected language.

Units
Press and release the UP or DOWN button until "Units" displays in the EVIC and press the SELECT button. The EVIC, odometer, and navigation system (if equipped) can be changed between English and Metric units of measure. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button the selected setting will be displayed.
Nav-TurnByTurn—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the navigation system utilizes voice commands, guiding through the drive route, mile by mile, turn-by-turn until the final destination is reached. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
ParkAssistSystem—IfEquipped
The Rear Park Assist system will scan for objects behind the vehicle when the transmission is in the REVERSE position and the vehicle speed is less than 11 mph (18 km/h). The system can be enabled with Sound Only or Sound and Display. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Refer to “Rear Park Assist System” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for system function and operating information.
TiltMirrorInReverse
When this feature is selected and the shift lever is placed in reverse gear, the side mirrors tilt downward to allow the driver to see into the previous blind spot and avoid objects in close proximity to the rear of the vehicle. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT

button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
AutoWipers—IfEquipped
When ON is selected, the system will automatically activate the windshield wipers if it senses moisture on the windshield. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated. When the system is deactivated, the system reverts to the standard intermittent wiper operation.
HillStartAssist(HSA)
When on is selected, the HSA system is active. Refer to "Electronic Brake Control System" in "Starting And Operating" for system function and operating information. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
HeadlampOffDelay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a checkmark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
IlluminatedApproach
When this feature is selected, the headlights will activate and remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when the doors are unlocked with the RKE transmitter. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is

330 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
HeadlampsWithWipers
When this feature is selected and the HEADLIGHT switch is in the AUTO position, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on. The headlights will also turn off when the wipers are turned off if they were turned on by this feature. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
AutomaticHighBeams—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the high beam headlights will deactivate automatically under certain conditions. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated. Refer to “Automatic High Beam — If Equipped” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
FlashLampsWithLock
When this feature is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the RKE transmitter. This feature may be selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
AutoLockDoors
When this feature is selected, all doors will lock automatically when the vehicle reaches a speed of 15 mph (24 km/h). To make your selection, press and release the
SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated, or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
AutoUnlockDoors
When this feature is selected, all doors will unlock when the vehicle is stopped and the transmission is in the PARK or NEUTRAL position and the driver's door is opened. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated, or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
HornWithRemoteStart
When this feature is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the RKE transmitter REMOTE START button is pressed. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
SoundHornWithRemoteLock
When this feature is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the RKE transmitter LOCK button is pressed. This feature may be selected with or without the Flash Lamps with Lock feature. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
RemoteUnlockSequence
When UnlockDriverDoorOnlyOn1stPressis selected, only the driver's door will unlock on the first press of the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button. When Driver Door 1st Press is selected, you must press the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenger's doors.

332 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
When UnlockAllDoorsOn1stPressis selected, all of the doors will unlock on the first press of the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
KeyFobLinkedToMemory
When this feature is selected the memory seat, mirror, and radio settings will return to the memory set position when the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button is pressed. If this feature is not selected then the memory seat, mirror, and radio settings can only return to the memory set position using the seat mounted switch. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
KeylessEnter-N-Go™(PassiveEntry)
This feature allows you to lock and unlock the vehicle's door(s) without having to press the RKE transmitter lock or unlock buttons. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated. Refer to "Keyless Enter-N-Go™" in "Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle".
RemoteStartComfortSys.
When this feature is selected and the remote start is activated, the heated steering wheel and driver heated seat features will automatically turn on in cold weather. In warm weather, the driver vented seat feature will automatically turn on when the remote start is activated. These features will stay on through the duration of remote start or until the key is turned to RUN. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 333
a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
Key-OffPowerDelay
When this feature is selected, the power window switches, radio, hands-free system (if equipped), DVD video system (if equipped), power sunroof (if equipped), and power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is turned OFF. Opening either front vehicle door will cancel this feature. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
AirSuspensionDisplayAlerts-IfEquipped
When All is selected, all the Air Suspension Alerts will be displayed. When Warnings Only is selected only the Air Suspension Warnings will be displayed. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
AeroRideHeightMode(1500Only)-IfEquipped
When this feature is selected the Ride Height will automatically be adjusted depending on the vehicle speed. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
Tire/JackMode-IfEquipped
When this feature is selected the air suspension system is disabled to assist with changing a spare tire. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.

334 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TransportMode-IfEquipped
When this feature is selected the air suspension system is disabled to assist with flat bed towing. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
WheelAlignmentMode-IfEquipped
Before performing a wheel alignment this mode must be enabled. Refer to your authorized dealer for further information.
HornwithRemoteLower-IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the RKE transmitter REMOTE LOWER button is pressed. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
LightswithRemoteLower-IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash when the RKE transmitter REMOTE LOWER button is pressed. This feature may be selected with or without the sound horn on lower feature selected. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
TrailerSelect
When this feature is selected, the Trailer Type can be selected between "Trailer 1", "Trailer 2", "Trailer 3" and "Trailer 4". To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 335
release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
TrailerBrakeType
When this feature is selected, the Trailer Brake Type can be changed between "Light Electric", "Heavy Electric", "Light EOH" and "Heavy EOH". To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Refer to "Integrated Trailer Brake Module" in "Starting And Operating."
TrailerName
When this feature is selected, the Trailer name can be selected from 16 names. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
CalibrateCompass
Refer to "Compass Display" for more information.
CompassVariance
Refer to "Compass Display" for more information.
Screen Setup Driver Selectable Items
Odometer
•000
•000.0
UpperLeft
- None
- Compas

Information Provided by: DEALER
336 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- Outside Temp (default setting)
- Trans Temp
- Oil Temp
• Time - Range To Empty (RTE)
• Average MPG - Current MPG
- Trip A
- Trip B
- Trailer Trip (distance only)
- Trailer Brake Gain
UpperRight
- None
- Compass (default setting)
- Outside Temp
- Trans Temp
- Oil Temp
• Time - Range To Empty (RTE)
• Average MPG - Current MPG
- Trip A
- Trip B
- Trailer Trip (distance only)
- Trailer Brake Gain
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 337
LowerLeft
- None (default setting)
- Compass
- Outside Temp
- Trans Temp
- Oil Temp
• Time - Range
•AVG MPG - Current MPG
- Trailer Brake Gain
- None (default setting)
LowerRight
- Compass
- Outside Temp
- Trans Temp
- Oil Temp
• Time - Range
• AVG MPG - Current MPG
- Trailer Brake Gain
RestoreToDefaults(RestoresAllSettingsToDefault Settings)
- Cancel
- Okay
338 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Uconnect® SETTINGS
The Uconnect® system uses a combination of soft and hard keys located on the center of the instrument panel that allows you to access and change the customer programmable features.
Hard-Keys
Hard-Keys are located below the Uconnect® system in the center of the instrument panel. In addition, there is a Scroll/Enter control knob located on the right side of the Climate Controls in the center of the instrument panel. Turn the control knob to scroll through menus and change settings (i.e., 30, 60, 90), press the center of the control knob one or more times to select or change a setting (i.e., ON, OFF).
Your Uconnect® system may also have a Screen Off and Back hard-keys located below the system.
Press the Screen Off hard-key to turn off the Uconnect® screen. Press the Screen Off hard-key a second time to turn the screen on.
Press the Back hard-key to exit out of a Menu or certain option on the Uconnect® system.
Soft-Keys
Soft-Keys are accessible on the Uconnect® display.
CustomerProgrammableFeatures—Uconnect® 5.0/8.4Settings
Uconnect® 5.0 — Press the SETTINGS hard-key to display the menu setting screen. Uconnect® 8.4 — Touch the "Apps" soft-key, then touch the "Settings" soft-key to display the menu setting screen. In this mode the Uconnect® system allows you to access programmable features that may be equipped such as Display, Clock, Safety/Assistance, Lights, Doors & Locks, Auto-On

Comfort & Remote Start, Engine Off Operation, Compass Settings, Audio, Phone/Bluetooth® and SiriusXM Setup.
NOTE: Only one touchscreen area may be selected at a time.
When making a selection, touch the soft-key to enter the desired mode. Once in the desired mode, touch and release the preferred setting until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Once the setting is complete, either touch the back arrow soft-key or the Back hard-key to return to the previous menu or touch the "X" soft-key to close out of the settings screen. Touching the Up or Down Arrow soft-keys on the right side of the screen will allow you to toggle up or down through the available settings.
Display
After pressing the "Display" soft-key the following settings will be available.
- DisplayMode
When in this display you may select one of the auto display settings. To change Mode status, touch and release the "Day." "Night" or "Auto" soft-key. Then touch the back arrow soft-key.
- DisplayBrightnessWithHeadlightsON
When in this display, you may select the brightness with the headlights on. Adjust the brightness with the "+" and "-" setting soft-keys or by selecting any point on the scale between the "+" and "-" soft-keys. Then touch the back arrow soft-key.
- DisplayBrightnessWithHeadlightsOFF
When in this display, you may select the brightness with the headlights off. Adjust the brightness with the "+" and "-" setting soft-keys or by selecting any point on the scale between the "+" and "-" soft-keys. Then touch the back arrow soft-key.

340 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- SetLanguage
When in this display, you may select one of three languages for all display nomenclature, including the trip functions and the navigation system (if equipped). Touch the "Set Language" soft-key and then touch the desired language soft-key until a check-mark appears next to the language, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- Units
When in this display, you may select to have the EVIC, odometer, and navigation system (if equipped) changed between US and Metric units of measure. Touch "US" or "Metric" until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
• VoiceResponseLength
When in this display, you may change the Voice Response Length settings. To change the Voice Response Length, touch the "Brief" or "Detailed" soft-key until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- TouchscreenBeep
When in this display, you may turn on or shut off the sound heard when a touchscreen button (soft-key) is pressed. Touch the "Touchscreen Beep" soft-key until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- NavigationTurn-By-TurnInCluster—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the turn-by-turn directions will appear in the display as the vehicle approaches a

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 341
designated turn within a programmed route. To make your selection, touch the "Navigation Turn-By-Turn In Cluster" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
•FuelSaverDisplayInCluster
The “ECO” message is located in the instrument cluster display, this message can be turned on or off. To make your selection, touch the “Fuel Saver Display” soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
Clock
After pressing the "Clock" soft-key the following settings will be available:
- SyncTimeWithGPS
When in this display, you may automatically have the radio set the time. To change the Sync Time setting, touch the "Sync with GPS Time" soft-key until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- SetTimeHours
When in this display, you may adjust the hours. The "Sync with GPS Time" soft-key must be unchecked. To make your selection, touch the "+" or "-" soft-keys to adjust the hours up or down. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu or touch the" X" soft-key to close out of the settings screen.

342 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- SetTimeMinutes
When in this display, you may adjust the minutes. The "Sync with GPS Time" soft-key must be unchecked. To make your selection, touch the "+" or "-" soft-keys to adjust the minutes up or down. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu or touch the "X" soft-key to close out of the settings screen.
- TimeFormat
When in this display, you may select the time format display setting. Touch the "Time Format" soft-key until a check-mark appears next to the 12hrs or 24hrs setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
Safety&DrivingAssistance
After pressing the "Safety & Driving Assistance" soft-key the following settings will be available.
•ParkAssist
The Rear Park Assist system will scan for objects behind the vehicle when the transmission shift lever is in RE-VERSE and the vehicle speed is less than 11 mph (18 km/h). The system can be enabled with Sound Only or Sound and Display. To change the Park Assist status, touch and release the "Sound Only" or the "Sounds and Display" soft-key. Then touch the back arrow soft-key. Refer to "ParkSense® Rear Park Assist" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for system function and operating information.
- TiltMirrorsInReverse
When this feature is selected, the outside sideview mirrors will tilt downward when the ignition is in the RUN position and the transmission shift lever is in the RE-VERSE position. The mirrors will move back to their previous position when the transmission is shifted out of

REVERSE. To make your selection, touch the "Tilt Mirrors In Reverse" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
•ParkView®BackupCamera
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera that allows you to see an on-screen image of the rear surroundings of your vehicle whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE. The image will be displayed on the radio touchscreen display along with a caution note to "check entire surroundings" across the top of the screen. After five seconds, this note will disappear. The ParkView® camera is located on the rear of the vehicle above the rear License plate. To make your selection, touch the "ParkView® Backup Camera" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, indicating that the setting had been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
•ParkView®CameraDelay
When this feature is enabled, it will allow the ParkView Backup Camera display to remain on while in drive for up to 10 seconds, or 8 mph. To make your selection, touch the "ParkView® Backup Camera Delay" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, indicating that the setting had been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- ParkView®BackupCameraStaticGridlines
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera Static Guidelines that allows you to see straight grid line overlay over the ParkView Back up camera display whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE. The image will be displayed on the radio touchscreen display along with a caution note to "check entire surroundings" across the top of the screen. After five seconds, this note will disappear. To make your selection, touch the "ParkView® Backup Camera Static

344 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Gridlines" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, indicating that the setting had been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- ParkView®BackupCameraFixedGuidelines
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera Fixed Guidelines that allows you to see Fixed Guidelines over the ParkView Back up Camera display whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE. The image will be displayed on the radio touchscreen display along with a caution note to “check entire surroundings” across the top of the screen. After five seconds, this note will disappear. To make your selection, touch the “ParkView® Backup Camera Fixed Guidelines” soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, indicating that the setting had been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- ParkView®BackupCameraActiveGuidelines
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera Active Guidelines that allows you to see Active (Dynamic) Guidelines which deflect with steering wheel angle over the ParkView Back up Camera display whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE. The image will be displayed on the radio touchscreen display along with a caution note to "check entire surroundings" across the top of the screen. After five seconds, this note will disappear. To make your selection, touch the "ParkView® Backup Camera Active Guidelines" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, indicating that the setting had been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.

•ParkSense®FrontParkAssistChimeVolume
Front Park Assist chime volume settings can be selected from the EVIC or Uconnect® System (if equipped). The chime volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and HIGH. The factory default volume setting is MEDIUM.
Refer to "EVIC settings" or "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
• ParkSense®RearParkAssistChimeVolume
Rear Park Assist chime volume settings can be selected from the EVIC or Uconnect® System (if equipped). The chime volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and HIGH. The factory default volume setting is MEDIUM.
Refer to "EVIC settings" or "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
• RainSensingAutoWipers
When this feature is selected, the system will automatically activate the windshield wipers if it senses moisture on the windshield. To make your selection, touch the "Rain Sensing" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
• HillStartAssist—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the Hill Start Assist (HSA) system is active. Refer to "Electronic Brake Control System" in "Starting And Operating" for system function and operating information. To make your selection, touch the "Hill Start Assist" soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
346 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- FourCornerAirSuspensionModes—IfEquipped
There are four air suspension modes designed to protect the system in unique situations. Tire Jack Mode is selected to assist in changing a spare tire. Transport Mode is selected to assist when the vehicle is being flat bed towed. Wheel Alignment Mode is selected before performing a wheel alignment, refer to your authorized dealer for information. Protection Mode will automatically be selected to “protect” the air suspension system when the payload has been exceeded or load leveling cannot be achieved.
Lights
After pressing the Lights soft-key the following settings will be available.
- HeadlightOffDelay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a checkmark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
•HeadlightIlluminationOnApproach
When this feature is selected, the headlights will activate and remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when the doors are unlocked with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. To change the Illuminated Approach status, touch the + or - soft-key to select your desired time interval. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
•HeadlightsWithWipers—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, and the headlight switch is in the AUTO position, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on. The headlights will also turn off when the wipers are

turned off if they were turned on by this feature. To make your selection, touch the Headlights With Wipers soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
• AutoDimHighBeam—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the high beam headlights will deactivate automatically under certain conditions. To make your selection, touch the Auto High Beams soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu. Refer to "Lights/Automatic High Beam — If Equipped" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for further information.
•DaytimeRunningLights—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected, the headlights will turn on whenever the engine is running. To make your selection, touch the Daytime Running Lights soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- FlashLampsWithLock
When this feature is selected, the exterior lamps will flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. This feature may be selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To make your selection, touch the Flash Headlights with Lock soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.

348 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Doors&Locks
After pressing the Doors & Locks soft-key the following settings will be available:
•AutoLock
When this feature is selected, all doors will lock automatically when the vehicle reaches a speed of 15 mph (24 km/h). To make your selection, touch the Auto Lock soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
•AutoUnlockOnExit
When this feature is selected, all doors will unlock when the vehicle is stopped and the transmission is in the PARK or NEUTRAL position and the driver's door is opened. To make your selection, touch the Auto Unlock On Exit soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- FlashLampsWithLock
When this feature is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the RKE transmitter. This feature may be selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To make your selection, press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
•SoundHornWithLock
When this feature is selected, the horn will sound when the door locks are activated. To make your selection, touch the Sound Horn With Lock soft-key, until a checkmark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.

• SoundHornWithRemoteStart
When this feature is selected, the horn will sound when the remote start is activated. To make your selection, touch the Sound Horn With Remote Start soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- 1stPressOfKeyFobUnlocks
When 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks is selected, only the driver's door will unlock on the first press of the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter UNLOCK button. When 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks is selected, you must press the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenger's doors. When Unlock All Doors On 1st Press is selected, all of the doors will unlock on the first press of the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button.
NOTE: If the vehicle is programmed 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks, all doors will unlock no matter which Passive Entry equipped door handle is grasped. If 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks is programmed, only the driver's door will unlock when the driver's door is grasped. With Passive Entry, if 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks is programmed touching the handle more than once will only result in the driver's door opening. If driver door first is selected, once the driver door is opened, the interior door lock/unlock switch can be used to unlock all doors (or use RKE transmitter).
- PassiveEntry
This feature allows you to lock and unlock the vehicles door(s) without having to press the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter lock or unlock buttons. To make your selection, touch the Passive Entry soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to

350 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
return to the previous menu. Refer to "Keyless Enter-N-Go™" in "Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle".
•MemoryToFOB—IfEquipped
This feature provides automatic driver seat positioning to enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the vehicle. To make your selection, touch the Memory Linked To FOB soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
NOTE: The seat will return to the memorized seat location (if Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock is set to ON) when the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is used to unlock the door. Refer to "Driver Memory Seat" in "Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle" for further information.
RemoteStartComfortSystems—IfEquipped
After pressing the "Auto-On Comfort & Remote Start" button on the touchscreen the following settings will be available:
•HornWithRemoteStart
When this feature is selected, the horn will sound when the remote start is activated. To make your selection, press the "Sound Horn With Remote Start" button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
- Auto-OnDriverHeated/VentilatedSeat&Steering WheelWithVehicleStart—IfEquipped
When this feature is selected the driver's heated seat and heated steering wheel will automatically turn on when

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 351
temperatures are below 40^ F ( 4.4^ C). When temperatures are above 80^ F ( 26.7^ C), the driver vented seat will turn on. To make your selection, press the “Auto Heated Seats” button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
EngineOffOptions
After pressing the Engine Off Options soft-key the following settings will be available.
- EasyExitSeats
When this feature is selected, the Driver's seat will automatically move rearward once the engine is shut off. To make your selection, touch the Easy Exit Seats soft-key, until a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting has been selected. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.
- EngineOffPowerDelay
When this feature is selected, the power window switches, radio, Uconnect® phone system (if equipped), DVD video system (if equipped), power sunroof (if equipped), and power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the ignition is cycled to OFF. Opening either front door will cancel this feature. To change the Engine Off Power Delay status touch the 0 seconds, 45 seconds, 5 minutes or 10 minutes soft-key. Then touch the arrow back soft-key.
- HeadlightOffDelay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when exiting the vehicle. To change the Headlight Off Delay status touch the + or - soft-key to select your desired time interval. Touch the back arrow soft-key to return to the previous menu.

352 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CompassSettings—IfEquipped
After pressing the "Compass Settings" soft-key the following settings will be available:
•Variance
Compass Variance is the difference between Magnetic North and Geographic North. To compensate for the differences the variance should be set for the zone where the vehicle is driven, per the zone map. Once properly set, the compass will automatically compensate for the differences, and provide the most accurate compass heading.
NOTE: Keep magnetic materials, such as iPod's®, Mobile Phones, Laptops and Radar Detectors, away from the top of the instrument panel where the compass module is located. These materials can cause interference with the compass sensor, and it may give false readings.

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 040506040 CompassVarianceMap•PerformCompassCalibration
Touch the "Calibration" soft-key to change this setting. This compass is self-calibrating, which eliminates the need to manually reset the compass. When the vehicle is new, the compass may appear erratic and the EVIC will display CAL until the compass is calibrated. You may

also calibrate the compass by pressing the "ON" soft-key and completing one or more 360-degree turns (in an area free from large metal or metallic objects) until the CAL indicator displayed in the EVIC turns off. The compass will now function normally.
Audio
After pressing the "Audio" soft-key the following settings will be available:
•Balance/Fade
When in this display you may adjust the Balance and Fade settings.
• Equalizer
When in this display you may adjust the Bass, Mid and Treble settings. Adjust the settings with the "+" and "-" soft-keys or by selecting any point on the scale between the "+" and "-" soft-keys. Then touch the back arrow soft-key.
NOTE:Bass/Mid/Treble allow you to simply slide your finger up or down to change the setting as well as touch directly on the desired setting.
- SpeedAdjustedVolume
This feature increases or decreases volume relative to vehicle speed. To change the Speed Adjusted Volume touch the "Off," "1," "2" or "3" soft-key. Then touch the back arrow soft-key.
- SurroundSound—IfEquipped
This feature provides simulated surround sound mode. To make your selection, touch the "Surround Sound" soft-key, select On or Off followed by pressing the back arrow soft-key.
• AUXVolumeMatch—IfEquipped
This feature provides the ability to tune the audio level for portable devices connected through the AUX input.
354 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
To make your selection, touch the "AUX Volume Match" soft-key, select On or Off followed by pressing the back arrow soft-key.
- Loudness—IfEquipped
The Radio automatically turns on when vehicle is in run or will recall whether it was on or off at last ignition off. To make your selection, touch the “Loudness” soft-key, select On or Off followed by pressing the back arrow soft-key.
TrailerBrake
- TrailerSelect
When this feature is selected, the Trailer Type can be selected between "Trailer 1," "Trailer 2," "Trailer 3" and "Trailer 4." To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
- TrailerBrakeType
When this feature is selected, the Trailer Brake Type can be changed between "Light Electric," "Heavy Electric," "Light EOH" and "Heavy EOH.". To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Refer to "Integrated Trailer Brake Module" in "Starting And Operating."
- TrailerName
When this feature is selected, the Trailer name can be selected from 16 names. To make your selection, scroll up or down until the preferred setting is highlighted, then

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 355
press and release the SELECT button until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that the setting has been selected.
Phone/Bluetooth®
After touching the "Phone/Bluetooth®" soft-key the following settings will be available:
- PairedDevices
This feature shows which phones are paired to the Phone/Bluetooth® system. For further information, refer to the Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
AirSuspension—IfEquipped
After pressing the "Suspension" soft-key the following settings will be available.
- SoundHornWithRemoteLower
When this feature is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the RKE transmitter REMOTE LOWER button is pressed. Touch the box next to your selection and a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
- FlashLightsWithRemoteLower
When this feature is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash when the RKE transmitter REMOTE LOWER button is pressed twice. This feature may be selected with or without the Sound Horn on Lower feature selected. Touch the box next to your selection and a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.

356 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- SuspensionDisplayMessages
When All is selected, all the Air Suspension Alerts will be displayed. When Warnings Only is selected only the Air Suspension Warnings will be displayed.
• AutomaticAeroMode(1500ModelOnly)
When this feature is selected the Ride Height will automatically be adjusted depending on the vehicle speed. Touch the box next to your selection and a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
•TireJackMode
When this feature is selected the air suspension system is disabled to assist with changing a spare tire. Touch the box next to your selection and a check-mark appears next
to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
- TransportMode
When this feature is selected the air suspension system is disabled to assist with flat bed towing. Touch the box next to your selection and a check-mark appears next to the feature showing the system has been activated or the check-mark is removed showing the system has been deactivated.
- WheelAlignmentMode
Before performing a wheel alignment this mode must be enabled. Refer to your authorized dealer for further information.

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 357
SiriusXMSetup
After pressing the "SIRIUS" Setup soft-key the following settings will be available:
- ChannelSkip
SiriusXM can be programmed to designate a group of channels that are the most desirable to listen to or to exclude undesirable channels while scanning. To make your selection, touch the “Channel Skip” soft-key, select the channels you would like to skip followed by pressing the back arrow soft-key.
- SubscriptionInformation
New vehicle purchasers or lessees will receive a free limited time subscription to SiriusXM Satellite Radio with your radio. Following the expiration of the free services, it will be necessary to access the information on the Subscription Information screen to re-subscribe.
Touch the "Subscription Info" soft-key to access the Subscription Information screen.
Write down the SIRIUS ID numbers for your receiver. To reactivate your service, either call the number listed on the screen or visit the provider online.
NOTE:SiriusXM Travel Link is a separate subscription and is available for U.S. residents only.
Uconnect® RADIOS — IF EQUIPPED
For detailed information about your Uconnect® radio, refer to your Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
Located in the lower section of the front integrated center stack, in front of the rotary shifter, this feature allows an iPod® or external USB device to be plugged into the USB port.

358 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
iPod® control supports Mini, 4G, Photo, Nano, 5G iPod® and iPhone® devices. Some iPod® software versions may not fully support the iPod® control features. Please visit Apple's website for software updates.
For further information, refer to the Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS — IF EQUIPPED
The remote sound system controls are located on the back surface of the steering wheel. Reach behind the wheel to access the switches.

natural_image
Interior view of a car steering wheel with black arrows pointing to the dashboard (no text or symbols)045035190
RemoteSoundSystemControls(BackViewOfSteering Wheel)
The right hand control is a rocker type switch with a pushbutton in the center. Pressing the top of the switch will increase the volume, and pressing the bottom of the switch will decrease the volume.
The button located in the center of the right hand control will switch modes to Radio, CD or other valid audio sources.
The left hand control is a rocker type switch with a pushbutton in the center. The function of the left hand control is different depending on which mode you are in.
The following describes the left hand control operation in each mode.
Radio Operation
Pressing the top of the switch will SEEK up for the next listenable station and pressing the bottom of the switch will SEEK down for the next listenable station.
The button located in the center of the left hand control will tune to the next pre-set station that you have programmed in the radio pre-set pushbuttons.
CD Player
Pressing the top of the switch once will go to the next track on the CD. Pressing the bottom of the switch once will go to the beginning of the current track or to the beginning of the previous track if it is within eight seconds after the current track begins to play.
If you press the switch up or down twice it plays the second track, three times, it will play the third, etc.
CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE
To keep a CD/DVD in good condition, take the following precautions:
- Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the surface.
- If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth, wiping from center to edge.
360 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratching the disc.
- Do not use solvents such as benzene, thinner, cleaners, or anti-static sprays.
- Store the disc in its case after playing.
- Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.
- Do not store the disc where temperatures may become too high.
NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particular disc, it may be damaged (e.g., scratched, reflective coating removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc) oversized, or have protection encoding. Try a known good disc before considering disc player service.
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be turned down or off during mobile phone operation when not using Uconnect® (if equipped).
CLIMATE CONTROLS
The Climate Control System allows you to regulate the temperature, amount, and direction of air circulating throughout the vehicle. The controls are located on the instrument panel below the radio.

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 361
Manual Climate Controls Without Touchscreen — If Equipped
The controls for the manual heating and air conditioning system in this vehicle consist of a series of outer rotary dials and inner push knobs. These comfort controls can be set to obtain desired interior conditions.

text_image
1 PUSH 2 A/C PUSH 3 PUSH 4 5 6 7 04560137361 — Front Blower 5 — MAX A/C
2 — Temperature Control 6 — Air Conditioning (A/C)
3 — MODE Control 7 — DEFROST Mode
4 — RECIRCULATION Control

Information Provident by
DEALER
法定代表人:王
362 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
FrontBlowerControl

045671419
There are four blower speeds. Use this control to regulate the amount of air forced through the system in any mode you select. The blower speed increases as you move the control clockwise from the OFF position.
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Remote Start, the climate controls will not function during Remote Start operation if the blower control is left in the OFF position.
TemperatureControl

045671420
Use this control to regulate the temperature of the air inside the passenger compartment. Rotating the knob counterclockwise, from top center into the blue area of the scale, indicates cooler temperatures. Rotating the knob clockwise, into the red area, indicates warmer temperatures.

Information Provided by: DEALER
AirConditioningOperation

Push the A/C button to engage the Air Conditioning (A/C). A LED will illuminate when the A/C system is engaged.
MAXA/C
For maximum cooling, when MAX A/C is selected the A/C is turned on automatically and the air is recirculated.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 363
NOTE:A/C cannot be deselected when in MAX A/C position. The LED will blink three times if the A/C button is pushed. If your air conditioning performance seems lower than expected, check the front of the A/C condenser (located in front of the radiator), for an accumulation of dirt or insects. Clean with a gentle water spray from behind the radiator and through the condenser. Fabric front fascia protectors may reduce airflow to the condenser, reducing air conditioning performance.
ModeControl(AirDirection)

045671421
Mode control allows you to choose from several patterns of air distribution. You can select either a primary mode, as identified by the symbols, or a blend of two of these modes. The closer the control is to a particular mode, the more air distribution you
receive from that mode.

364 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
PanelMode

Air is directed through the outlets in the instrument panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct V.
Bi-LevelMode

Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
NOTE: There is a difference in temperature (in any conditions other than full cold or full hot), between the upper and lower outlets for added comfort. The warmer air goes to the floor outlets. This feature gives improved comfort during sunny but cool conditions.
FloorMode

Air is directed through the floor outlets with a small amount through the defrost and side win-emist outlets.
MixMode

Air is directed through the floor, defrost and side window demist outlets. This setting works best in or snowy conditions that require extra heat at the shield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort, reducing moisture on the windshield.

Information Provided by: DEALER E-FROCESS
DefrostMode

Air is directed through the windshield and side window demist outlets. Use the DEFROST mode with maximum blower and warm temperature settings for best windshield and side window defrosting.
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in MIX and DEFROST, or a blend of these modes even if the A/C button is not pressed. This dehumidifies the air to help dry the windshield. To improve fuel economy, use these modes only when necessary.
RecirculationControl

Press the Recirculation Control button to choose between outside air intake or recirculation of the air inside the vehicle. A LED will illuminate when you are in Re circulation mode. Only use the Recirculation mode to te mporarily block out any outside odors, smoke, or dust, and to cool the interior rapidly upon initial start-up in very hot or humid weather.
NOTE:
- If the RECIRCULATION button is pressed when the system is in Defrost mode, the Recirculation LED indicator will flash three times and then turn off to indicate Recirculation mode is not allowed.
- Continuous use of the Recirculation mode may make the inside air stuffy and window fogging may occur. Extended use of this mode is not recommended.
- In cold or damp weather, the use of the Recirculation mode will cause windows to fog on the inside because of moisture buildup inside the vehicle. For maximum defogging, select the outside air position.
366 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
- The A/C can be deselected manually without disturbing the mode control selection by pressing the A/C button.
AirOutlets
The airflow from each of the instrument panel outlets can be adjusted for direction, and turned on or off to control airflow.
NOTE: For maximum airflow to the rear, the center instrument panel outlets can be directed toward the rear seat passengers.
EconomyMode
If ECONOMY mode is desired, press the A/C button to turn off the LED indicator and the A/C compressor. Rotate the temperature control knob to the desired temperature. Also, make sure to select only Panel, Bi-Level or Floor modes.
Stop/StartSystem—IfEquipped
While in an Autostop, the Climate Controls system may automatically adjust airflow to maintain cabin comfort. Customer settings will be maintained upon return to an engine running condition.

Information Provided by. DEALER
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 367
Manual Climate Controls With Touchscreen — If Equipped
Hard-Keys
The hard-keys are located below the radio touchscreen.

text_image
2 9 7 10 4 A/G OFF FRONT 3 8 5 0456013738ClimateControls—Hard-Keys
Soft-Keys
Soft-keys are accessible on the radio touchscreen.

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 MAX A/C A/C 10:10 FRENT RENT 68° 6 OFF 7 Radio Media Citrate Nov Phone Settings Apps 0456013737TemperatureControls—Soft-Keys

Information Provided by: DEALER
368 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
ButtonDescriptions(AppliesToBothHard-KeysAnd Soft-Keys)
1.MAXA/CButton
Press and release to toggle between MAX A/C and the prior settings. The soft-key illuminates when MAX A/C is ON. In MAX A/C, the blower level and mode position can be adjusted to desired user settings. Pressing other settings will cause the MAX A/C operation to switch to the prior settings and the MAX A/C indicator will turn off.
2.A/CButton
Press and release to change the current setting, the indicator illuminates when A/C is ON. Performing this function again will cause the A/C operation to switch into manual mode and the A/C indicator will turn off.
3. RecirculationButton
Press and release to change the current setting; the indicator illuminates when ON.
4.FrontDefrostButton
Press and release to change the current airflow setting to Defrost mode. The indicator illuminates when this feature is ON. Air comes from the windshield and side window demist outlets. When the defrost button is selected, the blower level will increase. Use Defrost mode with maximum temperature settings for best windshield and side window defrosting and defogging. Performing this function will cause the ATC to switch into manual mode. If the front defrost mode is turned off the climate system will return the previous setting.
5.DefrostButton
Press and release this button to turn on the rear window defroster (if equipped) and the heated outside mirrors (if

equipped). An indicator will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window defroster automatically turns off after 10 minutes.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to the heating elements:
- Usecarewhenwashingtheinsideoftherear window.Donotuseabrasivewindowcleanerson theinteriorsurfaceofthewindow.Useasoftcloth andamildwashingsolution,wipingparalleltothe heatingelements.Labelscanbepeeledoffafter soakingwithwarmwater.
- Donotusescrapers, sharpinstruments, or abrasive windowcleanersontheinteriorsurfaceofthe window.
- Keepallobjectsasafedistancefromthewindow.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 369
6.Modes
The airflow distribution mode can be adjusted so air comes from the instrument panel outlets, floor outlets, demister outlets and defrost outlets. The Mode settings are as follows:
- PanelMode
Air comes from the outlets in the instrument panel. Each of these outlets can be individually adjusted to direct the flow of air. The air vanes of the center outlets and outboard outlets can be moved up and down or side to side to regulate airflow direction. There is a shut off wheel located below the air vanes to shut off or adjust the amount of airflow from these outlets.
- Bi-LevelMode
Air comes from the instrument panel outlets and floor outlets. A slight amount of air is directed through the defrost and side window demister
outlets.

370 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:BI-LEVEL mode is designed under comfort conditions to provide cooler air out of the panel outlets and warmer air from the floor outlets.
- FloorMode

Air comes from the floor outlets. A slight amount of air is directed through the defrost and side window demister outlets.
- MixMode

Air comes from the floor, defrost and side window demister outlets. This mode works best in cold or snowy conditions.
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in MIX and DEFROST modes even if the A/C button is not pressed. This dehumidifies the air to help dry the windshield. To improve fuel economy, utilize these modes only when required.
7.BlowerControl
Blower control is used to regulate the amount of air forced through the climate system. There are seven blower speeds available. Adjusting the blower will cause automatic mode to switch to manual operation. The speeds can be selected using either hard-keys or soft-keys as follows:
Hard-Key
The blower speed increases as you turn the control clockwise from the lowest blower setting. The blower speed decreases as you turn the knob counterclockwise.
Soft-Key
Use the small blower icon to reduce the blower setting and the large blower icon to increase the blower setting. Blower can also be selected by pressing the blower bar area between the icons.

8. ClimateControlOFFButton
Press and release this button to turn the Climate Control ON/OFF.
9.TemperatureControlDownButton
Push the button for cooler temperature settings. On the touchscreen, slide the temperature bar towards the blue arrow soft-key for cooler temperature settings.
10. TemperatureControlUpButton
Push the button for warmer temperature settings. On the touchscreen, slide the temperature bar towards the blue arrow soft-key for cooler temperature settings.
RecirculationControl
When outside air contains smoke, odors, or high humidity, or if rapid cooling is desired, you may wish to recirculate interior air by pressing the RECIRCULATION control button.
Recirculation mode should only be used temporarily. The recirculation LED will illuminate on the blower control knob when this button is selected. Push the button a second time to turn off the Recirculation mode LED and allow outside air into the vehicle.
NOTE: In cold weather, use of Recirculation mode may lead to excessive window fogging. The Recirculation mode is not allowed in Defrost mode to improve window clearing operation. Recirculation will be disabled automatically if these modes are selected.

372 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Automatic Climate Controls With Touchscreen — If Equipped
Hard-Keys
The hard-keys are located below the Uconnect® screen.

text_image
2 14 10 12 7 5 OFF A/C AUTO FRONT 3 13 4 8 6 0456005994AutomaticClimateControls—Hard-Keys
Soft-Keys
Soft-keys are accessible on the Uconnect® system screen.

text_image
1 2 3 5 Max A/C A/C Front Rear Temp 70 78 Fan A Mode Driver Sync Auto Climate Off Pass 6 11 15 10 9 4 12 0456004816Uconnect®5.0AutomaticTemperatureControls—Soft-Keys

Information Provider Pty. DEALER

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 MAX A/C A/C AUTO FRONT REAR 7 14 68° 72° 13 OFF Auto Media Control Home Air Air 9 12 10 11 10 0442005993Uconnect®8.4AutomaticTemperatureControls—Soft-Keys
ButtonDescriptions(AppliesToBothHard-KeysAnd Soft-Keys)
1.MAXA/CButton
Press and release to change the current setting, the indicator illuminates when MAX A/C is ON. Performing
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 373
this function again will cause the MAX A/C operation to switch into manual mode and the MAX A/C indicator will turn off.
2.A/CButton
Press and release to change the current setting, the indicator illuminates when A/C is ON. Performing this function again will cause the A/C operation to switch into manual mode and the A/C indicator will turn off.
3.RecirculationButton
Press and release to change the current setting, the indicator illuminates when ON.
4. AUTOOperationButton
Automatically controls the interior cabin temperature by adjusting airflow distribution and amount. Performing this function will cause the ATC to switch between manual mode and automatic modes. Refer to "Automatic Operation" for more information.

374 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
5.FrontDefrostButton
Press and release to change the current airflow setting to Defrost mode. The indicator illuminates when this feature is ON. Air comes from the windshield and side window demist outlets. When the defrost button is selected, the blower level will increase. Use Defrost mode with maximum temperature settings for best windshield and side window defrosting and defogging. Performing this function will cause the ATC to switch into manual mode. If the front defrost mode is turned off the climate system will return the previous setting.
6.DefrostButton
Press and release this button to turn on the rear window defroster (if equipped) and the heated outside mirrors (if equipped). An indicator will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window defroster automatically turns off after 10 minutes.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to the heating elements:
- Usecarewhenwashingtheinsideoftherear window.Donotuseabrasivewindowcleanerson theinteriorsurfaceofthewindow.Useasoftcloth andamildwashingsolution,wipingparalleltothe heatingelements.Labelscanbepeeledoffafter soakingwithwarmwater.
- Donotusescrapers, sharpinstruments, or abrasive window cleanerson the interiorsurface of the window.
- Keepallobjectsasafedistancefromthewindow.
7.PassengerTemperatureControlUpButton
Provides the passenger with independent temperature control. Push the hard-key button for warmer temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide the soft-key temperature bar towards the red arrow soft-key for warmer temperature settings.
NOTE: Pressing this button while in Sync mode will automatically exit Sync.
8.PassengerTemperatureControlButtonDown
Provides the passenger with independent temperature control. Push the hard-key button for cooler temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide the soft-key temperature bar towards the blue arrow soft-key for cooler temperature settings.
NOTE: Pressing this button while in Sync mode will automatically exit Sync.
9.SYNC
Press the Sync soft-key to toggle the Sync feature On/Off. The Sync indicator is illuminated when this feature is enabled. Sync is used to synchronize the passenger temperature setting with the driver temperature setting. Changing the passenger temperature setting while in Sync will automatically exit this feature.
10.BlowerControl
Blower control is used to regulate the amount of air forced through the climate system. There are seven blower speeds available. Adjusting the blower will cause automatic mode to switch to manual operation. The speeds can be selected using either hard-keys or soft-keys as follows:
Hard-Key
The blower speed increases as you turn the control clockwise from the lowest blower setting. The blower speed decreases as you turn the knob counterclockwise.

376 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Soft-Key
Use the small blower icon to reduce the blower setting and the large blower icon to increase the blower setting. Blower can also be selected by pressing the blower bar area between the icons.
11.Modes
The airflow distribution mode can be adjusted so air comes from the instrument panel outlets, floor outlets, demist outlets and defrost outlets. The Mode settings are as follows:
- PanelMode

Air comes from the outlets in the instrument panel. Each of these outlets can be individually adjusted to direct the flow of air. The air vanes of the center outlets and outboard outlets can be moved up and down or side to side to regulate airflow
direction. There is a shut off wheel located below the air vanes to shut off or adjust the amount of airflow from these outlets.
- Bi-LevelMode

Air comes from the instrument panel outlets and floor outlets. A slight amount of air is directed through the defrost and side window demister outlets.
NOTE:BI-LEVEL mode is designed under comfort conditions to provide cooler air out of the panel outlets and warmer air from the floor outlets.
- FloorMode

Air comes from the floor outlets. A slight amount of air is directed through the defrost and side window demister outlets.

- MixMode

Air comes from the floor, defrost and side window demist outlets. This mode works best in cold or snowy conditions.
12. ClimateControlOFFButton
Press and release this button to turn the Climate Control ON/OFF.
13.DriverTemperatureControlDownButton
Provides the driver with independent temperature control. Push the hard-key button for cooler temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide the soft-key temperature bar towards the blue arrow soft-key for cooler temperature settings.
NOTE: In Sync mode, this button will also automatically adjust the passenger temperature setting at the same time.
14.DriverTemperatureControlUpButton
Provides the driver with independent temperature control. Push the hard-key button for warmer temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide the soft-key temperature bar towards the red arrow soft-key for warmer temperature settings.
NOTE: In Sync mode, this button will also automatically adjust the passenger temperature setting at the same time.
15.TemperatureControl(Uconnect®5.0)
Press the temperature soft-key to regulate the temperature of the air inside the passenger compartment. Moving the temperature bar into the red area, indicates warmer temperatures. Moving the temperature bar into the blue area indicates cooler temperatures.

378 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
AutomaticOperation
- Press the AUTO hard-key or soft-key button on the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) Panel.
- Next, adjust the temperature you would like the system to maintain by adjusting the driver and passenger temperature hard or soft control buttons. Once the desired temperature is displayed, the system will achieve and automatically maintain that comfort level.
- When the system is set up for your comfort level, it is not necessary to change the settings. You will experience the greatest efficiency by simply allowing the system to function automatically.
NOTE:
- It is not necessary to move the temperature settings for cold or hot vehicles. The system automatically adjusts the temperature, mode, and blower speed to provide comfort as quickly as possible.
- The temperature can be displayed in U.S. or Metric units by selecting the US/M customer-programmable feature. Refer to the "Uconnect® System Settings" in this section of the manual.
To provide you with maximum comfort in the Automatic mode, during cold start-ups the blower fan will remain on low until the engine warms up. The blower will increase in speed and transition into Auto mode.
RecirculationControl

When outside air contains smoke, odors, or high humidity, or if rapid cooling is desired, you may wish to recirculate interior air by pressing the RECIRCULATION control button.
Recirculation mode should only be used temporarily. The recirculation LED will illuminate on the soft and hard keys when either button is selected. Push either soft or

UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 379
hard key a second time to turn off the Recirculation mode LED and allow outside air into the vehicle.
NOTE: In cold weather, use of Recirculation mode may lead to excessive window fogging. The recirculation feature may be unavailable (soft-key button greyed out) if conditions exist that could create fogging on the inside of the windshield. On systems with Manual Climate Controls, the recirculation mode is not allowed in Defrost mode to improve window clearing operation. Recirculation will be disabled automatically if this mode is selected. Attempting to use Recirculation while in this mode will cause the LED in the control button to blink and then turn off.
Summer Operation
The engine cooling system must be protected with a high-quality antifreeze coolant to provide proper corrosion protection and to protect against engine overheating. OAT coolant (conforming to MS-12106) is recommended. Refer to "Maintenance Procedures" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for proper coolant selection.
Winter Operation
To ensure the best possible heater and defroster performance, make sure the engine cooling system is functioning properly and the proper amount, type, and concentration of coolant is used. Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for proper coolant selection. Use of the air Recirculation mode during Winter months is not recommended because it may cause window fogging.
Vacation/Storage
Any time you store your vehicle or keep it out of service (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in fresh air with the blower setting in high. This will ensure

380 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility of compressor damage when the system is started again.
Window Fogging and Frosting
Vehicle windows tend to fog on the inside of the glass in mild, rainy and/or humid weather. Windows may frost on the inside of the glass in very cold weather. To clear the windows, select Defrost or Mix mode and increase the front blower speed. Do not use the Recirculation mode without A/C for long periods, as fogging may occur.
NOTE: Automatic Temperature Controls (ATC) will automatically adjust the climate control settings to reduce or eliminate window fogging on the front windshield. When this occurs, recirculation will be unavailable.
Outside Air Intake
Make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the windshield, is free of obstructions such as leaves. Leaves collected in the air intake may reduce airflow, can cause odor, and if they enter the plenum they could plug the water drains. In winter months, ensure the air intake is clear of ice, slush and snow.

Operating Tips Chart
| WEATHER | CONTROL SETTINGS |
Hot weather and vehicle interior is very hot![]() | Set the mode control to [TDSV], A/C on, and blower on high. Roll down the windows for a minute to flush out the hot air. Once comfort is achieved adjust controls for comfort. |
Warm weather![]() | Turn A/C on and set the mode control to the [+CS] position. |
Cool ![]() | Operate in [AWKC] position. |
Cool & Humid conditions![]() | Set the mode control to [Z4AT] and turn on A/C to keep windows dear. |
| Cold Weather | Set the mode control to the Short ion. If windshield fogging starts to occur, move the control towards the [Z5AT] position. |
0456001003

Information Provided by
DEALER
电(开) 01 二、安装费
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
■STARTING PROCEDURES....390
□Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
□Automatic Transmission....391
□Keyless Enter-N-Go™. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
□Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
☐Extreme Cold Weather (Below -20^ F Or -29^ C)....393
□If Engine Fails To Start....393
□After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
■ STOP/START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED .....395
□Automatic Mode....395
□Possible Reasons The Engine Does Not AUTO S T O P ....396
□To Start The Engine While In Autostop Mode. .396
□To Manually Turn Off The Stop Start System . .398
□To Manually Turn On The Stop Start System . .399
□System Malfunction....399
■ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED ...399
■AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION .....400
□ Key Ignition Park Interlock....402
384 STARTING AND OPERATING
□Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System . . .403
□Eight-Speed Automatic Transmission — If Equipped....403
☐Six-Speed Automatic Transmission — 1500 Models Only (If Equipped) .....412
☐Six-Speed Automatic Transmission — 2500/3500 Models Only .425
■FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE OPERATION — IF EQUIPPED....436
□ Manually Shifted Transfer Case — If Equipped. .436
□Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Four-Position Switch) — If Equipped .....440
□Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Five-Position Switch) — If Equipped .....447
□Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Five-Position Switch) — If Equipped .....452
■AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (1500 MODELS ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED .....459
□Description....459
□Air Suspension Modes .....463
□Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display Messages....464
□Operation....464
■AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (2500/3500 MODELS ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED .....466
□Description....466
□Air Suspension Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Display Messages....469

STARTING AND OPERATING 385
□Operation....469
☐Off-Road Driving Tips And Vehicle Characteristics....474
□Driving In Snow, Mud And Sand . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
□Crossing Obstacles (Rocks And Other High Points)....478
□Hill Climbing....481
□Driving Through Water....484
□ Airing Down For Off-Road Driving....487
□Vehicle Recovery....487
□After Driving Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
■LIMITED-SLIP DIFFERENTIAL....492
■DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES....493
□Acceleration....493
□Traction....494
■DRIVING THROUGH WATER....494
□Flowing/Rising Water....494
□Shallow Standing Water....495
■OFF-ROAD DRIVING TIPS....496
□After Driving Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
■WINCH USAGE — POWER WAGON ONLY — (IF EQUIPPED) .....498
STARTING AND OPERATING
□Things To Know Before Using Your Winch....498
□Understanding The Features Of Your Winch. . .501
□Winch Accessories....503
□Operating Your Winch....504
□Rigging Techniques....516
■POWER STEERING — 1500 MODELS .....518
■POWER STEERING — 2500/3500 MODELS ....519
□Power Steering Fluid Check — 2500/3500 Models ..... .520
■FUEL SAVER TECHNOLOGY 5.7L/6.4L ENGINES ONLY — IF EQUIPPED .....521
■PARKING BRAKE....521
□ Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System .....524
□Hydraulic Brake Assist — 2500/3500 Models Only (Except Power Wagon)....526
■ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .526
□Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)....527
□ Traction Control System (TCS) — If Equipped . .527
□Brake Assist System (BAS) — If Equipped . . . .528
□Hill Start Assist (HSA) — If Equipped . . . . . . .529
□Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) — If Equipped .....532
□ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
□Trailer Sway Control (TSC) — If Equipped . . .538
■TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION .....539
□ Tire Markings .....539
STARTING AND OPERATING 387
□Tire Identification Number (TIN)....542
□Tire Terminology And Definitions....544
□Tire Loading And Tire Pressure .....545
■TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION .....550
□Tire Pressure....550
□Tire Inflation Pressures .....552
☐Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .553
□Radial Ply Tires....553
□Tire Types .554
□Run Flat Tires — If Equipped .....555
□Spare Tires — If Equipped .....556
□Tire Spinning....558
□ Tread Wear Indicators .....559
□Life Of Tire....559
□Replacement Tires....560
■SUPPLEMENTAL TIRE PRESSURE INFORMATION
— IF EQUIPPED....561
■TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) .....562
■TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS....564
☐Directional Tires — If Equipped .....565
□Dual Rear Wheels — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .565
■TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS) . .567
□Base System....569
□Premium System — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
☐Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS) 3500
Series Trucks....575
□ General Information .....577

STARTING AND OPERATING
■FUEL REQUIREMENTS....577
□3.6L/6.4L Engine....577
□5.7L Engines....577
□Reformulated Gasoline....578
□Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends....578
□E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles .....579
□MMT In Gasoline....580
□Materials Added To Fuel....580
□Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
□Carbon Monoxide Warnings....582
■FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED....582
□E-85 General Information .....582
□Ethanol Fuel (E-85)....584
□Fuel Requirements....584
☐Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles (E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles .....585
□Starting....585
□Cruising Range....585
□Replacement Parts....586
□Maintenance....586
■ADDING FUEL....586
□Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message .....588
■VEHICLE LOADING....588
□Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
■TRAILER TOWING....591
STARTING AND OPERATING 389
□Common Towing Definitions....591
□Trailer Hitch Type and Maximum Trailer Weight....594
□Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)....595
□Trailer And Tongue Weight....599
□Towing Requirements....600
□Towing Tips....610
■SNOWPLOW....612
□1500 Models Only....612
□2500/3500 Models Only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
■RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)....617
□Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .617
□Recreational Towing — Two-Wheel Drive Models....618
□Recreational Towing — Four-Wheel Drive Models....619
390 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING PROCEDURES
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust both inside and outside mirrors, and fasten your seat belt.
The starter should not be operated for more than 15-second intervals. Waiting a few seconds between such intervals will protect the starter from overheating.
WARNING!
Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoan unlocked vehicle.Leavingchildrenina vehicleunattendedisdangerousforanumberof reasons.Achildorotherscouldbeseriouslyor fatally injured.Childrenshouldbewarnednotto touchtheparkingbrake,brakepedalortheshift lever.DonotleavetheKeyFobinornearthevehicle, orinalocationaccessibletochildren,anddonot
WARNING!(Continued)
leavetheignitionofvehicleequippedwithkeyless Enter-N-GointheACCorON/RUNmode.Achild couldoperatepowerwindows,othercontrols,or movethevehicle.
Normal Starting
Normal starting of either a warm or cold engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the accelerator pedal. Cycle the ignition to the START position and release when the engine starts. If the engine fails to start within 10 seconds, cycle the ignition to the OFF position, wait five seconds, then repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
(Continued)


Automatic Transmission
Start the engine with the shift lever in the NEUTRAL or PARK. Apply the brake before shifting into any driving range.
NOTE: This vehicle is equipped with at transmission shiftinterlockingsystem. The brakepedal must be pressed to shift out of PARK.
TipStartFeature
Donotpress the accelerator. Cycle the ignition switch briefly to the START position and release it. The starter motor will continue to run but will automatically disengage when the engine is running.
Keyless Enter-N-Go™

This feature allows the driver to operate the ignition switch with the push of a button, as long as the Remote Start/Keyless Enter-N-Go™ Key Fob is in the passenger compartment.
Normal Starting
UsingTheENGINESTART/STOPButton
- The transmission must be in PARK or NEUTRAL.
- Press and hold the brake pedal while pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button once.
- The system takes over and attempts to start the vehicle. If the vehicle fails to start, the starter will disengage automatically after 10 seconds.

392 STARTING AND OPERATING
- If you wish to stop the cranking of the engine prior to the engine starting, press the button again.
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the accelerator pedal.
ToTurnOffTheEngineUsingENGINE START/STOPButton
- Place the shift lever/gear selector in PARK, then press and release the ENGINE START/STOP button.
-
The ignition switch will return to the OFF position.
-
If the shift lever/gear selector is not in PARK, the ENGINE START/STOP button must be held for two seconds or three short presses in a row with the vehicle speed above 5 mph (8 km/h) before the engine will shut off. The ignition switch position will remain in the ACC position until the shift lever/gear selector is in PARK and the button is pressed twice to the OFF position. If the shift lever/gear selector is not in PARK and the ENGINE START/STOP button is pressed once, the EVIC (if equipped) will display a "Vehicle Not In Park" message and the engine will remain running. Never leave a vehicle out of the PARK position, or it could roll.
NOTE: If the ignition switch is left in the ACC or RUN (engine not running) position and the transmission is in PARK, the system will automatically time out after 30 minutes of inactivity and the ignition will switch to the OFF position.

ENGINESTART/STOPButtonFunctions—With Driver'sFootOFFTheBrakePedal(InPARKOr NEUTRALPosition)
The ENGINE START/STOP button operates similar to an ignition switch. It has three positions, OFF, ACC, RUN. To change the ignition switch positions without starting the vehicle and use the accessories follow these steps:
- Starting with the ignition in the OFF position:
- Press the ENGINE START/STOP button once to change the ignition to the ACC position.
- Press the ENGINE START/STOP button a second time to change the ignition to the RUN position.
- Press the ENGINE START/STOP button a third time to return the ignition to the OFF position.
Extreme Cold Weather (Below -20°F Or -29°C)
To ensure reliable starting at these temperatures, use of an externally powered electric engine block heater (available from your authorized dealer) is recommended.
If Engine Fails To Start
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the "Normal Starting" procedure, it may be flooded. Push the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it there while cranking the engine. This should clear any excess fuel in case the engine is flooded.
CAUTION!
Topreventdamagetothestarter, donotcrank the engineformorethan15secondsatatime. Wait10to 15secondsbeforetryingagain.
WARNING!
- Neverpourfuelorotherflammableliquidsinto thethrottlebodyairinletopeninginanattemptto startthevehicle. This could result in a flashfire causing serious personal injury.
- Donotattempttopushortowyourvehicletogetit started. Vehiclesequippedwithanautomatictransmissioncannotbestedthisway.Unburnedfuel couldenterthecatalyticconverterandoncethe enginehasstarted,igniteanddamagetheconverter andvehicle.
- If the vehicle has adischarged battery, booster cables maybe used to obtain a start from a booster battery or the battery in another vehicle. This type of start can be dangerous if done improperly. Refer to "Jump Starting" in "What To Do In Emergencies" for further information.
If the engine has been flooded, it may start to run, but not have enough power to continue running when the ignition button/key is released. If this occurs, continue cranking with the accelerator pedal pushed all the way to the floor. Release the accelerator pedal and the ignition button/key once the engine is running smoothly.
If the engine shows no sign of starting after two 15-second periods of cranking with the accelerator pedal held to the floor, the "Normal Starting" procedure should be repeated.
After Starting
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will decrease as the engine warms up.
STOP/START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED
The Stop/Start function is developed to save fuel and reduce emissions. The system will stop the engine automatically during a vehicle stop if the required conditions are met. Releasing the brake pedal will automatically re-start the vehicle.
Automatic Mode
The Stop/Start feature is enabled after every normal customer engine start. It will remain in STOP/START NOT READY until you drive forward with a vehicle speed greater than 5 mph (8 km/h). At that time, the system will go into STOP/START READY and if all other conditions are met, can go into an STOP/START AUTO STOP ACTIVE "Autostop" mode.
ToActivateTheAutostopMode, TheFollowingMust Occur:
- The system must be in STOP/START READY state. A STOP/START READY message will be displayed in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) within the Stop/Start section. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- The vehicle must be completely stopped.
- The transmission Gear Selector must be in Drive and the brake pedal depressed.
The engine will shut down, the tachometer will move to the zero position and the stop/start telltale will illuminate indicating you are in an Autostop. While in an Autostop, the Climate Controls system may automatically adjust airflow to maintain cabin comfort. Customer settings will be maintained upon return to an engine running condition.

396 STARTING AND OPERATING
Possible Reasons The Engine Does Not AUTO STOP
Prior to engine shut down, the system will check many safety and comfort conditions to see if they are fulfilled. In following situations the engine will not stop:
- Driver's seat belt is not buckled
- Driver's door is not closed
- Outside temperature is less than 1^ F ( -17^ C) or greater than 104^ F ( 40^ C)
- Battery temperature too warm or cold
• The vehicle is on a steep grade - Cabin heating or cooling is in process and an acceptable cabin temperature has not been achieved
•HVAC is set to full defrost mode at a high blower speed
• Engine has not reached normal operating temperature
- Battery discharged
• The transmission is not in DRIVE
- Hood is open
- Vehicle is in 4LO transfer case mode
Other factors which can inhibit AutoStop include: fuel level, accelerator pedal input, engine temp too high and steering angle.
It may be possible for the vehicle to be driven several times without the STOP/START system going into a STOP/START READY state under more extreme conditions of the items listed above.
To Start The Engine While In Autostop Mode
While in DRIVE the engine will start when the brake pedal is released or the throttle pedal is depressed. The transmission will automatically reengage upon engine

restart. During this transition the brakes will hold the vehicle to avoid undesired vehicle movement.
ConditionsthatwillcausetheenginetostartautomaticallywhileinAutostopmode.
The Engine Will Start Automatically When:
- The transmission selector is moved from DRIVE to REVERSE or NEUTRAL
- To maintain cabin temperature near the HVAC settings
•HVAC is set to full defrost mode
• Autostop time exceeds 5 minutes - Battery voltage drops too low
- Low brake vacuum (e.g. after several brake pedal applications)
- STOP/START OFF switch is pressed
- 4WD system is put into 4LO mode
• The emissions system requires it
• A STOP/START system error occurs
ConditionsthatforceanautomaticshifttoPARKwhile inAutostopmode.
The Engine Will Not Start Automatically and the Transmission will be placed in PARK if:
• The driver door is open and brake pedal released
- The driver door is open and the driver seat belt is unbuckled
• The engine hood has been opened
• A STOP/START system error occurs
The engine may then be restarted by moving the transmission shift selector out of PARK (e.g. to DRIVE) or, in some cases, only by a KEY START. The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display a SHIFT OUT OF
398 STARTING AND OPERATING
PARK message, or a STOP/START KEY START REQUIRED message, to indicate which action is required. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
To Manually Turn Off The Stop Start System
- Press the STOP/START Off switch (located on the switch bank). The light on the switch will illuminate.

text_image
Control panel of a car with visible infotainment and function buttons, including a black arrow pointing to the function button.STOP/STARTOFFSwitch
- The STOP/START OFF message will appear in Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

- At the next vehicle stop (after turning off the STOP/START system) the engine will not be stopped.
- If the STOP/START system is manually turned off, the engine can only be started and stopped by cycling the ignition switch.
- The STOP/START system will reset itself back to an ON condition every time the key is turned off and back on.
To Manually Turn On The Stop Start System
- Press the STOP/START Off switch (located on the switch bank).
- The light on the switch will turn off.
System Malfunction
If there is a malfunction in the STOP/START system, the system will not shut down the engine. A SERVICE STOP/START SYSTEM message will appear in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
The system will need to be checked by your authorized dealer.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED
The engine block heater warms the engine, and permits quicker starts in cold weather. Connect the cord to a standard 110-115 Volt AC electrical outlet with a grounded, three-wire extension cord.

400 STARTING AND OPERATING
1500Models
The engine block heater cord is routed under the hood on the passenger side of the vehicle near the right head lamp assembly. It is located between the front grill and the radiator, but underneath the black upper seal.
2500/3500Models
The engine block heater cord is routed through the grille by the right front tow hook.
It includes a removable cap that is secured by a tethered strap. It also has a c-clip that is used for storage when not in use for the winter months. During winter months, remove the heater cord wiring assembly from itself on the c-clip.
The engine block heater must be plugged in at least one hour to have an adequate warming effect on the engine.
WARNING!
Remembertodisconnecttheengineblockheater cordbeforedriving.Damagetothe110-115Volt electricalcordcouldcauseelectrocution.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
CAUTION!
Damagetothetransmissionmayoccurifthefollowingprecautionsarenotobserved:
- ShiftintoPARKonlyafterthevehiclehascometo acompletestop.
- ShiftintooroutofREVERSEonlyafterthevehicle hascometoacompletestopandtheengineisat idlespeed.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
CAUTION!(Continued)
- DonotshiftbetweenPARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, orDRIVEwhentheengineisaboveidle speed.
- Beforeshiftingintoanygear,makesureyourfoot isfirmlypressingthebrakepedal.
NOTE: You must press and hold the brake pedal while shifting out of PARK.
WARNING!
- It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL if the engines speed is higher than idlespeed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Unintendedmovementofvehiclecouldinjure thoseinornearthevehicle.Aswithallvehicles, youshouldneverexitavehiclewhiletheengineis running.Beforeexitingavehicle,alwaysapplythe parkingbrake,shiftthetransmissionintoPARK, turntheengineOFF,andremovethekeyfob.When theignitionisinthefullOFF(keyremoval)position,thetransmissionislockedinPARK,securing thevehicleagainstunwantedmovement.
- Whenleavingthevehicle,alwaysremovethekey fobandlockyourvehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoan unlocked vehicle. Allowingchildrento beinavehicleunattendedisdangerousfora numberofreasons.Achildorotherscouldbe seriouslyorfatallyinjured.Childrenshouldbe warnednottotouchtheparkingbrake,brakepedal orthetransmissiongearselector.
- Donotleavethekeyfobinornearthevehicle(or inalocationaccessibletochildren), and donot leavetheignitionofavehicleequipped with KeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUN mode. Achildcouldoperatepowerwindows, other controls, ormovethevehicle.
Key Ignition Park Interlock
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interlock which requires the transmission to be in PARK

before the ignition switch can be turned to the full OFF (key removal) position. The Key Fob can only be removed from the ignition when the ignition is in the full OFF position, and the transmission is locked in PARK whenever the ignition switch is in the full OFF position.
NOTE: If a malfunction occurs, the system will trap the Key Fob in the ignition switch to warn you that this safety feature is inoperable. The engine can be started and stopped but the Key Fob cannot be removed until you obtain service.
Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
This vehicle is equipped with a Brake Transmission Shift Interlock System (BTSI) that holds the transmission gear selector in PARK unless the brakes are applied. To shift the transmission out of PARK, the ignition switch must be turned to the ON/RUN position (engine running, for vehicles with eight-speed transmission) and the brake pedal must be pressed. In 8-speed vehicles, the brake pedal must also be pressed to shift from NEUTRAL into DRIVE or REVERSE when the vehicle is stopped or moving at low speeds.
Eight-Speed Automatic Transmission — If Equipped
The transmission is controlled using a rotary electronic gear selector located on the instrument panel. The transmission gear range (PRND) is displayed both above the gear selector and in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). To select a gear range, simply rotate the gear selector. You must press the brake pedal to shift the transmission out of PARK, or to shift from NEUTRAL into DRIVE or REVERSE, when the vehicle is stopped or moving at low speeds (refer to "Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System" in this section). To shift past multiple gear ranges at once (such as Park to Drive), simply rotate the gear selector to the appropriate detent. Select the DRIVE range for normal driving.

The electronically-controlled transmission provides a precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped. Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when shifting between these gears.
The transmission gear selector has only PARK, RE-VERSE, NEUTRAL, and DRIVE positions. Manual downshifts can be made using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) switches (described later in this section). Pressing the GEAR-/GEAR+ switches (on the steering wheel) while in the DRIVE position will select the highest available transmission gear, and will display that gear in the instrument cluster as 1, 2, 3, etc.

text_image
PRND 2WD 4WD LOCK 2WD 4WD LOW051269900
ElectronicTransmissionGearSelector
GearRanges
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range.

NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating. This is especially important when the engine is cold.
PARK(P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the transmission. The engine can be started in this range. Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before shifting the transmission to PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
NOTE: On four-wheel drive vehicles be sure that the transfer case is in a drive position.
WARNING!
- NeverusethePARKpositionasasubstituteforthe parkingbrake.Alwaysapplytheparkingbrake fullywhenparkedtoguardagainstvehiclemovementandpossibleinjuryordamage.
- Yourvehiclecouldmoveandinjureyouandothers ifitisnotinPARK.Makesurethetransmissionis inPARKbeforeleavingthevehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL if the engines speed higher than idlespeed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Unintendedmovementofvehiclecouldinjure thoseinornearthevehicle.Aswithallvehicles, youshouldneverexitavehiclewhiletheengineis running.Beforeexitingavehicle,alwaysapplythe parkingbrake,shiftthetransmissionintoPARK, turntheengineOFF,andremovethekeyfob.When theignitionisinthefullOFF(keyremoval)position,thetransmissionislockedinPARK,securing thevehicleagainstunwantedmovement. - Whenleavingthevehicle,alwaysremovethekey fobandlockyourvehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoan unlocked vehicle. Allowingchildrento beinavehicleunattendedisdangerousfora numberofreasons.Achildorotherscouldbe seriouslyorfatallyinjured.Childrenshouldbe warnednottotouchtheparkingbrake,brakepedal orthetransmissiongearselector.
- Donotleavethekeyfobinornearthevehicle(or inalocationaccessibletochildren), and donot leavetheignitionofavehicleequipped with KeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUN mode. Achildcouldoperatepowerwindows, other controls, ormovethevehicle.
CAUTION!
- DONOTracetheenginewhenshifting from PARKorNEUTRALintoanothergearrange, asthis candamagethedrivetrain.
- BeforemovingthegearslectoroutofPARK, you muststarttheengine, and alsopressthebrake pedal. Otherwise, damagetothegearslectorcould result.
The following indicator should be used to ensure that you have engaged the transmission into PARK:
- With brake pedal released, look at the transmission gear display and verify that it indicates PARK.
REVERSE(R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete stop.

408 STARTING AND OPERATING
NEUTRAL(N)
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged periods with the engine running. The engine may be started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
DonotcoastinNEUTRALandneverturnoffthe ignitiontocoastdownahill.Theseareunsafe practicesthatlimityourresponsetochangingtraffic orroadconditions.Youmightlosecontrolofthe vehicleandhaveacollision.
CAUTION!
Towingthevehicle,coasting,ordrivingforanyother reasonwiththetransmissioninNEUTRALcancause
CAUTION!(Continued)
severetransmissiondamage.Referto"Recreational Towing"in"StartingAndOperating"and"TowingA DisabledVehicle"in"WhatToDoInEmergencies" forfurtherinformation.
DRIVE(D)
This range should be used for most city and highway driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission automatically upshifts through all forward gears. The DRIVE provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or while towing heavy trailers), use the Electronic Range Select (ERS) switches (refer to "Electronic Range Select
(ERS) Operation"in this section) to select a lower gear range. Under these conditions, using a lower gear range will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
During extremely cold temperatures (-22°F [-30°C] or below), transmission operation may be modified depending on engine and transmission temperature as well as vehicle speed. Normal operation will resume once the transmission temperature has risen to a suitable level.
TransmissionLimpHomeMode
Transmission function is monitored electronically for abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission may operate only in certain gears, or may not shift at all. Vehicle performance may be severely degraded and the engine may stall. In some situations, the transmission may not re-engage if the engine is turned off and restarted. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. A message in the instrument cluster will inform the driver of the more serious conditions, and indicate what actions may be necessary.
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the following steps:
NOTE: In cases where the instrument cluster message indicates the transmission may not re-engage after engine shutdown, perform this procedure only in a desired location (preferably, at your authorized dealer).
- Stop the vehicle.
- Shift the transmission into PARK, if possible. If not, shift the transmission to NEUTRAL.
- Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. On vehicles with Keyless Enter-N-Go™, press and hold the ignition switch until the engine turns OFF.

410 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Wait approximately 30 seconds.
- Restart the engine.
- Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no longer detected, the transmission will return to normal operation.
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recommend that you visit your authorized dealer at your earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could recur.
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer service is required.
ElectronicRangeSelect(ERS)Operation—Eight-SpeedTransmission
The Electronic Range Select (ERS) switches allow the driver to limit the highest available gear when the transmission is in DRIVE. For example, if you shift the transmission into 3 (third gear), the transmission will not shift above third gear (except to prevent engine overspeed), but will shift down into second and first gears normally.
You can switch between DRIVE and ERS mode at any vehicle speed. When the gear selector is in DRIVE, the transmission will operate automatically, shifting between all available gears. Tapping the GEAR- switch (on the steering wheel) will activate ERS mode, display the current gear in the instrument cluster, and maintain that gear as the top available gear. Once in ERS mode, tapping the GEAR- or GEAR+ switch will change the top available gear.


text_image
GEAR- GEAR+ ON/OFF RES + CANCEL SET -051269899
1 — ERS (-) Switch 2 — ERS (+) Switch
To exit ERS mode, simply press and hold the GEAR+ switch until "D" is once again displayed in the instrument cluster.
WARNING!
Donotdownshiftforadditionalenginebrakingona slipperysurface. Thedrivewheelscouldlosetheir gripandthevehiclecouldskid,causingacollisionor personalinjury.
WhentoUseTOW/HAULMode
When driving in hilly areas, towing a trailer, carrying a heavy load, etc., and frequent transmission shifting occurs, press the TOW/HAUL switch to activate TOW/HAUL mode. This will improve performance and reduce the potential for transmission overheating or failure due to excessive shifting.

Information Provided by: DEALER
412 STARTING AND OPERATING

text_image
Control panel of a vehicle showing dashboard and infotainment gauges with Chinese labels and a black arrow pointing to a display.TOW/HAULSwitch
The "TOW/HAUL Indicator Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster to indicate that TOW/HAUL mode has been activated. Pressing the switch a second time restores normal operation. Normal operation is always
the default at engine start-up. If TOW/HAUL mode is desired, the switch must be pressed each time the engine is started.
Six-Speed Automatic Transmission — 1500 Models Only (If Equipped)
The transmission gear position display (located in the instrument cluster) indicates the transmission gear range. The shift lever is mounted either on the right side of the steering column (if equipped) or on the console (if equipped). You must press the brake pedal to move the shift lever out of PARK (refer to "Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System" in this section). To drive, move the shift lever from PARK or NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position. Pull the shift lever toward you when shifting into REVERSE or PARK, or when shifting out of PARK (column shift only).

The electronically-controlled transmission provides a precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped. Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when shifting between these gears.
The transmission shift lever has only PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, and DRIVE shift positions. Manual downshifts can be made using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control (refer to "Electronic Range Select (ERS) Operation" in this section). Pressing the ERS (- / + ) switches (column shift) or moving the shift lever to the left or right (- / + ) (console shift) while in the DRIVE position will select the highest available transmission gear, and will display that gear in the instrument cluster as 1, 2, 3, etc.
GearRanges
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range.
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating. This is especially important when the engine is cold.
PARK(P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the transmission. The engine can be started in this range. Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle in this range.

414 STARTING AND OPERATING
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before shifting the transmission to PARK, otherwise the load on the transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
WARNING!
- NeverusethePARKpositionasasubstituteforthe parkingbrake.Alwaysapplytheparkingbrake fullywhenparkedtoguardagainstvehiclemovementandpossibleinjuryordamage.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Yourvehiclecouldmoveandinjureyouandothers ifitisnotcompletelyinPARK.Checkbytryingto movetheshiftleveroutofPARKwiththebrake pedalreleased.Makesurethetransmissionisin PARKbeforeleavingthevehicle.
- It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL if the engines speed higher than midlespeed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
WARNING!(Continued)
- Unintendedmovementofvehiclecouldinjure thoseinandnearthevehicle.Aswithallvehicles, youshouldneverexitavehiclewhiletheengineis running.Beforeexitingavehicle,alwaysapplythe parkingbrake,shiftthetransmissionintoPARK, turntheengineOFF,andremovethekeyfob.When theignitionisinthefullOFF(keyremoval)position,thetransmissionislockedinPARK,securing thevehicleagainstunwantedmovement.
- Whenleavingthevehicle,alwaysremovethekey fobandlockyourvehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoan unlocked vehicle. Allowingchildrento beinavehicleunattendedisdangerousfora numberofreasons. Achildorotherscouldbe seriouslyorfatallyinjured. Childrenshouldbe warnednottotouchtheparkingbrake,brakepedal ortheshiftlever.Donotleavethekeyfobinor nearthevehicle(orinalocationaccessibleto children),anddonotleavetheignitionofavehicle equippedwithKeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACC orON/RUNmode.Achildcouldoperatepower windows,othercontrols,ormovethevehicle.
416 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
- BeforemovingtheshiftleveroutofPARK,you mustturntheignitionswitchfromtheOFFpositiontotheON/RUNposition,andalsopressthe brakepedal.Otherwise,damagetheshiftlever couldresult.
- DONOTracetheenginewhenshifting from PARKorNEUTRALintoanothergearrange, asthis candamagethedrivetrain.
The following indicators should be used to ensure that you have engaged the transmission into the PARK position:
- When shifting into PARK, pull the column-mounted shift lever toward you and move it all the way counterclockwise until it stops. For console-mounted shifter, firmly move the shift lever all the way forward and to the left until it stops.
- Release the shift lever and make sure it is fully seated in the PARK gate.
- Look at the transmission gear position display and verify that it indicates the PARK position.
- With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE(R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into Reverse only after the vehicle has come to a complete stop.
NEUTRAL(N)
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged periods with the engine running. The engine may be started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.

WARNING!
DonotcoastinNEUTRALandneverturnoffthe ignitiontocoastdownahill.Theseareunsafe practicesthatlimityourresponsetochangingtraffic orroadconditions.Youmightlosecontrolofthe vehicleandhaveacollision.
CAUTION!
Towingthevehicle,coasting,ordrivingforanyother reasonwiththetransmissioninNEUTRALcancause severetransmissiondamage.Referto"Recreational Towing"in"StartingAndOperating"and"TowingA DisabledVehicle"in"WhatToDoInEmergencies" forfurtherinformation.
DRIVE(D)
This range should be used for most city and highway driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission automatically upshifts through underdrive first and second gears, direct third gear and overdrive fourth and fifth gears. The DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
To access all six available gears, you must use the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control, described below.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or while towing heavy trailers), use the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control (refer to “Electronic Range Select (ERS) Operation)” in this section) to select a lower gear range. Under these conditions, using a lower gear
418 STARTING AND OPERATING
range will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
If the transmission temperature exceeds normal operating limits, the powertrain controller will modify the transmission shift schedule and expand the range of torque converter clutch engagement. This is done to prevent transmission damage due to overheating.
If the transmission becomes extremely hot or is in danger of overheating, the “Transmission Temperature Warning Light” may illuminate and the transmission may operate differently until the transmission cools down.
NOTE: Use caution when operating a heavily loaded vehicle at low speeds (such as towing a trailer up a steep grade, or in stop-and-go traffic) during hot weather. In these conditions, torque converter slip can impose a significant additional heat load on the cooling system. Downshifting the transmission to the lowest possible gear (when climbing a grade), or shifting to NEUTRAL (when stopped in heavy traffic) can help to reduce this excess heat generation.
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may be modified depending on engine and transmission temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature improves warm up time of the engine and transmission to achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of both the torque converter clutch and the top overdrive gear are inhibited until the transmission fluid is warm (refer to the "Note" under "Torque Converter Clutch" in this section). During extremely cold temperatures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be limited to first and

direct gears only. Normal operation will resume once the transmission temperature has risen to a suitable level.
TransmissionLimpHomeMode
Transmission function is monitored electronically for abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains in direct gear regardless of which forward gear is selected. PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be driven to an authorized dealer for service without damaging the transmission.
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the following steps:
- Stop the vehicle.
- Shift the transmission into PARK.
- Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
-
Wait approximately 10 seconds.
-
Restart the engine.
-
Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no longer detected, the transmission will return to normal operation.
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recommend that you visit your authorized dealer at your earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could recur.

If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer service is required.
ElectronicRangeSelect(ERS)Operation—Six-SpeedTransmission
The Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control allows the driver to limit the highest available gear when the shift lever is in the DRIVE position. For example, if you shift the transmission into 3 (third gear), the transmission will not shift above third gear, but will shift down into second and first gears normally.
Use of ERS (or TOW/HAUL mode) also enables an additional underdrive gear which is not normally used during through-gear accelerations. This additional gear can improve vehicle performance and cooling capability when towing a trailer on certain grades. In ERS mode, gears 1 though 3 are underdrive gears, and ERS 4 is direct drive. ERS 5 and 6 (Overdrive gears) are the same as the normal fourth and fifth gears.
You can switch between DRIVE and ERS mode at any vehicle speed. When the shift lever is in the DRIVE position, the transmission will operate automatically, shifting between all available gears. Tapping the ERS (-) switch (column shift) or tapping the shift lever to the left (-) (console shift) will activate ERS mode, display the current gear in the instrument cluster, and maintain that gear as the top available gear. For example, if you are in DRIVE and are in third (direct) gear, when you tap the shift lever/switch one time in the (-) direction, the display will show 4 (ERS 4 is direct gear). Another tap down (-) will shift the transmission down to ERS 3 (the added underdrive gear). Once in ERS mode, tapping ERS (-) or (+) will change the top available gear.

STARTING AND OPERATING 421

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel showing a black handle and a white arrow pointing to a button, with no visible text or symbols.ColumnShiftLeverConsoleShiftLever

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a hand operating a gear shift into a multi-compartment container with no visible text or symbols.To exit ERS mode, simply press and hold the shift lever to the right (+) (console shift) or press the ERS (+) switch (column shift) until "D" is once again displayed in the instrument cluster.
422 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Donotdownshiftforadditionalenginebrakingona slipperysurface. Thedrivewheelscouldlosetheir gripandthevehiclecouldskid,causingacollisionor personalinjury.
NOTE: To select the proper gear position for maximum deceleration (engine braking), simply press and hold the shift lever to the left (-) (console shift) or the ERS (-) switch down (column shift). The transmission will shift to the range from which the vehicle can best be slowed down.
CAUTION!
When using ERSforengine braking while descending steep grades, be careful not too overspeed the engine. Apply the brakes as needed to prevent engine overspeed.
OverdriveOperation
The automatic transmission includes an electronically controlled Overdrive (fourth and fifth gears). The transmission will automatically shift into Overdrive if the following conditions are present:
• the shift lever is in the DRIVE position,
- the transmission fluid has reached an adequate temperature,
- the engine coolant (antifreeze) has reached an adequate temperature,
- vehicle speed is sufficiently high, and
• the TOW/HAUL switch has not been activated.
STARTING AND OPERATING 423
WhenToUseTOW/HAULMode
When driving in hilly areas, towing a trailer, carrying a heavy load, etc., and frequent transmission shifting occurs, press the TOW/HAUL switch to activate TOW/HAUL mode. This will improve performance and reduce the potential for transmission overheating or failure due to excessive shifting. When operating in TOW/HAUL mode, transmission upshifts are delayed, and the transmission will automatically downshift (for engine braking) during steady braking maneuvers.

text_image
050170421TOW/HAULSwitch
The "TOW/HAUL Indicator Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster to indicate that TOW/HAUL mode has been activated. Pressing the switch a second time restores normal operation. Normal operation is always the default at engine start-up. If TOW/HAUL mode is desired, the switch must be pressed each time the engine is started.

WARNING!
Donotusethe"TOW/HAUL"featurewhendriving inicyorslipperyconditions.Theincreasedengine brakingcancausetherearwheelstoslide,andthe vehicletoswingaroundwiththepossiblelossof vehiclecontrol,whichmaycauseanaccidentpossiblyresultinginpersonalinjuryordeath.
TorqueConverterClutch
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle. A clutch within the torque converter engages automatically at calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly different feeling or response during normal operation in the upper gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during some accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
NOTE:
- The torque converter clutch will not engage, and the transmission will not shift into the top overdrive gear, until the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm [usually after 1 to 3 miles (2 to 5 km) of driving]. Because top gear is disabled, and the engine speed is higher when the torque converter clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission is not shifting properly when cold. This is normal. Using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control, when the transmission is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that the transmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
- If the vehicle has not been driven for several days, the first few seconds of operation after shifting the transmission into gear may seem sluggish. This is due to the fluid partially draining from the torque converter into the transmission. This condition is normal and will not

cause damage to the transmission. The torque converter will refill within five seconds after starting the engine.
Six-Speed Automatic Transmission — 2500/3500 Models Only
The transmission gear position display (located in the instrument cluster) indicates the transmission gear range. The shift lever is mounted on the right side of the steering column. You must press the brake pedal to move the shift lever out of PARK (refer to "Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System" in this section). To drive, move the shift lever from PARK or NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position. Pull the shift lever toward you when shifting into RE-VERSE or PARK, or when shifting out of PARK.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped. Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when shifting between these gears.
The transmission shift lever has only PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, and DRIVE shift positions. Manual downshifts can be made using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control (refer to “Electronic Range Select (ERS) Operation” in this section). Pressing the ERS (-/+) switches (on the shift lever) while in the DRIVE position will select the highest available transmission gear, and will display that gear in the instrument cluster as 1, 2, 3, etc.
426 STARTING AND OPERATING
GearRanges
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range.
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating. This is especially important when the engine is cold.
PARK(P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the transmission. The engine can be started in this range. Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before shifting the transmission to PARK, otherwise the load on the transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
On four-wheel drive vehicles be sure that the transfer case is in a drive position.
WARNING!
- NeverusethePARKpositionasasubstituteforthe parkingbrake.Alwaysapplytheparkingbrake fullywhenparkedtoguardagainstvehiclemovementandpossibleinjuryordamage.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Yourvehiclecouldmoveandinjureyouandothers ifitisnotcompletelyinPARK.Checkbytryingto movetheshiftleveroutofPARKwiththebrake pedalreleased.Makesurethetransmissionisin PARKbeforeleavingthevehicle.
- It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL if the engines speed higher than midlespeed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Unintendedmovementofvehiclecouldinjure thoseinandnearthevehicle.Aswithallvehicles, youshouldneverexitavehiclewhiletheengineis running.Beforeexitingavehicle,alwaysapplythe parkingbrake,shiftthetransmissionintoPARK, turntheengineOFF,andremovethekeyfob.When theignitionisinthefullOFF(keyremoval)position,thetransmissionislockedinPARK,securing thevehicleagainstunwantedmovement.
- Whenleavingthevehicle,alwaysremovethekey fobandlockyourvehicle.
(Continued)
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
WARNING!(Continued)
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoan unlocked vehicle. Allowingchildrento beinavehicleunattendedisdangerousfora numberofreasons. Achildorotherscouldbe seriouslyorfatallyinjured. Childrenshouldbe warnednottotouchtheparkingbrake,brakepedal ortheshiftlever. Donotleavethekeyfobinor nearthevehicle (orinalocationaccessibleto children), anddonotleavetheignitionofavehicle equipped with KeylessEnter-N-Go™ intheACC orON/RUNmode. Achildcouldoperatepower windows, othercontrols, ormovethevehicle.
CAUTION!
- BeforemovingtheshiftleveroutofPARK,you mustturntheignitionswitchfromtheOFFpositiontotheON/RUNposition,andalsopressthe brakepedal.Otherwise,damagetheshiftlever couldresult.
- DONOTracetheenginewhenshifting from PARKorNEUTRALintoanothergearrange, asthis candamagethedrivetrain.
The following indicators should be used to ensure that you have engaged the transmission into the PARK position:
- When shifting into PARK, pull the shift lever toward you and move it all the way counterclockwise until it stops.
- Release the shift lever and make sure it is fully seated in the PARK gate.
- Look at the transmission gear position display and verify that it indicates the PARK position.
- With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE(R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete stop.
NEUTRAL(N)
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged periods with the engine running. The engine may be started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
DonotcoastinNEUTRALandneverturnoffthe ignitiontocoastdownahill.Theseareunsafe practicesthatlimityourresponsetochangingtraffic orroadconditions.Youmightlosecontrolofthe vehicleandhaveacollision.
CAUTION!
Towingthevehicle,coasting,ordrivingforanyother reasonwiththetransmissioninNEUTRALcancause severetransmissiondamage.Referto"Recreational Towing"in"StartingAndOperating"and"TowingA DisabledVehicle"in"WhatToDoInEmergencies" forfurtherinformation.
430 STARTING AND OPERATING
DRIVE(D)
This range should be used for most city and highway driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission automatically upshifts through underdrive first, second, and third gears, direct fourth gear and overdrive fifth and sixth gears. The DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or while towing heavy trailers), use the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control (refer to “Electronic Range Select (ERS) Operation” in this section) to select a lower gear range. Under these conditions, using a lower gear range will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
If the transmission temperature exceeds normal operating limits, the powertrain controller will modify the transmission shift schedule and expand the range of torque converter clutch engagement. This is done to prevent transmission damage due to overheating.
If the transmission becomes extremely hot or is in danger of overheating, the "Transmission Temperature Warning Light" may illuminate and the transmission may operate differently until the transmission cools down.
NOTE: Use caution when operating a heavily loaded vehicle at low speeds (such as towing a trailer up a steep grade, or in stop-and-go traffic) during hot weather. In these conditions, torque converter slip can impose a significant additional heat load on the cooling system. Downshifting the transmission to the lowest possible gear (when climbing a grade), or shifting to NEUTRAL (when stopped in heavy traffic) can help to reduce this excess heat generation.

During cold temperatures, transmission operation may be modified depending on engine and transmission temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature improves warm up time of the engine and transmission to achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of both the torque converter clutch and the top overdrive gear are inhibited until the transmission fluid is warm (refer to the "Note" under "Torque Converter Clutch" in this section). During extremely cold temperatures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be limited to first and direct gears only. Normal operation will resume once the transmission temperature has risen to a suitable level.
TransmissionLimpHomeMode
Transmission function is monitored electronically for abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains in fourth gear regardless of which forward gear is selected. PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be driven to an authorized dealer for service without damaging the transmission.
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the following steps:
- Stop the vehicle.
- Shift the transmission into PARK.
- Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
- Wait approximately 10 seconds.
- Restart the engine.
- Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no longer detected, the transmission will return to normal operation.

432 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recommend that you visit your authorized dealer at your earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could recur.
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer service is required.
ElectronicRangeSelect(ERS)Operation
The Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control allows the driver to limit the highest available gear when the shift lever is in the DRIVE position. For example, if you shift the transmission into 3 (third gear), the transmission will not shift above third gear, but will shift down into second and first gears normally.
You can switch between DRIVE and ERS mode at any vehicle speed. When the shift lever is in the DRIVE position, the transmission will operate automatically, shifting between all available gears. Tapping the ERS (-) switch will activate ERS mode, display the current gear in the instrument cluster, and maintain that gear as the top available gear. Once in ERS mode, tapping ERS (-) or (+) will change the top available gear.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel with a black arrow pointing to a handle, showing no text or symbols on the component itself.ColumnShiftLever

To exit ERS mode, simply press and hold the ERS (+) switch until "D" is once again displayed in the instrument cluster.
WARNING!
Donotdownshiftforadditionalenginebrakingona slipperysurface. Thedrivewheelscouldlosetheir gripandthevehiclecouldskid,causingacollisionor personalinjury.
NOTE: To select the proper gear position for maximum deceleration (engine braking), simply press and hold the ERS (-) switch down. The transmission will shift to the range from which the vehicle can best be slowed down.
CAUTION!
When using ERSforengine braking while descending steep grades, be careful not too overspeed the engine. Apply the brakes as needed to prevent engine overspeed.
OverdriveOperation
The automatic transmission includes an electronically controlled Overdrive (fifth and sixth gears). The transmission will automatically shift into Overdrive if the following conditions are present:
- The shift lever is in the DRIVE position.
- The transmission fluid has reached an adequate temperature.
- The engine coolant has reached an adequate temperature.
434 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Vehicle speed is sufficiently high.
• The TOW/HAUL switch has not been activated.
WhenToUseTOW/HAULMode
When driving in hilly areas, towing a trailer, carrying a heavy load, etc., and frequent transmission shifting occurs, press the TOW/HAUL switch to activate TOW/HAUL mode. This will improve performance and reduce the potential for transmission overheating or failure due to excessive shifting. When operating in TOW/HAUL mode, transmission upshifts are delayed, and the transmission will automatically downshift (for engine braking) during steady braking maneuvers.

text_image
Control panel of a car dashboard with directional buttons and a black arrow pointing to a specific display area.TOW/HAULSwitch
The "TOW/HAUL Indicator Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster to indicate that TOW/HAUL mode has been activated. Pressing the switch a second time restores normal operation. Normal operation is always the default at engine start-up. If TOW/HAUL mode is desired, the switch must be pressed each time the engine is started.

WARNING!
Donotusethe"TOW/HAUL"featurewhendriving inicyorslipperyconditions.Theincreasedengine brakingcancausetherearwheelstoslide,andthe vehicletoswingaroundwiththepossiblelossof vehiclecontrol,whichmaycauseanaccidentpossiblyresultinginpersonalinjuryordeath.
TorqueConverterClutch
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle. A clutch within the torque converter engages automatically at calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly different feeling or response during normal operation in the upper gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during some accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
NOTE:
- The torque converter clutch will not engage, and the transmission will not shift to sixth gear, until the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm [usually after 1 to 3 miles (2 to 5km ) of driving]. Because sixth gear is disabled, and engine speed is higher when the torque converter clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission is not shifting properly when cold. This is normal. Using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) shift control, when the transmission is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that the transmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
- If the vehicle has not been driven for several days, the first few seconds of operation after shifting the transmission into gear may seem sluggish. This is due to the fluid partially draining from the torque converter into the transmission. This condition is normal and will not

cause damage to the transmission. The torque converter will refill within five seconds after starting the engine.
Four-wheel drive trucks are equipped with either a manually shifted transfer case or an electronically shifted transfer case. Refer to the operating instructions for your transfer case, located in this section for further information.
Manually Shifted Transfer Case — If Equipped
The transfer case provides four mode positions.
- Two-wheel drive high range (2H)
- Four-wheel drive high range (4H)
• Neutral (N) - Four-wheel drive low range (4L)
This transfer case is intended to be driven in the 2H position for normal street and highway conditions such as dry, hard surfaced roads.
When additional traction is required, the 4H and 4L positions can be used to lock the front and rear drive-shafts together and force the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This is accomplished by simply moving the shift lever to the desired positions once the appropriate speed and gear requirements are met refer to "Shifting Procedure – Manually Shifted Transfer Case" in this section for further information. The 4H and 4L positions are intended for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Driving in the 4H and 4L positions on dry, hard surfaced roads may cause increased tire wear and damage to the driveline components.
The "Transfer Case Position Indicator Light" in the instrument cluster will alert the driver that the vehicle is in four-wheel drive and that the front and rear drive-shafts are locked together. This light will illuminate when
the transfer case is shifted into either the 4H or 4L position. There is no light for the 2H or NEUTRAL positions on some models.
When operating your vehicle in 4L, the engine speed is approximately three times that of the 2H or 4H positions at a given road speed. Take care not to overspeed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
Proper operation of four-wheel drive vehicles depends on tires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel. Any difference will adversely affect shifting and can cause damage to the drivetrain.
NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only the front or rear wheels are spinning. The front and rear driveshaft speeds must be equal for the shift to take place. Shifting while only the front or rear wheels are spinning can cause damage to the transfer case.
Because four-wheel drive provides improved traction, there is a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds. Do not go faster than road conditions permit.
NOTE: Delayed shifts out of four-wheel drive may be experienced due to uneven tire wear, low or uneven tire pressures, excessive vehicle loading, or cold temperatures.
WARNING!
Youorotherscouldbeinjuredorkilledifyouleave thevehicleunattendedwiththetransfercaseinthe NEUTRALpositionwithoutfirstfullyengagingthe parkingbrake. ThetransfercaseNEUTRALposition disengagesboththefrontandreadriveshaftsfrom thepowertrainandwillallowthevehicletomove regardlessofthetransmissionposition. Theparking brakeshouldalwaysbeappliedwhenthedriveris not in tevehicle.

438 STARTING AND OPERATING
For additional information on the appropriate use of each transfer case mode position, see the information below:
2H
Rear-Wheel Drive High Range — This range is for normal street and highway driving on dry hard surfaced roads.
4H
Four-Wheel Drive High Range — This range locks the front and rear driveshafts together forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. Additional traction for loose, slippery road surfaces only.
Neutral(N)
Neutral — This range disengages the front and rear driveshafts from the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behind another vehicle. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
4L
Four-Wheel Drive Low Range — This range locks the front and rear driveshafts together forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. Additional traction and maximum pulling power for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
CAUTION!
Donotuse4L(Low)rangewhenoperatingthe vehicleondrypavement.Drivelinehardwaredamagecanresult.
ShiftingProcedure—ManuallyShiftedTransfer Case
2HTo4H
Shifting between 2H and 4H can be made with the vehicle stopped or in motion. If the vehicle is in motion, shifts can be made up to 55 mph (88 km/h). With the
vehicle in motion, the transfer case will engage/disengage faster if you momentarily release the accelerator pedal after completing the shift. Apply a constant force when shifting the transfer case lever.
2HOr4HTo4L
With the vehicle rolling at 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h), shift the transmission into NEUTRAL. While the vehicle is coasting at 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h), shift the transfer case lever firmly to the desired position. Do not pause in transfer case NEUTRAL.
NOTE:
- Pausing in transfer case NEUTRAL in vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission may require shutting the engine OFF to avoid gear clash while completing the shift. If difficulty occurs, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL, hold foot on brake, and turn the engine OFF. Make shift to the desired mode.
- Shifting into or out of 4L is possible with the vehicle completely stopped, however difficulty may occur due to the mating clutch teeth not being properly aligned. Several attempts may be required for clutch teeth alignment and shift completion to occur. The preferred method is with the vehicle rolling 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h). Avoid attempting to engage or disengage 4L with the vehicle moving faster than 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h).
- Do not attempt to shift into or from 4L while the transmission is in gear.
TransferCasePositionIndicatorLight
The “Transfer Case Position Indicator Light” in the instrument cluster is used to alert the driver that the front axle is fully engaged and all four wheels are driving.

440 STARTING AND OPERATING
Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Four-Position Switch) — If Equipped
This is an electronic shift transfer case and is operated by the 4WD Control Switch (Transfer Case Switch), which is located on the instrument panel.

text_image
4WD LOCK 4WD 2WD LOW NEUTRAL 051905705TransferCaseSwitch(Four-Position)
This electronically shifted transfer case provides four mode positions:
- Two-wheel drive high range (2WD)
- Four-wheel drive lock range (4WD LOCK)
- Four-wheel drive low range (4WD LOW)
• Neutral (NEUTRAL)
This electronically shifted transfer case is designed to be driven in the two-wheel drive position (2WD) for normal street and highway conditions on dry, hard surfaced roads.
When additional traction is required, the transfer case 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions can be used to maximize torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This is accomplished by rotating the 4WD Control Switch to the desired position. Refer to "Shifting Procedure" in this section for specific shifting instructions. The 4WD LOCK

and 4WD LOW positions are designed for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Driving in the 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions on dry hard surfaced roads may cause increased tire wear and damage to the driveline components.
NOTE: The transfer case NEUTRAL position is selected by pressing the button located on the lower left hand corner of the 4WD Control Switch. The transfer case NEUTRAL position is to be used for recreational towing only. Refer to "Recreational Towing" in "Starting and Operating" for further information.
TransferCasePositionIndicatorLights
The Transfer Case Position Indicator Lights (4WD and 4LOW) are located in the instrument cluster and indicate the current and desired transfer case selection. When you select a different transfer case position, the indicator lights will do the following:
IfAllShiftConditionsAreMet:
- The current position indicator light will turn OFF.
- The selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift.
- When the shift is complete, the indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.
IfOneOrMoreShiftConditionsAreNotMet:
- The indicator light for the current position will remain ON.
- The newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash.
- The transfer case willnotshift.
442 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: Before retrying a selection, make certain that all the necessary requirements for selecting a new transfer case position have been met. To retry the selection, turn the control knob back to the current position, wait five seconds, and retry selection. To find the shift requirements, refer to the "Shifting Procedure" for your transfer case, located in this section.
The "SVC 4WD Warning Light" monitors the electronic shift four-wheel drive system. If this light remains on after engine start up or illuminates during driving, it means that the four-wheel drive system is not functioning properly and that service is required.
WARNING!
Alwaysengagetheparkingbrakewhenpoweringdown thevehicleifthe"SVC4WDWarningLight"isilluminated.Notengagingtheparkingbrakemayallowthe vehicletoroll,whichmaycausepersonalinju ry.
NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only the front or rear wheels are spinning, as this can cause damage to driveline components.
When operating your vehicle in 4WD LOW, the engine speed is approximately three times that of the 2WD or 4WD LOCK positions at a given road speed. Take care not to overspeed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
Proper operation of four-wheel drive vehicles depends on tires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel. Any difference in tire size can cause damage to the drivetrain.
Because four-wheel drive provides improved traction, there is a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds. Do not go faster than road conditions permit.

WARNING!
Youorotherscouldbeinjuredorkilledifyouleave thevehicleunattendedwiththetransfercaseinthe NEUTRALpositionwithoutfirstfullyengagingthe parkingbrake. ThetransfercaseNEUTRALposition disengagesboththefrontandreadriveshaftsfrom thepowertrainandwillallowthevehicletomove regardlessofthetransmissionposition. Theparking brakeshouldalwaysbeappliedwhenthedriveris notinthevehicle.
For additional information on the appropriate use of each transfer case mode position, see the information below:
2WD
Rear Wheel Drive High Range — This range is for normal street and highway driving on dry, hard surfaced roads.
4WDLOCK
Four-Wheel Drive Lock Range — This range maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This range provides additional traction for loose, slippery road surfaces only.
444 STARTING AND OPERATING
4WDLOW
Four-Wheel Drive Low Range — This range provides low speed four-wheel drive. It maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This range provides additional traction and maximum pulling power for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
NEUTRAL(N)
Neutral — This range disengages both the front and rear driveshafts from the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behind another vehicle. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
ShiftingProcedure
NOTE:
- If any of the requirements to select a new transfer case position have not been met, the transfer case will not shift. The position indicator light for the previous position will remain ON and the newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash until all the requirements for the selected position have been met. To retry a shift: return the control knob back to the original position, make certain all shift requirements have been met, wait five seconds and try the shift again.
- If all the requirements to select a new transfer case position have been met, the current position indicator light will turn OFF, the selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift. When the shift is complete, the position indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.

2WDTo4WDLOCK
Rotate the 4WD control switch to the desired position. Shifts between 2WD and 4WD LOCK can be done with the vehicle stopped or in motion. With the vehicle in motion, the transfer case will engage/disengage faster if you momentarily release the accelerator pedal after turning the control switch. If the vehicle is stopped, the ignition switch must be in the ON position with the engine either running or off. This shift cannot be completed if the ignition switch is in the ACC position.
NOTE: The four-wheel drive system will not allow shifts between 2WD/4WD LOCK if the front and/or rear wheels are spinning (no traction). In this situation, the selected position indicator light will flash and the original position indicator light will remain ON. At this time, reduce speed and stop spinning the wheels to complete the shift.
2WDOr4WDLOCKTo4WDLOW
NOTE: When shifting into or out of 4WD LOW some gear noise may be heard. This noise is normal and is not detrimental to the vehicle or occupants.
Shifting can be performed with the vehicle rolling 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h) or completely stopped. You can use either of the following procedures:
PreferredProcedure
- With the engine running, slow the vehicle to 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h).
- Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL.
- While still rolling, rotate the transfer case control switch to the desired position.
- After the desired position indicator light is ON (not flashing), shift the transmission back into gear.
446 STARTING AND OPERATING
AlternateProcedure
- Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.
- With the ignition switch in the ON position and the engine running, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL.
- Rotate the transfer case control switch to the desired position.
- After the desired position indicator light is ON (not flashing), shift the transmission back into gear.
NOTE:
- If Steps 1 or 2 of either the Preferred or Alternate Procedure are not satisfied prior to attempting the shift, then the desired position indicator light will flash continuously while the original position indicator light is ON, until all requirements have been met.
- The ignition switch must be in the ON position for a shift to take place and for the position indicator lights to be operable. If the ignition switch is not in the ON position, the shift will not take place and no position indicator lights will be on or flashing.
Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Five-Position Switch) — If Equipped
This is an electronic shift transfer case and is operated by the 4WD Control Switch (Transfer Case Switch), which is located on the instrument panel.

text_image
4WD AUTO 4WD LOCK 4WD LOW 2WD NEUTRAL 051905843TransferCaseSwitch(Five-Position)
This electronically shifted transfer case provides five mode positions:
- Two-wheel drive high range (2WD)
- Four-wheel drive automatic range (4WD AUTO)
- Four-wheel drive lock range (4WD LOCK)
- Four-wheel drive low range (4WD LOW)
• Neutral (NEUTRAL)
This electronically shifted transfer case is designed to be driven in the two-wheel drive position (2WD) or four-wheel drive position (4WD AUTO) for normal street and highway conditions on dry hard surfaced roads). Driving the vehicle in 2WD will have greater fuel economy benefits as the front axle is not engaged in 2WD.

448 STARTING AND OPERATING
For variable driving conditions, the 4WD AUTO mode can be used. In this mode, the front axle is engaged, but the vehicle's power is sent to the rear wheels. Four - wheel drive will be automatically engaged when the vehicle senses a loss of traction. Because the front axle is engaged, this mode will result in lower fuel economy than the 2WD mode.
When additional traction is required, the transfer case 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions can be used to maximize torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This is accomplished by rotating the 4WD Control Switch to the desired position. Refer to "Shifting Procedure" for specific shifting instructions. The 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions are designed for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Driving in the 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions on dry hard surfaced roads may cause increased tire wear and damage to the driveline components.
NOTE: The transfer case NEUTRAL position is selected by depressing the button located on the lower left hand corner of the 4WD Control Switch. The transfer case NEUTRAL position is to be used for recreational towing only. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
TransferCasePositionIndicatorLights
The Transfer Case Position Indicator Lights (4WD, 4LOW, and 4WD AUTO) are located in the instrument cluster and indicate the current and desired transfer case selection. When you select a different transfer case position, the indicator lights will do the following:
IfAllShiftConditionsAreMet:
- The current position indicator light will turn OFF.
- The selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift.

- When the shift is complete, the indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.
IfOneOrMoreShiftConditionsAreNotMet:
- The indicator light for the current position will remain ON.
- The newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash.
- The transfer case willnotshift.
NOTE: Before retrying a selection, make certain that all the necessary requirements for selecting a new transfer case position have been met. To retry the selection, turn the control knob back to the current position, wait five seconds, and retry selection. To find the shift requirements, refer to the "Shifting Procedure" for your transfer case, located in this section.
The “SVC 4WD Warning Light” monitors the electronic shift four-wheel drive system. If this light remains on after engine start up or illuminates during driving, it means that the four-wheel drive system is not functioning properly and that service is required.
WARNING!
Alwaysengagetheparkingbrakewhenpowering downthevehicleifthe"SVC4WDWarningLight"is illuminated. Notengagingtheparkingbrakemay allowthevehicletorollwhichmaycausepersonal injuryordeath.
NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only the front or rear wheels are spinning. This could cause damage to driveline components.
When operating your vehicle in 4WD LOW, the engine speed is approximately three times that of the 2WD, 4WD
450 STARTING AND OPERATING
AUTO or 4WD LOCK positions at a given road speed. Take care not to overspeed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
Proper operation of four-wheel drive vehicles depends on tires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel. Any difference in tire size can cause damage to the drivetrain.
Because four-wheel drive provides improved traction, there is a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds. Do not go faster than road conditions permit.
WARNING!
Youorotherscouldbeinjuredorkilledifyouleave thevehicleunattendedwiththetransfercaseinthe NEUTRALpositionwithoutfirstfullyengagingthe parkingbrake.ThetransfercaseNEUTRALposition
WARNING!(Continued)
disengagesboththefrontandreadriveshaftsfrom thepowertrainandwillallowthevehicletomove regardlessofthetransmissionposition.Theparking brakeshouldalwaysbeappliedwhenthedriveris notinthevehicle.
For additional information on the appropriate use of each transfer case mode position, see the information below:
2WD
Rear-Wheel Drive High Range - This range is for normal street and highway driving on dry hard surfaced roads.
4WDAUTO
Four-Wheel Drive Auto Range - This range sends power to the rear wheels. The four – wheel drive system will be automatically engaged when the vehicle senses a loss of traction. Additional traction for varying road conditions.
(Continued)

4WDLOCK
Four-Wheel Drive Lock Range - This range maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. Additional traction for loose, slippery road surfaces only.
4WDLOW
Four - Wheel Drive Low Range - This range provides low speed four-wheel drive. It maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This range provides additional traction and maximum pulling power for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
NEUTRAL(N)
Neutral - This range disengages both the front and rear driveshafts from the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behind another vehicle. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
ShiftingProcedure
NOTE:
- If any of the requirements to select a new transfer case position have not been met, the transfer case will not shift. The position indicator light for the previous position will remain ON and the newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash until all the requirements for the selected position have been met. To retry a shift: return the control knob back to the original position, make certain all shift requirements have been met, wait five seconds and try the shift again.

452 STARTING AND OPERATING
- If all the requirements to select a new transfer case position have been met, the current position indicator light will turn OFF, the selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift. When the shift is complete, the position indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.
Electronically Shifted Transfer Case (Five-Position Switch) — If Equipped
This is an electronic shift transfer case and is operated by the 4WD Control Switch (Transfer Case Switch), which is located on the instrument panel.

text_image
PRND 4WD AUTO 2WD 4WD LOCK 4WD LOW 051874148TransferCaseSwitch(Five-Position)
This electronically shifted transfer case provides five mode positions:
- Two-wheel drive high range (2WD)
- Four-wheel drive automatic range (4WD AUTO)
• Four-wheel drive lock range (4WD LOCK)

STARTING AND OPERATING 453
- Four-wheel drive low range (4WD LOW)
- Neutral (NEUTRAL)
This electronically shifted transfer case is designed to be driven in the two-wheel drive position (2WD) or four-wheel drive position (4WD AUTO) for normal street and highway conditions on dry hard surfaced roads). Driving the vehicle in 2WD will have greater fuel economy benefits as the front axle is not engaged in 2WD.
For variable driving conditions, the 4WD AUTO mode can be used. In this mode, the front axle is engaged, but the vehicle's power is sent to the rear wheels. Four-wheel drive will be automatically engaged when the vehicle senses a loss of traction. Because the front axle is engaged, this mode will result in lower fuel economy than the 2WD mode.
When additional traction is required, the transfer case 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions can be used to maximize torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front
and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This is accomplished by rotating the 4WD Control Switch to the desired position. Refer to "Shifting Procedure" for specific shifting instructions. The 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions are designed for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Driving in the 4WD LOCK and 4WD LOW positions on dry hard surfaced roads may cause increased tire wear and damage to the driveline components.
NOTE: The transfer case NEUTRAL position is selected by depressing the recessed button (with a ballpoint pen or similar object) located in the center of the 4WD Control Switch. The transfer case NEUTRAL position is to be used for recreational towing only. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.

454 STARTING AND OPERATING
TransferCasePositionIndicatorLights
The Transfer Case Position Indicator Lights (4WD, 4LOW, and 4WD AUTO) are located in the instrument cluster and indicate the current and desired transfer case selection. When you select a different transfer case position, the indicator lights will do the following:
IfAllShiftConditionsAreMet:
- The current position indicator light will turn OFF.
- The selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift.
- When the shift is complete, the indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.
IfOneOrMoreShiftConditionsAreNotMet:
- The indicator light for the current position will remain ON.
- The newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash.
- The transfer case willnotshift.
NOTE: Before retrying a selection, make certain that all the necessary requirements for selecting a new transfer case position have been met. To retry the selection, turn the control knob back to the current position, wait five seconds, and retry selection. To find the shift requirements, refer to the "Shifting Procedure" for your transfer case, located in this section.
The "SVC 4WD Warning Light" monitors the electronic shift four-wheel drive system. If this light remains on after engine start up or illuminates during driving, it

means that the four-wheel drive system is not functioning properly and that service is required.
WARNING!
Alwaysengagetheparkingbrakewhenpowering downthevehicleifthe"SVC4WDWarningLight"is illuminated. Notengagingtheparkingbrakemay allowthevehicletorollwhichmaycausepersonal injuryordeath.
NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only the front or rear wheels are spinning. This could cause damage to driveline components.
When operating your vehicle in 4WD LOW, the engine speed is approximately three times that of the 2WD, 4WD AUTO or 4WD LOCK positions at a given road speed. Take care not to overspeed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
Proper operation of four-wheel drive vehicles depends on tires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel. Any difference in tire size can cause damage to the drivetrain.
Because four-wheel drive provides improved traction, there is a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds. Do not go faster than road conditions permit.
WARNING!
Youorotherscouldbeinjuredorkilledifyouleave thevehicleunattendedwiththetransfercaseinthe NEUTRALpositionwithoutfirstfullyengagingthe parkingbrake. ThetransfercaseNEUTRALposition disengagesboththefrontandreadriveshaftsfrom thepowertrainandwillallowthevehicletomove regardlessofthetransmissionposition. Theparking brakeshouldalwaysbeappliedwhenthedriveris not in tevehicle.

456 STARTING AND OPERATING
For additional information on the appropriate use of each transfer case mode position, see the information below:
2WD
Rear-Wheel Drive High Range - This range is for normal street and highway driving on dry hard surfaced roads.
4WDAUTO
Four-Wheel Drive Auto Range - This range sends power to the rear wheels. The four-wheel drive system will be automatically engaged when the vehicle senses a loss of traction. Additional traction for varying road conditions.
4WDLOCK
Four-Wheel Drive Lock Range - This range maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. Additional traction for loose, slippery road surfaces only.
4WDLOW
Four-Wheel Drive Low Range - This range provides low speed four-wheel drive. It maximizes torque to the front driveshaft, forcing the front and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed. This range provides additional traction and maximum pulling power for loose, slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
NEUTRAL(N)
Neutral - This range disengages both the front and rear driveshafts from the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behind another vehicle. Refer to “Recreational Towing” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.

ShiftingProcedure
NOTE:
- If any of the requirements to select a new transfer case position have not been met, the transfer case will not shift. The position indicator light for the previous position will remain ON and the newly selected position indicator light will continue to flash until all the requirements for the selected position have been met.
- If all the requirements to select a new transfer case position have been met, the current position indicator light will turn OFF, the selected position indicator light will flash until the transfer case completes the shift. When the shift is complete, the position indicator light for the selected position will stop flashing and remain ON.
2WDTo4WDAUTOOr4WDLOCK
Press the desired position on the 4WD Control Switch to shift the transfer case. Shifts between 2WD and 4WD AUTO and 4WD LOCK can be done with the vehicle stopped or in motion. With the vehicle in motion, the transfer case will engage/disengage faster if you momentarily release the accelerator pedal after turning the control switch. If the vehicle is stopped, the ignition switch must be in the ON position with the engine either running or OFF. This shift cannot be completed if the ignition switch is in the ACC position.
2WDOr4WDAUTOOr4WDLOCKTo4WDLOW
NOTE: When shifting into or out of 4WD LOW some gear noise may be heard. This noise is normal and is not detrimental to the vehicle or occupants.

458 STARTING AND OPERATING
Shifting can be performed with the vehicle rolling 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h) or completely stopped. Use either of the following procedures:
PreferredProcedure
- With the engine running, slow the vehicle to 2 to 3 mph (3 to 5 km/h).
- Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL.
- While still rolling, press the desired position on the transfer case control switch.
- After the desired position indicator light is ON (not flashing), shift the transmission back into gear.
AlternateProcedure
- Bring the vehicle to complete stop.
-
With the ignition switch in the ON position and the engine running, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL.
-
Press the desired position on the transfer case control switch.
- After the desired position indicator light is ON (not flashing), shift the transmission back into gear.
NOTE:
- If Steps 1 or 2 of either the Preferred or Alternate Procedure are not satisfied prior to attempting the shift or if they no longer are being met while the shift attempt is in process, the desired position indicator light will flash continuously while the original position indicator light is ON, until all requirements have been met.
- The ignition switch must be in the ON position for a shift to take place and for the position indicator lights to be operable. If the ignition switch is not in the ON position, then the shift will not take place and no position indicator lights will be on or flashing.
STARTING AND OPERATING 459
AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (1500 MODELS ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED
Description
The air suspension system provides full time load leveling capability along with the benefit of being able to adjust vehicle height by the push of a button.

text_image
1 2 3 4 5 6 TOWI HAUL WHIP PUSH A/C NEUTRAL 058171263AirSuspensionSwitch
1 — Up Button
2 — Down Button
3 — Entry/Exit Mode Indicator Lamp (Customer selectable)
4 — Normal Ride Height Indicator Lamp (Customer selectable)
5 — Off-Road 1 Indicator Lamp (Customer selectable)
6 — Off-Road 2 Indicator Lamp (Customer selectable)

Information Provided by: DEALER
460 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: The vehicle will automatically enter Aero Mode when the vehicle speed remains between 62 mph (100 km/h) and 66 mph (106 km/h) for greater than 20 seconds or if the vehicle speed exceeds 66 mph (106 km/h).
- NormalRideHeight(NRH)– This is the standard position of the suspension and is meant for normal driving.
- Off-Road1(OR1)(Raisesthevehicleapproximately 1in[26mm])– This position should be the primary position for all off-road driving until Off Road 2 (OR2) is needed. A smoother and more comfortable ride will result. To enter OR1, press the “Up” button once from the NRH position while the vehicle speed is below 35 mph (56 km/h). When in the OR1 position, if the vehicle speed remains between 40 mph (64 km/h) and 50 mph (80 km/h) for greater than 20 seconds or if the vehicle speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h), the vehicle will be automatically lowered to NRH. Off-Road 1
may not be available due to vehicle payload, an EVIC message will be displayed when this occurs. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- Off-Road2(OR2)(Raisesthevehicleapproximately 2in[51mm])— This position is intended for off-roading use only where maximum ground clearance is required. To enter OR2, press the "Up" button twice from the NRH position or once from the OR1 position while vehicle speed is below 20 mph (32 km/h). While in OR2, if the vehicle speed exceeds 25 mph (40 km/h) the vehicle height will be automatically lowered to OR1. Off-Road 2 may not be available due to vehicle payload, an EVIC message will be displayed when this occurs. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- If the vehicle is in OFFROAD1 or OFFROAD2 setting, be aware of your surroundings, you may not have the clearance required for certain areas and vehicle damage may occur.
- AeroMode(Lowersthevehicleapproximately.6in [15mm])– This position provides improved aerodynamics by lowering the vehicle. The vehicle will automatically enter Aero Mode when the vehicle speed remains between 62 mph (100 km/h) and 66 mph (106 km/h) for greater than 20 seconds or if the vehicle speed exceeds 66 mph (106 km/h). The vehicle will return to NRH from Aero Mode if the vehicle speed remains between 30 mph (48 km/h) and 35 mph (56 km/h) for greater than 20 seconds or if the vehicle speed falls below 30 mph (48 km/h).
NOTE: Automatic Aero Mode may be disabled through vehicle settings in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) when equipped with Uconnect 3.0, or your Uconnect® Radio when equipped with UConnect® 5.0, 8.4A, or 8.4AN. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" or "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
- Entry/ExitMode(Lowersthevehicleapproximately2 in[51mm])– This position lowers the vehicle for easier passenger entry and exit as well as lowering the rear of the vehicle for easier loading and unloading of cargo. To enter Entry/Exit Mode, press the “Down” button once from the NRH while the vehicle speed is below 33 mph (53 km/h). Once the vehicle speed goes below 15 mph (24 km/h) the vehicle height will begin to lower. If the vehicle speed remains between 15 mph (24 km/h) and 25 mph (40 km/h) for greater than 60 seconds, or the vehicle speed exceeds 25 mph (40 km/h) the Entry/Exit change will be cancelled. To return to Normal Height Mode, press the “Up” button once while in Entry/Exit or drive the vehicle over

462 STARTING AND OPERATING
15 mph (24 km/h). Entry/Exit mode may not be available due to vehicle payload, an EVIC message will be displayed when this occurs. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE:Entry/Exit mode may be achieved using your key fob for easier entry/loading. Refer to “A Word About Your Keys” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
- When in ENTRY/EXIT setting, be aware of your surroundings, you may not have the clearance required for certain areas and vehicle damage may occur.
The system requires that the ignition be in ON/RUN position or the engine running for all user requested changes. When lowering the vehicle all of the doors, must be closed. If a door is opened at any time while the vehicle is lowering the change will not be completed until the open door(s) is closed.
This system uses a lifting and lowering pattern which keeps the headlights from incorrectly shining into oncoming traffic. When raising the vehicle, the rear of the vehicle will move up first and then the front. When lowering the vehicle, the front will move down first and then the rear.
After the engine is turned off, it may be noticed that the air suspension system operates briefly, this is normal. The system is correcting the position of the vehicle to ensure a proper appearance.
To assist with changing a spare tire, the air suspension system has a feature which allows the automatic leveling to be disabled. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: If equipped with a touch screen radio all enabling/disabling of air suspension features must be done through the radio. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

WARNING!
Theairsuspensionsystemusesahighpressure volumeofairtooperatethesystem.Toavoidpersonalinjuryordamagetothesystem,seeyour authorizeddealerforservice.
Air Suspension Modes
The Air Suspension system has multiple modes to protect the system in unique situations:
Tire/JackMode
To assist with changing a spare tire, the air suspension system has a feature which allows the automatic leveling to be disabled. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.
TransportMode
To assist with flat bed towing, the air suspension system has a feature which will put the vehicle into Entry/Exit height and disable the automatic load leveling system. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.
WheelAlignmentMode
Before performing a wheel alignment this mode must be enabled. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.

464 STARTING AND OPERATING
ProtectionMode
In order to “protect” the air suspension system, the vehicle will enter Protection Mode when load leveling cannot be achieved. Some driving may be required to clear the protection mode telltale in the EVIC. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: If equipped with a touch screen radio all enabling/disabling of air suspension features must be done through the radio. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display Messages
When the appropriate conditions exist, a message will appear in the EVIC display. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
An audible chime will be heard whenever a system error has been detected.
Operation
The indicator lamps 3 through 6 will illuminate to show the current position of the vehicle. Flashing indicator lamps will show a position which the system is working to achieve. When raising, if multiple indicator lamps are flashing, the highest flashing indicator lamp is the position the system is working to achieve. When lowering, if multiple indicators are flashing, the lowest solid indicator lamp is the position the system is working to achieve.

Pressing the "UP" button once will move the suspension one position higher from the current position, assuming all conditions are met (i.e. key in ON/RUN position, engine running, speed below threshold, etc). The "UP" button can be pressed multiple times, each press will raise the requested level by one position up to a maximum position of OR2 or the highest position allowed based on current conditions (i.e. vehicle speed, etc).
Pressing the "DOWN" button once will move the suspension one position lower from the current level, assuming all conditions are met (i.e. key in ON/RUN position, engine running, doors closed, speed below threshold, etc). The "DOWN" button can be pressed multiple times, each press will lower the requested level by one position down to a minimum of Entry/Exit Mode or the lowest position allowed based on current conditions (i.e. vehicle speed, etc.)
Automatic height changes will occur based on vehicle speed and the current vehicle height. The indicator lamps and EVIC messages will operate the same for automatic changes and user requested changes.
- Off-Road 2 (OR2) – Indicator lamps 3, 4, 5 and 6 will be illuminated when the vehicle is in OR2.
- Off-Road 1 (OR1) – Indicator lamps 3, 4 and 5 will be illuminated when the vehicle is in OR1.
- Normal Ride Height (NRH)/Aero Mode – Indicator lamps 3 and 4 will be illuminated when the vehicle is in this position.
- Entry/Exit Mode – Indicator lamp 3 will be illuminated when the vehicle is in Entry Exit Mode. Entry/Exit mode can be requested up to 33 mph (53 km/h). If vehicle speed is reduced to, and kept below, 15 mph (24 km/h) indicator lamp 4 will flash and indicator lamp 3 will remain solid until Entry/Exit Mode is achieved at which point indicator lamp 4 will turn off.

466 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Transport Mode – No indicator lamps will be illuminated. Transport Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
- Tire/Jack Mode – indicator lamps 3 and 6 will be illuminated. Tire/Jack Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
- Wheel Alignment Mode – indicator lamps 3 and 4 will be illuminated. Wheel Alignment Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (2500/3500 MODELS ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED
Description
The air suspension system is a rear leveling ride height system. The main purpose of this system is to maintain the truck's rear ride height level.

text_image
All TRAILER HEIGHT TOW OFF 0581005440RearLevelingRideHeightSwitch
NormalRideHeight(NRH)- This is the standard position of the suspension and is meant for normal driving.

TrailerMode(Lowersthevehicleapproximately1in(25 mm)– This position will lower the rear suspension and provide load leveling for all loading conditions including towing a trailer. The trailer button will blink continuously until trailer height has been achieved.
The system requires that the ignition be in ON/RUN position or the engine running for all user requested changes.
After the engine is turned off, it may be noticed that the air suspension system operates briefly, this is normal. The system is correcting the position of the vehicle to ensure a proper appearance.
NOTE: If equipped with a touch screen radio all enabling/disabling of air suspension features must be done through the radio. Refer to "Uconnect® Access Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
WARNING!
Theairsuspensionsystemusesahighpressure volumeofairtooperatethesystem.Toavoidpersonalinjuryordamagetothesystem,seeyour authorizeddealerforservice.
Air Suspension Modes
The Air Suspension system has multiple modes to protect the system in unique situations:
Tire/JackMode
To assist with changing a spare tire, the air suspension system has a feature which allows the automatic leveling to be disabled. This mode is intended to be used with engine running. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

468 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.
TransportMode
To assist with flat bed towing, the air suspension system has a feature which will put the vehicle below Normal Ride Height (NRH) and disable the automatic load leveling system. This mode is intended to be used with engine running. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.
WheelAlignmentMode
Before performing a wheel alignment this mode must be enabled. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE: This mode is intended to be enabled with engine running.
ProtectionMode
In order to “protect” the air suspension system, the vehicle will enter Protection Mode when load leveling cannot be achieved. Some driving may be required to clear the protection mode telltale in the EVIC. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: If equipped with a touch screen radio all enabling/disabling of air suspension features must be done through the radio. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.

Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display Messages
When the appropriate conditions exist, a message will appear in the EVIC display. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
An audible chime will be heard whenever a system error has been detected.
Operation
Pushing the Trailer Mode button once, while at Normal Ride Height (NRH) will lower the vehicle to trailer level.
NOTE: The LED will continuously blink until vehicle trailer level that been achieved.
Pushing the Trailer Mode again will raise the vehicle to Normal Ride Height (NRH).
NOTE: The LED will continuously blink until Normal Ride Height (NRH) has been achieved.
- Transport Mode – No indicator lamps will be illuminated. Transport Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
- Tire/Jack Mode – The LED will be illuminated. Tire/Jack Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
- Wheel Alignment Mode – The LED will be illuminated. Wheel Alignment Mode is disabled by driving the vehicle.
This vehicle is equipped with electronically locking front and rear differentials. These differentials, when engaged, mechanically lock together the axle shafts forcing the wheels to spin at an equal rate. This allows the vehicle to maintain its momentum and prevents it from becoming

470 STARTING AND OPERATING
stuck. The locking front and rear differentials should only be engaged during low-speed, extreme off-road situations where one wheel is likely to not be in contact with the ground. It is not recommended to drive the vehicle with the differentials locked on pavement due to the reduced ability to turn and speed limitations.
CAUTION!
- Donotlockthefrontorrearaxleonhardsurfaced roads. The ability to osteer the vehicle is reduced and damage to the drivetrain may occur when the axles are locked on hardsurfaced roads.
- Donottrytolocktherearaxleifthevehicleis stuckandthetiresarespinning.Youcandamage drivetraincomponents.Locktherearaxlebefore attemptingsituationsornavigatingterrain,which couldpossiblycausethevehicletobecomestuck.
The locking axles are controlled by the axle locker switch.
The switch has three positions, AXLE UNLOCK, REAR LOCK, and FRONT/REAR LOCK. Under normal driving conditions, the switch should be left in the AXLE UNLOCK position. In the AXLE UNLOCK position, the front and rear axles are unlocked. In the REAR LOCK position, the rear axle is locked. In the FRONT/REAR LOCK position, the front and rear axles are locked.
NOTE: Even when the axles are in the AXLE UNLOCK position, the limited slip differential in the rear axle still provides torque biasing capability for moderate low traction environments.
During the command to lock the axle, the indicator light will flash until the axle is locked. After the lock command has been successfully executed, the light will remain on solid.
To lock the rear axle, place the vehicle in 4LO. Refer to "Four Wheel Drive Operation" in "Starting and Operating" for further information. Move the axle locker switch position to REAR LOCK while traveling less than 3 mph (5 km/h). The RR indicator light will remain on when the rear axle is locked.
NOTE: Left to right wheel speed difference may be necessary to allow the axle to fully lock. If the indicator light is flashing after placing the switch in the REAR LOCK or FRONT/REAR LOCK position, drive the vehicle in a turn or on loose gravel to expedite the locking action.
WARNING!
Donotusethelockedaxlepositionfornormal driving.Alockedfrontaxleisintendedforoff-road drivingonly.Lockingthefrontaxleduringon-road
WARNING!(Continued)
drivingwillreducethesteeringability.Thiscould causeacollisionandyoumaybeseriouslyinjured.
To lock the front axle; move the axle locker switch to FRONT/REAR LOCK while traveling less than 3 mph (5 km/h). The indicator light will be solid when the front axle is locked.
NOTE: The rear axle must be locked before the front axle will lock.
To unlock the front axle; move the axle locker switch to REAR LOCK. The FRONT/REAR LOCK indicator light will go out when the axle is unlocked.
472 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: The axle lockers could be torque locked due to side to side loads on the axle. Driving slowly while turning the steering wheel from a left hand turn to a right hand turn or driving in REVERSE for a short distance may be required to release the torque lock and unlock the axles.
To unlock the rear axle; move the axle locker switch to AXLE UNLOCK. The REAR LOCK indicator light will go out when the rear axle is unlocked.
Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic disconnecting stabilizer/sway bar. This system allows greater front suspension travel in off-road situations.
Due to the use of taller springs, this vehicle has an increased ride height of approximately 1.9 in (48.3 mm) in the front and 1.5 in (38.1 mm) in the rear. A major advantage to increasing ride height is the positive effect it has on approach/departure and break over angles.
This system is controlled by the electronic control sway bar switch located on the instrument panel.

text_image
AXLE UNLOCK REAR LOCK FRONT/REAR LOCK SWAY BAR 1 2 0523071341 — On Road 2 — Off Road

Information Provided by: DEALER
STARTING AND OPERATING 473
The switch has two positions; On-Road and Off-Road. The system is normally in the On-Road mode, indicated by a solid green light. The stabilizer/sway bar should remain in the On-Road mode during normal driving conditions.
WARNING!
Donotdisconnectthestabilizerbaranddriveon hardsurfacedroadsoratspeedsabove18mph (29km/h),youmaylosecontrolofthevehicle,which couldresultinseriousinjuryordeath.Thefront stabilizerbarenhancesvehiclestabilityandisnecessaryformaintainingcontrolofthevehicle.The systemmonitorsvehiclespeedandwillattemptto reconnectthestabilizerbaratspeedsover18mph (29km/h).Thisisindicatedbyaflashingoffroad lightandsolidonroadlight.Oncevehiclespeedis reducedbelow14mph(22km/h),thesystemwill attempttoreturntotheOff-Roadmode.
To disconnect the stabilizer/sway bar, shift to either 4HI or 4LO as shown in "Four Wheel Drive Operation" and press the right hand Off Road stabilizer/sway bar button to obtain the Off-Road position. The amber indicator light will flash until the stabilizer/sway bar has been fully disconnected.
NOTE: The stabilizer/sway bar may be torque locked due to left and right suspension height differences. This condition is due to driving surface differences or vehicle loading. In order for the stabilizer/sway bar to disconnect/reconnect, the right and left halves of the bar must be aligned. This alignment may require that the vehicle be driven onto level ground or rocked from side to side.
To return to the On-Road mode; press the left hand On Road stabilizer/sway bar button.

474 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Ifthestabilizer/swaybarwillnotreturntoOn-Road mode,vehiclestabilityisgreatlyreduced.Donot attempttodrivethevehicleover18mph(29km/h). Drivingfasterthan18mph(29km/h)maycauseloss ofcontrolofthevehicle,whichcouldresultin seriousinjuryordeath.Contactyourlocalservice centerforassistance.
Off-Road Driving Tips And Vehicle Characteristics
Your vehicle has excellent on and off-road capabilities. These off-road capabilities will allow you to explore those wilderness trails where few travel, providing a source of exciting and satisfying recreation. Before you venture out, you should contact your local governmental
agency to determine the designated off-road vehicle (ORV) trails or recreation areas. You should always tread lightly and only use established roads, trails or ORV recreational areas. The National Forest Service, Bureau of Land Management or local Department of Natural Resources are a wealth of information and usually have maps with marked trails.
SkidPlatesAndUnderbodyProtection
Steel skid plates protect the major driveline components of the truck including the fuel tank, transfer case and steering damper. In addition, this vehicle is equipped with boxed cross members and fore/aft rails. This additional protection allows the vehicle to be utilized in severe off-road situations that would be considered impassable by a normal truck.

RampTravelIndex(RTI)
The ramp travel index is the distance, in inches, that you can drive your vehicle with one wheel on a 20-degree ramp without lifting any other wheel off the ground. This distance up the ramp divided by the wheelbase of the vehicle and multiplied by 1,000 is the RTI. This vehicle has an RTI of 655, which means you can articulate one front wheel 32 inches in the air while the other three wheels remain in contact with the ground.
WaterFordingCharacteristics
Water fording characteristic is the vehicle's ability to cross a body of still water, where the powertrain and drivetrain are safe from water ingestion. This vehicle has high water fording characteristics with the ability to cross a pool of water, without stopping, 24 inches deep at a maximum speed of 10mph (16km / h) and a pool of water 30 inches deep at a maximum speed of 5mph (8km / h) , both with an entrance ramp angle of 1.3 degrees.
CAUTION!
Thedoorsillheightis25inches.Watermayintrude intotheinteriorofthevehicleatgreaterdepths.
Simultaneous Brake And Throttle Operation
Many off-road driving conditions require the simultaneous use of the brake and throttle (two footed driving). When climbing rocks, logs, or other stepped objects, using light brake pressure with light throttle will keep the vehicle from jerking or lurching. This technique is also used when you need to stop and restart a vehicle on a steep incline.
TheBasicsOfOff-RoadDriving
You will encounter many types of terrain driving off-road. You should be familiar with the terrain and area before proceeding. There are many types of surface conditions: hard packed dirt, gravel, rocks, grass, sand,

476 STARTING AND OPERATING
mud, snow and ice. Every surface has a different effect on your vehicle's steering, handling and traction. Controlling your vehicle is one of the keys to successful off-road driving, so always keep a firm grip on the steering wheel and maintain a good driving posture. Avoid sudden accelerations, turns or braking. In most cases there are no road signs, posted speed limits or signal lights. Therefore you will need to use your own good judgment on what is safe and what isn't. When on a trail you should always be looking ahead for surface obstacles and changes in terrain. The key is to plan your future driving route while remembering what you are currently driving over.
CAUTION!
Neverparkyourvehicleoverdrygrassorother combustiblematerials.Theheatfromyourvehicle exhaustsystemcouldcauseafire.
WARNING!
Alwayswearyourseatbeltandfirmlytiedown cargo. Unsecuredcargocanbecomeprojectilesinan off-roadsituation.
WhenToUseLowRange
When driving off-road, shift into 4L (Low Range) for additional traction or to improve handling and control on slippery or difficult terrain. Due to the lower gearing, low range will allow the engine to operate in a higher power range. This will allow you to idle over obstacles and down hills, with improved control and less effort. Also, use 4L (Low Range) in rain, ice, snow, mud, sand, to get heavy loads rolling, improve traction, or whenever 4H (High Range) traction will not do the job.
Driving In Snow, Mud And Sand
There is a drastic reduction in traction when driving in snow, mud or sand. The vehicle will be less responsive to steering, acceleration and braking inputs. Therefore you should accelerate slowly, leave greater stopping distances and avoid abrupt vehicle maneuvers. You want to keep a slow constant steady pace. The key is to maintain the vehicle's momentum.
- Snow– In heavy snow or for additional control and traction at slower speeds, shift the transmission to a low gear and shift the transfer case to 4L (Low Range) if necessary. Do not shift to a lower gear than necessary to maintain headway. Over-revving the engine can spin the wheels and traction will be lost. If you start to slow to a stop, try turning your steering wheel no more than a 14 turn quickly back and forth, while still applying throttle. This will allow the tires to get a fresh "bite" and help maintain your momentum.
CAUTION!
Onicyorslipperyroads, donotdownshiftathigh engineRPMsorvehiclespeedsbecauseenginebrakingmaycauseskiddingandlossofcontrol.
- Mud– Deep mud creates a great deal of suction around the tires and is very difficult to get through. You should use 4L (Low Range) with a gear low enough to maintain your momentum without shifting. If you start to slow to a stop, try turning your steering wheel no more than a 14 turn quickly back and forth for additional traction. Mud holes pose an increased threat of vehicle damage and getting stuck. They are normally full of debris from previous vehicles getting stuck. As a good practice before entering any mud hole, get out and determine how deep it is, if there are any hidden obstacles and if the vehicle can be safely recovered if stuck.

478 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Sand– Soft sand is very difficult to travel through with full tire pressure. When crossing soft sandy spots in a trail maintain your vehicle's momentum and do not stop. The key to driving in soft sand using the appropriate tire pressure, accelerating slowly, avoiding abrupt maneuvers and maintaining the vehicle's momentum. If you are going to be driving on large soft sandy areas or dunes, reduce your tire pressure to a minimum of 15 psi (103 kPa) to allow for a greater tire surface area. Reduced tire pressure will drastically improve your traction and handling, while driving on the soft sand, but you must return the tires to normal air pressure before driving on pavement or other hard surfaces. Be sure you have a way to air the tires back up prior to reducing the pressure.
CAUTION!
Reduced tire pressures may cause unseating and total loss of air pressure. Toreducether is of tire unseating, while a reduced tire pressure, reduce your speed and avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers.
Crossing Obstacles (Rocks And Other High Points)
While driving off road, you will encounter many types of terrain. These varying types of terrain bring different types of obstacles. Before proceeding review the path ahead to determine the correct approach and your ability to safely recover the vehicle if something goes wrong. Keeping a firm grip on the steering wheel, bring the vehicle to a complete stop and then inch the vehicle forward until it makes contact with the object. Apply the

throttle lightly while holding a light brake pressure and ease the vehicle up and over the object.
WARNING!
Crossingobstaclescancauseabruptsteeringsystem loadingwhichcouldcauseyoutoloosecontrolof yourvehicle.
UsingASpotter
There are many times where it is hard to see the obstacle or determine the correct path. Determining the correct path can be extremely difficult when you are confronting many obstacles. In these cases have someone guide you over, through, or around the obstacle. Have the person stand a safe distance in front of you where they can see the obstacle, watch your tires and undercarriage, and guide you through.
CrossingLargeRocks
When approaching large rocks, choose a path which ensures you drive over the largest with your tires. This will lift your undercarriage over the obstacle. The tread of the tire is tougher and thicker than the side wall and is designed to take the abuse. Always look ahead and make every effort to cross the large rocks with your tires.
CAUTION!
- Neverattempttostraddlearockthatislarge enoughtostrikeyouraxlesorundercarriage.
- Neverattempttodriveoverarockwhichislarge enoughtocontactthedoorsills.
CrossingARavine, Gully, Ditch, WashoutOrRut
When crossing a ravine, gully, ditch, washout or a large rut, the angled approach is the key to maintaining your
480 STARTING AND OPERATING
vehicle's mobility. Approach these obstacles at a 45-degree angle and let each tire go through the obstacle independently. You need to use caution when crossing large obstacles with steep sides. Do not attempt to cross any large obstacle with steep sides at an angle great enough to put the vehicle at risk of a rollover. If you get caught in a rut, dig a small trench to the right or left at a 45-degree angle ahead of the front tires. Use the removed dirt to fill the rut ahead of the turnout you just created. You should now be able to drive out following the trench you just created at a 45-degree angle.
WARNING!
Thereisanincreasedriskofrolloverwhencrossing anobstacle,atanyangle,withsteepsides.
CrossingLogs
To cross a log, approach it at a slight angle (approximately 10 to 15 degrees). This allows one front tire to be on top of the log while the other just starts to climb the log. While climbing the log, modulate your brake and accelerator to avoid spinning the log out from under your tires. Then ease the vehicle off the log using your brakes.
CAUTION!
Donotattempttocrossalogwithagreaterdiameter thantherunninggroundclearanceorthevehiclewill becomehighcentered.
GettingHighCentered
If you get hung up or high centered on an object, get out of the vehicle and try to determine what the vehicle is hung up on, where it is contacting the underbody and

STARTING AND OPERATING 481
what is the best direction to recover the vehicle. Depending on what you are in contact with, jack the vehicle up and place a few rocks under the tires so the weight is off of the high point when you let the vehicle down. You can also try rocking the vehicle or winching the vehicle off the object.
CAUTION!
Winchingorrockingthevehicleoffhardobjects increasestheriskofunderbodydamage.
Hill Climbing
Hill climbing requires good judgment and a good understanding of your abilities and your vehicle's limitations. Hills can cause serious problems. Some are just too steep to climb and should not be attempted. You should always feel confident with the vehicle and your abilities. You should always climb hills straight up and down. Never attempt to climb a hill on an angle.
- BeforeClimbingASteepHill– As you approach a hill consider its grade or steepness. Determine if it is too steep. Look to see what the traction is on the hill side trail. Is the trail straight up and down? What is on top and the other side? Are there ruts, rocks, branches or other obstacles on the path? Can you safely recover the vehicle if something goes wrong? If everything looks good and you feel confident, then change transmission into a lower gear, shift the transfer case into 4L (Low) and proceed with caution. You should use first gear and 4L (Low Range) for very steep hills.
- DrivingUpHill– Once you have determined your ability to proceed and have shifted into the appropriate gear, line your vehicle up for the straightest possible run. Accelerate with an easy constant throttle and

482 STARTING AND OPERATING
apply more power as you start up the hill. Do not race forward into a steep grade, the abrupt change of grade could cause you to lose control. If the front end begins to bounce, ease off the throttle slightly to bring all four tires back on the ground. As you approach the crest of the hill ease off the throttle and slowly proceed over the top. If the wheels start to slip as you approach the crest of a hill, ease off the accelerator and maintain headway by turning the steering wheel no more than a 14 turn quickly back and forth. This will provide a fresh "bite" into the surface and will usually provide enough traction to complete the climb. If you do not make it to the top, place the vehicle in REVERSE and back straight down the grade using engine resistance along with the vehicle brakes.
WARNING!
Neverattempttoclimbahillatanangleorturn aroundonasteepgrade.Drivingacrossanincline increasestheriskofarollover,whichmayresultin severeinjuryordeath.
- Driving Down Hill – Before driving down a steep hill you need to determine if it is too steep for a safe descent. What is the surface traction? Is the grade too steep to maintain a slow controlled descent? Are there obstacles? Is it a straight descent? Is there plenty of distance at the base of the hill to regain control if the vehicle descends too fast? If you feel confident in your ability to proceed then make sure you are in 4L (Low Range) with the transmission in first gear (manually select first gear on automatic transmissions) and proceed with caution. Allow engine braking to control the descent and apply your brakes if necessary, but do not allow the tires to lock.

WARNING!
DonotdescendasteepgradeinNEUTRAL.Use vehiclebrakesinconjunctionwithenginebraking. Descendingagradetoofastcouldcauseyoutolose controlandbeseriouslyinjuredorkilled.
- DrivingAcrossAnIncline– If at all possible avoid driving across an incline. If it is necessary, know your vehicle's abilities. Driving across an incline places more weight on the down hill wheels, which increases the possibilities of a down hill slide or rollover. Make sure the surface has good traction with firm and stable soils. If possible transverse the incline at an angle heading slightly up or down.
WARNING!
Drivingacrossaninclineincreasetheriskofa rollover,whichmayresultinsevereinjury.
- IfYouStallOrBeginToLoseHeadway– If you stall or begin to lose headway while climbing a steep hill, allow your vehicle to come to a stop and immediately apply the brake. Restart the engine and shift into REVERSE. Back slowly down the hill allowing the compression braking of the engine and transmission to help regulate your speed. If the brakes are required to control vehicle speed, apply them lightly and avoid locking or skidding the tires.
WARNING!
If the engineestallsoryouloseheadwayor cannot make it to the top of a steep ephill or grade, never attempt to turnaround. Todos may result in tipping and rolling the vehicle, which may result in severe injury. Always back carefully straight down a hill in REVERSE. Never backdown a hill in NEU-TRAL using only the vehicle brakes. Never drive diagonally across a hill, always drivestraight up or down.
Driving Through Water
Extreme care should be taken crossing any type of water. Water crossings should be avoided if possible and only be attempted when necessary, in a safe responsible manner. You should only drive through areas which are designated and approved. You should tread 1 lightly and
avoid damage to the environment. You should know your vehicle's abilities and be able to recover it if something goes wrong. You should never stop or shut a vehicle off when crossing deep water unless you ingested water into the engine air intake. If the engine stalls do not attempt to restart it. Determine if it has ingested water first. The key to any crossing is low and slow. You want to use first gear in 4L (Low Range) and proceed very slowly with a constant slow speed (3-5 mph [5–8 km/h] maximum) and light throttle. Keep the vehicle moving; do not try to accelerate through the crossing. After crossing any water higher than the bottom of the axle differentials, you should inspect all of the vehicle fluids for signs of water ingestion.

CAUTION!
Wateringestionintotheaxles,transmission,transfer case,engineorvehicleinteriorcanoccurifyoudrive toofastorthroughtoodeepofwater.Watercancause permanentdamagetoengine,drivelineorother vehiclecomponentsandyourbrakeswillbeless effectiveoncewetand/ormuddy.
- BeforeYouCrossAnyTypeOfWater– As you approach any type of water you need to determine if you can cross it safely and responsibly. If necessary, get out and walk through the water or probe it with a stick. You need to be sure of its depth, approach angle, current and bottom condition. Be careful of murky or muddy waters, check for hidden obstacles. Make sure you will not be intruding on any wildlife and you can recover the vehicle if necessary. The key to a safe
crossing is the water depth, current and bottom conditions. On soft bottoms the vehicle will sink in, effectively increasing the water level on the vehicle. Be sure to consider this when determining the depth and the ability to safely cross.
- CrossingPuddles, Pools, Flooded Areas Or Other Standing Water– Puddles, pools, flooded or other standing water areas normally contain murky or muddy waters. These water types normally contain hidden obstacles and make it difficult to determine an accurate water depth, approach angle, and bottom condition. Murky or muddy water holes are where you want to hook up tow straps prior to entering. This makes for a faster, cleaner and easier vehicle recovery. If you are able to determine you can safely cross, than proceed using the low and slow method.
CAUTION!
Muddywaterscanreducethecoolingsystemeffectivenessbydepositingdebrisontotheradiator.
- CrossingDitches,Streams,ShallowRiversOrOther FlowingWater– Flowing water can be extremely dangerous. Never attempt to cross a fast running stream or river even in shallow water. Fast moving water can easily push your vehicle downstream sweeping it out of control. Even in very shallow water, a high current can still wash the dirt out from around your tires putting you and your vehicle in jeopardy. There is still a high risk of personal injury and vehicle damage with slower water currents in depths greater than the vehicle's running ground clearance. You should never attempt to cross flowing water which is deeper than the vehicle's running ground clearance. Even the slowest current can push the heaviest vehicle
downstream out of control if the water is deep enough to push on the large surface area of the vehicle's body. Before you proceed determine the speed of the current, the water's depth, approach angle, bottom condition and if there are any obstacles, then cross at an angle heading slightly upstream using the low and slow technique.
WARNING!
Neverdrivethroughfastmovingdeepwater.Itcan pushyourvehicledownstream,sweepingitoutof control.Thiscouldputyouandyourpassengersat riskofinjuryordrowning.
Airing Down For Off-Road Driving
Running lower tire pressure off-road can improve your ride comfort and vehicle traction. Reducing the tire air pressure allows the tire to bulge slightly, improving its surface area for better flotation and ability to mold or form to the ground contour. Different terrain, tires, and vehicles require different tire pressure. Hard surfaces like rock and heavier vehicles require higher pressures than softer surfaces such as sand and lighter vehicles. You will need to experiment to determine what is right for your situation. It is easier and faster to let air out than it is to replace it so, start high and lower it as required. Remember you must return the tires to normal air pressure before driving on road or at highway conditions. Be sure you have a way to return the tires to their normal on road air pressure.
CAUTION!
Reduced tire pressure increase estheriskoftired damage and may cause unreseating with total loss of air pressure. Toreducetheriskoftire unseating, while at areduced tire pressure, drive at lowers speeds and avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers.
Vehicle Recovery
If you drive off-road, you may encounter a situation where you will need to recover your vehicle. Vehicle recovery should always be given consideration before attempting a questionable obstacle. You should never go off-road driving without the ability to recover your vehicle from a situation. Having another vehicle with you usually works best for most situations. The first thing to do is assess the situation. Why are you stuck? Are you hung up on something? Would it be easier to go forward or to go backward? Can you still move the

vehicle? Is there an anchor point to winch to? Are you alone or do you have another vehicle to help? Is there high risk of vehicle damage during the recovery process? Answering these questions will help you determine the best method of recovery. If you can still move the vehicle slightly and the only issue is slick ground, then rock cycling your vehicle would be the first choice. If you have ample room, an additional vehicle and there is low risk of vehicle impingement on the surroundings, then using a tow strap to the vehicle tow hooks would be fast and easy. If the vehicle is severely hung up or in a situation where great care needs to be taken during the recovery, then nothing can do the job better than a winch. If you are severely hung up on something you should jack the vehicle up and stack something under the wheels to allow the vehicle to roll off the object without causing further damage. This should be tried before attempting any recovery method.
CAUTION!
Pullingthevehicleoffanobstacle, withoutfirst clearingtheobject, mayresultinadditionalunderbodydamage.
- RockCyclingYourVehicle– Rock cycling your vehicle is one of the easiest, fastest and most commonly used methods. This simply involves shifting your vehicle from DRIVE to REVERSE, while applying throttle after each shift. During this process, for additional traction, try turning your steering wheel quickly left and right no more than a 14 turn. If you are stuck in mud, sand, or snow try spinning your tires during this process to clean the debris from the tread and improve the traction. You want to create a rocking motion with the vehicle. This helps build vehicle momentum, which hopefully gets you out. Remember to ease off and on the accelerator before and after the
shift. If after a few rock cycles your vehicle is not free, stop and try another method of recovery. Continuous rock cycling will only cause unnecessary damage to your vehicle and the environment.
CAUTION!
Damagecanoccurwhenspinningyourtiresatan excessivehighspeed.Donotspinyourtiresfaster thananindicated30mph(48km/h).
- Using The Tow Hooks With A Tow Strap – Tow straps are a quick and easy way to recover your vehicle from minor situations if you have a secondary vehicle which is not stuck. The tow hooks on your vehicle are designed to take the abusive force generated during vehicle recovery. Do not use the bumper or any other vehicle component as an attachment point. Using tow straps requires coordination between the two drivers. Good communication and line of sight are required for
a safe recovery. First connect the tow strap to the correct attachment points on both vehicles. There should be a least 20 to 30 feet between the vehicles to allow for a safe recovery. If necessary join two tow straps together using a 1½ inch hard wood dowel. This will keep the straps from becoming knotted and is safer than using a clevis pin if the strap breaks. Next have the tow vehicle backup, leaving two to three feet worth of slack in the strap. Then the tow vehicle, using light throttle, should accelerate tightening the strap providing the pulling force needed to free the vehicle. The vehicle being recovered should assist in the recovery, at the time of the snap, by slowly spinning the tires in the same direction as the pulling vehicle. After the vehicle becomes free, the driver of the previously stuck vehicle should signal they are free and should hit their brakes stopping both vehicles. The driver of the pulling vehicle should let off the throttle without using the

490 STARTING AND OPERATING
brakes, once signaled by the other driver. This sequence is important to avoid having the recovered vehicle hit the pulling vehicle.
WARNING!
Neverusetowstrapswithendhooksorlinktwo strapswithaclevispin.Theseheavymetalobjects couldbecomeprojectilesifastrapbreaks,which couldcausesevereinjury.Neverleavemorethanttwo orthreefeetofslackinthestrap.Moreslackthanthis greatlyincreasetheriskofinjuryandvehicledam- age.Alwayskeepeveryoneatleast30feetawayfrom astrappingorwinchingsituation.
- Winching(ReferTo"WinchOperation"ForAdditionalInformation)- Winching is most commonly used in the following situations: there is no support vehicle available, a high controlled force is required to
recover the vehicle, there is a high risk of environmental or vehicle damage, or where nothing else seems to work. A winch can deliver a high pulling force with a great deal of control. It allows you to walk the vehicle out of the situation in a slow controlled manner. This control works well for avoiding further vehicle damage. Once you decide it is time to use the winch look for a good anchor point. It needs to be strong enough to hold more than the vehicle's weight and provide a direction of pull as straight as possible. Use block and tackle if necessary to improve the angle of pull or increase the winch's pulling force. If the anchor point is a tree use a strap around its base and hook the cable to the strap. If it is another vehicle, then place that vehicle in PARK and block the front tires. If you cannot find an anchor point within reach try using your spare tire by burying it. Once you have determined an anchor point hook up the cable, ensuring there are a least five wraps of cable left on the drum, and place a

floor mat or something else over the strung out cable. Placing something over the strung out cable helps keep the cable on the ground if it breaks. Next, place the vehicle in first gear and apply a very light throttle as you power the winch in. Be careful not to allow slack in the cable as you recover the vehicle. Do not try to guide the cable into the drum. If it starts to bunch up on one end, let it. You can re-spool the cable afterwards. Never use a winch cable as a tow strap and always stand back while winching.
WARNING!
Winchcablesareunderhightensionwheninuseand canbecomeaprojectileiftheyfail.Neverstandover orstraddlethewinchcable.Neverjerkoroverload thewinchcable.Neverstandinfrontofthevehicle whilewinching.Failuretofollowtheseinstructions canresultinseriousorfatalinjury.
After Driving Off-Road
Off-road operation puts more stress on your vehicle than does most on-road driving. After going off-road, it is always a good idea to check for damage. That way you can get any problems taken care of right away and have your vehicle ready when you need it.
- Completely inspect the underbody of your vehicle. Check tires, body structure, steering, suspension, and exhaust system for damage.
- Inspect the radiator for mud and debris and clean as required.
-
Check threaded fasteners for looseness, particularly on the chassis, drivetrain components, steering, and suspension. Retighten them, if required, and torque to the values specified in the Service Manual.
-
Check for accumulations of plants or brush. These things could be a fire hazard. They might hide damage to fuel lines, brake hoses, axle pinion seals, and propeller shafts.
- After extended operation in mud, sand, water, or similar dirty conditions, have the radiator, fan, brake rotors, wheels, brake linings, and axle yokes inspected and cleaned as soon as possible.
WARNING!
Abrasivematerialinanypartofthebrakesmaycause excessivewearorunpredictablebraking.Youmight nothavefullbrakingpowerwhenyouneeditto preventacollision.Ifyouhavebeenoperatingyour vehicleindirtyconditions,getyourbrakeschecked andcleanedasnecessary.
- If you experience unusual vibration after driving in mud, slush or similar conditions, check the wheels for impacted material. Impacted material can cause a wheel imbalance and freeing the wheels of it will correct the situation.
LIMITED-SLIP DIFFERENTIAL
The limited-slip differential provides additional traction on snow, ice, mud, sand and gravel, particularly when there is a difference between the traction characteristics of the surface under the right and left rear wheels. During normal driving and cornering, the limited-slip unit performs similarly to a conventional differential. On slippery surfaces, however, the differential delivers more of the driving effort to the rear wheel having the better traction.
The limited-slip differential is especially helpful during slippery driving conditions. With both rear wheels on a slippery surface, a slight application of the accelerator

will supply maximum traction. When starting with only one rear wheel on an excessively slippery surface, slight momentary application of the parking brake may be necessary to gain maximum traction.
WARNING!
Onvehiclesequippedwithalimited-slipdifferential neverruntheenginewithonerearwheeloffthe groundsincethevehiclemaydrivethroughtherear wheelremainingontheground.Youcouldlose controlofthevehicle.
Care should be taken to avoid sudden accelerations when both rear wheels are on a slippery surface. This could cause both rear wheels to spin, and allow the vehicle to slide sideways on the crowned surface of a road or in a turn.
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
Acceleration
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs when there is a difference in the surface traction under the rear (driving) wheels.
WARNING!
Rapidacceleration on slipperysurfaces is dangerous. Unequaltraction can cause sudden pulling of therear wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle and possibly have a collision. Accelerates slowly and carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction (ice, snow, wet mud, looses and, etc.).
494 STARTING AND OPERATING
Traction
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a wedge of water to build up between the tire and road surface. This is known as hydroplaning and may cause partial or complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To reduce this possibility, the following precautions should be observed:
- Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are slushy.
- Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
- Replace tires when tread wear indicators first become visible.
- Keep tires properly inflated.
- Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a sudden stop.
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Limited Slip Differential (LSD) that reduces, but does not eliminate, the amount of wheel slip across a given axle for improved handling.
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
Driving through water more than a few inches/centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
Flowing/Rising Water
WARNING!
Donotdriveonoracrossaroadorpathwherewater isflowingand/orrising(asinstormrun-off).Flowingwatercanwearawaytheroadorpath'ssurface andcauseyourvehicletosinkintodeeperwater. Furthermore,flowingand/orrisingwatercancarry

(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
yourvehicleawayswiftly.Failuretofollowthis warningmayresultininjuriesthatareseriousor fataltoyou,yourpassengers,andothersaroundyou.
Shallow Standing Water
Although your vehicle is capable of driving through shallow standing water, consider the following Cautions and Warnings before doing so.
WARNING!
- Drivingthroughstandingwaterlimitsyourvehicle'stractioncapabilities.Donotexceed5mph (8km/h)whendrivingthroughstandingwater.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Drivingthroughstandingwaterlimitsyourvehicle'sbrakingcapabilities,whichincreasesstoppingdistances.Therefore,afterdrivingthroughstandingwater,driveslowlyandlightlypressonthebrakepedalseveraltimestodrythebrakes.
- Failuretofollowthesewarningsmayresultin injuriesthatareseriousorfataltoyou,yourpassengers,andothersaroundyou.
CAUTION!
- Alwayscheckthedepthofthestandingwater beforedrivingthroughit.Neverdrivethrough standingwaterthatisdeeperthanthebottomof thetirerimsmountedonthevehicle.
(Continued)
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Determinetheconditionoftheroadorthepath thatisunderwaterandifthereareanyobstaclesin thewaybeforedrivingthroughthestandingwater.
- Donotexceed5mph(8km/h)whendriving throughstandingwater.Thiswillminimizewave effects.
- Drivingthroughstandingwatermaycausedamage toyourvehicle'sdrivetraincomponents.Always inspectyourvehicle'sfluids(i.e.,engineoil,transmission,axle,etc.)forsignsofcontamination(i.e., fluidthatismilkyorfoamyinappearance)after drivingthroughstandingwater.Donotcontinueto operatethevehicleifanyfluidappearscontaminated,asthismayresultinfurtherdamage.Such damageisnotcoveredbytheNewVehicleLimited Warranty.
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Gettingwaterinsideyourvehicle'senginecan causeittolockupandstallout,andcauseserious internaldamagetotheengine.Suchdamageisnot coveredbytheNewVehicleLimitedWarranty.
OFF-ROAD DRIVING TIPS
Care should be taken when attempting to climb steep hills or driving diagonally across a hill or slope. If natural obstacles force you to travel diagonally up or down a hill, choose a mild angle and keep as little side tilt as possible. Keep the vehicle moving and make turns slowly and cautiously.
If you must back down a hill, back straight down using REVERSE gear. Never back down in NEUTRAL or diagonally across the hill.
When driving over sand, mud, and other soft terrain, shift to low gear and drive steadily. Apply the accelerator slowly to avoid spinning the wheels.
Do not reduce the tire pressures for this type of driving.
After Driving Off-Road
Off-road operation puts more stress on your vehicle than does most on-road driving. After going off-road, it is always a good idea to check for damage. That way you can get any problems taken care of right away and have your vehicle ready when you need it.
- Completely inspect the underbody of your vehicle. Check tires, body structure, steering, suspension, and exhaust system for damage.
-
Inspect the radiator for mud and debris and clean as required.
-
Check threaded fasteners for looseness, particularly on the chassis, drivetrain components, steering, and suspension. Retighten them, if required, and torque to the values specified in the Service Manual.
- Check for accumulations of plants or brush. These things could be a fire hazard. They might hide damage to fuel lines, brake hoses, axle pinion seals, and propeller shafts.
- After extended operation in mud, sand, water, or similar dirty conditions, have the radiator, fan, brake rotors, wheels, brake linings, and axle yokes inspected and cleaned as soon as possible.
WARNING!
Abrasivematerialinanypartofthebrakesmaycause excessivewearorunpredictablebraking.Youmight nothavefullbrakingpowerwhenyouneeditto preventacollision.Ifyouhavebeenoperatingyour vehicleindirtyconditions,getyourbrakeschecked andcleanedasnecessary.
- If you experience unusual vibration after driving in mud, slush or similar conditions, check the wheels for impacted material. Impacted material can cause a wheel imbalance and freeing the wheels of it will correct the situation.
Your vehicle is equipped with an electric vehicle recovery winch. This winch uses the electrical power from the vehicle charging system to power a motor that winds wire rope into the winch drum via planetary gear reduction. By nature, a winch is capable of generating very high forces and should be used with care. Do not operate the winch without reading and understanding the complete winch owner's manual.
TensioningTheWireRope
The winch rope must be properly tensioned before use. Follow the instructions below to tension the rope:
- Un-spool the wire rope leaving five wraps of rope on the winch drum.
- Attach the hook to a suitable anchor point.
CAUTION!
Becertaintheanchorwillwithstandtheloadrequiredtotensionthewirerope.
- Apply at least 500 lbs (227 kg) of tension to the rope while winding the rope. Always use care to ensure the rope does not pile up on one side of the drum and is neatly wound onto the drum.
CAUTION!
Wireropemustspoolonthewinchdruminthe directionindicatedonthedrumrotationdecalonthe winch.
LowVoltageInterrupt
Your winch is equipped with a device that will interrupt winch function if the vehicle charging system voltage drops to a low level. The winch will not power-in or out for 30 seconds if this device is tripped. If the interrupt is tripped, the vehicle should be operated at high idle for a few minutes to allow the vehicle charging system to recover before continuing to winch.
500 STARTING AND OPERATING
WinchMotorThermalProtection
Your winch is equipped with a thermal protection device in the motor. If the winch is operated for an excessive duration, the device may interrupt motor function to protect the winch motor. During this time the winch will power-out but will not power-in. Allow the winch motor to cool for a few minutes before continuing to winch. The winch will resume normal function once the motor cools.

Information Provided by. DEALER
Understanding The Features Of Your Winch

text_image
Technical diagram of an electric motor with numbered components and labeled parts054000966
WinchComponents

Information Provided by.
DEALER
502 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Motor: The winch motor is powered by the vehicle charging system and features a thermal protection switch that automatically stops motor function in the power-in direction if the motor gets too hot.
- RemoteSocket: The remote socket allows the remote control to be attached to the control pack to allow the winch to function.
- WinchDrumWithIntegralBrake:The winch drum allows the wire rope to be stored on the winch and transmits force to the wire rope. The winch is equipped with an integral brake that will stop rotation of the winch drum if the winch motor is stopped.
- 3-StagePlanetaryGearSet: Provides balance between speed and pulling power.
-
WireRope: The wire rope allows the winch to be connected to an anchor to provide a pulling force.
-
Clutch Lever: The clutch lever allows the winch drum to be disconnected from the winch motor to allow the wire rope to be pulled from the winch by hand.
- RemoteControl: The remote control provides the interface between the winch operator and the winch. The remote control provides the ability to power the winch in, out, and stop the winch. To operate the winch, the toggle switch is pressed down to power the winch in and up to power the winch out. The winch will stop if the switch is left in the neutral (center) position.
CAUTION!
If not installed, the hook strap must be placed on the hook.
Fairlead: The fairlead acts as a guide for the wire rope and minimizes damage to the rope.
Winch Accessories
The following accessories are necessary to attach the winch to anchors, change direction of pull, and for safe winching.

natural_image
Illustration of a pair of gloves (no text or symbols)054000967
Gloves: Wire rope, through use, will develop "barbs" which can slice skin. It is extremely important to wear protective gloves while operating the winch or handling the wire rope. Avoid loose fitting clothes or anything that could become entangled in the wire rope and other moving parts.

natural_image
3D rendered image of a mechanical clamp or bracket component (no text or symbols visible)054000968
STARTING AND OPERATING 503
Snatch/BlockPulley:Used properly, the multi-purpose snatch block allows you to (1) increase the winch's pulling power; and (2) change your pulling direction without damaging the wire rope. Proper use of the snatch block is covered in "Before You Pull."

Informationa Provident by. DEALER

natural_image
Metallic hook with a loop and mounting hole (no text or symbols)054000969
Clevis/D-Shackles: The D-Shackle is a safe means of connecting the looped ends of cables, straps and snatch blocks. The shackle's pin is threaded to allow easy removal.

054000970
TreeTrunkProtector: Typically made of tough, high-quality nylon, it provides the operator an attachment point for the winch rope to a wide variety of anchor points and objects, as well as protect living trees.
Operating Your Winch
WARNING!
Failuretoobserveanyofthesewarningsregarding properwinchusagemayresultinsevereinjury.
• Always uses supplied hookstraptohold the hook when spooling wireropeinorout.
- Neveruseasahoist.
• Neverusetomovepersons.
- Neverexceedwinchorwireroperatedcapacity.
- Alwayswearheavyleathergloveswhenhandling thewirerope.
- Nevertouchwireropeorhookwhileintensionor underload.
- Never engage or disengage clutch if winch is under load, wireropeisintension, or wireropedrumis moving.
(Continued)

WARNING!(Continued)
- Alwaysstandclearofwireropeandloadandkeep othersawayduringwinching.
- Alwayskeephandsandclothingclearofthewire rope,hookandfairleadopeningduringoperation andwhenspooling.
- Neverwrapwireropebackontoitself.Alwaysuse achokerchain,wirechokerropeortreetrunk protectorontheanchor.
- Neverattacharecoverystraptothewinchhookto increasethelengthofapull.
- Neverattempttotowavehiclewiththerecovery strapattacheddirectlytothewinchhook.
- Never use "bungee" straps that develop tremendous and potentially dangerous amountsofforcewhen stretched.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Always disconnecttheremotecontrolwhennotin use.
- Neverwinchwhentherearelessthanfivewrapsof wireropearoundthewinchdrum.
- Alwayspassremotecontrolthroughawindowto avoidpinchingleadindoor,whenusingremote insideavehicle.
- Neverleavetheremotecontrolpluggedintothe winchwhilefreespooling,riggingorsittingidle.
GeneralInformation
Practice using your winch before you get stuck. Some key points to remember when using your winch are:
- Always take your time to assess the situation and plan your pull carefully.
- Alwaystake your time when using a winch.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
506 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Use the right equipment for the situation.
- Always wear leather gloves and do not allow the wire rope to slip through your hands when handling the rope.
- Only the operator should handle the wire rope and remote control.
- Think safety at all times.
VehicleRecoveryUsingTheWinch
CAUTION!
- AlwaysKnowYourWinch: Takethetimetofully readandunderstandtheincludedInstallationand OperationsGuide, and BasicGuidetoWinching Techniques, inordertounderstandyourwinchand thewinchingoperation.
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Alwaysinspectwinchinstallationandwirerope conditionbeforeoperatingthewinch.Frayed, kinkedordamagedwireropemustbereplaced immediately. Looseordamagedwinchinstallation mustbecorrectedimmediately.
- Alwaysbesureanyelementwhichcaninterfere withsafewinchingoperationsisremovedpriorto initiatingwinching.
- Alwayskeepremotecontrolleadclearofthedrum, wireropeandrigging.
- Inspectforcracks, pinches, frayedwires, or loose connections. Replace if damaged.
- BecarefulnottopulltheWinchCableCollar throughtherollers.WatchandlistentoWinchfor propersnugness.
(Continued)

STARTING AND OPERATING 507
- Inspect the winch, winch mount, and wire rope for damage. Do not use the winch if the mount is loose or rope shows excessive wear or damage.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a coiled wire being inserted into a cylindrical component (no text or symbols)WinchRopeFreeSpool
- Disengage the clutch to allow free spooling of the winch drum, rotate the clutch lever on the winch to disengage. Freespooling conserves battery power.

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing a lever mechanism with arrows indicating motion direction (no text or symbols)-
Put on gloves.
-
Free the winch hook and attach the hook strap. Free the winch hook from its anchor point. Attach the hook strap to the hook (if not attached).

508 STARTING AND OPERATING

natural_image
Illustration of a hand connecting a car tire to a rope knot (no text or symbols)054000973

natural_image
Illustration of a mechanic using a tool to lift a car into the hood (no text or symbols present)054000974
HookStrap
- Pull the wire to the anchor point. Pull out enough wire rope to reach your anchor point. Be sure to keep a certain amount of tension on the wire as it can become twisted and over-wrapped when slackened, leading to wire rope damage. To prevent losing the end, hold the hook strap while you work.
PullingWireRope
- Secure to the anchor point. Once you have established your anchor point, secure the tree-trunk protector or choker-chain around the object.

Information Provided by: DEALER
STARTING AND OPERATING 509

natural_image
Illustration of a person cutting a pine tree with a rope, no text or symbols present054000975
TreeTrunkProtector
CAUTION!
Alwaysbecertaintheanchoryouselectwillwithstandtheload.
NOTE: Howtochooseananchorpoint: A secure anchor is critical to winching operations. An anchor must be strong enough to hold while winching. Natural anchors include trees, stumps and rocks. Hook the cable as low as possible. If no natural anchors are available when recovering another vehicle, your vehicle becomes the anchor point. In this case, be sure to put the transmission in NEUTRAL, apply the hand brake and block its wheels to prevent your vehicle from moving. Ideally, you'll want an anchor point that will enable you to pull straight in the direction the vehicle will move. This allows the wire rope to wind tightly and evenly onto the spooling drum. An anchor point as far away as possible will provide the winch with its greatest pulling power.
- Attach the Clevis/D-shackle and Tree Trunk Protector. Attach the shackle to the two ends of the strap or chain and through the hook loop, being careful not to over tighten (tighten and back-off 1/2 turn).
510 STARTING AND OPERATING

natural_image
Illustration of two hands tying a rope knot with a hook (no text or symbols)054000976
Clevis/D-Shackles
- Lock the clutch. Lock the winch drum by rotating the clutch lever on the winch to engage.
NOTE: Always ensure the clutch is fully engaged or disengaged.
- Connect the remote control to the winch control box, located behind the front bumper. Be careful not to let the remote control cord dangle in front of the winch. If you choose to control the winch from inside your vehicle, always pass the remote through a window to avoid pinching the cord in the door. Always disconnect the remote control when not in use.

Information Provided by: DEALER
STARTING AND OPERATING 511

natural_image
Close-up of a hand adjusting a mechanical component with a cylindrical pin (no visible text or symbols)WinchBoxRemoteControl
- Put wire rope under tension. Using the remote control switch, slowly wind the wire rope until no slack remains. Once the wire rope is under tension, stand well clear of it and never step over it.

natural_image
Illustration of a mechanic using a hose to clean the engine compartment of a car (no text or symbols visible)-
Check your anchor. Make sure all connections are secured and free of debris before continuing with the winching procedure.
-
Check wire rope. The wire rope should be neatly wound around the spooling drum. Improper winding can cause damage to the wire rope.

512 STARTING AND OPERATING

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing internal components including hoses and springs (no text or symbols)WireNeatlyWoundAroundTheSpoolingDrum

natural_image
3D rendering of a cylindrical electronic component with a straight line extending from its end (no text or symbols visible)In certain situations you may decide to throw a heavy blanket or similar object over the wire rope. A heavy blanket can absorb energy should the wire rope break. Place it on the wire rope midway between the winch and the anchor point. Do this before the wire rope is put under ten-
sion. Do not approach or move the blanket once tension is applied. Do not allow it to get pulled into the fairlead. If it is necessary to move or remove the blanket, slack the tension on the wire rope first.
- Establish "no people" zones: Make your intentions clear. Be sure that everyone in the immediate vicinity surrounding the winching operation is completely aware of your intentions before you pull. Declare wherethespectatorsshouldnotstand-never

STARTING AND OPERATING 513
behindorinfrontofthevehicleandnevernearthe wireropeorsnatchblock.Yoursituationmayhave other"nopeople"zones.


natural_image
Simple mechanical diagram showing two connected components with a central shaft (no text or symbols)054000981
NoPeopleZones
- Begin winching. With the winching vehicles engine on and light tension already on the wire rope, begin winching slowly and steadily. Be sure that the wire
rope is winding evenly and tightly around the spooling drum. For additional assistance, the winched vehicle can be slowly driven while being pulled by the winch. Continue pulling until the vehicle is on stable ground. If you are able to drive the vehicle, the winching operation is complete.

natural_image
Illustration of a man sitting in a car, holding a smartphone, with no visible text or symbols on the vehicle or background.UsingTheRemoteControl

Information Provider Syc.
DEALER
514 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
- Avoid overheating the winch motor. For extended winching, stop at reasonable intervals to allow the winch motor to cool down.
- Whatolookforunderload:The wire rope must always spool onto the drum as indicated by the drum rotation decal on the winch. As you power-in, make sure the wire rope winds evenly and tightly on the drum. This prevents the outer wire wraps from drawing into the inner wraps, binding and damaging the wire rope. Avoid shock loads by using the control switch intermittently to take up wire rope slack. Shock loads can momentarily far exceed the winch and wire rope ratings. During side pulls the wire rope tends to stack up at one end of the drum. This stack can become large enough to cause serious damage to the winch. So, line up pulls as straight ahead as possible and stop winching if the wire rope comes close to the tie rods or mounting plate. To fix
an uneven stack, spool out that section of the rope and reposition it to the opposite end of the drum, which will free up space for continued winching.
- Secure vehicle. Once recovery of the vehicle is complete, be sure to secure the vehicle's brakes and shift the transmission to PARK. Release tension in the wire rope.
- Disconnect the wire rope, and disconnect from the anchor.
- Rewind the wire rope. The person handling the wire rope should walk the rope in and not let it slide through the hand, control the winch at all times.
STARTING AND OPERATING 515

natural_image
Illustration of a mechanic using a tool to clean the engine compartment of a car (no text or symbols visible)WARNING!
Topreventseriousinjury, NEVERputyourfingers insidethehookareaasyouarepowering-in.
NOTE:Howtospoolundernoload:Arrange the remote control lead so it cannot be caught in the winch. Arrange the wire rope so it will not kink or tangle when spooled. Be sure any wire rope already on the spooling drum is wound tightly and evenly layered. Tighten and straighten the layer if necessary. Keep the wire rope under light tension and spool the wire rope back and onto the winch drum in even layers. Stop frequently to tighten and straighten the layers as necessary. Repeat this process until the winch hook is the same distance as the full length of the remote control from the winch. Pinch the hook between your thumb and forefinger and attach the hook strap. Hold the hook strap between the thumb and forefinger to keep tension on the wire rope. Walk the wire rope towards the fairlead, carefully spooling in the remaining wire rope. By pulsing the remote control switch.
- Store the hook on the most outboard loop of the tow hook.

516 STARTING AND OPERATING

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a cable being inserted into a vehicle chassis (no text or symbols visible)HookInStoredPosition
- Disconnect the remote control. Disconnect the remote control cord from the control box and store in a clean and dry place. Winching operations are now complete. Put the cap on the solenoid plug-in.
NOTE: Always store the remote control in a protected, clean, dry area.
Rigging Techniques
Various winching situations will require application of other winching techniques. These could range from too little distance to achieve maximum pull using straight line rigging, simply increasing pulling power, or maintaining a straight-line pulling situation. You will have to assess what technique is correct for your situation. Think "safety" at all times.

HowToChangeThePullingDirection

natural_image
Top-down diagram of a car with two cars connected by a pulley, no text or symbols presentChangePullingDirections
054000984
STARTING AND OPERATING 517
All winching operations should have a straight line from the winch to the object being pulled. This minimizes the wire rope collecting on one side of the drum affecting pulling efficiency and damaging wire rope. A snatch block, secured to a point directly in front of the vehicle will enable you to change your pulling direction while still allowing the wire rope to be at 90^ to wind properly onto the spooling drum.
IncreasingPullingPower
In some cases, you may find yourself needing more pulling power. The use of snatch blocks increases mechanical advantage and that increases your pulling power.

Information Provided by DEALER
518 STARTING AND OPERATING
DoubleLine

natural_image
Illustration of a car being connected to a plug, with hands connecting the plug to the engine (no text or symbols present)054000986
Because pulling power decreases with the number of layers of wire rope on the winch drum, you can use a snatch block to double line out more wire rope. This decreases the number of layers of wire rope on the drum, and increases pulling power. Start by feeding out enough wire rope to free the winch hook. Attach the hook to your vehicle's frame/tow hook and run the wire rope through a snatch block. Disengage the clutch and, using the snatch block, pull out enough wire to reach your anchor point. Do not attach the hook to the mounting kit. Secure to the anchor point with a tree trunk protector or choker chain. Attach the clevis/shackle. Attach the shackle to the two ends of the strap/chain, being careful not to over tighten (tighten and back-off 1/2 turn).
POWER STEERING — 1500 MODELS
The electric power steering system will give you good vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability in tight spaces. The system will vary its assist to provide light efforts while parking and good feel while driving. If the electric steering system experiences a fault that prevents it from providing assist, you will still have the ability to steer the vehicle manually.

If the Steering icon is flashing, it indicates that the vehicle needs to be taken to the dealer for service. It is likely the vehicle has lost power steering assistance.
If the Steering icon is displayed and the "POWER STEERING SYSTEM OVER TEMP" message is displayed on the EVIC screen, they indicate that extreme steering maneuvers may have occurred which caused an over temperature condition in the power steering system. Once driving conditions are safe, pull over and let the vehicle idle for a few moments until the icon and message turn off. Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If the Steering icon is displayed and the "SERVICE POWER STEERING – ASSIST OFF" message is displayed the EVIC screen, they indicate the vehicle needs to be taken to the dealer for service. Refer to "Electronic
Vehicle Information (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
NOTE:
- Even if the power steering assistance is no longer operational, it is still possible to steer the vehicle. Under these conditions there will be a substantial increase in steering effort, especially at low speeds and during parking maneuvers.
- If the condition persists, see your authorized dealer for service.
POWER STEERING — 2500/3500 MODELS
The standard power steering system will give you good vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability in tight spaces. The system will provide mechanical steering capability if power assist is lost.

520 STARTING AND OPERATING
If for some reason the power assist is interrupted, it will still be possible to steer your vehicle. Under these conditions, you will observe a substantial increase in steering effort, especially at very low vehicle speeds and during parking maneuvers.
NOTE:
- Increased noise levels at the end of the steering wheel travel are considered normal and do not indicate that there is a problem with the power steering system.
- Upon initial start-up in cold weather, the power steering pump may make noise for a short amount of time. This is due to the cold, thick fluid in the steering system. This noise should be considered normal, and it does not in any way damage the steering system.
CAUTION!
Prolongedoperationofthesteeringsystemattheend ofthesteeringwheeltravelwillincreasethesteering fluidtemperatureanditshouldbeavoidedwhen possible.Damagetothepowersteeringpumpmay occur.
Power Steering Fluid Check — 2500/3500 Models
Checking the power steering fluid level at a defined service interval is not required. The fluid should only be checked if a leak is suspected, abnormal noises are apparent, and/or the system is not functioning as anticipated. Coordinate inspection efforts through an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
Donotusechemicalflushesinyourpowersteering systemasthechemicalscandamageyourpower steeringcomponents.Suchdamageisnotcoveredby theNewVehicleLimitedWarranty.
WARNING!
Fluidlevelshouldbecheckedonalevelsurfaceand withtheengineofftopreventinjuryfrommoving partsandtoensureaccuratefluidlevelreading.Do notoverfill.Useonlymanufacturer'srecommended powersteeringfluid.
If necessary, add fluid to restore to the proper indicated level. With a clean cloth, wipe any spilled fluid from all surfaces. Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.
FUEL SAVER TECHNOLOGY 5.7L/6.4L ENGINES ONLY — IF EQUIPPED
This feature offers improved fuel economy by shutting off four of the engine's eight cylinders during light load and cruise conditions. The system is automatic with no driver inputs or additional driving skills required.
NOTE: This system may take some time to return to full functionality after a battery disconnect.
PARKING BRAKE
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking brake is fully applied. Also, be certain to leave the transmission in PARK.
The foot operated parking brake is located below the lower left corner of the instrument panel. To apply the park brake, firmly push the park brake pedal fully. To release the parking brake, pull the parking brake release handle.

522 STARTING AND OPERATING

natural_image
Interior view of a car's seat and dashboard area showing a parking slot and foot pedal (no text or symbols visible)ParkingBrakeRelease
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition switch ON, the "Brake Warning Light" in the instrument cluster will illuminate.
NOTE:
- When the parking brake is applied and the transmission is placed in gear, the "Brake Warning Light" will flash. If vehicle speed is detected, a chime will sound to alert the driver. Fully release the parking brake before attempting to move the vehicle.
- This light only shows that the parking brake is applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade. Apply the parking brake before placing the shift lever in PARK, otherwise the load on the transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. The parking brake should always be applied whenever the driver is not in the vehicle.

WARNING!
- NeverusethePARKpositionasasubstituteforthe parkingbrake.Alwaysapplytheparkingbrake fullywhenparkedtoguardagainstvehiclemovementandpossibleinjuryordamage.
- Neverleavechildrenaloneinavehicle,orwith accesstoanunlockedvehicle.Leavingunattended childreninavehicleisdangerousforanumberof reasons.Achildorotherscouldbeseriouslyor fatallyinjured.
- DonotleavetheKeyFobinornethevehicle,or inalocationaccessibletochildren,anddonot leaveavehicleequippedwithKeylessEnter-N-Go™intheACCorON/RUNmode.Achildcould operatepowerwindows,othercontrols,ormove thevehicle.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Besuretheparkingbrakeisfullydisengaged beforedriving;failuretodosocanleadtobrake failureandacollision.
- Alwaysfullyapplytheparkingbrakewhenleavingyourvehicleoritmayrollandcausedamageor injury. Also, becertaintoleavethetransmissionin PARK. Failuretodosomaycausethevehicletoroll andcausedamageorinjury.
CAUTION!
IftheBrakeSystemWarningLightremainsonwith theparkingbrakereleased,abrakesystemmalfunctionisindicated.Havethebrakesystemservicedby anauthorizeddealerimmediately.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
524 STARTING AND OPERATING
BRAKE SYSTEM
If power assist is lost for any reason (for example, repeated brake applications with the engine off), the brakes will still function. However, you will experience a substantial increase in braking effort to stop the vehicle.
If either the front or rear hydraulic system loses normal braking capability, the remaining system will still function with some loss of overall braking effectiveness. This will be evident by increased pedal travel during application, greater pedal force required to slow or stop, and activation of the “Brake Warning Light” and the “ABS Warning Light” (if equipped) during brake use.
Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System
WARNING!
The Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System contains sophisticated electronicequipment. It may be susceptible to interference caused by improperly installed or high output radiotransmitting equipment. This interference can cause possible loss of anti-lock braking capability. Installation of such equipment should be performed by qualified professionals.
The Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) is designed to aid the driver in maintaining vehicle control under adverse braking conditions. The system operates with a separate computer to modulate hydraulic pressure to prevent wheel lockup and help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
The system's pump motor runs during an ABS stop to provide regulated hydraulic pressure. The pump motor makes a low humming noise during operation. This is normal.
The ABS conducts a low-speed selftest at about 10 mph (16 km/h). If you have your foot lightly on the brake while this test is occurring, you may feel slight pedal movement. The movement can be more apparent on ice and snow. This is normal.
When you are in a severe braking condition involving use of the ABS, you will experience some pedal drop as the vehicle comes to a complete stop. This is the result of the system reverting to the base brake system and is normal.
Engagement of the ABS may be accompanied by a pulsing sensation. You may also hear a clicking noise. These occurrences are normal, and indicate that the system is functioning.
ABSWarningLight
The ABS includes an amber warning light. When the light is illuminated, the ABS is not functioning. The system reverts to standard, non-anti-lock brakes.
WARNING!
- Pumpingoftheanti-lockbrakeswilldiminish theireffectivenessandmayleadtoacollision.
Pumpingmakethestoppingdistancelonger.Just pressfirmlyonyourbrakepedalwhenyouneedto slowdownorstop. - The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the extraction afforded.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- The ABScannotpreventcollisions, including those resulting from excessivespeedinturns, following another vehicle to closely, or hydroplaning.
- The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must never be exploited in areckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user's safety or the safety of others.
Hydraulic Brake Assist — 2500/3500 Models Only (Except Power Wagon)
The brake system power assist is provided by a hydro-boost unit which shares fluid with the power steering system. You may experience some clicking or hissing noises from the hydro-boost system during hard braking conditions.
NOTE: Under cold temperatures, pedal effort will be higher than normal until the power steering fluid reaches operating temperature.
Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced electronic brake control system that includes Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), Traction Control System (TCS), Brake Assist System (BAS), Electronic Roll Mitigation (ERM), Hill Start Assist (HSA), Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and Trailer Sway Control (TSC). All of the systems work together to enhance vehicle stability and control in various driving conditions, and are commonly referred to as ESC.
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
The ABS aids the driver in maintaining vehicle control under adverse braking conditions. The system controls hydraulic brake pressure to prevent wheel lockup and help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces during braking.
NOTE: ABS improves steering control of the vehicle during hard braking maneuvers.
WARNING!
- ABScannotpreventthenaturallawsofphysics fromactingonthevehicle,norcanitincrease brakingorsteeringefficiencybeyondthatafforded bytheconditionofthevehiclebrakesandtiresor thetractionafforded.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- The ABScannotpreventcollisions, including those resulting from excessivespeedinturns, following another vehicle to closely, or hydroplaning.
- The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must never be exploited in areckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user's safety or the safety of others.
Traction Control System (TCS) — If Equipped
The TCS monitors the amount of wheel spin of each of the driven wheels. If wheel spin is detected, brake pressure is applied to the slipping wheel(s), and engine power is reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and stability. A feature of the TCS functions similarly to a limited-slip differential and controls the wheel spin across a driven axle. If one wheel on a driven axle is spinning faster than the other, the system will apply the

528 STARTING AND OPERATING
brake of the spinning wheel. This will allow more engine torque to be applied to the wheel that is not spinning. This feature remains active even if TCS and ESC are in the "Partial Off" mode. Refer to "Electronic Stability Control (ESC)" in this section of this manual. This brake pressure modulation transfers drive torque from slipping to non-slipping wheels to provide optimal forward traction.
Brake Assist System (BAS) — If Equipped
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle's braking capability during emergency braking maneuvers. The BAS detects an emergency braking situation by sensing the rate and amount of brake application and then applies optimum pressure to the brakes. The system applies optimum pressure to the brakes in emergency braking conditions. This can help reduce braking distances. The BAS complements the ABS. Applying the brakes very quickly results in the best BAS assistance. To receive the benefit of BAS, you must apply continuous braking pressure during the stopping sequence. Do not reduce brake pedal pressure unless braking is no longer desired.
Once the brake pedal is released, the BAS is deactivated.
WARNING!
- The BAS cannot prevent then natural law so physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded.
- The BAS cannot prevent collisions, including those resulting from excessive speedinturns, following another vehicle to closely, or hydroplaning.
(Continued)

WARNING!(Continued)
- The capabilities of a BAS-equipped vehicle must never be exploited in areckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user's safety or the safety of others.
Hill Start Assist (HSA) — If Equipped
The HSA system is designed to assist the driver in launching a vehicle on an incline. HSA will maintain the level of brake pressure the driver inputs for a short duration once the driver takes his foot off of the brake pedal. If the driver does not apply the throttle during this short duration, the system will release brake pressure and the vehicle will roll down the incline. The system will release brake pressure in proportion to the amount of throttle applied.
During operation, HSA will activate the brake control system and a clicking noise may occur. If your foot is on the brake pedal during operation you may feel a slight pedal movement. The clicking and pedal movement is normal and both will stop when HSA becomes inactive.
HSAActivationCriteria
The following criteria must be met in order for HSA to activate:
- Vehicle must be stopped
- Vehicle must be on an approximate 7% or greater incline
- Gear selection matches vehicle uphill direction (i.e., vehicle facing uphill is in forward gear; vehicle backing uphill is in REVERSE gear).
WARNING!
Theremaybesituationsonminorhillswithloaded vehicleorwhilepullingatrailerwherethesystem willnotactivateandslightrollingmayoccur,which couldcauseacollisionwithanothervehicleorobject. Alwaysrememberthedriverisresponsibleforbrakingthevehicle.
The system will only work if the intended direction of the vehicle and vehicle gear match. For example, if the intended direction is forward up a hill and the vehicle is in DRIVE and the activation criteria are met, HSA will activate.
The system will work in REVERSE and all forward gears, and will not activate if the vehicle is placed in NEU-TRAL.
TowingAndHaulingWithHSA
The HSA system does not know if your vehicle is loaded or towing a trailer unless the TOW/HAUL switch, located on the center stack, is selected. When activated, the "TOW/HAUL Indicator Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster. Refer to "Automatic Transmission" in "Starting and Operating" for further information. In order to accommodate the extra weight entailed under towing and hauling conditions and to increase driver comfort while launching on a hill, the system recognizes when the TOW/HAUL switch is activated and compensates by releasing brake pressure at a slower rate while throttle is applied in order to prevent the vehicle from rolling down the hill.

WARNING!
- If you use a trailer brake controller with your trailer, your trailer brakes may be activated and deactivated with the brakes switch. If so, when the brake pedal is released, ther may not been enough brake pressure to hold the vehicle and trailer on a hill and this could cause a collision with another vehicle or object behind you. In order to avoid rolling down the inclinewhileresuming acceleration, manually activate the trailer brake or apply more vehicle brake pressure prioritoreleasing the brake pedal. Always remember the driver responsible for braking the vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- HSAisnotaparkingbrake. If you stop the vehicle on a hill without putting the transmission in PARK or using the parking brake, it will rolldown the incline and could collidewith another vehicle, object person, and causes serious or fatal injury. Always remember to set the parking brakewhile parking on a hill and that the driver is responsible for braking the vehicle.
HSAOff
Non-EVICEquippedVehicles
If you wish to turn off the HSA system, follow this procedure:
-
Start with the engine OFF, and the vehicle in PARK with the wheels straight.
-
Start the engine.

532 STARTING AND OPERATING
- With the engine running and the brake applied, rotate the steering wheel 180^ counterclockwise from center.
- Press the "ESC Off" switch four times within 20 seconds. The "ESC Off Indicator Light" should appear and disappear four times.
- Rotate the steering wheel 360^ clockwise.
- Cycle ignition switch OFF then ON.
- If the sequence was completed properly, the "ESC Off Indicator Light" will blink several times to confirm HSA is off.
Steps 1 through 7 must be completed within 90 seconds to turn off HSA. Repeat steps 1 through 7 to re-enable HSA functionality.
EVICEquippedVehicles
HSA is a Customer Programmable Feature on an EVIC equipped vehicle. If you wish to turn off the HSA feature, refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Customer Programmable Features" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) — If Equipped
The ESC system enhances directional control and stability of the vehicle under various driving conditions. ESC corrects for oversteering or understeering of the vehicle by applying the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting the oversteer or understeer condition. Engine power may also be reduced to help the vehicle maintain the desired path.
ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the vehicle path intended by the driver and compares it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual path does not match the intended path, ESC applies the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting the oversteer or understeer condition.

•Oversteer - when the vehicle is turning more than appropriate for the steering wheel position.
- Understeer - when the vehicle is turning less than appropriate for the steering wheel position.
WARNING!
ElectronicStabilityControl(ESC) cannot prevent the naturallawsofphysicsfromactingonthevehicle, norcanitincreaseethetractionaffordedbyprevailing roadconditions. ESC cannot prevent accidents, includingthoseresultingfromexcessivespeedin turns, drivingonveryslippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. ESCals cannot prevent accidents resulting from lossofvehiclecontrolduetoin appropriate driverinputfortheconditions. Only asafe, attentive, and skillfuldriver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must never be
WARNING!(Continued)
exploitedinarecklessordangerousmannerwhich couldjeopardizetheuser'ssafetyorthesafetyof others.
AllTwo-WheelDriveVehiclesAndFour-Wheel DriveVehiclesIn2WD,4WDAUTO,Or4WD LOCKModesCanChooseTheFollowingESC OperatingModes:
ESCON
This is the normal operating mode for ESC in 2WD/4WD AUTO/4WD LOCK modes and in 2WD vehicles. Whenever the vehicle is started or the transfer case (if equipped) is shifted from 4WD LOW or Neutral, back to 4WD LOCK or 4WD AUTO, the ESC system will be in this mode. This mode should be used for almost all driving situations. ESC should only be turned to "Partial Off" or "ESC Off" for specific reasons as noted below.
534 STARTING AND OPERATING
ESCPartialOff
This mode is entered by momentarily pressing the "ESC Off" switch. When in "Partial Off" mode, the TCS portion of ESC, except for the "limited slip" feature described in the TCS section, has been disabled and the "ESC Off Indicator Light" will be illuminated. All other stability features of ESC function normally. This mode is intended to be used if the vehicle is in deep snow, sand, or gravel conditions and more wheel spin than TCS would normally allow is required to gain traction. To turn ESC on again, momentarily press the "ESC Off" switch. This will restore the normal "ESC On" mode of operation.
NOTE: To improve the vehicle's traction when driving with snow chains or starting off in deep snow, sand or gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the "Partial Off" mode by pressing the "ESC Off" switch. Once the situation requiring ESC to be switched to the "Partial Off" mode is overcome, turn ESC back on by momentarily pressing the "ESC Off" switch. This may be done while the vehicle is in motion.

Information Provided by. DEALER
WARNING!
- Whenin"PartialOff"mode,theTCSfunctionality ofESC,(exceptforthelimitedslipfeaturedescribedintheTCSsection),hasbeendisabledand the"ESCOffIndicatorLight"willbeilluminated. Whenin"PartialOff"mode,theenginepower reductionfeatureofTCSisdisabled,andthe enhancedvehiclestabilityofferedbytheESCsystemisreduced.
- TrailerSwayControl(TSC)isdisabledwhenthe ESCsystemisinthe"PartialOff"mode.
AllFour-WheelDriveVehiclesIn4WDAUTOAnd 4WDLOCKModesCanAlsoChooseThe FollowingESCOperatingMode.ThisIsTheOnly SelectableESCOperatingModein4WDLOW:
FullOff
This mode is intended for off-road use when ESC stability features could inhibit vehicle maneuverability due to trail conditions. This mode is entered by pressing and holding the "ESC Off" switch for five seconds when the vehicle is stopped and the engine is running. After five seconds, the "ESC Off Indicator Light" will illuminate. Press and release the trip odometer button located on the instrument cluster to clear this message.
NOTE: The "ESC OFF" message will display and the audible chime will sound when the shift lever is placed into the PARK position from any other position and then moved out of the PARK position. This will occur even if the message was previously cleared.

In this mode, ESC and TCS except for the “limited slip” feature described in the TCS section are turned off until the vehicle reaches a speed of 40 mph (64 km/h). At 40 mph (64 km/h) the system returns to “Partial Off” mode, described above. When the vehicle speed drops below 35 mph (56 km/h) the ESC system shuts off. ESC is off at low vehicle speeds so that it will not interfere with off-road driving but ESC function returns to provide the stability feature at speeds above 40 mph (64 km/h). The “ESC Off Indicator Light” will always be illuminated when ESC is off. To turn ESC on again, momentarily press the “ESC Off” switch. This will restore the normal “ESC On” mode of operation.
"ESC Off" is the only operating mode for ESC in 4WD LOW. Whenever the vehicle is started in 4WD LOW or the transfer case (if equipped) is shifted from 4WD LOCK or NEUTRAL, to 4WD LOW, the ESC system will be in this mode.
WARNING!
IntheESC"FullOff"mode,theenginetorquereductionandstabilityfeaturesaredisabled.Therefore, theenhancedvehiclestabilityofferedbyESCis unavailable.Inanemergencyevasivemaneuverthe ESCsystemwillnotengagetoassistinmaintaining stability."ESCOff"modeisintendedforoff-highwayoroff-roaduseonly.
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And ESC OFF Indicator Light

The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” in the instrument cluster will come on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position. It should go out with the engine. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator comes on continuously with the engine running, a

malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this light remains on after several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” (located in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as the tires lose traction and the ESC system becomes active. The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” also flashes when TCS is active. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” begins to flash during acceleration, ease up on the accelerator and apply as little throttle as possible. Be sure to adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road conditions.
NOTE:
- The "ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light" and the "ESC OFF Indicator Light" come on momentarily each time the ignition switch is turned ON.
• Each time the ignition is turned ON, the ESC system will be ON even if it was turned off previously. - The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver that caused the ESC activation.

The “ESC OFF Indicator Light” indicates the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is partially off.

Information Provided by: DEALER
538 STARTING AND OPERATING
Trailer Sway Control (TSC) — If Equipped
The TSC system uses sensors in the vehicle to recognize an excessively swaying trailer and will take the appropriate actions to attempt to stop the sway. The system may reduce engine power and apply the brake of the appropriate wheel(s) to counteract the sway of the trailer. TSC will become active automatically once an excessively swaying trailer is recognized. No driver action is required to activate. Note that TSC cannot stop all trailers from swaying. Always use caution when towing a trailer and follow the trailer tongue weight recommendations. Refer to "Trailer Towing" in "Starting and Operating" for further information. When TSC is functioning, the "ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light" will flash, the engine power may be reduced and you may feel the brakes being applied to individual wheels to attempt to stop the trailer from swaying. TSC is disabled when the ESC system is in the "Partial Off" or "Full Off" modes.
TSC is only active in the default “ESC On” mode. TSC can be disabled by pressing the “ESC Off” switch and entering “ESC Partial Off” mode. It is not active in the “ESC Partial Off” or “ESC Off” modes. Refer to the ESC portion of this section for an explanation of the different ESC operating modes.
WARNING!
IfTSCactivateswhiledriving,slowthevehicle down,stopathenearestsafelocation,andadjustthe trailerloadtoeliminatetrailersway.
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
Tire Markings

text_image
P215/65R15 95H MANUFACTURER TIRE NAME FEVATION TO INJECTION TENDER 0549037731 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards 4 — Maximum Load Code (TIN)
2 — Size Designation 5 — Maximum Pressure
3 — Service Description 6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
NOTE:
- P (Passenger) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S. design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter "P" molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
- European-Metric tire sizing is based on European design standards. Tires designed to this standard have the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with the section width. The letter "P" is absent from this tire size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
- LT (Light Truck) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S. design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the letters "LT" that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
540 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary emergency use only. Temporary high pressure compact spare tires have the letter "T" or "S" molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: T145/80D18 103M.
- High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
TireSizingChart
| EXAMPLE: |
| SizeDesignation: |
| P= Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards"....blank....." = Passenger car tire based on European design standardsLT= Light truck tire based on U.S. design standardsT o r S = Temporary spare tire31= Overall diameter in inches (in) |
| 215= Section width in millimeters (mm) |
| 65= Aspect ratio in percent (%)– Ratio of section height to section width of tire10.5= Section width in inches (in) |

Information Provided by: DEALER
| EXAMPLE: |
| R= Construction code- "R"means radial construction- "D"means diagonal or bias construction |
| 15= Rim diameter in inches (in) |
| ServiceDescription: |
| 95= Load Index- A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry |
| H= Speed Symbol- A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to its load index under certain operating conditions- The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and posted speed limits) |
542 STARTING AND OPERATING
| EXAMPLE: |
| LoadIdentification: |
| "....blank....." = Absence of any text on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire |
| ExtraLoad(XL)= Extra load (or reinforced) tire |
| LightLoad(LL)= Light load tire |
| C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure |
| MaximumLoad- Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry |
| Maximum Pressure - Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire |
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard side of the tire.
STARTING AND OPERATING 543
| EXAMPLE: |
| DOTMAL9ABCD0301 |
| DOT= Department of Transportation- This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire safety standards and is approved for highway use |
| MA= Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits) |
| L9= Code representing the tire size (two digits) |
| ABCD= Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits) |
| 03= Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)- 03 means the 3rd week |
| 01= Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)- 01 means the year 2001- Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991 |
544 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Terminology And Definitions
| TermDefinition | |
| B-PillarThe vehicle B-Pillar | is the structural member of the body located behind the front door. |
| ColdTireInflationPressureCold tire in | flation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a three hour period. In-flation pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per square inch) or kPa (kilopascals). |
| MaximumInflationPressureThe maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation pressure is molded into the sidewall. | |
| RecommendedColdTireInflationPres-sure | Vehicle manufacturer's recommended cold tire inflation pressure as shown on the tire placard. |
| TirePlacardA paper label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the vehicle's loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures. | |
STARTING AND OPERATING 545
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
TireAndLoadingInformationPlacardLocation
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the driver's side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver's side door.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the door, seat, and window (no text or symbols visible)B-PillarLocationForTireAndLoadingInformation Placard

Informationa Provident by. DEALER
546 STARTING AND OPERATING
TireAndLoadingInformationPlacard

text_image
TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION SEATING CAPACITY - TOTAL 5 FRONT 2 REAR 3 THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX KG OR XXX LBS. TIRE FRONT REAR SPARE ORIGINAL TIRE SIZE P195/70R14 P195/70R14 T125/70D15 COLD TIRE INFLATION PRESSURE 200kPa, 29PSI 200kPa, 29PSI 420kPa, 60PSI SEE OWNER'S MANUAL FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 4N109268TireAndLoadingInformationPlacard
This placard tells you important information about the:
- Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
- Total weight your vehicle can carry.
- Tire size designed for your vehicle.
- Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and spare tires.
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You will not exceed the tire's load carrying capacity if you adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading Information placard and in the "Vehicle Loading" section of this manual.

NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition, gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear axles must not be exceeded. For further information on GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to "Vehicle Loading" in this section.
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your vehicle, locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or XXX kg" on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed the weight referenced here.
StepsForDeterminingCorrectLoadLimit
-
Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or XXX kg" on your vehicle's placard.
-
Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
- Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
- The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if "XXX" amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will be five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs (340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) - 750 lbs (340 kg) = 650 lbs [295 kg]).
- Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
548 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
- If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. The following table shows examples on how to calculate total load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities of your vehicle with varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. This table is for illustration purposes only and may not be accurate for the seating and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
- For the following example, the combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs (392 kg).

Information Provided by. DEALER

text_image
Occupants TOTAL FRONT REAR Combined weight of occupants and cargo from Tire Placard MINUS Combined Occupant's weight = AVAILABLE Cargo/Luggage and Trailer Tongue Weight EXAMPLE 1 5 2 3 865 lbs minus 670 lbs = 195 lbs EXAMPLE 2 3 2 1 865 lbs minus 540 lbs = 325 lbs EXAMPLE 3 2 2 0 865 lbs minus 400 lbs = 465 lbs E X A M P E811a4d11

Information Provided by
DEALER
法定代表人:王伟 二、批准事项
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading can cause it re failure, affect vehicle handling, and increase your stopping distance. Usetires of the recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Three primary areas are affected by improper tire pressure:
•Safety
• Economy
• Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
Safety
WARNING!
- Improperlyinflatedtiresaredangerousandcan causecollisions.
- Under-inflationincreasestireflexingandcanresultinover-heatingandtirefailure.
• Over-inflationreducesatire'sabilitytocushion shock. Objectsontheroadandchuckholescan causedamagethatresultintirefailure.
• Over-inflatedorunder-inflatedtirescanaffective-vehiclehandlingandcanfailsuddenly, resulting in lossofvehiclecontrol. - Unequaltirepressurescancausesteeringproblems.Youcouldlosecontrolofyourvehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Unequaltirepressuresfromonesideofthevehicle totheothercancausethevehicletodrifttothe rightorleft.
- Alwaysdrivewitheachtireinflatedtotherecommendedcoldtireinflationpressure.
Economy
Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the tire tread. These abnormal wear patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need for earlier tire replacement. Under-inflation also increases tire rolling resistance resulting in higher fuel consumption.
RideComfortAndVehicleStability
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride. Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable ride. Both underinflation and over-inflation affect the stability of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of sluggish response or over responsiveness in the steering.
NOTE:
- Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause erratic and unpredictable steering response.
- Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the vehicle to drift left or right.
552 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Inflation Pressures
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the driver's side B-Pillar or rear edge of the driver's side door.
At least once a month:
- Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality pocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual judgement when determining proper inflation. Tires may look properly inflated even when they are under-inflated.
- Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage.
CAUTION!
Afterinspectingoradjustingthetirepressure,always reinstallthevalvestemcap.Thiswillpreventmoisture anddirtfromenteringthevalvestem,whichcould damagethevalvestem.
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always "cold tire inflation pressure." Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with temperature changes.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per 12^ F ( 7^ C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in the winter.

Example: If garage temperature = 68^ F ( 20^ C) and the outside temperature = 32^ F ( 0^ C) then the cold tire inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa), which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12^ F ( 7^ C) for this outside temperature condition.
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa) during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle loading may be required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to your authorized tire dealer or original equipment vehicle dealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
WARNING!
Highspeeddrivingwithyourvehicleundermaxi- mumloadisdangerous.Theaddedstrainonyour tirescouldcausethemtofail.Youcouldhavea seriouscollision.Donotdriveavehicleloadedtothe maximumcapacityatcontinuousspeedsabove 75mph(120km/h).
Radial Ply Tires
WARNING!
Combiningradialplytireswithothertypesoftires onyourvehiclewillcauseyourvehicletohandle poorly.Theinstabilitycouldcauseacollision.Alwaysuseradialplytiresinsetsoffour.Never combinethemwithothertypesoftires.
554 STARTING AND OPERATING
TireRepair
If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it meets the following criteria:
- The tire has not been driven on when flat.
- The damage is only on the tread section of your tire (sidewall damage is not repairable).
- The puncture is no greater than 14''(6~mm) .
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and additional information.
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and service description (Load Index and Speed Code).
Tire Types
AllSeasonTires—IfEquipped
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (spring, summer, fall and winter). Traction levels may vary between different all season tires. All season tires can be identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
SummerOrThreeSeasonTires—IfEquipped
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or on ice. If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be aware these tires are not designed for winter or cold driving conditions. For more information, contact a authorized dealer. Summer tires do not contain the all season designation or mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall.

Use summer tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
SnowTires
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires during the winter. Snow tires can be identified by a mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall.
If you need snow tires, select tires equivalent in size and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what was originally equipped with your vehicle and should not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph (120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be checked before using these tire types.
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles (80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat mode.

See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
Spare Tires — If Equipped
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with TIREFIT instead of a spare tire, please refer to "TIREFIT KIT" in "What To Do In Emergencies" for further information.
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, donottake your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a compact, full size or limited -usetemporary spare installed. Damageto the vehicle may result.
SpareTireMatchingOriginalEquippedTireAndWheel—IfEquipped
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and wheel equivalent in look and function to the original equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option, refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended tire rotation pattern.
CompactSpareTire—IfEquipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only. You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a compact spare by looking at the spare tire description on the Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the driver's side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire. Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter "T" or "S" preceding the size designation. Example: T145/80D18 103M.
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
Since this tire has limited tread life, the original equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire. Do not install more than one compact spare tire and wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
WARNING!
Compactsparesarefortemporaryemergencyuse only.Withthesespares,donotdrivemorethan 50mph(80km/h).Temporaryusespareshavelimited treadlife.Whenthetreadisworntothetreadwear indicators,thetemporaryusesparetireneedstobe replaced.Besuretofollowthewarnings,which applytoyourspare.Failureretodosocouldresultin sparetirefailureandlossofvehiclecontrol .
FullSizeSpare—IfEquipped
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only. This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size spare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the first opportunity.
Limited-UseSpare—IfEquipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as

558 STARTING AND OPERATING
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the first opportunity.
WARNING!
Limited-usesparesareforemergencyuseonly.Installationofthislimited-usesparetireaffectsvehicle handling.Withthistire,donotdrivemorethanthe speedlistedonthelimit-usesparewheel.Keep inflatedtothecoldtireinflationpressureslistedon yourTireandLoadingInformationPlacardlocated onthedriver'ssideB-Pillarortherearedgeofthe driver'ssidedoor.Replace(orrepair)theoriginal equipmenttireatthefirstopportunityandreinstallit onyourvehicle.Failureretodosocouldresultinloss ofvehiclecontrol.
Tire Spinning
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not spin your vehicle's wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping.
Refer to "Freeing A Stuck Vehicle" in "What To Do In Emergencies" for further information.
WARNING!
Fastspinningtirescanbedangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause it damaged or failure. Atire could explode and injuresome one. Donot spiny our vehicle's wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) form more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and donot let any on near aspinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
STARTING AND OPERATING 559
Tread Wear Indicators
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires to help you in determining when your tires should be replaced.

natural_image
Two views of a car tire showing tread pattern and side profile (no text or symbols)055007576
1 — WornTire
2—New Tire
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth becomes 1/16 in (2 mm). When the tread is worn to the tread wear indicators, the tire should be replaced. Refer to "Replacement Tires" in this section for further information.
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying factors including, but not limited to:
- Driving style
- Tire pressure
- Distance driven
- Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or higher, and summer tires typically have a reduced tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle maintenance schedule is highly recommended.

WARNING!
Tiresandthesparetireshouldbereplacedaftersix years,regardlessoftheremainingtread.Failureto followthiswarningcanresultinsuddentirefailure. Youcouldlosecontrolandhaveacollisionresulting inseriousinjuryordeath.
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact with oil, grease, and gasoline.
Replacement Tires
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for wear and correct cold tire inflation pressure. The manufacturer strongly recommends that you use tires equivalent to the originals in size, quality and performance when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on "Tread Wear Indicator." Refer to the Tire and Loading Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart example found in the Tire Safety Information section of this manual for more information relating to the Load Index and Speed Symbol of a tire.
It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously affect your vehicle's handling. If you ever replace a wheel, make sure that the wheel's specifications match those of the original wheels.
It is recommended you contact your authorized tire dealer or original equipment dealer with any questions you may have on tire specifications or capability. Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
Loading

WARNING!
- Donotuseatire, wheelsizeorratingotherthan thatspecifiedforyourvehicle. Some combinations of unapprovedtiresandwheelsmaychangesuspensiondimensionsandperformancecharacteristics, resultinginchangestosteering, handling, and brakingofyourvehicle. This can cause unpredictablehandlingandstresstosteeringandsuspensioncomponents. You could lose control and have a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use only the tire and wheelsizes with load ratings approved for your vehicle.
- Neveruseatirewithasmallerloadindexor capacity,otherthanwhatwasoriginallyequipped onyourvehicle.Usingatirewithasmallerload indexcouldresultintireoverloadingandfailure. Youcouldlosecontrolandhaveacollision.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Failuretoequipyourvehiclewithtireshaving adequatespeedcapabilitycanresultinsuddentire failureandlossofvehiclecontrol.
CAUTION!
Replacingoriginaltireswithtiresofadifferentsize mayresultinfalsespeedometerandodometerreadings.
SUPPLEMENTAL TIRE PRESSURE INFORMATION — IF EQUIPPED
A light load vehicle condition is defined as two passengers [150 lbs (68 kg) each] plus 200 lbs (91 kg) of cargo. Cold tire inflation pressures for a lightly loaded vehicle will be found on the face of the driver's door.
562 STARTING AND OPERATING
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Use of traction devices require sufficient tire-to-body clearance. Follow these recommendations to guard against damage.
Please follow the table below for proper tire size, chain type, and axle recommendations:
- Traction device must be of proper size for the tire, as recommended by the traction device manufacturer.
| VehicleAxleRecommendationsTireSizesChainClass | |||
| 1500 Models Rear Only P265/70R17 S Class | |||
| 2500 Models Rear Only LT245/70R17E | LT265/70R18ELT275/70R18E | U Class | |
| 2500 Power Wagon Mod-els | Rear Only LT285/70R17D U Class | ||
| 3500 (Single Rear Wheel)Models | Rear Only LT265/70R18ELT275/70R18E | U Class | |
| 3500 (Dual Rear Wheel)Models | Front/Rear LT235/80R17E U Class | ||

WARNING!
Using tires of different size and type (M+S, Snow) between front and rear axles can cause unpredictable handling. You could close control and have a collision.
CAUTION!
To avoid damagetoyourvehicleortires, observethe following precautions:
- Because of restricted traction device clearance between tires and others suspension components, it is important that only traction devices being good condition are used. Brokendevices can cause serious damage. Stop the vehicle immediately if noise occurs that could indicate device breakage. Remove the damaged part of the device before further use.
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Installdeviceastightlyaspossibleandthenre-tightenafterdrivingabout ^1/2 mile(0.8km).
- Donotexceed30mph(48km/h).
- Drivecautiously and avoid severeturnsandlarge bumps, especially withloaded vehicle.
- Donotdriveforaprolongedperiodondrypavement.
- Observethetractiondevicemanufacturer's instructionsonthemethodofinstallation,operating speed,andconditionsforuse.Alwaysusethe suggestedoperatingspeedofthedevicemanufacturer'sifitislessthan30mph(48km/h).
- Donotusetractiondevicesonacompactsparetire.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
564 STARTING AND OPERATING
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
Tires on the front and rear axles of vehicles operate at different loads and perform different steering, driving, and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at unequal rates.
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires. The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain mud, snow and wet traction levels and contribute to a smooth, quiet ride.
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals. More frequent rotation is permissible if desired. The reasons for any rapid or unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being performed.
The suggested rotation method is the “forward cross” shown in the following diagram. This rotation pattern does not apply to some directional tires that must not be reversed.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Vehicle Icon"] --> B["Left Vehicle"]
A --> C["Right Vehicle"]
B --> D["Left Vehicle"]
B --> E["Right Vehicle"]
C --> F["Left Vehicle"]
C --> G["Right Vehicle"]
TireRotation
055703771

Information Provided by. DEALER & PROCESS
Directional Tires — If Equipped
For the R/T package with 22" tires and wheels, the rotational direction of the tire must be taken into consideration when rotating the tires. The recommended rotation pattern for directional tires is shown below.
Dual Rear Wheels — If Equipped
The tires used on dual wheel assemblies should be matched for wear to prevent overloading one tire in a set. To check if tires are even, lay a straight edge across all four tires. The straight edge should touch all the tires.

flowchart
graph LR
A["Channel 1"] <--> B["Channel 2"]
C["Channel 3"] <--> D["Channel 4"]
055710740


flowchart
graph TD
A["Top Block"] --> B["Bottom Block"]
B --> C["Top Block"]
C --> D["Bottom Block"]
D --> A
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style C fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style D fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
055740470
TireRotationTireRotation

Information Provided by.
DEALER
566 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS):
- The Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS) uses unique sensors in the inner rear wheels to help identify them from the outer rear wheels, because of this, the inner and outer wheel locations can't be switched.
- After a tire rotation is completed, as shown below, the system can auto learn the locations of each sensor ID. Auto learning/localization occurs when the vehicle ignition status is changed from Off to On and speeds of greater than 5 mph (8km/h) are obtained and remain over 5mph (8km/h) for at about a 15 minute period. You may need to drive for 20 minutes to account slower speeds and stops.
- If the tires are rotated incorrectly, The Auto localization of the TPIS sensors will fail to locate correctly resulting in incorrect locations for the pressure values displayed in the Instrument Cluster.
CAUTION!
3500DualRearTiresmayonlyhaveoneapproved directionofrotation.Thisistoaccommodatethe asymmetricaldesign(treadpattern)oftheOn/Off-RoadtireandtheuseofOutlineWhiteLetter(OWL) tires.
- Whenreplacingaflat,thesparetiremayhavetobe remountedontherim,orinstalledatadifferent location,tomaintainthecorrectplacementofthe tireonthewheelrelativetothetire/wheelposition onthetruck.Forexample,ifthespareisusedto replaceanouterreartireitwillhavetobere-mountedontherimsothatthewheelisdished inward.Thatwaythetreaddesignofasymmetrical tiresandthewhitewritingoftheOWLtireswill maintainproperposition.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recommended cold placard pressure.
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (6.5°C). This means that when the outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on cold inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidewall. Refer to "Tires – General Information" in "Starting and Operating" for information on how to properly inflate the vehicle's tires. The tire pressure will also increase as the vehicle is driven - this is normal and there should be no adjustment for this increased pressure.
The TPMS will warn the driver of a low tire pressure if the tire pressure falls below the low-pressure warning limit for any reason, including low temperature effects and natural pressure loss through the tire.
The TPMS will continue to warn the driver of low tire pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended cold placard pressure. Once the low tire pressure warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring [TPM] Telltale Light) illuminates, you must increase the tire pressure to the recommended cold placard pressure in order for the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” to turn off. The system will automatically update and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off once the system receives the updated tire pressures. The vehicle may need

to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (25 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended cold (parked for more than three hours) placard pressure of 30 psi (207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68°F (20°C) and the measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa), a temperature drop to 20°F (-7°C) will decrease the tire pressure to approximately 23 psi (158 kPa). This tire pressure is sufficiently low enough to turn ON the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light." Driving the vehicle may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately 27 psi (186 kPa), but the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will still be ON. In this situation, the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn OFF only after the tires are inflated to the vehicle's recommended cold placard pressure value.
CAUTION!
- TheTPMShasbeenoptimizedfortheoriginal equipmenttiresandwheels.TPMSpressuresand warninghavebeenestablishedforthetiresize equippedonyourvehicle.Undesirablesystemoperationorsensordamagemayresultwhenusing replacementequipmentthatisnotofthesamesize, type,and/orstyle.Aftermarketwheelscancause sensordamage.Usingaftermarkettiresealantsmay causetheTirePressureMonitoringSystem(TPMS) sensorobecomeinoperable.Afterusinganafter-markettiresealantitisrecommendedthatyoutake yourvehicletoyourlocaldealer tohave your sensorfunctionchecked.
- After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, alwaysreinstallthevalvestemcap.Thiswill preventmoistureanddirtfromenteringthevalve stem,whichcoulddamagetheTPMsensor.
NOTE:
- The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care and maintenance or to provide warning of a tire failure or condition.
- The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge while adjusting your tire pressure.
- Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
- The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure using an accurate tire pressure gauge, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light."
- Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure, and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in the tire.
Base System
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors mounted to each wheel as part of the valve stem transmit tire pressure readings to the receiver module.
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly and to maintain the proper pressure.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
- Receiver module,
- Four TPM sensors, and
- TPM Telltale Light

570 STARTING AND OPERATING
The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly (if equipped) has a TPM sensor. The matching full size spare can be used in place of any of the four road tires. The TPMS will only monitor the pressure in the full size spare when it is used in place of a road tire. Otherwise, a spare with a pressure below the low-pressure limit will not cause the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” to illuminate or the chime to sound.
TirePressureMonitoringLowPressureWarnings
The "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster, a "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message will display in the EVIC, and a chime will sound when tire pressure is low in one or more of the four active road tires. An "Inflate to XX" message will also be displayed. Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible, check the inflation pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate each tire
to the vehicle's recommended cold placard pressure value as shown in the "Inflate to XX" message. Once the system receives the updated tire pressures, the system will automatically update and the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" and "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message will turn off. The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (25 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
ServiceTPMSWarning
If a system fault is detected, the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. The system fault will also sound a chime. If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat, providing the system fault still exists. The "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn off when the fault condition no longer exists.

STARTING AND OPERATING 571
A system fault can occur due to any of the following:
- Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as the TPM sensors.
- Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains materials that may block radio wave signals.
- Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel housings.
- Using tire chains on the vehicle.
- Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
VehicleswithFullSizeSpare
- The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly has a TPM sensor that can be monitored by the TPMS.
- If you install the full size spare in place of a road tire that has a pressure below the low-pressur e warning
limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, a chime will sound, a "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message will be displayed, and the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn ON. An "Inflate to XX" message will also be displayed.
3. Driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) will turn off the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" and "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message, as long as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in any of the four active road tires.
Premium System — If Equipped
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors mounted to each wheel as part of the valve stem transmit tire pressure readings to the receiver module.

572 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly and to maintain the proper pressure.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
- Receiver module,
- Four TPM sensors,
- Various TPMS messages, which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC), and
- TPM Telltale Light
The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly (if equipped) has a TPM sensor. The full size spare can be used in place of any of the four road tires. A spare with a pressure below the low-pressure limit will not cause the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" to illuminate or the chime to sound.
TirePressureMonitoringLowPressureWarnings
The "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will illuminate in the instrument cluster and a chime will sound when tire pressure is low in one or more of the four active road tires. In addition, the EVIC will display a "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message for a minimum of five seconds and a graphic showing the pressure values of each tire with the low tire pressure values flashing or in a different color. An "Inflate to XX" message will also be displayed.

STARTING AND OPERATING 573
EXAMPLE ONLY

text_image
Low Tire PSI 27 30 27 21 2345 mi"LOWTIREPRESSURE"Message
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible and inflate the tires with a low pressure condition (those flashing or in a different color in the EVIC graphic) to the vehicle's recommended cold placard pressure inflation value as shown in the "Inflate to XX" message. Once the system receives the updated tire pressures, t he system
will automatically update, the graphic display in the EVIC will stop flashing or return to it's original color, and the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn off. The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
ServiceTPMSWarning
If a system fault is detected, the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. The system fault will also sound a chime. In addition, the EVIC will display a "SERVICE TPM SYSTEM" message for a minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value to indicate which sensor is not being received.

574 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE ONLY

text_image
Tire PSI 30 33 30 --055900260
TirePressureMonitorDisplay
If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat, providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault no longer exists, the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will no longer flash, and the "SERVICE TPM
SYSTEM" message will no longer display, and a pressure value will display in place of the dashes. A system fault can occur due to any of the following:
- Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as the TPM sensors.
- Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains materials that may block radio wave signals.
- Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel housings.
- Using tire chains on the vehicle.
- Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
VehiclesWithFullSizeSpare
- The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly has a TPM sensor that can be monitored by the TPMS.
- If you install the full size spare in place of a road tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, a chime will sound and the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn ON. In addition, the EVIC will display a "LOW TIRE PRESSURE" message and a graphic showing the low tire pressure value flashing or in a different color. An "Inflate to XX" message will also be displayed.
- After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (25 km/h) the "Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light" will turn OFF and the pressure value will be updated and stop flashing or return to it's
original color, as long as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in any of the four active road tires.
Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS) 3500 Series Trucks
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS).
The Tire Pressure Information System (TPIS) uses wireless technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to transmit tire pressure levels. Sensors mounted to each wheel as part of the valve stem transmit tire pressure readings to the receiver module.
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly and to maintain the proper pressure.

576 STARTING AND OPERATING
The TPIS consists of the following components:
- Receiver module
- Four TPM sensors (Single Rear Wheel (SRW) applications)
- Six TPM sensors (Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) applications)
- Pressure display in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
The TPIS system will display all four (Single Rear Wheel (SRW) applications) or six (Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) applications) tire pressure values EVIC display.
If a system fault is detected, the EVIC will display a "SERVICE TPM SYSTEM" message for a minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (--) in place of the pressure value to indicate which sensor is not being received.
If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat, providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault no longer exists, the "SERVICE TPM SYSTEM" message will no longer be displayed, and a pressure value will display in place of the dashes. A system fault can occur due to any of the following:
- Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as the TPM sensors.
- Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains materials that may block radio wave signals.
- Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel housings.
• Using tire chains on the vehicle. - Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
- This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
The TPM sensors are regulated under one of the following licenses:
| United States GQ4-61T | |
| Canada 1470A-42T |
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
3.6L/6.4L Engine

These engines are designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide excellent fuel economy and performance when using high quality unleaded “regular” gasoline having an octane rating of 87. The
use of premium gasoline is not recommended, as it will not provide any benefit over regular gasoline in these engines.
5.7L Engines

This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide satisfactory fuel economy and performance when using high quality unleaded gasoline having

578 STARTING AND OPERATING
an octane range of 87 to 89. The manufacturer recommends the use of 89 octane for optimum performance. The use of premium gasoline is not recommended, as it will not provide any benefit over regular gasoline in these engines.
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to your engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is required. Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard starting, stalling, and hesitations. If you experience these symptoms, try another brand of gasoline before considering service for the vehicle.
Over 40 auto manufacturer's world wide have issued and endorsed consistent gasoline specifications (the Worldwide Fuel Charter, WWFC) which define fuel properties necessary to deliver enhanced emissions, performance, and durability for your vehicle. The manufacturer recommends the use of gasolines that meet the WW FC specifications, if they are available.
Reformulated Gasoline
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.” Reformulated gasoline contain oxygenates and are specifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and improve air quality.
The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gasoline. Properly blended reformulated gasoline will provide excellent performance and durability of engine and fuel system components.
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxygenates such as Ethanol. Fuels blended with oxygenates may be used in your vehicle.

CAUTION!
DONOTusegasolinecontainingMethanolorgasolinecontainingmorethan10%Ethanol.Useofthese blendsmayresultinstartinganddrivabilityproblems,damagecriticalfuelsystemcomponents,cause emissionstoexceedtheapplicablestandard,and/or causethe"MalfunctionIndicatorLight"toilluminate.Pumplabelsshouldclearlycommunicateifa fuelcontainsgreaterthan10%Ethanol.
Problems that result from using gasoline containing Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol are not the responsibility of the manufacturer and may not be covered under New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles
Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles (FFV) are compatible with gasoline containing 10% ethanol (E10). Gasoline with higher ethanol content may void the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with E-85 fuel, the engine will have some or all of these symptoms:
- Operate in a lean mode.
- OBD II "Malfunction Indicator Light" on.
- Poor engine performance.
- Poor cold start and cold drivability.
- Increased risk for fuel system component corrosion.
To fix a Non-FFV vehicle inadvertently fueled once with E-85 perform the following:
- Drain the fuel tank (see your authorized dealer).

580 STARTING AND OPERATING
- Change the engine oil and oil filter.
- Disconnect and reconnect the battery to reset the engine controller memory.
More extensive repairs will be required for prolonged exposure to E-85 fuel.
MMT In Gasoline
Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl (MMT) is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline blended with MMT provides no performance advantage beyond gasoline of the same octane number without MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug life and reduces emissions system performance in some vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content of gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether the gasoline contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal and California reformulated gasoline.
Materials Added To Fuel
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional detergents or other additives is not needed under normal conditions and they would result in additional cost. Therefore, you should not have to add anything to the fuel.

Fuel System Cautions
CAUTION!
Followtheseguidelinestomaintainyourvehicle's performance:
• The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law. Using leaded gasoline can impaire engine performance and damage the emissions control system.
- Anout-of-tuneengineorcertainfuelorignition malfunctionscancausethecatalyticconverterto overheat. If you notice apungentburningodor or somelightsmoke, you'renginemaybeoutoftune ormalfunctioning and may require immediateservice. Contact your authorized dealer for service assistance.
CAUTION!(Continued)
• The useoffueladditives, which are now being sold as octaneenhancers, is not recommended. Most of these products contain high concentrations of methanol. Fuelsystem damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such fuel soradditives is not the responsibility of the manufacturer.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control system can result in civil penalties being assessed against you.
(Continued)

Information Provided by DEALER
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbonmonoxide(CO)inexhaustgasesisdeadly. Followtheprecautionsbelowtopreventcarbon monoxidepoisoning:
- Donotinhaleexhaustgases. They contain carbon monoxide, acolorless and odorless gas, which can kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as agarage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the engineer running for an extended period. If the vehicle is stopped in an open area with the engine running form more than a short period, adjust the ventilation system to force fresh, outside air into the vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Guardagainstcarbonmonoxidewithpropermaintenance.Havetheexhaustsysteminspectedevery timethevehicleisraised.Haveanyabnormal conditionsrepairedpromptly.Untilrepaired,drive withallsidewindowsfullyopen.
FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF EQUIPPED
E-85 General Information
The information in this section is for Flexible Fuel vehicles only. These vehicles can be identified by a unique fuel filler door label that states Ethanol(E-85)orUnleadedGasolineOnly. This section only covers those subjects that are unique to these vehicles. Please refer to the other sections of this manual for information on features that are common between Flexible Fuel and gasoline-only powered vehicles.

STARTING AND OPERATING 583

text_image
E85 / Gasoline TIGHTEN TO CLICK056502429

text_image
FLEXFUEL E85 ETHANOL056502430
E-85FuelCapE-85Badge

Information Provided by: DEALER
584 STARTING AND OPERATING
Ethanol Fuel (E-85)
E-85 is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline.
WARNING!
Ethanolvaporsareextremelyflammableandcould causeseriouspersonalinjury.Neverhaveanysmokingmaterialslitinornearthevehiclewhenremovingthefuelfillertubecap(gascap)orfillingthe tank.DonotuseE-85asacleaningagentandnever useitnearanopenflame.
Fuel Requirements
Your vehicle will operate on both unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87, or E-85 fuel, or any mixture of these two. For best results, a refueling pattern that alternates between E-85 and unleaded gasoline should be avoided.
When you do switch fuel types it is recommended that:
- you do not add less than 5 gallons (19 Liters) when refueling
- you operate the vehicle immediately after refueling for a period of at least 5 minutes
Observing these precautions will avoid possible hard starting and/or significant deterioration in driveability during warm up.
NOTE:
- When the ambient temperature is above 90^ (32°C), you may experience hard starting and rough idle following start up even if the above recommendations are followed.
- Some additives used in regular gasoline are not fully compatible with E-85 and may form deposits in your engine. To eliminate driveability issues that may be

caused by these deposits, a supplemental gasoline additive, such as MOPAR® Injector Cleanup or Techron may be used.
Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles (E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles
FFV vehicles operated on E-85 require specially formulated engine oils. These special requirements are included in MOPAR® engine oils, and in equivalent oils meeting Chrysler Specification MS-6395. The manufacturer only recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet the requirements of Material Standard MS-6395. MS-6395 contains additional requirements, developed during extensive fleet testing, to provide additional protection to Chrysler Group LLC engines. Use MOPAR® or an equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
Starting
The characteristics of E-85 fuel make it unsuitable for use when ambient temperatures fall below 0^ F ( -18^ C). In the range of 0^ F ( -18^ C) to 32^ F ( 0^ C), you may experience an increase in the time it takes for your engine to start, and a deterioration in driveability (sags and/or hesitations) until the engine is fully warmed up.
NOTE: Use of the engine block heater (if equipped) is beneficial for E-85 startability when the ambient temperature is less than 32^ F ( 0^ C).
Cruising Range
Because E-85 fuel contains less energy per gallon/liter than gasoline, you will experience an increase in fuel consumption. You can expect your miles per gallon (mpg)/miles per liter and your driving range to decrease by about 30%, compared to gasoline operation.

586 STARTING AND OPERATING
Replacement Parts
Many components in your Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV) are designed to be compatible with ethanol. Always be sure that your vehicle is serviced with correct ethanol compatible parts.
CAUTION!
Replacingfuelsystemcomponentswithnon-ethanol compatiblecomponentscandamageyourvehicle.
Maintenance
CAUTION!
Donotuseethanolmixturegreaterthan85%inyour vehicle.Itwillcausedifficultyincoldstartingand mayaffectdrivability.
ADDING FUEL
The fuel filler cap (gas cap) is located behind the fuel filler door, on the left side of the vehicle. Open the fuel door and remove the fuel cap by turning it counterclockwise.

text_image
A LIME OF NAT TURB ON SEAST FLOWING ON SEAST LIFT 056807288FuelFillerCap

NOTE: When removing the fuel filler cap, lay the cap tether in the hook, located on the fuel filler door.
CAUTION!
- Damagetothefuelsystemoremissionscontrol systemcouldresultfromusinganimproperfuel tankfillertubecap(gascap).
- Apoorlyfittinggascapcouldletimpuritiesinto thefuelsystem.
- Apoorlyfittinggascapmaycausethe"MalfunctionIndicatorLight(MIL)"toturnon.
- To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, donot "top off" the fuel tank after filling. Whenthefuel nozzle "clicks" or shutout, the fuel tank is full.
WARNING!
- Neverhaveanysmokingmaterialslitinornearthe vehiclewhenthegascapisremovedorthetankis beingfilled.
- Neveraddfueltothevehiclewhentheengineis running.
- Afiremayresultifgasolineispumpedintoa portablecontainerthatisinsideofavehicle.You couldbeburned.Alwaysplacegascontainerson thegroundwhilefilling.
NOTE:
- Tighten the gas cap until you hear a "clicking" sound. This is an indication that the gas cap is tightened properly. The MIL in the instrument cluster may turn on if the gas cap is not secured properly. Make sure that the gas cap is tightened each time the vehicle is refueled.

588 STARTING AND OPERATING
- When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank is full.
WARNING!
Staticelectricitycancauseanignitionofflammable liquid, vapororgasinanyvehicleortrailer. To reduceriskofseriousinjuryordeathwhenfilling containers:
- Alwaysplacecontaineronthegroundbeforefilling.
- Keepthepumpnozzleincontactwiththecontainer whenyouarefillingit.
- Useonlyapprovedcontainersforflammableliquid.
- Donotleavecontainerunattendedwhilefilling.
- Astaticelectricchargecouldcauseasparkandfire hazard.
Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message

If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuel filler cap is loose, improperly installed, or damaged, a loose gascap indicator will display in the EVIC telltale display area.
Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information. Tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the SELECT button to turn off the message. If the problem continues, the message will appear the next time the vehicle is started.
VEHICLE LOADING
Certification Label
As required by National Highway Traffic Safety Administration regulations, your vehicle has a certification label affixed to the driver's side door or pillar.

This label contains the month and year of manufacture, Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) front and rear, and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). A Month-Day-Hour (MDH) number is included on this label and indicates the Month, Day and Hour of manufacture. The bar code that appears on the bottom of the label is your VIN.
GrossVehicleWeightRating(GVWR)
The GVWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicle including driver, passengers, vehicle, options and cargo. The label also specifies maximum capacities of front and rear axle systems (GAWR). Total load must be limited so GVWR and front and rear GAWR are not exceeded.
Payload
The payload of a vehicle is defined as the allowable load weight a truck can carry, including the weight of the driver, all passengers, options and cargo.
GrossAxleWeightRating(GAWR)
The GAWR is the maximum permissible load on the front and rear axles. The load must be distributed in the cargo area so that the GAWR of each axle is not exceeded.
Each axle GAWR is determined by the components in the system with the lowest load carrying capacity (axle, springs, tires or wheels). Heavier axles or suspension components sometimes specified by purchasers for increased durability does not necessarily increase the vehicle's GVWR.
TireSize
The tire size on the Vehicle Certification Label represents the actual tire size on your vehicle. Replacement tires must be equal to the load capacity of this tire size.
RimSize
This is the rim size that is appropriate for the tire size listed.

590 STARTING AND OPERATING
InflationPressure
This is the cold tire inflation pressure for your vehicle for all loading conditions up to full GAWR.
CurbWeight
The curb weight of a vehicle is defined as the total weight of the vehicle with all fluids, including vehicle fuel, at full capacity conditions, and with no occupants or cargo loaded into the vehicle. The front and rear curb weight values are determined by weighing your vehicle on a commercial scale before any occupants or cargo are added.
Loading
The actual total weight and the weight of the front and rear of your vehicle at the ground can best be determined by weighing it when it is loaded and ready for operation. The entire vehicle should first be weighed on a commercial scale to insure that the GVWR has not been exceeded. The weight on the front and rear of the vehicle should then be determined separately to be sure that the load is properly distributed over the front and rear axle. Weighing the vehicle may show that the GAWR of either the front or rear axles has been exceeded but the total load is within the specified GVWR. If so, weight must be shifted from front to rear or rear to front as appropriate until the specified weight limitations are met. Store the heavier items down low and be sure that the weight is distributed equally. Stow all loose items securely before driving.
Improper weight distributions can have an adverse effect on the way your vehicle steers and handles and the way the brakes operate.

CAUTION!
DonotloadyourvehicleanyheavierthantheGVWR orthemaximumfrontandrearGAWR.Ifyoudo, partsonyourvehiclecanbreak,oritcanchangethe wayyourvehiclehandles.Thiscouldcauseyouto losecontrol.Alsooverloadingcanshortenthelifeof yourvehicle.
TRAILER TOWING
In this section you will find safety tips and information on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do with your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully review this information to tow your load as efficiently and safely as possible.
To maintain the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage, follow the requirements and recommendations in this manual concerning vehicles used for trailer to wing.
Common Towing Definitions
The following trailer towing related definitions will assist you in understanding the following information:
GrossVehicleWeightRating(GVWR)
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle. This includes driver, passengers, cargo and tongue weight. The total load must be limited so that you do not exceed the GVWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle Certification Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
GrossTrailerWeight(GTW)
The GTW is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all cargo, consumables and equipment (permanent or temporary) loaded in or on the trailer in its "loaded and ready for operation" condition. The recommended way to
592 STARTING AND OPERATING
measure GTW is to put your fully loaded trailer on a vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be supported by the scale.
GrossCombinationWeightRating(GCWR)
The GCWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicle and trailer when weighed in combination.
GrossAxleWeightRating(GAWR)
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or rear GAWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle Certification Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
WARNING!
It is important that you donot exceed them maximum frontorrear GAWR. Adangerous driving condition can result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose control of the vehicle and have an accident.
TongueWeight(TW)
The tongue weight is the downward force exerted on the hitch ball by the trailer. In most cases it should not be less than 10% of the trailer load. You must consider this as part of the load on your vehicle.
FrontalArea
The frontal area is the maximum height multiplied by the maximum width of the front of a trailer.

TrailerSwayControl
The trailer sway control can be a mechanical telescoping link that can be installed between the hitch receiver and the trailer tongue that typically provides adjustable friction associated with the telescoping motion to dampen any unwanted trailer swaying motions while traveling.
If equipped, the electronic Trailer Sway Control (TSC) recognizes a swaying trailer and automatically applies individual wheel brakes and/or reduces engine power to attempt to eliminate the trailer sway.
Weight-CarryingHitch
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue weight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch ball or some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds of hitches are the most popular on the market today and they are commonly used to tow small and medium sized trailers.
Weight-DistributingHitch
A weight-distributing system works by applying leverage through spring (load) bars. They are typically used for heavier loads to distribute trailer tongue weight to the tow vehicle's front axle and the trailer axle(s). When used in accordance with the manufacturer's directions, it provides for a more level ride, offering more consistent steering and brake control thereby enhancing towing safety. The addition of a friction/hydraulic sway control also dampens sway caused by traffic and crosswinds and contributes positively to tow vehicle and trailer stability. Trailer sway control and a weight distributing (load equalizing) hitch are recommended for heavier Tongue Weights (TW) and may be required depending on vehicle and trailer configuration/loading to comply with Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) requirements. Weight Distribution hitched are recommended for loads in excess of 5,000 lbs (2,268 kg).

- AnimproperlyadjustedWeightDistributingHitch systemmayreducehandling,stability,braking performance,andcouldresultinacollision.
- WeightDistributingSystemsmaynotbecpatiblewithSurgeBrakeCouplers.Consultwithyour hitchandtrailermanufacturerorareputableRecreationalVehicledealerforadditionalinformation.
Fifth-WheelHitch
The fifth-wheel hitch is a special high platform with a coupling that mounts over the rear axle of the tow vehicle in the truck bed. It connects a vehicle and fifth-wheel trailer with a coupling king pin.
GooseneckHitch
The gooseneck hitch employs a pivoted coupling arm which attaches to a ball mounted in the bed of a pickup truck. The coupling arm connects to the hitch mounted over the rear axle in the truck bed.
Trailer Hitch Type and Maximum Trailer Weight
The following chart provides the maximum trailer weight a given factory equipped trailer hitch type can tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the correct trailer hitch for your intended towing condition.
| TrailerHitchTypeandMaximumTrailerWeight | |
| HitchTypeMax.TrailerHitchMax. | |
| TrailerWeight | |
| Class III Bumper Hitch - 1500 Model | 5,000 lbs (2 268 kg) |
| Class IV - 1500 Model | 10,450 lbs (4 740 kg) |
| Class V - 2500/3500 Models | 17,000 lbs (7 711 kg) |
| Fifth Wheel - 2500/3500 Models | 25,000 lbs (11 339 kg) |
| Gooseneck - 2500 Model | 20,000 lbs (9 071 kg) |
| Gooseneck - 3500 Model | 30,000 lbs (13 636 kg) |
| Refer to the “Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)” for the Maximum Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) towable for your given drivetrain. | |
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed on your vehicle.
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)
The rear bumper is intended to tow trailers up to a 5,000 lbs (2 268 kg) without added equipment or alterations to the standard equipment.
596 STARTING AND OPERATING
Ram 1500 4x2
| STSLT/OutdoorsmanSport/Laramie | |||
| 3.6L V-6 8-Speed Automatic Transmission | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 7,400 lbs(3 379 kg)Max Payload: 1,920 lbs(871 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 7,400 lbs(3 357 kg)Max Payload: 1,900 lbs(862 kg) | - |
| 5.7L HEMI® V-8 6-Speed Automatic Transmission | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,450 lbs(4 740 kg)Max Payload: 1,730 lbs(785 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,450 lbs(4 740 kg)Max Payload: 1,700 lbs(771 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,250 lbs(4 649 kg)Max Payload: 1,600 lbs(726 kg) |
Ram 1500 4x4
| STSLT/OutdoorsmanSport/Laramie | |||
| 3.6L V-6 8-Speed Automatic Transmission | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 7,250 lbs(3 289 kg)Max Payload: 1,930 lbs(875 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 7,200 lbs(3 266 kg)Max Payload: 1,900 lbs(861 kg) | - |
| 5.7L HEMI® V-8 6-Speed Automatic Transmission | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,350 lbs(4 695 kg)Max Payload: 1,500 lbs(680 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,350 lbs(4 695 kg)Max Payload: 1,480 lbs(671 kg) | Standard Towing:5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)Max Towing: 10,050 lbs(4 558 kg)Max Payload: 1,390 lbs(630 kg) |
598 STARTING AND OPERATING
Ram 2500 And 3500
| STSLT/Outdoorsman/SportLaramie | |||
| 5.7L HEMI® V-8 6-Speed Automatic Transmission | Max Towing: 13,850 lbs (6 282 kg)Max Payload: 4,480 lbs (2 032 kg) | Max Towing: 13,810 lbs (6 282 kg)Max Payload: 4,440 lbs (2 014 kg) | Max Towing: 13,350 lbs (6 055 kg)Max Payload: 4,410 lbs (2 000 kg) |
| 6.4L HEMI® V-8 6-Speed Automatic Transmission | Max Towing: 16,450 lbs (7 462 kg)Max Payload: 7,220 lbs (3 275 kg) | Max Towing: 16,400 lbs (7 439 kg)Max Payload: 7,170 lbs (3 252 kg) | Max Towing: 15,810 lbs (7 171 kg)Max Payload: 6,950 lbs (3 152 kg) |
NOTE: For additional trailer towing information (maximum trailer weight ratings) refer to the following website addresses:
- http://www.ramtrucks.com
- http://www.ramtruck.ca(Canada)

Information Provided by. DEALER
Trailer And Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% of the weight in the front of the trailer. This places 10% of the GTW on the tow hitch of your vehicle. Loads balanced over the wheels or heavier in the rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side which will cause loss of control of the vehicle and trailer. Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of many trailer collisions. Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on your trailer hitch.

text_image
60% 40% 057003767Consider the following items when computing the weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
• The tongue weight of the trailer
- The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment put in or on your vehicle
• The weight of the driver and all passengers

600 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additional factory-installed options or dealer-installed options must be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle. Refer to “Tire Safety Information/Tire and Loading Information Placard” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
Towing Requirements
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drivetrain components the following guidelines are recommended:
CAUTION!
- Donottowatraileratallduringthefirst500miles (805km)thenewvehicleisdriven.Theengine,axle orotherpartscouldbedamaged.
- Then, during the first 500 miles (805 km) that a traileristowed, donot drive over 50 mph (80 km/h) and donot make starts at full throttle. This helps the engine and other part of the vehicle wear in at the heavier loads.
WARNING!
Impropertowingcanleadtoacollision.Followthese guidelinestomakeyourtrailertowingassafeas possible:
- Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer and will not shift during travel. When trailering cargothatis not fully secured, dynamic load shifts can occur that may be difficult for the driver to control. You could lose control of your vehicle and have a collision.
- Whenhaulingcargoortowingatrailer, donot overloadyourvehicleortrailer. Overloadingcan causealossofcontrol, poorperformanceordamagetobrakes, axle, engine, transmission, steering, suspension, chassisstructureortires.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Safetychainsmustalwaysbeusedbetweenyour vehicleandtrailer.Alwaysconnectthechainsto thehookretainersofthevehiclehitch.Crossthe chainsunderthetrailertongueandallowenough slackforturningcorners.
- Vehicleswithtrailersshouldnotbeparkedona grade.Whenparking,applytheparkingbrakeon thetowvehicle.Putthetowvehicletransmissionin PARK.Forfour-wheeldrivevehicles,makesure thetransfercaseisnotinNEUTRAL.Always,blockor"chock"thetrailerwheels.
• GCWRmustnotbeexceeded.
(Continued)
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
WARNING!(Continued)
- Totalweightmustbedistributedbetweenthetow vehicleandthetrailersuchthatthefollowingfour ratingsarenotexceeded:
1.GVWR
2.GTW
3.GAWR - Tongueweighitratingforthetrailerhitchutilized.
TowingRequirements—Tires
- Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact spare tire.
- Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe and satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Refer to "Tires – General Information" in "Starting and Operating" for proper tire inflation procedures.
- Check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation pressures before trailer usage.
- Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage before towing a trailer. Refer to "Tires – General Information" in "Starting and Operating" for the proper inspection procedure.
- When replacing tires, refer to "Tires – General Information" in "Starting and Operating" for proper tire replacement procedures. Replacing tires with a higher load carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limits.
TowingRequirements—TrailerBrakes
WARNING!
- Donotconnecttrailerbrakestoyourvehicle's hydraulicbrakelines.Itcanoverloadyourbrake systemandcauseittofail.Youmightnothave brakeswhenyouneedthemandcouldhavean accident.
- Towinganytrailerwillincreaseyourstopping distance.Whentowingyoushouldallowforadditionalspacebetweenyourvehicleandthevehicleinfrontofyou.Failurertodosocouldresultinan accident.
CAUTION!
If the trailer weighsmorethan 1,000 lbs (454 kg) loaded, it should have its own brakes and they should be of adequate capacity. Failure to this could lead to accelerated brakeling wear, higher brake pedaleffort, and longer stopping distances.
- Do notinterconnect the hydraulic brake system or vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the trailer. This could cause inadequate braking and possible personal injury.
- An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is required when towing a trailer with electronically actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with a hydraulic surge actuated brake system, an electronic brake controller is not required.
- Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over 1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in excess of 1,653 lbs (750 kg).
Integrated Trailer Brake Module—If Equipped
Your vehicle may have an Integrated Trailer Brake Module (ITBM) for Electric and Electric Over Hydraulic (EOH) trailer brakes.
NOTE: This module has been designed and verified with electric trailer brakes and new electric over hydraulic systems. Some previous EOH systems may not be compatible with ITBM.

text_image
① - + ② OFF ③ 057070422IntegratedTrailerBrakeModule(ITBM)
1 — GAIN Adjustment Button
2 — GAIN Adjustment Button
3 — Manual Brake Control Lever
STARTING AND OPERATING 605
The user interface consists of the following:
ManualBrakeControlLever
Slide the manual brake control lever to the right to activate power to the trailer's electric brakes independent of the tow vehicle's brakes. If the manual brake control lever is activated while the brake is also applied, the greater of the two inputs determines the power sent to the trailer brakes.
The trailer and the vehicle's brake lamps will come on when either vehicle braking or manual trailer brakes are applied.
TrailerBrakeStatusIndicatorLight
This light indicates the trailer electrical connection status.
If no electrical connection is detected after the ignition is turned on, pressing the GAIN adjustment button or
sliding the manual brake control lever will display the GAIN setting for 10 seconds and the "Trailer Brake Status Indicator Light" will not be displayed.
If a fault is detected in the trailer wiring or the Integrated Trailer Brake Module (ITBM), the "Trailer Brake Status Indicator Light" will flash.
GAINAdjustmentButtons(+/-)
Pressing these buttons will adjust the brake control power output to the trailer brakes in 0.5 increments. The GAIN setting can be increased to a maximum of 10 or decreased to a minimum of 0 (no trailer braking).
GAIN
The GAIN setting is used to set the trailer brake control for the specific towing condition and should be changed as towing conditions change. Changes to towing conditions include trailer load, vehicle load, road conditions and weather.

AdjustingGAIN
NOTE: This should only be performed in a traffic free environment at speeds of approximately 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h).
- Make sure the trailer brakes are in good working condition, functioning normally and properly adjusted. See your trailer dealer if necessary.
- Hook up the trailer and make the electrical connections according to the trailer manufacturer's instructions.
-
When a trailer with electric/EOH brakes is plugged in, the trailer connected message should appear in the EVIC (if the connection is not recognized by the ITBM, braking functions will not be available), the GAIN setting will illuminate and the correct type of trailer must be selected from the EVIC options.
-
Press the UP or DOWN button on the steering wheel until "TRAILER TOW" appears on the screen.
- Press the RIGHT arrow on the steering wheel to enter "TRAILER TOW".
- Press the UP or DOWN buttons until Trailer Brake Type appears on the screen.
NOTE:1500ModelsOnly—Light Electric and Heavy Electric will only be available due to the tow capacities of the vehicle.
-
Press the RIGHT arrow and then press the UP or DOWN buttons until the proper Trailer Brake Type appears on the screen.
-
In a traffic-free environment, tow the trailer on a dry, level surface at a speed of 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h) and squeeze the manual brake control lever completely.
-
If the trailer wheels lockup (indicated by squealing tires), reduce the GAIN setting; if the trailer wheels turn freely, increase the GAIN setting.
trailer, trailer wheel lockup may not be attainable even with the maximum GAIN setting of 10.
Repeat steps 8 and 9 until the GAIN setting is at a point just below trailer wheel lockup. If towing a heavier
| LightElectricHeavyElectricLightEOHHeavyEOH | ||||
| Type of Trailer Brakes | Electric Trailer Brakes | Electric Trailer Brakes | Electric over Hydraulic Trailer Brakes | Electric over Hydraulic Trailer Brakes |
| Load | *Under 10,000 lbs | *Above 10,000 lbs | *Under 10,000 lbs | *Above 10,000 lbs |
* The suggested selection depends and may change depending on the customer preferences for braking performance. Condition of the trailer brakes, driving and road state may also affect the selection.
EVICDisplayMessages
The trailer brake control interacts with the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Display messages, along with a single chime, will be displayed when a malfunction is determined in the trailer connection, trailer brake control, or on the trailer. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.

CAUTION!
Connectingatrailerthatisnotcompatiblewiththe ITBMsystemmayresultinreducedorcompleteloss oftrailerbraking.Theremaybeaincreaseinstoppingdistanceortrailerinstabilitywhichcouldresult indamagetoyourvehicle,trailer,orotherproperty.
WARNING!
Connectingatrailerthatisnotcompatiblewiththe ITBMsystemmayresultinreducedorcompleteloss oftrailerbraking.Theremaybeaincreaseinstoppingdistanceortrailerinstabilitywhichcouldresult inpersonalinjury.
NOTE:
- An aftermarket controller may be available for use with trailers with air or electric-over-hydraulic trailer brake systems. To determine the type of brakes on your trailer and the availability of controllers, check with your trailer manufacturer or dealer.
- Removal of the ITBM will cause errors and it may cause damage to the electrical system and electronic modules of the vehicle. See your authorized dealer if an aftermarket module is to be installed.
TowingRequirements—TrailerLightsAndWiring
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size, stoplights and turn signals on the trailer are required for motoring safety.
The Trailer Tow Package may include a four- and seven-pin wiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer harness and connector.

STARTING AND OPERATING 609
NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicles wiring harness.
The electrical connections are all complete to the vehicle but you must mate the harness to a trailer connector. Refer to the following illustrations.

flowchart
graph TD
A["6"] --> B(( ))
C["5"] --> D(( ))
E["4"] --> F(( ))
G["3"] --> H(( ))
B --> I["1"]
D --> I
F --> I
H --> J["2"]
057003766
Four-PinConnector
1 — Female Pins 4 — Park
2 — Male Pin 5 — Left Stop/Turn
3 — Ground 6 — Right Stop/Turn

Information Provided by
DEALER
法定代表人:王伟

广力云智慧零售收银系统

flowchart
graph TD
A["1"] --> B["2"]
B --> C["3"]
C --> D["4"]
D --> E["5"]
E --> F["6"]
F --> G["7"]
G --> H["8"]
H --> I["9"]
I --> J["10"]
J --> K["11"]
K --> L["12"]
L --> M["13"]
M --> N["14"]
N --> O["15"]
O --> P["16"]
P --> Q["17"]
Q --> R["18"]
R --> S["19"]
S --> T["20"]
057003765
Seven-PinConnector
1 — Battery 5 — Ground
2 — Backup Lamps 6 — Left Stop/Turn
3 — Right Stop/Turn 7 — Running Lamps
4 — Electric Brakes
Towing Tips
Before setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping and backing the trailer up in an area away from heavy traffic.
AutomaticTransmission
The "DRIVE" range can be selected when towing. The transmission controls include a drive strategy to avoid frequent shifting when towing. However, if frequent shifting does occur while in DRIVE, select "TOW/HAUL" mode or select a lower gear range (using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) switches).
NOTE: Using "TOW/HAUL" mode or selecting a lower gear range (using the ERS switches) while operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting and heat build up. This action will also provide better engine braking.

When towing a loaded trailer up steep grades at low speeds (20 mph [32 km/h] or below), holding your vehicle in first gear (using the ERS switches) can help to avoid transmission overheating.
If you regularly tow a trailer for more than 45 minutes of continuous operation, then change the automatic transmission fluid and filter(s) as specified for "police, taxi, fleet, or frequent trailer towing." Refer to "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals.
NOTE: Check the automatic transmission fluid level before towing (6-speed automatic only).
Tow/HaulMode
To reduce potential for automatic transmission overheating, turn the "TOW/HAUL" feature ON when driving in hilly areas, or select a lower gear range (using the Electronic Range Select (ERS) switches) on more severe grades.
ElectronicSpeedControl—IfEquipped
- Do not use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
- When using the speed control, if you experience speed drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), disengage until you can get back to cruising speed.
- Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to maximize fuel efficiency.
CoolingSystem
To reduce potential for engine and transmission overheating, take the following actions:
CityDriving
When stopped for short periods of time, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and increase engine idle speed.
HighwayDriving
Reduce speed.

612 STARTING AND OPERATING
AirConditioning
Turn off temporarily.
AirSuspensionSystem
To aid in attaching/detaching the trailer from the vehicle, the air suspension system can be used. Refer to "Air Suspension System" in "Starting And Operating" for further information.
NOTE: The vehicle must remain in the engine running position while attaching a trailer for proper leveling of the air suspension system.
SNOWPLOW
1500 Models Only
NOTE: Do not use this model vehicle for snowplow applications.
WARNING!
Snowplowsandotheraftermarketequipments should not be added to the frontend of your vehicle. The airbagcrash sensors may be affected by the change in the frontend structure. The airbags could deploy unexpectedly or could fail to deploy during a collision resulting in serious injury or death.
CAUTION!
Using this vehicle for snow plow applications can cause damage to the vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 613
WARNING!
Attachingasnowplowtothisvehiclecouldadversely affectperformanceoftheairbagsysteminacollision. Donotexpectthattheairbagwillperformasdescribedearlierinthismanual.
2500/3500 Models Only
Snowplow Prep Packages are available as a factory installed option. These packages include components necessary to equip your vehicle with a snowplow.
NOTE: Before installation of a snowplow it is highly recommended that the owner/installer obtain and follow the recommendations contained within the current Body Builders Guide. See your authorized dealer, installer or snowplow manufacturer for this information. There are unique electrical systems that must be connected to properly assure operator safety and prevent overloading vehicle systems.
WARNING!
Attachingasnowplowtothisvehiclecouldadversely affectperformanceoftheairbagsysteminacollision. Donotexpectthattheairbagwillperformasdescribedearlierinthismanual.
The "LampOut" indicator could illuminate if exterior lamps are not properly installed.
BeforePlowing
- Check the hydraulic system for leaks and proper fluid level.
- Check the mounting bolts and nuts for proper tightness.
- Check the runners and cutting edge for excessive wear. The cutting edge should be 14 to 12 in (6 cm to 1.2 cm) above ground in snow plowing position.
- Check that snowplow lighting is connected and functioning properly.
SnowplowPrepPackageModelAvailability
ForInformationaboutsnowplowapplicationsvisit www.ramtrucks.comorrefertothecurrentBodyBuildersGuide.
- The maximum number of occupants in the truck should not exceed two.
- The total GVWR or the Front GAWR or the Rear GAWR should never be exceeded.
- Cargo capacity will be reduced by the addition of options or passengers, etc.
The loaded vehicle weight, including the snowplow system, all aftermarket accessories, driver, passengers, options, and cargo, must not exceed either the Gross Vehicle Weight (GVWR) or Gross Axle Weight (GAWR) ratings. These weights are specified on the Safety Compliance Certification Label on the driver's side door opening.

NOTE: Detach the snowplow when transporting passengers.
Vehicle front end wheel alignment was set to specifications at the factory without consideration for the weight of the plow. Front end toe-in should be checked and reset if necessary at the beginning and end of the snowplow season. This will help prevent uneven tire wear.
The blade should be lowered whenever the vehicle is parked.
Maintain and operate your vehicle and snowplow equipment following the recommendations provided by the specific snowplow manufacturer.
OverTheRoadOperationWithSnowplow Attached
The blade restricts air flow to the radiator and causes the engine to operate at higher than normal temperatures. Therefore, when transporting the plow, angle the blade completely and position it as low as road or surface conditions permit. Do not exceed 40 mph (64 km/h). The operator should always maintain a safe stopping distance and allow adequate passing clearance.
OperatingTips
Under ideal snow plowing conditions, 20 mph (32 km/h) should be maximum operating speed. The operator should be familiar with the area and surface to be cleaned. Reduce speed and use extreme caution when plowing unfamiliar areas or under poor visibility.

616 STARTING AND OPERATING
GeneralMaintenance
Snowplows should be maintained in accordance with the plow manufacturer's instructions.
Keep all snowplow electrical connections and battery terminals clean and free of corrosion.
When plowing snow, to avoid transmission and drivetrain damage, the following precautions should be observed.
- Operate with transfer case in 4L when plowing small or congested areas where speeds are not likely to exceed 15mph (24km / h) . At higher speeds operate in 4H.
- Vehicles with automatic transmissions should use 4L range when plowing deep or heavy snow for extended periods of time to avoid transmission overheating.
- Do not shift the transmission unless the engine has returned to idle and wheels have stopped. Make a practice of stepping on the brake pedal while shifting the transmission.
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.) Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
| TowingConditionWheelsOFFTheGround | Two-WheelDriveModels | Four-WheelDriveModels | |
| Flat Tow NONE N | OTAL- | LOWED | SeeInstructions•Automatic transmission in PARK•Manual transmission in gear (NOT in NEUTRAL)•Transfer case in NEUTRAL (N)•Tow in forward direction |
| Dolly Tow Front N | OTAL- | LOWED | NOTALLOWED |
| Rear OK NOTALLOWED | |||
| On Trailer ALL OK | OK | ||
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with air suspension must be lowered to the "Entry/Exit" (lowest) level, and have automatic leveling disabled, before tying them down (from the body) on a trailer or flatbed truck. Refer to "Air Suspension – If Equipped" for more information. If the vehicle cannot be lowered to the "Entry/Exit" level (for example, engine will not run), tie-downs must be fastened to the axles (not to the body). Failure to follow these instructions may cause fault codes to be set and/or cause loss of proper tie-down tension.
Recreational Towing — Two-Wheel Drive Models
DONOTflattowthisvehicle.Damagethedrivetrain willresult.
Recreational towing (for two-wheel drive models) is allowed ONLY if the rear wheels are OFF the ground. This may be accomplished using a tow dolly or vehicle trailer. If using a tow dolly, follow this procedure:
- Properly secure the dolly to the tow vehicle, following the dolly manufacturer's instructions.
- Drive the rear wheels onto the tow dolly.
- Firmly apply the parking brake. Place automatic transmission in PARK, manual transmission in gear (not in NEUTRAL).
- Properly secure the rear wheels to the dolly, following the dolly manufacturer's instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position and remove the Key Fob.
- Install a suitable clamping device, designed for towing, to secure the front wheels in the straight position.
CAUTION!
- Towingwiththerearwheelsonthegroundwill causeseveretransmissiondamage.Damagefrom impropertowingisnotcoveredundertheNew VehicleLimitedWarranty.
- Donotdisconnectthedriveshaftbecausefluidmay leakfromthetransmission,causingdamageto internalparts.
Recreational Towing — Four-Wheel Drive Models
NOTE: Both the manual shift and electronic shift transfer cases must be shifted into NEUTRAL (N) for recreational towing. Automatic transmissions must be shifted into PARK for recreational towing. Manual transmissions must be placed in gear (NOT in NEUTRAL) for recreational towing. Refer to the following for the proper transfer case NEUTRAL (N) shifting procedure for your vehicle.
CAUTION!
- Frontorrearwheelliftsmustnotbeused. Internal damagetothetransmissionortransfercasewill occurifafrontorrearwheelliftisusedwhen recreationaltowing.
(Continued)
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Towonlyintheforwarddirection. Towing this vehiclebackwardscancauseseveredamagetothe transfercase.
- AutomatictransmissionsmustbeplacedinPARK forrecreationaltowing.
- Manualtransmissionsmustbeplacedingear(not inNeutral)forrecreationaltowing.
- Before recreational towing, perform the procedure outlined under "Shifting Into NEUTRAL(N)" to be certain that the transfer case is fully in NEUTRAL (N). Otherwise, internal damage will result.
- Towing this vehicle inviolation of the aboverequirements can cause severetransmission and/or transfercased damage. Damage from impropertowing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Donotdisconnectthereardriveshaftbecausefluid willleakfromthetransfercase,causingdamageto internalparts.
- Donotuseabumper-mountedclamp-ontowbar onyourvehicle.Thebumperfacebarwillbe damaged.
ShiftingIntoNEUTRAL(N)
Use the following procedure to prepare your vehicle for recreational towing.
WARNING!
Youorotherscouldbeinjuredorkilledifyouleave thevehicleunattendedwiththetransfercaseinthe NEUTRAL(N)positionwithoutfirstfullyengaging
(Continued)
(Continued)

STARTING AND OPERATING 621
WARNING!(Continued)
theparkingbrake. ThetransfercaseNEUTRAL(N) positiondisengagesboththefrontandredrive-shaftsfromthepowertrainandwillallowthevehicle tomove, evenifthetransmissionisinPARK. The parkingbrakeshouldalwaysbeappliedwhenthe driverisnotinthevehicle.
CAUTION!
It isnecessary to follow these stepstobecertain that the transfer case is fully in NEUTRAL(N) before recreational towing top prevent damage to internal parts.
- Bring the vehicle to a complete stop, with the engine running. Firmly apply the parking brake.
-
Shift the transmission to NEUTRAL.
-
Press and hold the brake pedal.
- Depress the clutch pedal on a manual transmission.
-
If the transfer case is in 4WD AUTO (if equipped), press a selector button or rotate the selector switch to shift the transfer case into the 2WD or 4WD LOCK position.
-
With manual shift transfer case, shift the transfer case lever into NEUTRAL (N).
- With electronic shift transfer case, press and hold the transfer case NEUTRAL (N) button. Some models have a small, recessed "N" button (at the center of the transfer case switches) that must be pressed using a ballpoint pen or similar object. Other models have a rectangular NEUTRAL switch, below the rotary transfer case control knob. The NEUTRAL (N) indicator light will blink while the shift is in progress. The light will stop blinking (stay on solid) when the

622 STARTING AND OPERATING
shift to NEUTRAL (N) is complete. After the shift is completed and the NEUTRAL (N) light stays on, release the NEUTRAL (N) button.
- Release the parking brake.
- Shift the transmission into REVERSE.
- Release the brake pedal (and clutch pedal on manual transmissions) for five seconds and ensure that there is no vehicle movement.
- Repeat steps 7 and 8 with automatic transmission in DRIVE or manual transmission in first gear.
-
Shift the transmission to NEUTRAL. Firmly apply the parking brake. Turn OFF the engine. For vehicles with Keyless Enter-N-Go™, press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button until the engine shuts off.
-
Shift the transmission into PARK or place manual transmission in gear (NOT in Neutral). On 8-speed transmissions the shifter will automatically select PARK when the engine is turned off.
- Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then cycle the key or the Keyless Enter-N-Go™ button to the RUN position and back to the OFF position.
- Attach the vehicle to the tow vehicle using a suitable tow bar.
- Release the parking brake.
NOTE: With electronic shift transfer case:
- Steps 2 through 4 are requirements that must be met prior to pressing the NEUTRAL (N) button, and must continue to be met until the shift has been completed. If any of these requirements are not met prior to pressing the NEUTRAL (N) button or are no longer met during the shift, the NEUTRAL (N) indicator light

will flash continuously until all requirements are met or until the NEUTRAL (N) button is released.
- The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN position for a shift to take place and for the position indicator lights to be operable. If the ignition switch is not in the ON/RUN position, the shift will not take place and no position indicator lights will be on or flashing.
- A flashing NEUTRAL (N) position indicator light indicates that shift requirements have not been met.
ShiftingOutOfNEUTRAL(N)
Use the following procedure to prepare your vehicle for normal usage.
- Bring the vehicle to a complete stop, leaving it connected to the tow vehicle.
- Firmly apply the parking brake.
-
Press and hold the brake pedal.
-
Start the engine. Shift the transmission into NEU-TRAL. Depress the clutch pedal on a manual transmission.
- With manual shift transfer case, shift the transfer case lever to the desired position.
- With electronic shift transfer case with rotary selector switch, press and hold the transfer case NEUTRAL (N) button until the NEUTRAL (N) indicator light turns off. After the NEUTRAL (N) indicator light turns off, release the NEUTRAL (N) button. After the NEUTRAL (N) button has been released, the transfer case will shift to the position indicated by the selector switch.
- With electronic shift transfer case with pushbutton selector switch, press and hold the switch for the desired transfer case position, until the NEUTRAL (N) indicator light turns off and the desired position indicator light turns on.
NOTE: When shifting out of transfer case NEUTRAL (N), turning the engine OFF is not required, but may be helpful to avoid gear clash. With the 8-speed automatic transmission, the engine must remain running, since turning the engine OFF will shift the transmission to PARK (and the transmission must be in NEUTRAL for the transfer case to shift out of NEUTRAL).
- Turn the engine OFF. Shift automatic transmission into PARK. On 8-speed transmissions the shifter will automatically select PARK when the engine is turned off.
-
Release the brake pedal (and clutch pedal on a manual transmission).
-
Disconnect vehicle from the tow vehicle.
-
Start the engine.
-
Press and hold the brake pedal.
-
Release the parking brake.
STARTING AND OPERATING 625
- Shift the transmission into gear, release the brake pedal (and clutch pedal on manual transmissions), and check that the vehicle operates normally.
NOTE: With electronic shift transfer case:
- Steps 3 and 4 are requirements that must be met prior to pressing the button to shift out of NEUTRAL (N), and must continue to be met until the shift has been completed. If any of these requirements are not met before pressing the button or are no longer met during the shift, the NEUTRAL (N) indicator light will flash continuously until all requirements are met or until the button is released.
- The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN position for a shift to take place and for the position indicator lights to be operable. If the ignition switch is not in the ON/RUN position, the shift will not take place and no position indicator lights will be on or flashing.
- A flashing NEUTRAL (N) position indicator light indicates that shift requirements have not been met.

Information Provided by
DEALER
电子邮箱:@zzq.com
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
■HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS....629
■IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS....629
■WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS....630
□Torque Specifications....631
■JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING....633
□ Jacking And Tire Changing 1500 Series Trucks . .633
□Jacking And Tire Changing 2500 And 3500 Series Trucks....651
■HOISTING....671
■JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURES .....671
□Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 672
□Jump-Starting Procedure....673
■FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE....675
■EMERGENCY TOW HOOKS — IF EQUIPPED . .677
■SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE....678
☐Column Shifter — If Equipped .....678
□ Center Console Shifter — If Equipped .....679
628 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
■MANUAL PARK RELEASE — 8 SPEED TRANSMISSION....680
■TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE....682
□Two-Wheel Drive Models....684
□Four-Wheel Drive Models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the upper switch bank just below the radio.

Press the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning flasher. When the switch is activated, all direc-
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming traffic of an emergency. Press the switch a second time to turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
This is an emergency warning system and it should not be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when your vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for other motorists.
When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance, the Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate even though the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
NOTE: With extended use the Hazard Warning flashers may wear down your battery.
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
In any of the following situations, you can reduce the potential for overheating by taking the appropriate action.
- On the highways — slow down.
- In city traffic — while stopped, place the transmission in NEUTRAL, but do not increase the engine idle speed.
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down an impending overheat condition:
- If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C system adds heat to the engine cooling system and turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
- You can also turn the temperature control to maximum heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control to high. This allows the heater core to act as a

630 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat from the engine cooling system.
CAUTION!
Drivingwithahotcoolingsystemcoulddamage yourvehicle.IfthetemperaturegaugereadsHOT(H),pulloverandstopthevehicle.Idlethevehicle withtheairconditionerturnedoffuntilthepointer dropsbackintothenormalrange.Ifthepointer remainsonHOT(H),andyouhearcontinuous chimes,turntheengineoffimmediatelyandcallfor service.
WARNING!
Youorotherscanbebadlyburnedbyhotengine coolant(antifreeze)orsteamfromyourradiator.If
WARNING!(Continued)
youseeorhearsteamcomingfromunderthehood, donotopenthehooduntiltheradiatorhashadtime tocool.Nevertrytoopenacoolingsystempressure capwhentheradiatororcoolantbottleishot.
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to ensure that the wheel is properly mounted to the vehicle. Any time a wheel has been removed and reinstalled on the vehicle the lug nuts/bolts should be torqued using a properly calibrated torque wrench.
(Continued)

Information Provided by. DEALER
Torque Specifications
| LugNut/Bolt Torque | LugNut/ Bolt Type | **Lug Nut/Bolt Size | LugNut/ Bolt Socket Size |
| 130 Ft-Lbs (176 N·m) | Cone M14 x 1.50 | 22 mm | |
| 140 Ft-Lbs (190 N·m) | Flanged | ||
**Use only Chrysler recommended lug nuts/bolts and clean or remove any dirt or oil before tightening.
NOTE: Dual wheels are flat mounted, center piloted. The lug nuts are a two-piece assembly. When the tires are being rotated or replaced, clean these lug nuts and add two drops of oil at the interface between the lug nut/bolt and the washer.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a downward force applied to a component (no text or symbols present)060505399
Do not oil wheel studs.
Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to mounting the tire and remove any corrosion or loose particles.
632 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

natural_image
Close-up of a car tire with a white arrow pointing to the wheel rim (no text or symbols)0605005441

flowchart
graph TD
1 --> 2
2 --> 3
3 --> 4

flowchart
graph TD
1 --> 2
2 --> 3
3 --> 4
4 --> 1
5 --> 2
5 --> 3
5 --> 4
0605006372
WheelMountingSurface4And5LugNuts/BoltsTorquePattern
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until each nut/bolt has been tightened twice.
After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut/bolt torque to be sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are properly seated against the wheel.
WARNING!
To avoid the riskofforcing the vehicle off the jack, donottight enthe lugnuts fully until the vehicle has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may result in personal injury.

Information Provided by: DEALER
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING
Jacking And Tire Changing 1500 Series Trucks
WARNING!
- Donotattempttochangeatireonthesideofthe vehicleclosetomovingtraffic.Pullfarenoughoff theroadtoavoidthedangerofbeinghitwhen operatingthejackorchangingthewheel.
- Beingunderajacked-upvehicleisdangerous. The vehiclecouldslipoffthejackandfallonyou.You couldbecrushed.Neverputanypartofyourbody underavehiclethatisonajack.Ifyouneedtoget underaraisedvehicle,takeittoaservicecenter whereitcanberaisedonalift.
- Neverstartorruntheenginewhilethevehicleis onajack.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Thejackisdesignedtobeusedasatoolfor changingtiresonly.Thejackshouldnotbeusedto liftthevehicleforservicepurposes.Thevehicle shouldbejackedonafirmlevelsurfaceonly. Avoidiceorslipperyareas.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with an air suspension system, there is a feature which allows the automatic leveling to be disabled to assist with changing a tire.
If your vehicle is equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be activated through the Uconnect® system. Refer to "Uconnect® Settings" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
If your vehicle is not equipped with a touchscreen, this feature can be activated through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to "Electronic Vehicle
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
634 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Information Center (EVIC)" in "Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information.
JackLocation
The jack and jack tools are stored under the front passenger seat.
RemovalOfJackAndTools(1500Series)
To access the jack and jack tools you must remove the plastic access cover, located on the side of the front passengers seat. To remove the cover, pull the front part of the cover (closest to the front of the seat) toward you to release a locking tab. Once the front of the cover is loose, slide the cover toward the front of the seat until it is free from the seat frame.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seatbelt and directional arrow (no text or symbols)JackAccessCover
Remove the jack and tools by turning the wing bolt counterclockwise, remove the wing bolt and then slide the assembly out from under the seat.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 635

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and seatbelt with a white arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)JackAndTools(1500Series)JackAndToolBag
Release the tool bag straps from the jack and remove tools from bag.

natural_image
Mechanical device with attached lever and base plate (no visible text or symbols)060573848
WARNING!
Afterusingthejackandtools,alwaysreinstallthem intheoriginalcarrierandlocation.Whiledriving
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
636 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!(Continued)
youmayexperienceabruptstopping,rapidaccelerationorsharpturns.Aloosejack,tools,bracketor otherobjectsinthevehiclemaymovearoundwith force,resultinginseriousinjury.
RemovingTheSpareTire
- Remove the spare tire before attempting to jack up the truck. Attach the wheel wrench to the jack extension tube with the curved angle facing away from the vehicle. Insert the tube through the access hole between the lower tailgate and the top of the bumper and into the winch mechanism tube.

natural_image
Mechanical component assembly showing a bracket with mounting holes and a wrench inserted (no visible text or symbols)060573849
WheelWrenchAndJackExtensionTubeAssembled
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 637

natural_image
Side view of a car's rear bumper with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Mechanic using a tool to adjust or install a car component (no visible text or symbols)InsertingTheJackExtensionTubeIntoTheAccessHoleRotatingTheWheelWrenchHandle
- Rotate the wheel wrench handle counterclockwise
until the spare tire is on the ground with enough cable slack to allow you to pull it out from under the vehicle.

Information Provided like
DEALER
表三 中 内 以 二 年 定 低
638 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
- Pull the spare tire out from under the vehicle to gain access to the spare tire retainer.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a car wheel mounted on a vehicle chassis with attached suspension components (no text or symbols)- Lift the spare tire with one hand to give clearance to tilt the retainer at the end of the cable.

natural_image
Illustration of hands installing a car tire component into a car hood (no text or symbols visible)PullingTheSpareTireOutGainingAccessToTheRetainer

Information Provider by: DEALER
- Pull the retainer through the center of the wheel.

natural_image
Close-up of a hand adjusting a car tire with a tool, no visible text or symbolsPullingTheRetainerThroughTheCenterOfTheWheel
NOTE: The winch mechanism is designed for use with the jack extension tube only. Use of an air wrench or other power tools is not recommended and can damage the winch.
Preparations
- Park the vehicle on a firm, level surface. Avoid ice or slippery areas.
WARNING!
Donotattempttochangeatireonthesideofthe vehicleclosetomovingtraffic,pullfarenoughoff theroadtoavoidthedangerofbeinghitwhen operatingthejackorchangingthewheel.
- Turn on the Hazard Warning flasher.
- Set the parking brake.
- Place the shift lever into PARK. On four-wheel drive vehicles, shift the transfer case to the 4L position.
- Turn the ignition OFF.

640 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally opposite the jacking position. For example, if the right front wheel is being changed, block the left rear wheel.

NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is being jacked.
JackInstructions(1500Series)
WARNING!
Carefully follow the set of receiving warning to help prevent personal injury or damage to your vehicle:
- Alwaysparkonafirm, levelsurfaceasfarfromthe edgeoftheroadwayaspossiblebeforeraisingthe vehicle.
• TurnontheHazardWarningflasher. - Blockthewheeldiagonallyoppositethewheelto beraised.
- Settheparkingbrakefirmlyandsetanautomatic transmissioninPARK;amanualtransmissionin REVERSE.
- Neverstartorruntheenginewiththevehicleona jack.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotletanyonesitinthevehiclewhenitisona jack.
- Donotgetunderthevehiclewhenitisonajack. If youneedtogetunderaraisedvehicle, takeittoa servicecenterwhereitcanberaisedonalift.
- Onlyusethejackinthepositionsindicatedandfor liftingthisvehicleduringatirechange.
- If working on or near a roadway, be extremely careful of motortraffic.
- Toassurethatsparetires,flatorinflated,are securelystowed,sparesmustbestowedwiththe valvestemfacingtheground.

text_image
PRND31 P RJackWarningLabel
CAUTION!
Donotattempttoraisethevehiclebyjackingon locationsotherthanthoseindicatedintheJacking Instructionsforthisvehicle.
- Remove the spare wheel, jack, and tools from storage.
- Using the wheel wrench, loosen, but do not remove, the wheel nuts by turning them counterclockwise one turn while the wheel is still on the ground.
642 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
- Placement of the jack:
4x2SeriesTrucksFrontJackingLocation
There is a jack location indicator on the rear portion of the lower control arm.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a component with an arrow pointing to a specific part (no text or symbols present)4X2FrontJackingLocationIndicator
When changing a front wheel, place the scissor jack under the rear portion of the lower control arm as shown below.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a bracket and wheel assembly (no text or symbols)4X2FrontJackingLocation

Information Provider Syc. DEALER
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 643
4x4SeriesTrucksFrontJackingLocation
There is a jack location indicator on the rear portion of the lower control arm.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing car suspension system with no visible text or symbols4X4FrontJackingLocationIndicator
When changing a front wheel, place the scissor jack under the rear portion of the lower control arm as shown below.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing suspension and suspension components (no text or symbols)4X4FrontJackingLocation

Information Provided by: DEALER
644 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4x2and4x4RearJackingLocation
Operate the jack using the jack drive tube and the wheel wrench. The tube extension may be used but is not required.
For 4x2 and 4x4 trucks, when changing a rear wheel, assemble the jack drive tube to the jack and connect the drive tube to the extension tube. Place the jack under the axle between the wheel and the shock bracket with the drive tubes extending to the rear.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a vehicle's lower body and suspension components (no text or symbols)RearJackingLocation
Connect the jack tube extension and wheel wrench.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 645
CAUTION!
Before raising the wheel off the ground, makes sure that the jack will not damage surrounding truck parts and adjust the jack position as required.
- By rotating the lug wrench clockwise, raise the vehicle until the wheel just clears the surface.
WARNING!
Raisingthevehiclehigherthannecessarycanmake thevehicleunstableandcauseacollision.Itcould slipoffthejackandhurtsomeonearit.Raisethe vehicleonlyenoughtoremovethetire.
- Remove the wheel nuts and pull the wheel off. Install the spare wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped end of the wheel nuts toward the wheel. To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack, do not fully tighten the wheel nuts until the vehicle has been lowered.
- Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the wrench while at the end of the handle for increased leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until each nut has been tightened twice. For the correct lug nut torque refer to "Torque Specifications" in this section. If in doubt about the correct tightness, have them checked with a torque wrench by you authorized dealer or service station.
WARNING!
Aloosetireorjackthrownforwardinacollisionor hardstopcouldinjuresomeoneinthevehicle.Alwaysstowthejackpartsandtheextratireandwheel intheplacesprovided.
- Install the wheel center cap and remove the wheel blocks. Do not install chrome or aluminum wheel center caps on the spare wheel. This may result in cap damage.
- Lower the jack to its fully closed position. If the bottle jack will not lower by turning the dial (thumbwheel) by hand, it may be necessary to use the jack drive tube in order to lower the jack. Stow the replaced tire, jack, and tools as previously described.
- Adjust the tire pressure when possible.
NOTE: Do not oil wheel studs. For chrome wheels, do not substitute with chrome plated wheel nuts.
ToStowTheFlatOrSpare
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with aluminum wheels cannot be stored under the vehicle because the wheel retainer will not fit through the wheel pilot hole. Secure the flat tire in the bed of the truck. Havetheflattire repairedorreplacedimmediately.
WARNING!
Aloosetirethrownforwardinacollisionorhard stopcouldinjuretheoccupantsinthevehicle.Have thedeflated(flat)tirerepairedorreplacedimmediately.
- Turn the wheel so that the valve stem is facing the ground and toward the rear of the vehicle for convenience in checking the spare tire inflation. Slide the wheel retainer through the center of the wheel.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 647

natural_image
Close-up of a hand adjusting a car tire wheel, no visible text or symbols
natural_image
Illustration of hands cleaning a car tire with a handle (no text or symbols)060573852
ReinstallingTheRetainerPullingTheRetainerThroughTheCenterOfTheWheel
- Lift the spare tire with one hand to give clearance to tilt the retainer at the end of the cable and position it properly across the wheel opening.
AndPositioningIt
- Attach the wheel wrench to the jack extension tube with the curved angle facing away from the vehicle. Insert the tube through the access hole between the lower tailgate and the top of the bumper and into the winch mechanism tube.

Information Provided by: DEALER
648 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a car's rear wheel and suspension components (no text or symbols)WheelWrenchAndJackExtensionTubeAssembledAndInPosition
- Rotate the lug wrench handle clockwise until the wheel is drawn into place against the underside of the vehicle. Continue to rotate until you feel the winch mechanism slip, or click three or four times. It cannot be overtightened. Push against the tire several times to ensure it is firmly in place.

natural_image
Mechanic using a tool to adjust the engine compartment (no text or symbols visible)RotatingTheWheelWrenchHandle
NOTE: The winch mechanism is designed for use with the jack extension tube only. Use of an air wrench or other power tools is not recommended and can damage the winch.

ReinstallingTheJackAndTools(1500Series)
- Tighten the jack all the way down by turning the jack turn-screw counterclockwise until the jack is snug.
- Position the jack and tool bag. Make sure the lug wrench is under the jack near the jack turn-screw.

natural_image
Mechanical device with attached cable and housing (no visible text or symbols)060573848
JackAndToolBag
- Secure the tool bag straps to the jack.

natural_image
Mechanical component with attached clamps and tubing, no visible text or symbols060601443
JackAndToolsTied
- Place the jack and tools in the storage position holding the jack by the jack turn-screw, slip the jack and tools under the seat so that the bottom slot engages into the fastener on the floor.

Information Provided by. DEALER
650 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

natural_image
Close-up of a car's dashboard and engine compartment with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Interior view of a car showing seatbelt and dashboard controls with an arrow pointing to a vehicle (no text or symbols visible)JackHoldDownFastenerJackAndTools(1500Series)
NOTE: Ensure that the jack slides into the front hold down location.
- Turn the wing bolt clockwise to secure to the floor pan. Reinstall the plastic cover.

Information Provident Syc. DEALER
WARNING!
Afterusingthejackandtools,alwaysreinstallthem intheoriginalcarrierandlocation.Whiledriving youmayexperienceabruptstopping,rapidaccelerationorsharpturns.Aloosejack,tools,bracketor otherobjectsinthevehiclemaymovearoundwith force,resultinginseriousinjury.
Jacking And Tire Changing 2500 And 3500 Series Trucks
WARNING!
- Donotattempttochangeatireonthesideofthe vehicleclosetomovingtraffic.Pullfarenoughoff theroadtoavoidthedangerofbeinghitwhen operatingthejackorchangingthewheel.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Beingunderajacked-upvehicleisdangerous. The vehiclecouldslipoffthejackandfallonyou. You couldbecrushed. Neverputanypartofyourbody underavehiclethatisonajack. If youneedtoget underaraisedvehicle, takeittoaservicecenter whereitcanberaisedonalift.
- Neverstartorruntheenginewhilethevehicleis onajack.
- Thejackisdesignedtobeusedasatoolfor changingtiresonly.Thejackshouldnotbeusedto liftthevehicleforservicepurposes.Thevehicle shouldbejackedonafirmlevelsurfaceonly. Avoidiceorslipperyareas.
JackLocation
The jack and jack tools are stored under the front passenger seat.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
652 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
RemovalOfJackAndTools(2500,3500Series)
To access the jack and jack tools you must remove the plastic access cover, located on the side of the front passengers seat. To remove the cover, pull the front part of the cover (closest to the front of the seat) toward you to release a locking tab. Once the front of the cover is loose, slide the cover toward the front of the seat until it is free from the seat frame.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing the seatbelt and directional arrow (no text or symbols)JackAccessCover
Remove the jack and tools by turning the wing bolt counterclockwise, remove the wing bolt and then slide the assembly out from under the seat.

Information Provided by. DEALER
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 653

natural_image
Mechanical component assembly inside a car, showing a lock and valve mechanism (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Technical illustration of a mechanical assembly with cylindrical components and mounting brackets (no text or symbols)060574343
JackAndTools(2500/3500Series)JackAndToolsBracketAssembly
Remove the jack and tools from the bracket assembly.
Turn the jack-turn-screw counterclockwise to release jack from bracket assembly.

Information Provider Pty. DEALER
654 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Afterusingthejackandtools,alwaysreinstallthem intheoriginalcarrierandlocation.Whiledriving youmayexperienceabruptstopping,rapidaccelerationorsharpturns.Aloosejack,tools,bracketor otherobjectsinthevehiclemaymovearoundwith force,resultinginseriousinjury.
RemovingTheSpareTire
- Remove the spare tire before attempting to jack up the truck. Attach the wheel wrench to the jack extension tube with the curved angle facing away from the vehicle. Insert the tube through the access hole between the lower tailgate and the top of the bumper and into the winch mechanism tube.

natural_image
Mechanical component assembly showing a bracket with mounting holes and a wrench inserted (no visible text or symbols)060573849
WheelWrenchAndJackExtensionTubeAssembled
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 655

natural_image
Side view of a car's rear bumper with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Mechanic using a tool to adjust or install a car component (no visible text or symbols)InsertingTheJackExtensionTubeIntoTheAccessHoleRotatingTheWheelWrenchHandle
- Rotate the wheel wrench handle counterclockwise
until the spare tire is on the ground with enough cable slack to allow you to pull it out from under the vehicle.

Information Provided like
DEALER
表三 中 内 以 二 年 定 低
656 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
- Pull the spare tire out from under the vehicle to gain access to the spare tire retainer.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a car wheel mounted on a vehicle chassis with attached suspension components (no text or symbols)- Lift the spare tire with one hand to give clearance to tilt the retainer at the end of the cable.

natural_image
Illustration of hands installing or adjusting a car tire component (no text or symbols visible)PullingTheSpareTireOutGainingAccessToTheRetainer

Information Provider by: DEALER
- Pull the retainer through the center of the wheel.

natural_image
Close-up of a hand adjusting a car tire with a tool, no visible text or symbolsPullingTheRetainerThroughTheCenterOfTheWheel
NOTE: The winch mechanism is designed for use with the jack extension tube only. Use of an air wrench or other power tools is not recommended and can damage the winch.
Preparations
- Park the vehicle on a firm, level surface. Avoid ice or slippery areas.
WARNING!
Donotattempttochangeatireonthesideofthe vehicleclosetomovingtraffic,pullfarenoughoff theroadtoavoidthedangerofbeinghitwhen operatingthejackorchangingthewheel.
- Turn on the Hazard Warning flasher.
- Set the parking brake.
- Place the shift lever into PARK. On four-wheel drive vehicles, shift the transfer case to the 4L position.
- Turn the ignition OFF.

658 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally opposite the jacking position. For example, if the right front wheel is being changed, block the left rear wheel.

NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is being jacked.
JackInstructions(2500,3500Series)
WARNING!
Carefully follow the set of receiving warning to help prevent personal injury or damage to your vehicle:
- Alwaysparkonafirm, levelsurfaceasfarfromthe edgeoftheroadwayaspossiblebeforeraisingthe vehicle.
• TurnontheHazardWarningflasher. - Blockthewheeldiagonallyoppositethewheelto beraised.
- Settheparkingbrakefirmlyandsetanautomatic transmissioninPARK;amanualtransmissionin REVERSE.
- Neverstartorruntheenginewiththevehicleona jack.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotletanyonesitinthevehiclewhenitisona jack.
- Donotgetunderthevehiclewhenitisonajack. If youneedtogetunderaraisedvehicle, takeittoa servicecenterwhereitcanberaisedonalift.
- Onlyusethejackinthepositionsindicatedandfor liftingthisvehicleduringatirechange.
- If working on or near a roadway, be extremely careful of motortraffic.
- Toassurethatsparetires,flatorinflated,are securelystowed,sparesmustbestowedwiththe valvestemfacingtheground.

text_image
PRNO3L P RJackWarningLabel

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing internal components with a white arrow pointing to a specific part (no text or symbols present)Lug WrenchAdapterLocationAndJackingTools

Information Provided by: DEALER
660 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Donotattempttoraisethevehiclebyjackingon locationsotherthanthoseindicatedintheJacking Instructionsforthisvehicle.
- Remove the spare wheel, jack, and tools from storage.
- Using the lug wrench, loosen, but do not remove, the wheel nuts by turning them counterclockwise one turn while the wheel is still on the ground. Changing a dually tire requires the lug wrench adapter.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with hub caps/wheel covers they must be removed before raising the vehicle off the ground. Refer to "Hub Caps/Wheel Covers — If Equipped" in this section.

natural_image
Close-up of a car wheel rim with a black arrow pointing to the center bull (no text or symbols visible)LugWrenchAdapter
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 661

natural_image
Top-down view of a car tire wheel assembly with a wrench inserted (no text or symbols visible)LugWrenchAdapterAndWrench
- Placement of the jack:
4x2SeriesTrucksFrontJackingLocation
For 2500 and 3500 4x2 series trucks, when changing a front wheel, place the bottle jack under the frame rail behind the wheel. Locate the jack as far forward as possible on the straight part of the frame.
Operate the jack using the jack drive tube and the wheel wrench. The tube extension, may be used, but is not required.

natural_image
Side profile illustration of a pickup truck with an upward arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols)060609051
4x2FrontJackingLocation
4x4SeriesTrucksFrontJackingLocation
For 2500 and 3500 4x4 series trucks, when changing the front wheel, assemble the jack drive tube to the jack and

662 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
connect the drive tube to the extension tube. Place the jack under the axle as close to the tire as possible with the drive tubes extending to the front. Connect the jack tube extension and wheel wrench.

natural_image
Front view of a black Toyota T-9 SUV with two upward arrows indicating side-mounted or head-mounted components (no text or symbols on the vehicle itself)4x4FrontJackingLocation
4x2and4x4RearJackingLocation
For 4x2 and 4x4 trucks, when changing a rear wheel, assemble the jack drive tube to the jack and connect the drive tube to the extension tube. Place the jack under the axle between the spring and the shock absorber with the drive tubes extending to the rear.

natural_image
Top-down view of a 4X4 pickup truck showing front wheel, exhaust pipe, and tire (no text or symbols on the vehicle itself)RearJackingLocation(All)

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 663
Connect the jack tube extension and wheel wrench.
CAUTION!
Before raising the wheel off the ground, makesure that the jack will not damage surrounding truck parts and adjust the jack position as required.
NOTE: If the bottle jack will not lower by turning the dial (thumbwheel) by hand, it may be necessary to use the jack drive tube in order to lower the jack.
- By rotating the wheel wrench clockwise, raise the vehicle until the wheel just clears the surface.
WARNING!
Raisingthevehiclehigherthannecessarycanmake thevehicleunstableandcauseacollision.Itcould slipoffthejackandhurtsomeonenearit.Raisethe vehicleonlyenoughtoremovethetire.
- Remove the wheel nuts and pull the wheel off. On single rear-wheel (SRW) trucks, install the spare wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped end of the wheel nuts toward the wheel. On 3500 dual rear-wheel models (DRW) the wheel nuts are a two-piece assembly with a flat face. Lightly tighten the wheel nuts. To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack, do not fully tighten the wheel nuts until the vehicle has been lowered.

664 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

natural_image
Close-up of a car tire with a black arrow pointing to the wheel rim (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Close-up of an aircraft landing gear with visible treads and a small attached component (no text or symbols)InnerWheelProperPlacementDualRearWheelPlacement
- Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the wrench while at the end of the handle for increased leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until each nut has been tightened twice. For the correct lug nut torque refer to "Torque Specifications" in this section. If in doubt about the correct tightness, have

Information Provided by: DEALER
them checked with a torque wrench by you authorized dealer or service station.
WARNING!
Aloosetireorjackthrownforwardinacollisionor hardstopcouldinjuresomeoneinthevehicle.Alwaysstowthejackpartsandtheextratireandwheel intheplacesprovided.
- Install the wheel center cap and remove the wheel blocks. Do not install chrome or aluminum wheel center caps on the spare wheel. This may result in cap damage.
-
Lower the jack to its fully closed position. If the bottle jack will not lower by turning the dial (thumbwheel) by hand, it may be necessary to use the jack drive tube in order to lower the jack. Stow the replaced tire, jack, and tools as previously described.
-
Adjust the tire pressure when possible.
NOTE: Do not oil wheel studs. For chrome wheels, do not substitute with chrome plated wheel nuts.
ToStowTheFlatOrSpare
NOTE: Havetheflattirerepairedorreplacedimmediately.
WARNING!
Aloosetirethrownforwardinacollisionorhard stopcouldinjuretheoccupantsinthevehicle.Have thedeflated(flat)tirerepairedorreplacedimmediately.
- Turn the wheel so that the valve stem is facing the ground and toward the rear of the vehicle for convenience in checking the spare tire inflation. Slide the wheel retainer through the center of the wheel.
666 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

natural_image
Close-up of a hand adjusting a car tire wheel with a tool, no visible text or symbols
natural_image
Illustration of hands installing or adjusting a car tire component (no text or symbols visible)ReinstallingTheRetainerPullingTheRetainerThroughTheCenterOfTheWheel
- Lift the spare tire with one hand to give clearance to tilt the retainer at the end of the cable and position it properly across the wheel opening.
AndPositioningIt
- Attach the wheel wrench to the jack extension tube with the curved angle facing away from the vehicle. Insert the tube through the access hole between the lower tailgate and the top of the bumper and into the winch mechanism tube.

Information Provident by: DEALER
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 667

natural_image
Mechanical assembly diagram showing a tire mounted on a vehicle chassis with attached components (no text or symbols)WheelWrenchAndJackExtensionTubeAssembledAndInPosition
- Rotate the lug wrench handle clockwise until the wheel is drawn into place against the underside of the vehicle. Continue to rotate until you feel the winch
mechanism slip, or click three or four times. It cannot be overtightened. Push against the tire several times to ensure it is firmly in place.

natural_image
Mechanic using a tool to adjust the engine compartment of a vehicle (no text or symbols visible)RotatingTheWheelWrenchHandle

Information Provident Syc. DEALER
668 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
NOTE: The winch mechanism is designed for use with the jack extension tube only. Use of an air wrench or other power tools is not recommended and can damage the winch.
ReinstallingTheJackAndTools(2500And3500 Series)
-
Tighten the jack all the way down by turning the jack turn-screw counterclockwise until the jack is snug.
-
Position the jack and tools into bracket assembly. Make sure the lug wrench is under the jack near the jack turn-screw. Snap tools into bracket assembly clips. Install the jack into bracket assembly and turn the jack-turn-screw clockwise until jack is snug into bracket assembly.

natural_image
3D technical illustration of a mechanical assembly with cylindrical components and mounting brackets (no text or symbols)JackAndToolsBracketAssembly
- Place the jack and tool bracket assembly in the storage position holding the jack by the jack turn-screw, slip the jack and tools under the seat so that the bottom slot engages into the fastener on the floor.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 669

natural_image
Close-up of a car's dashboard and engine compartment with a white arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)
natural_image
Mechanical assembly with a black arrow pointing to a component, no visible text or symbolsJackHoldDownFastenerJackAndTools(2500/3500Series)
NOTE: Ensure that the jack and tool bracket assembly slides into the front hold down location.
- Turn the wing bolt clockwise to secure to the floor pan. Reinstall the plastic cover.
HubCaps/WheelCovers—IfEquipped
The hub caps must be removed before raising the vehicle off the ground.

Information Provided by: DEALER
CAUTION!
Useextremec cautionwhenremovingthefrontand rearcentercaps. Damagecanoccurtothecentercap and/orthewheelifscrewdrivertypetoolsareused. A pullingmotion, notapryoffmotion, isrecommendedtoremovethecaps.
For single rear wheel (SRW) models, use the flat blade on the end of the lug wrench to pull the hub cap off. Insert the blade end into the pull off notch and carefully pull the hub cap off with a back and forth motion.
On 3500 models with dual rear wheels (DRW), you must first remove the hub caps. The jack handle driver has a hook at one end that will fit in the pull off notch of the rear hub caps. Position the hook and pull straight out on the ratchet firmly. The hub cap should pop off. The wheel skins can now be removed. For the front hub cap, use the
flat blade on the end of the lug wrench to pull the caps off. The wheel skin can now be removed.
CAUTION!
- Useapullingmotiontoremovethehubcap.Donot useatwistingmotionwhenremovingthehubcap, damagetothehubcap;finishmayoccur.
- Therearhubcapsonthedualrearwheelhastwo pulloffnotches.Makesurethatthehookofthe jackhandledriverislocatedsquarelyinthecap notchbeforeattemptingtopulloff.
You must use the flat end of the lug wrench to pull off the wheel skins. Locate the hub cap pull notches (2 notches on each cap). Insert the flat tip completely and using a back and forth motion, loosen the wheel skin. Repeat this procedure around the tire until the skin pops off.
Replace the wheel skins first using a rubber mallet. When replacing the hub caps, tilt the cap retainer over the lug nut bolt circle and strike the high side down with a rubber mallet. Be sure that the hub caps and wheel skins are firmly seated around the wheel.
HOISTING
A conventional floor jack may be used at the jacking locations. Refer to the graphics that show jacking locations. However, a floor jack or frame hoist must never be used on any other parts of the underbody.
CAUTION!
Neveruseafloorjackdirectlyunderthedifferential housingofaloadedtruckordamagetoyourvehicle mayresult.
JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURES
If your vehicle has a discharged battery it can be jump-started using a set of jumper cables and a battery in another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack follow the manufacturer's operating instructions and precautions.
CAUTION!
Donotuseaportablebatteryboosterpackorany otherboostersourcewithasystemvoltagegreater than12Voltsordamagetothebattery,startermotor, alternatororelectricalsystemmayoccur.
672 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Donotattemptjump-startingifthebatteryisfrozen. Itcouldruptureorexplodeandcausepersonalinjury.
Preparations For Jump-Start
The battery in your vehicle is located in the front of the engine compartment, behind the left headlight assembly.
NOTE: The positive battery post is covered with a protective cap. Lift up on the cap to gain access to the positive battery post.

natural_image
Interior view of a car showing engine compartment with a black arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)PositiveBatteryPost
WARNING!
• Takecaretoavoidtheradiatorcoolingfanwheneverthehoodisraised.ItcanstartanytimetheignitionswitchisON.Youcanbeinjuredbymovingfanblades.
- Removeanymetaljewelrysuchasrings, watch bandsandbraceletsthatcouldmakeaninadvertent electricalcontact. Youcouldbeseriouslyinjured.
- Batteriescontainsulfuricacidthatcanburnyour skinoreyesandgeneratehydrogengaswhichis flammableandexplosive.Keepopenflamesor sparksawayfromthebattery.
-
Set the parking brake, shift the automatic transmission into PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
-
Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
-
If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Donotallowvehiclestotoucheachotherasthis couldestablishagroundconnectionandpersonal injurycouldresult.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Failure to follow this jump-starting procedure could result in personal injury or property damaged due to battery explosion.
674 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in damageto the charging system of the booster vehicle orthedischarged vehicle.
ConnectingTheJumperCables
- Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
- Connect the opposite end of the positive (+)jumper cable to the positive (+)post of the booster battery.
- Connect the negative (-) end of the jumper cable to the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
- Connect the opposite end of the negative (-)jumper cable to a good engine ground (exposed metal part of the discharged vehicle's engine) away from the battery and the fuel injection system.
WARNING!
Donotconnectthejumpercabletothenegative(-) postofthedischargedbattery. Theresultingelectricalsparkcouldcausethebatterytoexplodeand couldresultinpersonalinjury. Onlyusethespecific groundpoint, donotuseanyotherexposedmetal parts.
-
Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then start the engine in the vehicle with the discharged battery.
-
Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables in the reverse sequence:
DisconnectingTheJumperCables
- Disconnect the negative (-)end of the jumper cable from the engine ground of the vehicle with the discharged battery.
- Disconnect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper cable from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
- Disconnect the positive (+)end of the jumper cable from the positive (+)post of the booster battery.
- Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper cable from the positive (+) post of the vehicle with the discharged battery.
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle you should have the battery and charging system inspected at your authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
Accessoriespluggedintothevehiclepoweroutlets drawpowerfromthevehicle'sbattery,evenwhennot inuse(i.e.,cellularphones,etc.).Eventually,if pluggedinlongenoughwithoutengineoperation, thevehicle'sbatterywilldischargesufficientlyto degradebatterylifeand/orpreventtheenginefrom starting.
FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand, or snow, it can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE and REVERSE (with automatic transmission) or 2nd gear and REVERSE (with manual transmission), while gently
676 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
pressing the accelerator. Use the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure that will maintain the rocking motion, without spinning the wheels or racing the engine.
NOTE: For trucks equipped with 8-speed automatic transmission: Shifts between DRIVE and REVERSE can only be achieved at wheel speeds of 5 mph (8 km/h) or less. Whenever the transmission remains in NEUTRAL for more than two seconds, you must press the brake pedal to engage DRIVE or REVERSE.
CAUTION!
Racingtheengineorspinningthewheelsmayleadto transmissionoverheatingandfailure.AllowtheenginetoidlewiththetransmissioninNEUTRALforat leastoneminuteaftereveryfiverocking-motion cycles.Thiswillminimizeoverheatingandreduce
CAUTION!(Continued)
theriskoftransmissionfailureduringprolonged effortstofreeeastuckvehicle.
NOTE: Press the "ESC Off" switch, to place the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system in "Partial Off" mode, before rocking the vehicle. Refer to "Electronic Brake Control" in "Starting And Operating" for further information. Once the vehicle has been freed, press the "ESC Off" switch again to restore "ESC On" mode.
CAUTION!
- When "rocking" astuckvehiclebyshiftingbetweenDRIVE/2ndgearandREVERSE, donotspin thewheelsfasterthan15mph(24km/h), ordrive-traindamagemayresult.
(Continued)
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Revvingtheengineorspinningthewheelstoofast mayleadtotransmissionoverheatingandfailure. Itcanalsodamagethetires.Donotspinthewheels above30mph(48km/h)whileingear(notransmissionshiftingoccurring).
WARNING!
Fastspinningtirescanbedangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheels speeds may caused damage, or even failure, of the axle and tires. Atire could explode and injuresome one. Donot spiny our vehicle's wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and donot let any on near aspinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
EMERGENCY TOW HOOKS — IF EQUIPPED
Your vehicle may be equipped with emergency tow hooks.
NOTE: For off-road recovery, it is recommended to use both of the front tow hooks to minimize the risk of damage to the vehicle.
WARNING!
- Donotuseachainforfreeingastuckvehicle. Chainsmaybreak,causingseriousinjuryordeath.
- Standclearofvehicleswhenpullingwithtow hooks.Towstrapsmaybecomedisengaged,causingseriousinjury.
678 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Towhooksareforemergencyuseonlytorescuea vehiclestrandedoff-road.Donotusetowhooksfor towtruckhookuporhighwaytowing.Youcould damageyourvehicle.
If a malfunction occurs and the shift lever cannot be moved out of the PARK position, you can use one of the following procedures to temporarily move the shift lever:
Column Shifter — If Equipped
- Turn the engine off.
- Firmly apply the parking brake.
- Tilt the steering wheel to the full up position.
-
Press and maintain firm pressure on the br ake pedal.
-
Insert a screwdriver or similar tool, into the access port (ringed circle) on the bottom of the steering column and push and hold the override release lever up.

natural_image
Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)ShiftLeverOverrideAccessPort
- Move the shift lever to the NEUTRAL position.
- The vehicle may then be started in NEUTRAL.
Center Console Shifter — If Equipped
- Turn the engine off.
- Firmly apply the parking brake.
- Using a small screwdriver or similar tool, remove the shift lever override access cover (located to the right of the shift lever).
- Press and maintain firm pressure on the brake pedal.
- Insert the screwdriver or similar tool into the access hole, and push and hold the override release lever down.

natural_image
Mechanical assembly showing a lever mechanism with a directional arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols present)ShiftLeverOverrideAccessCover
- Move the shift lever to the NEUTRAL position.
- The vehicle may then be started in NEUTRAL.
- Reinstall the shift lever override access cover.
680 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
MANUAL PARK RELEASE — 8 SPEED TRANSMISSION
WARNING!
Alwayssecureyourvehiclebyfullyapplyingthe parkingbrake, beforeactivatingtheManualPark Release. ActivatingtheManualParkReleasewill allowyourvehicletorollawayifitisnotsecuredby theparkingbrakeorbyproperconnectiontoatow vehicle. ActivatingtheManualParkReleaseonan unsecuredvehiclecouldleadtoseriousinjuryor deathforthoseinoraroundthevehicle.
In order to push or tow the vehicle in cases where the transmission will not shift out of PARK (such as a dead battery), a Manual Park Release is available.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a parking control panel with an arrow pointing to the door (no text or symbols visible)ManualParkReleasePullStrap
Follow these steps to activate the Manual Park Release:
-
Firmly apply the parking brake.
-
Using a small screwdriver or similar tool, remove the Manual Park Release access cover, which is just above the parking brake release handle, below and to the left of the steering column.
- Using the screwdriver or similar tool, push the Manual Park Release lever locking tab (just below the middle of the lever) to the right.
- While holding the locking tab in the disengaged position, pull the tether strap to rotate the lever rearward, until it locks in place pointing towards the driver's seat. Release the locking tab and verify that the Manual Park Release lever is locked in the released position.
- The vehicle is now out of PARK and can be towed. Release the parking brake only when the vehicle is securely connected to a tow vehicle.
ToResetTheManualParkRelease:
- Push the locking tab to the right, to unlock the lever.
- Rotate the Manual Park Release lever forward to its original position, until the locking tab snaps into place to secure the lever.
- Pull gently on the tether strap to confirm that the lever is locked in its stowed position.
- Re-install the access cover.

682 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled vehicle using a commercial wrecker service. If the transmission and drivetrain are operable, disabled vehicles may also be towed as described under “Recreational Towing” in the “Starting and Operating” section.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with air suspension must be placed in Transport mode, before tying them down (from the body) on a trailer or flatbed truck. Refer to "Air Suspension" in "Starting and Operating" for more information. If the vehicle cannot be placed in Transport mode (for example, engine will not run), tie-downs must be fastened to the axles (not to the body). Failure to follow these instructions may cause fault codes to be set and/or cause loss of proper tie-down tension.

Information Provided by. DEALER
| Towing Condition | Wheels OFFthe Ground | 2WDModels4WDModels | |
| Flat Tow NONE Iftransmissionisoperable:Transmission in NEUTRAL30 mph (48 km/h)maxspeed15 miles (24 km)maxdistance (6-speed transmission)30 miles (48 km)maxdistance (8-speed transmission) | Seeinstructionsin“RecreationalTowing”under“StartingandOperating”Automatic Transmission in PARKManual Transmission in gear (NOT NEUTRAL)Transfer Case in NEUTRAL(N)Tow in forward direction | ||
| Wheel Lift or Dolly Tow | Front NOTALLOWED | ||
| Rear OK | NOTALLOWED | ||
| Flatbed ALLBESTMETHODBESTMETHOD | |||
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to prevent damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars and other equipment designed for this purpose, following equipment manufacturer's instructions. Use of safety chains is
mandatory. Attach a tow bar or other towing device to main structural members of the vehicle, not to bumpers or associated brackets. State and local laws regarding vehicles under tow must be observed.
684 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.) while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN position, not the ACC position.
If the key fob is unavailable or the vehicle's battery is discharged, refer to "Manual Park Release" or "Shift Lever Override" in this section for instructions on shifting the automatic transmission out of PARK for towing.
CAUTION!
Donotuseslingtypeequipmentwhentowing. Whensecuringthevehicletoaflatbedtruck, donot attachtofrontorrearsuspensioncomponents. Damagetoyourvehiclemayresultfromimpropertowing.
Two-Wheel Drive Models
The manufacturer recommends towing your vehicle with all four wheels OFF the ground using a flatbed.
If flatbed equipment is not available, and the transmission is operable, this vehicle may be towed (with rear wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:
• The transmission must be in NEUTRAL.
- The towing speed must not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
- The towing distance must not exceed 15 miles (24 km) for 6-speed transmission, or 30 miles (48 km) for 8-speed transmission.
If the transmission is not operable, or the vehicle must be towed faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or farther than 15 miles (24 km) for 6-speed transmission, or 30 miles (48 km) for 8-speed transmission, tow with the rear wheels OFFthe ground. Acceptable methods are to tow the vehicle on a flatbed, or with the front wheels raised and the rear wheels on a towing dolly, or (when using a suitable steering wheel stabilizer to hold the front wheels in the straight position) with the rear wheels raised and the front wheels on the ground.

CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle inviolation of the aboverequirements can cause severe engine and/or transmission damage. Damage from impropertowing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Four-Wheel Drive Models
The manufacturer recommends towing with all wheels OFFthe ground. Acceptable methods are to tow the vehicle on a flatbed or with one end of vehicle raised and the opposite end on a towing dolly.
If flatbed equipment is not available, and the transfer case is operable, the vehicle may be towed (in the forward direction, with ALLwheels on the ground), IF the transfer case is in NEUTRAL (N) and the transmission is in PARK(for automatic transmissions) or in gear (NOT in NEUTRAL, for manual transmissions). Refer to
"Recreational Towing" in "Starting And Operating" for further information and detailed instructions.
CAUTION!
- Frontorrearwheelliftsmustnotbeused. Internal damagetothetransmissionortransfercasewill occurifafrontorrearwheelliftisusedwhen towing.
- Towing this vehicle inviolation of the above requirements can cause severetransmission and/or transfercased damage. Damage from impropertowing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.

Information Provided by
DEALER
电(开) 01 二矿管管
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
■ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
■ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 5.7L . . . . . . . . . . . .691
■ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 6.4L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
■ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM (OBD II) . . .693 □Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
■EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS....694
■REPLACEMENT PARTS....695
■DEALER SERVICE....695
■MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES....696
□Engine Oil....697
□Engine Oil Filter....700
□Engine Air Cleaner Filter....701
□Maintenance-Free Battery....701
□Air Conditioner Maintenance .....702
□Front Driveshaft Lubrication — 2500/3500 (Four-Wheel Drive Models Only) .....704
□Body Lubrication....704
□Windshield Wiper Blades .705
688 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
□Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 705
□Exhaust System....706
□Cooling System....709
□Brake System....717
□Rear Axle And 4x4 Front Driving Axle Fluid Level....719
□Transfer Case....720
□Automatic Transmission....721
□Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion....725
■FUSES....733
□Power Distribution Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 734
■VEHICLE STORAGE....743
■REPLACEMENT BULBS....743
■BULB REPLACEMENT....745
☐Base Quad / Premium Bi-Halogen: Low Beam Headlamp, High Beam Headlamp, Front Park And Turn — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
□Fog Lamps — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
□Rear Tail/Stop, Turn Signal And Backup Lamps....748
□Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) With Cargo Lamp .750
□Cab Top Clearance Lamps — If Equipped . . . .752
☐Rear Lamp Bar ID Marker (Dual Rear Wheels) — If Equipped. .753
□Side Marker Lamps (Dual Rear Wheels) — If Equipped .754
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 689
■FLUID CAPACITIES....755
□Engine....758
■ FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS . .758
□Chassis....760
690 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L

text_image
Technical diagram of an automotive engine bay with numbered components for identification1 — Air Cleaner Filter 5 — Battery
2 — Engine Oil Dipstick 6 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
3 — Engine Oil Fill 7 — Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
4 — Brake Fluid Reservoir 8 — Engine Coolant Reservoir

Information Provider by: DEALER
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 5.7L

text_image
Labeled diagram of a car engine bay with numbered components for identification071405704
1 — Air Cleaner Filter 7 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
2 — Automatic Transmission Dipstick (6-Speed Trans Only) 8 — Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
3 — Engine Oil Fill 9 — Power Steering Fluid Reservoir (2500/3500 Models Only)
4 — Engine Oil Dipstick 10 — Coolant Pressure Cap
5 — Brake Fluid Reservoir 11 — Engine Coolant Reservoir
6 — Battery

Information Provided by: DEALER
692 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 6.4L

text_image
Labeled diagram of a car engine bay with numbered components for identification0745905289
1 — Coolant Pressure Bottle 6 — Battery
2 — Transmission Dipstick 7 — Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
3 — Engine Oil Fill 8 — Washer Solvent
4 — Engine Oil Dipstick 9 — Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
5 — Brake Fluid Reservoir
10 — Air Cleaner Filter

Information Provider Pty. DEALER
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM (OBD II)
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic transmission control systems. When these systems are operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” It will also store diagnostic codes and other information to assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as soon as possible.
CAUTION!
- ProlongeddrivingwiththeMILoncouldcause furtherdamagetotheemissioncontrolsystem.It couldalsoaffectfueleconomyanddriveability. Thevehiclemustbeservicedbeforeanyemissions testscanbeperformed.
- If the MIL is flashing, while the engine is running, severecatalytic converter damage and power loss will soon occur. Immediately service is required.
Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message

If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuel filler cap is loose, improperly installed, or damaged, a loose gascap indicator will display in the EVIC telltale display area.
Refer to "Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) in

694 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
"Understanding Your Instrument Panel" for further information. Tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the SELECT button to turn off the message. If the problem continues, the message will appear the next time the vehicle is started.
A loose, improperly installed, or damaged fuel filler cap may also turn on the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass an inspection of your vehicle's emissions control system. Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.

For states that require an Inspection and Maintenance (I/M), this check verifies the "Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)" is functioning and is not in the engine is running, and that the OBD II is ready for testing.
Normally, the OBD II system will be ready. The OBD II system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently serviced, recently had a dead battery or a battery replacement. If the OBD II system should be determined not ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.
Your vehicle has a simple ignition actuated test, which you can use prior to going to the test station. To check if your vehicle's OBD II system is ready, you must do the following:
- Cycle the ignition switch to the ON position, but do not crank or start the engine.
NOTE: If you crank or start the engine, you will have to start this test over.
- As soon as you cycle the ignition switch to the ON position, you will see the MIL symbol come on as part of a normal bulb check.

-
Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will happen:
-
The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then return to being fully illuminated until you turn OFF the ignition or start the engine. This means that your vehicle's OBD II system is notready and you should not proceed to the I/M station.
- The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully illuminated until you turn OFF the ignition or start the engine. This means that your vehicle's OBD II system is ready and you can proceed to the I/M station.
If your OBD II system is notready, you should see your authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement, you may need to do nothing more than drive your vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD II system to update. A recheck with the above test routine may then indicate that the system is now read y. Regardless of whether your vehicle's OBD II system is ready or not, if the MIL is illuminated during normal vehicle operation you should have your vehicle serviced before going to the I/M station. The I/M station can fail your vehicle because the MIL is on with the engine running.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Use of genuine MOPAR® parts for normal/scheduled maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures caused by the use of non-MOPAR® parts for maintenance and repairs will not be covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
DEALER SERVICE
Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personnel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are

696 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
available which include detailed service information for your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before attempting any procedure yourself.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control systems may void your warranty and could result in civil penalties being assessed against you.
WARNING!
Youcanbebadlyinjuredworkingonorarounda motorvehicle.Onlydoserviceworkforwhichyou havetheknowledgeandtheproperequipment.If youhaveanydoubtaboutyourabilitytoperforma servicejob,takeyourvehicletoacompetentmechanic.
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance services determined by the engineers who designed your vehicle.
Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed "Maintenance Schedule", there are other components which may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
- Failuretoproperlymaintainyourvehicleorperformrepairsandservicewhennecessarycould resultinmorecostlyrepairs,damagetoother componentsornegativelyimpactvehicleperformance.Immediatelyhavepotentialmalfunctions examinedbyanauthorizeddealerorqualified repaircenter.
(Continued)

CAUTION!(Continued)
- Yourvehiclehasbeenbuiltwithimprovedfluids thatprotecttheperformanceanddurabilityofyour vehicleandalsoallowextendedmaintenanceintervals.Donotusechemicalflushesinthesecomponentsasthechemicalscandamageyourengine, transmission,powersteeringorairconditioning. SuchdamageisnotcoveredbytheNewVehicle LimitedWarranty.Ifaflushisneededbecauseof componentmalfunction,useonlythespecified fluidfortheflushingprocedure.
Engine Oil
CheckingOilLevel
To assure proper lubrication of your vehicle's engine, the engine oil must be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at regular intervals, such as every fuel stop.
The best time to check the engine oil level is about five minutes after a fully warmed up engine is shut off.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil level readings. Always maintain the oil level within the SAFE zone on the dipstick. Adding one quart of oil when the reading is at the bottom of the SAFE zone will result in a reading at the top of the safe zone on these engines.
CAUTION!
Overfillingorunderfillingthecrankcasewillcause oilaerationorlossofoilpressure.Thiscoulddamage yourengine.
698 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ChangeEngineOil
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for further information.
NOTE: Undernocircumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months, whichever occurs first.
EngineOilSelection
For best performance and maximum protection under all types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395.
AmericanPetroleumInstitute(API)EngineOil IdentificationSymbol

text_image
AMERICAN PETROLEUM INSTITUTE FOR GASOLINE ENGINES CERTIFIEDThis symbol means that the oil has been certified by the American Petroleum Institute (API). The manufacturer only recommends API Certified engine oils.
CAUTION!
Donotusechemicalflushesinyourengineoilasthe chemicalscandamageyourengine.Suchdamageis notcoveredbytheNewVehicleLimitedWarranty.
EngineOilViscosity—3.6L/5.7LEngines(1500 ModelsOnly)
MOPAR® SAE 5W-20 engine oil approved to Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 or equivalent Pennzoil® or Shell Helix® is recommended for all operating temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine oil viscosity for your vehicle. For information on engine oil filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
NOTE:MOPAR® SAE 5W-30 engine oil approved to Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 may be used when SAE 5W-20 engine oil meeting MS-6395 is not available.
EngineOilViscosity—5.7LEngine(2500/3500 ModelsOnly)
MOPAR SAE 5W-20 engine oil or equivalent Pennzoil® or Shell Helix® is recommended for all operating temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy. The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on engine oil filler cap location, refer to "Engine Compartment" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.
NOTE:
- Lubricants which do not have both the engine oil certification mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade number should not be used.
700 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
- For 2500/3500 trucks with a 5.7L engine operating under a gross combined weight rating of 14,000 lbs (6 350 kg) or greater, SAE 5W-30 engine oil is recommended for all operating temperatures.
EngineOilViscosity—6.4LEngine
Use Pennzoil Ultra ^TM 0W–40 engine or equivalent MOPAR® oil meeting the Chrysler Material Standard MS-12633 for use in all operating temperatures.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on engine oil filler cap location, refer to the “Engine Compartment” in this section.
SyntheticEngineOils
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recommended oil quality requirements are met, and the recommended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes are followed.
DisposingOfUsedEngineOilAndOilFilters
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters, indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to the environment. Contact your authorized dealer, service station or governmental agency for advice on how and where used oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in your area.
Engine Oil Filter
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter at every engine oil change.
EngineOilFilterSelection
This manufacturer's engines have a full-flow type oil filter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The quality of replacement filters varies considerably. Only high

quality filters should be used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine oil filters are a high quality oil filter and are recommended.
Engine Air Cleaner Filter
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals.
WARNING!
Theairinductionsystem(aircleaner,hoses,etc.)can provide a measure of protection in the case of engine backfire. Donotremovetheairinduction system (air cleaner, hoses,etc.) unless such removal is necessary for repair or maintenance. Makes sure that no one is near the engine compartment before starting the vehicle with the air induction system (air cleaner, hoses,etc.) removed. Failure todos can result in serious personal injury.
EngineAirCleanerFilterSelection
The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine air cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recommended.
Maintenance-Free Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery. You will never have to add water, nor is periodic maintenance required.

WARNING!
- Batteryfluidisacorrosiveacidsolutionandcan burnorevenblindyou.Donotallowbatteryfluid tocontactyoureyes,skin,orclothing.Donotlean overabatterywhenattachingclamps.Ifacid splashesineyesoronskin,flushtheareimmediatelywithlargeamountsofwater.Referto "Jump-StartingProcedures"in"WhatToDoIn Emergencies"forfurtherinformation.
- Batterygasisflammableandexplosive.Keep flameorsparksawayfromthebattery.Donotuse aboosterbatteryoranyotherboostersourcewith anoutputgreaterthan12Volts.Donotallowcable clampstotoucheachother.
- Batteryposts, terminals, and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Washhands after handling.
CAUTION!
- It is essential when replacing the cables on the battery that the positive cable is attached to the positive post and then negative cable is attached to the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive (+) and negative (-) and are identified on the battery case. Cable clamp should be ignition on the terminal posts and free of corrosion.
- Ifa "fastcharger" is used while the battery is in the vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Donot use a "fastcharger" to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner should be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer at the start of each warm season. This service should include cleaning of the condenser fins and a performance test. Drive belt tension should also be checked at this time.
WARNING!
- Useonlyrefrigerantsandcompressorlubricants approvedbythemanufacturerforyourairconditioningsystem.Someunapprovedrefrigerantsare flammableandcanexplode,injuringyou.Other unapprovedrefrigerantsorlubricantscancausethe systemtofail,requiringcostlyrepairs.Referto WarrantyInformationBook,locatedontheDVD, forfurtherwarrantyinformation.
- The airconditioningsystem contains refrigerant underhigh pressure. To avoid risk of personal injury, ordamageto the system, adding refrigerant or any repair requiring linestobedisconnected should bed one by an experienced technician.
CAUTION!
Donotusechemicalflushesinyourairconditioning systemasthechemicalscandamageyourairconditioningcomponents.Suchdamageisnotcoveredby theNewVehicleLimitedWarranty.
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling R134a—If Equipped
R-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. However, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning service be performed by authorized dealer or other service facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system PAG compressor oil, and refrigerants.
704 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling HFO1234yf —If Equipped
HFO 1234yf Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product with a low GWP (Global Warming Potential). However, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning service be performed by authorized dealer or other service facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system PAG compressor oil, and refrigerants.
Front Driveshaft Lubrication — 2500/3500 (Four-Wheel Drive Models Only)
Lubricate the front driveshaft grease fitting at each oil change. Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals. Use MOPAR® Type MS-6560 (lithium-based grease), or equivalent.
Body Lubrication
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate, tailgate, decklid, sliding doors and hood hinges, should be lubricated periodically with a lithium based grease, such as MOPAR® Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to the application of any lubricant, the parts concerned should be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after lubricating excess oil and grease should be removed. Particular attention should also be given to hood latching components to ensure proper function. When performing other underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR® Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.

Windshield Wiper Blades
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the windshield periodically with a sponge or soft cloth and a mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove accumulations of salt or road film.
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt from a dry windshield.
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from the windshield. Keep the blade rubber out of contact with petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depending on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor performance of blades may be present with chattering, marks, water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions are present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necessary.
Adding Washer Fluid
The fluid reservoir is located under the hood and should be checked for fluid level at regular intervals. Fill the reservoir with windshield washer solvent only (not radiator antifreeze). When refilling the washer fluid reservoir, take some washer fluid and apply it to a cloth or towel and wipe the wiper blades clean. This will help blade performance.
To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system in cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets or exceeds the temperature range of your climate. This rating information can be found on most washer fluid containers.

WARNING!
Commerciallyavailablewindshieldwashersolvents areflammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care must be exercised when filling or working around the washers solution.
After the engine has warmed up, operate the defroster for a few minutes to reduce the possibility of smearing or freezing the fluid on the cold windshield. Windshield washer solution used with water as directed on the container, aids cleaning action, reduces the freezing point to avoid line clogging, and is not harmful to paint or trim.
Exhaust System
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust system.
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system; or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle; or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged; have an authorized technician inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
WARNING!
- Exhaustgasescaninjureorkill. They contain carbonmonoxide(CO), which is colorless and odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing CO, refer to "Safety Tips/ExhaustGas" in "Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle" for further information.
- Ahotexhaustsystemcanstartafireifyoupark overmaterialsthatcanburn.Suchmaterialsmight begrassorleavescomingintocontactwithyour exhaustsystem.Donotparkoroperateyourvehicleinareaswhereyourehaustsystemcancontactanythingthatcanburn.
CAUTION!
- The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control device and may seriously reduce engine performance and causes serious damage to the engine.
- Damagethecatalyticconvertercanresultifyour vehicleisnotkeptinproperoperatingcondition. Intheeventofenginemalfunction,particularly involvingenginemisfireorotherapparentlossof performance,haveyourvehicleservicedpromptly. Continuedoperationofyourvehiclewithasevere malfunctioncouldcausetheconvertertooverheat, resultinginpossibledamagetheconverterand vehicle.
708 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic converter will not require maintenance. However, it is important to keep the engine properly tuned to assure proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst damage.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control systems can result in civil penalties being assessed against you.
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool. Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer's specifications, should be obtained immediately.
To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter damage:
- Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition, when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in motion.
- Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the vehicle.
- Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
Cooling System
WARNING!
Youorotherscanbebadlyburnedbyhotengine coolant(antifreeze)orsteamfromyourradiator.If youseeorhearsteamcomingfromunderthehood, donotopenthehooduntiltheradiatorhashadtime tocool.Nevertrytoopenacoolingsystempressure capwhetheradiatorishot.
EngineCoolantChecks
Check the engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12 months (before the onset of freezing weather, where applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or rusty in appearance, the system should be drained, flushed and refilled with fresh coolant. Check the front of the A/C condenser (if equipped) or radiator for any accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 709
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the face of the A/C condenser (if equipped) or the back of the radiator core.
Check the engine cooling system hoses for brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts and tightness of the connection at the coolant recovery bottle and radiator. Inspect the entire system for leaks.
With the engine at normal operating temperature (but not running), check the cooling system pressure cap for proper vacuum sealing by draining a small amount of engine coolant (antifreeze) from the radiator drain cock. The radiator drain cock is located in the lower radiator tank. If the cap is sealing properly, the engine coolant (antifreeze) will begin to drain from the coolant expansion bottle. DO NOT REMOVE THE COOLANT PRESSURE CAP WHEN THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT.

710 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CoolingSystem—DrainFlushAndRefill
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with a reliable cooling system cleaner. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all deposits and chemicals. Properly dispose of old engine coolant (antifreeze).
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals.
SelectionOfCoolant
Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.
CAUTION!
- Mixingofenginecoolant(antifreeze)otherthan specifiedOrganicAdditiveTechnology(OAT)enginecoolant(antifreeze),mayresultinengine damageandmaydecreasecorrosionprotection. OrganicAdditiveTechnology(OAT)enginecoolantisdifferentandshouldnotbemixedwith HybridOrganicAdditiveTechnology(HOAT)enginecoolant(antifreeze)orany"globallycompatible"coolant(antifreeze).Ifanon-OATengine coolant(antifreeze)isintroducedintothecooling systeminanemergency,thecoolingsystemwill needtobedrained,flushed,andrefilledwithfresh OATcoolant(conformingtoMS-12106),byan authorizeddealerassoonaspossible.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
CAUTION!(Continued)
- Donotusewateraloneoralcohol-basedengine coolant(antifreeze)products.Donotuseadditional rustinhibitorsorantirustproducts,astheymaynot becompatiblewiththeradiatorenginecoolantand mayplugtheradiator.
- This vehicle has not been designed for use with propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze). Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
AddingCoolant
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS-12106) that allows extended maintenance intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up to ten years or 150,000 miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing this extended maintenance period, it is important that
you use the same engine coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS-12106) throughout the life of your vehicle.
Please review these recommendations for using Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106. When adding engine coolant (antifreeze):
- We recommend using MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology) that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106.
- Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106 and distilled water. Use higher concentrations (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below -34° F (-37° C) are anticipated.
712 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
- Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionized water when mixing the water/engine coolant (antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the engine cooling system.
Please note that it is the owner's responsibility to maintain the proper level of protection against freezing according to the temperatures occurring in the area where the vehicle is operated.
NOTE:
- Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could lead to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is needed to be added to the system please contact your local authorized dealer.
- Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not recommended and can result in cooling system damage. If HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in an emergency, have a authorized dealer drain, flush, and refill with OAT coolant (conforming to MS-12106) as soon as possible.
CoolingSystemPressureCap
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine coolant (antifreeze), and to ensure that the engine coolant (antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant expansion bottle.
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces.

WARNING!
- The warning words "DONOTOPENHOT" on the cooling system pressure cap areas safety precaution. Never add engine coolant (antifreeze) when the engine is overheated. Donot loosenor remove the captocoolan overheated engine. Heat causes pressure to build up in the cooling system. To prevent scalding or injury, donot remove the pressure cap while the system is shotor under pressure.
- Donotuseapressurecapotherthantheone specifiedforyourvehicle.Personalinjuryorenginedamagemayresult.
DisposalOfUsedEngineCoolant
Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check with your local authorities to determine the disposal rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by animals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) in open containers or allow it to remain in puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground spills immediately.
CheckingCoolantLevel—3.6Land5.7LEngines
With the engine OFF and cold, the level of the engine coolant should be between the ADD and SAFE range on the dipstick.
To check the coolant level:
- Open the coolant reservoir.

714 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with two circular components and a separate square, showing no visible text or symbols.
natural_image
Close-up of a hand using a tool to adjust or install a mechanical component (no visible text or symbols)OpeningTheCoolantReservoirCoolantReservoirDipstick
-
Lift and remove the plastic dipstick from the reservoir neck.
-
Check the coolant level on the dipstick.
The radiator normally remains completely full, so there is no need to remove the radiator cap unless checking for engine coolant (antifreeze) freeze point or replacing engine coolant (antifreeze). Advise your service attendant

of this. As long as the engine operating temperature is satisfactory, the coolant bottle need only be checked once a month.
When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to maintain the proper level, it should be added to the coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
CheckingCoolantLevel—6.4LEngine
The level of the coolant in the pressurized coolant bottle should be between the "MIN" and "MAX" range on the bottle when the engine is cold.
The radiator normally remains completely full, so there is no need to remove the cap unless checking for coolant freeze point or replacing engine coolant (antifreeze). Advise your service attendant of this. As long as the engine operating temperature is satisfactory, the coolant bottle need only be checked once a month. When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to maintain the proper level, it should be added to the coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
PointsToRemember
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/ kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming from the front of the engine compartment. This is normally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vaporized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
If an examination of your engine compartment shows no evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.

716 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
- Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
- Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in the coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (anti-freeze) needs to be added, the contents of the coolant expansion bottle must also be protected against freezing.
- If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are required, the cooling system should be pressure tested for leaks.
-
Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to MS-12106) and distilled water for proper corrosion protection of your engine which contains aluminum components.
-
Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle overflow hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
- Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the condenser clean.
- Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install ONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs may result in unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze) performance, poor gas mileage, and increased emissions.
Brake System
In order to assure brake system performance, all brake system components should be inspected periodically. Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper maintenance intervals.
WARNING!
Ridingthebrakescanleadtobrakefailureand possiblyacollision.Drivingwithyourfootrestingor ridingonthebrakepedalcanresultinabnormally highbraketemperatures,excessiveliningwear,and possiblebrakedamage.Youwouldnothaveyourfull brakingcapacityinanemergency.
BrakeFluidLevelCheck
The fluid level of the master cylinder should be checked when performing under the hood service or immediately if the brake system warning lamp indicates system failure.
The brake master cylinder has a translucent plastic reservoir. On the outboard side of the reservoir, there is a "MAX" dot and an "MIN" dot. The fluid level must be kept within these two dots. Do not add fluid above the MAX mark because leakage may occur at the cap.
With disc brakes the fluid level can be expected to fall as the brake linings wear. However, an unexpected drop in fluid level may be caused by a leak and a system check should be conducted.
Use only the manufacturer's recommended brake fluid. Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.

WARNING!
- Useonlymanufacturer's recommended brake fluid. Referto "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid can severely damage your brakes system and/or impair performance. The property of brake fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder reservoir.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- To avoid contamination from foreign matter or moisture, use only new brake fluidor fluid that has been in at nightly closed container. Keep them master cylinder reservoir arc secure data all times. Brake fluidina open container absorbsmoisture from the air resulting in lower boiling point. This may cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure. This could result in a collision.
• Overfillingthebrakefluidreservoircanresultin spillingbrakefluidonhotengineparts, causing thebrakefluidtocatchfire. Brakefluidcanalso damagepaintedandvinylsurfaces, careshouldbe takentoavoiditscontactwiththesesurfaces.
(Continued)
WARNING!(Continued)
- Donotallowpetroleumbasedfluidtocontaminate thebrakefluid.Brakesealcomponentscouldbe damaged,causingpartialorcompletebrakefailure. Thiscouldresultinacollision.
Rear Axle And 4x4 Front Driving Axle Fluid Level
For normal service, periodic fluid level checks are not required. When the vehicle is serviced for other reasons the exterior surfaces of the axle assembly should be inspected. If gear oil leakage is suspected inspect the fluid level. Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information. This inspection should be made with the vehicle in a level position.
For 1500 Model axles, the fluid level should be even with the bottom of the fill hole (within 1/4 in (6.4 mm) of edge of hole) for the FDU215 HD front axle and C235FE rear axle.
For all 2500/3500 Model axles, the fluid level should be 1/4 in ± 1/4 in (6.4 mm ± 6.4 mm) below the fill hole on the 9.25 in front and 3/4 in ± 1/4 in (19 mm ± 6.4 mm) on 10.5 in rear axles. The 11.5 in rear axle level should be 1/4 in ± 1/4 in (6.4 mm ± 6.4 mm) below the fill hole.
DrainAndRefill
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals.
LubricantSelection
Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.

720 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The presence of water in the gear lubricant will result in corrosion and possible failure of differential components. Operation of the vehicle in water, as may be encountered in some off-highway types of service, will require draining and refilling the axle to avoid damage.
Limited-SlipDifferentials
1500 Model rear axles equipped with a Limited Slip Differential require that 5 oz. (148 ml) MOPAR® Limited Slip Additive be added to the gear lubricant. Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information. The MOPAR® Limited Slip Additive should be added to the gear lubricant whenever a fluid change is made to an axle equipped with a Limited Slip Differential.
2500/3500 Model axles DONOTREQUIREany limited slip oil additive (friction modifiers).
NOTE: When refilling an axle with a Limited Slip Differential, (which requires a Limited Slip Additive), the Limited Slip Additive should be added before the gear lubricant is added to insure proper additive fill.
Transfer Case
DrainAndRefill
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper maintenance intervals.
LubricantSelection
Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in "Maintaining Your Vehicle" for further information.
FluidLevelCheck
This fluid level can be checked by removing the filler plug. The fluid level should be to the bottom edge of the filler plug hole with the vehicle in a level position.

Automatic Transmission
SelectionOfLubricant
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use only the manufacturer's specified transmission fluid. Refer to "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in this section for fluid specifications. It is important to maintain the transmission fluid at the correct level using the recommended fluid. No chemical flushes should be used in any transmission; only the approved lubricant should be used.
CAUTION!
Usingatransmissionfluidotherthanthemanufac-turer'srecommendedfluidmaycausedeterioration intransmissionshiftqualityand/ororqueconverter
CAUTION!(Continued)
shudder, and will require more frequent fluid and filter changes. Referto "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" in this section for fluids specifications.
SpecialAdditives
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using any special additives in the transmission. Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is an engineered product and its performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. Therefore, do not add any fluid additives to the transmission. The only exception to this policy is the use of special dyes for diagnosing fluid leaks. Avoid using transmission sealers as they may adversely affect seals.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
722 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Donotusechemicalflushesinyourtransmissionas thechemicalscandamageyourtransmissioncomponents.SuchdamageisnotcoveredbytheNew VehicleLimitedWarranty.
FluidLevelCheck—Eight-SpeedTransmission
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not require adjustment under normal operating conditions. Routine fluid level checks are not required, therefore the transmission has no dipstick. Your authorized dealer can check your transmission fluid level using special service tools.
If you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, visit your authorized dealer immediately to have the transmission fluid level checked. Operating the vehicle with an improper fluid level can cause severe transmission damage.
CAUTION!
Ifatransmissionfluidleakoccurs,visityourauthorizeddealerimmediately.Severetransmissiondamagemayoccur.Yourauthorizeddealerhastheproper toolstoadjustthefluidlevelaccurately.
FluidLevelCheck—Six-SpeedTransmission
It is best to check the fluid level when the transmission is at normal operating temperature (170-180°F / 77-82°C). This normally occurs after at least 15 miles (25 km) of driving. At normal operating temperature the fluid cannot be held comfortably between the fingertips. You can read the transmission sump temperature in the EVIC display (refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center [EVIC]” for further information).

Information Provided by: DEALER
Use the following procedure to check the transmission fluid level properly:
- Monitor the transmission temperature using the EVIC display, and operate the vehicle as required to reach the normal operating temperature.
- Park the vehicle on level ground.
- Run the engine at normal idle speed for at least 60 seconds, and leave the engine running for the rest of this procedure.
- Fully apply the parking brake and press the brake pedal.
-
Place the shift lever momentarily into each gear position (allowing time for the transmission to fully engage in each position), ending with the transmission in PARK.
-
Remove the dipstick, wipe it clean and reinsert it until seated.
- Remove the dipstick again and note the fluid level on both sides. The fluid level reading is only valid if there is a solid coating of oil on both sides of the dipstick. Note that the holes in the dipstick will be full of fluid if the actual level is at or above the hole. The fluid level should be between the "HOT" (upper) reference holes on the dipstick at normal operating temperature. If the fluid level is low, add fluid through the dipstick tube to bring it to the proper level. Donotoverfill. Use ONLY the recommended fluid (see "Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts" for fluid specifications). After adding any quantity of oil through the dipstick tube, wait a minimum of two minutes for the oil to fully drain into the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
724 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If it is necessary to check the transmission below the operating temperature, the fluid level should be between the two "COLD" (lower) holes on the dipstick with the fluid at 60-70°F / 16-21°C. Only use the COLD region of the dipstick as a rough reference when setting the fluid level after a transmission service or fluid change. Re-check the fluid level, and adjust as required, once the transmission reaches normal operating temperature.
CAUTION!
If the fluid temperature is below 50^ F ( 10^ C) it may not register on the dipstick. Donot add fluid until the temperature is elevated on oughto produce an accuratereading. Run the engine at idle, in PARK, to warm the fluid.
NOTE: To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmission after checking or replenishing fluid, make sure that the dipstick cap is properly reseated. It is normal for the dipstick cap to spring back slightly from its fully seated position, as long as its seal remains engaged in the dipstick tube.
FluidAndFilterChanges—Eight-Speed Transmission
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at the factory will provide satisfactory lubrication for the life of the vehicle.
Routine fluid and filter changes are not required. However change the fluid and filter if the fluid becomes contaminated (with water, etc.), or if the transmission is disassembled for any reason.
- Check for leaks. Release the parking brake.

FluidAndFilterChanges—Six-Speed Transmission
Refer to the "Maintenance Schedule" for the proper maintenance intervals.
In addition, change the fluid and filter(s) if the fluid becomes contaminated (with water, etc.), or if the transmission is disassembled for any reason.
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
ProtectionOfBodyAndPaintFromCorrosion
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking, which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants, road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and under-body protection.
The following maintenance recommendations will enable you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion resistance built into your vehicle.
WhatCausesCorrosion?
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
The most common causes are:
- Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
- Stone and gravel impact.
• Insects, tree sap and tar. - Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.

726 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Washing
- Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your vehicle in the shade using MOPAR® Car Wash, or a mild car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with clear water.
- If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumulated on your vehicle, use MOPAR® Super Kleen Bug and Tar Remover to remove.
- Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR® Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
- Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
CAUTION!
- Donotuseabrasiveorstrongcleaningmaterials suchassteelwoolorscouringpowderthatwill scratchmetalandpaintedsurfaces.
- Useofpowerwashersexceeding1,200psi(8274kPa) canresultindamageorremovalofpaintanddecals.
SpecialCare
- If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once a month.
-
It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and open.
-
If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint, touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of the owner.
- If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar cause that destroys the paint and protective coating, have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of the owner.
- If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers, de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well packaged and sealed.
- If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
- Use MOPAR® Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to match the color of your vehicle.
WheelAndWheelTrimCare
- All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
- To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Dark Vapor Chrome wheels DO NOT USE wheel cleaners, abrasives or polishing compounds. They will permanently damage this finish and such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. USE ONLY MILD SOAP AND WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used on a regular basis this is all that is required to maintain this finish.

728 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Donotusescouringpads,steelwool,abristlebrush, ormetalpolishes.Donotuseovencleaner.These productsmaydamagethewheel'sprotectivefinish. Avoidautomaticcarwashesthatuseacidicsolutions orharshbrushesthatmaydamagethewheel'sprotectivefinish.OnlyMOPAR®WheelCleaneror equivalentisrecommended.
StainRepelFabricCleaningProcedure—If Equipped
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following manner:
- Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting with a clean, dry towel.
-
Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
-
For tough stains, apply MOPAR® Total Clean, or a mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
- For grease stains, apply MOPAR® Multi-Purpose Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
- Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of protectants on Stain Repel products.
InteriorCare
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean fabric upholstery and carpeting.
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean vinyl upholstery.
MOPAR® Total Clean is specifically recommended for leather upholstery.
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt

can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth. Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth and MOPAR® Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not required to maintain the original condition.
WARNING!
Donotusevolatilesolventsforcleaningpurposes. Manyarepotentiallyflammable,andifusedin closedareastheymaycauserespiratoryharm.
CAUTION!
DonotuseAlcoholandAlcohol-basedand/orKeton basedcleaningproductstocleanleatherseats,as damagetotheseatmayresult.
CleaningHeadlights
Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlights and fog lights that are lighter and less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights.
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution followed by rinsing.
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.

GlassSurfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis with MOPAR® Glass Cleaner, or any commercial household-type glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type cleaner. Use caution when cleaning the inside rear window equipped with electric defrosters or the right rear quarter window equipped with the radio antenna. Do not use scrapers or other sharp instrument that may scratch the elements.
When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner directly on the mirror.
CleaningPlasticInstrumentClusterLenses
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
- Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be used, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp rag.
- Dry with a soft cloth.
SeatBeltMaintenance
Do not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemical solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric. Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution or lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the car to wash them. Dry with a soft cloth.
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the buckles do not work properly.

WARNING!
Afrayedortornbeltcouldripapartinacollisionand leaveyouwithnoprotection.Inspectthebeltsystem periodically,checkingforcuts,frays,orlooseparts. Damagedpartsmustbereplacedimmediately.Do notdisassembleormodifythesystem.Seatbelt assembliesmustbereplacedafteracollisionifthey havebeendamaged(i.e.,bentretractor,tornwebbing,etc.).
Tri-FoldSoftTonneauCoverCare
For cleaning and protecting the vinyl Tri-Fold Tonneau cover, use MOPAR® Whitewall & Vinyl Top Cleaner and MOPAR® Leather and Vinyl Conditioner/Protectant.
Spray-OnBedliner-IfEquipped
During ownership, the shine and luster of the Spray-On Bedliner can fade from oxidation, road dirt, h eavy-duty hauling and hard water stains. Weathering and UV exposure will lead to fading, dulling, and loss of gloss over time.
To help maintain the appearance of your Spray-On Bedliner, the manufacturer recommends you periodically rinse all loose dirt from your truck bed and clean your truck at least twice per year using the MOPAR® Spray-On Bedliner Conditioner available at your local authorized dealer.
ToHelpMaintainTheAppearanceOfYourSpray-On Bedliner, FollowTheStepsBelow:
- Rinse your truck bed out with water to remove any loose dirt and debris.
- Mix a mild soap or detergent with water with a soft cloth or brush.
- Rinse bedliner with water.

732 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
- Once dry, apply a small amount of MOPAR® Spray-On Bedliner Conditioner to a moist towel or sponge and wipe over the entire surface of the truck bedliner.
WARNING!
Donotusesilicon-basedprotectionproductstoclean yourbedliner.Silicon-basedproductscanbecome slipperyandmayresultinpersonalinjury.
Spray-On Bedliners are chemically-resistant to many different types of chemicals (including gasoline, oil, hydraulic fluids) for short periods of time. If a spill occurs on your Spray-On Bedliner, rinse the truck out as soon as possible to avoid permanent damage.
RepairingTheSpray-OnBedliner
While extremely tough, it is possible to damage a Spray-On Bedliner. One common condition is when loading a heavy pallet and dragging that pallet across the floor of the bed. If a nail or sharp point is exposed under the weight of the pallet a scratch or tear is possible. While not covered by your new vehicle warranty, a cosmetic fix to cover the metal exposed by the scratch is required. To repair a tear or gouge, follow the directions provided in the MOPAR® Quick Repair Kit.
FUSES
WARNING!
- Whenreplacingablownfuse,alwaysuseanappropriatereplacementfusewiththesameamp ratingastheoriginalfuse.Neverreplaceafuse withanotherfuseofhigheramprating.Never replaceablownfusewithmetalwiresoranyother material.Failuretouseproperfusesmayresultin seriouspersonalinjury,fireand/orpropertydamage.
- Beforereplacingafuse, makesurethattheignition isoffandthatalltheotherservicesareswitchedoff and/ordisengaged.
- Ifthereplacedfuseblowsagain,contactanaauthorizeddealer.
WARNING!(Continued)
- Ifageneralprotectionfuseforsafetysystems(air bagsystem,brakingsystem),powerunitsystems (enginesystem,gearboxsystem)orsteeringsystem blows,contactanauthorizeddealer.
(Continued)

Information Provided by: DEALER
734 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Power Distribution Center
The Power Distribution Center is located in the engine compartment near the battery. This center contains cartridge fuses, micro fuses, relays, and circuit breakers. A description of each fuse and component may be stamped on the inside cover, otherwise the cavity number of each fuse is stamped on the inside cover that corresponds to the following chart.

natural_image
Interior view of a vehicle showing a black arrow pointing to a component on a flatbed cab (no text or symbols visible)PowerDistributionCenterLocation
| CavityCartridgeFuseMicroFuseDescription | |||
| F01 80 Amp Red Rad Fan Control Module – If equipped | |||
| F03 60 Amp Yellow Rad Fan – If Equipped | |||
| F05 40 Amp Green | Compressor for Air Suspension – IfEquipped | ||

Information Provided by: DEALER
| CavityCartridgeFuseMicroFuseDescription | |||
| F06 40 Amp Green Antilock Brakes/Electronic Stability Con- | trol Pump | ||
| F07 40 Amp Green Starter Solenoid | |||
| F08 20 Amp Yellow Emissions Diesel - If Equipped | |||
| F09 40 Amp Green(Cummins Diesel)30 Amp Pink (1500 LD Diesel) | Diesel Fuel Heater - If Equipped | ||
| F10 40 Amp Green Body Controller / Exterior Lighting #2 | |||
| F10 50 Amp Red Body Controller / Exterior Lighting #2 - If | Equipped with Stop/Start | ||
| F11 30 Amp Pink Integrated Trailer Brake Module - If | Equipped | ||
| F12 40 Amp Green | Body Controller #3 / Interior Lights | ||
| F13 40 Amp Green | Blower Motor | ||
| F14 40 Amp Green | Body Controller #4 / Power Locks | ||
| CavityCartridge | FuseMicroFuseDescription | ||
| F15 30 Amp | Pink Electric Park Brake | Right Side – If | Equipped |
| F19 30 Amp | Pink SCR – If Equipped | ||
| F20 30 Amp | Pink Passenger Door Module | ||
| F21 30 Amp | Pink Drive Train Control Module | ||
| F22 20 Amp | Yellow Engine Control Module | ||
| F23 30 Amp | Pink Body Controller #1 | ||
| F24 30 Amp | Pink Driver Door Module | ||
| F25 30 Amp | Pink Front Wiper Low Speed | ||
| F25 30 Amp | Pink | Front Wiper High Speed | |
| F26 30 Amp | Pink | Antilock | Brakes/Stability ControlModule/Valves |
| F28 20 Amp | Yellow | Trailer Tow | Backup Lights – If Equipped |
| F29 20 Amp | Yellow | Trailer Tow | Parking Lights – If Equipped |
| F30 30 Amp | Pink | Trailer Tow Receptacle | |
| F32 30 Amp | Pink Drive Train Control | Module – If Equipped | |
| F33 20 Amp | Yellow Cummins Diesel | Fuel Heater #1 – If | Equipped / Rear Blower – If Equipped |
| F34 30 Amp | Pink Vehicle System Interface Module #2 – If | Equipped | |
| F35 30 Amp | Pink Sunroof – If Equipped | ||
| F36 30 Amp | Pink Rear Defroster– If Equipped | ||
| F37 30 Amp | Pink Cummins Diesel Fuel Heater #2 If | Equipped | |
| F38 30 Amp | Pink Power Inverter 115V AC– If Equipped | ||
| F39 30 Amp | Pink | Vehicle System Interface Module #1– If Equipped | |
| F41 | 10 Amp Red | Active Grill Shutter | |
| F42 | 20 Amp Yellow | Horn | |
| F43 | 10 Amp Red | Snow Plow (Left) – If Equipped | |
| CavityCartridgeFuseMicroFuseDescription | |||
| F44 10 Amp Red Diagnostic Port | |||
| F46 10 Amp Red Tire Pressure Monitor | |||
| F47 10 Amp Red Snow Plow (Right) - If Equipped | |||
| F49 10 Amp Red Instrument Panel Cluster | |||
| F50 20 Amp Yellow Air Suspension Control Module - If | Equipped | ||
| F51 10 Amp Red Ignition Node Module / Keyless Ignition | |||
| F52 5 Amp Tan | Battery Sensor | ||
| F53 20 Amp Yellow Trailer Tow - Left Turn/Stop Lights | |||
| F54 20 Amp Yellow | Adjustable Pedals | ||
| F55 20 Amp Yellow E38 Radio - If Equipped | |||
| F56 | 15 Amp Blue | Additional Diesel Content - If Equipped | |
| F57 20 Amp Yellow | Transmission | ||
| F58 20 Amp Yellow | (Gas Engine) / 25 Amp Natural (Cummins Diesel Engine) | Engine Cooling Pump | |
| F60 15 Amp Blue Underhood Lamp | |||
| F61 20 Amp Yellow Power Take-off Unit – If Equipped | |||
| F62 10 Amp Red Air Conditioning Clutch | |||
| F63 20 Amp Yellow Ignition Coils (Gas), Urea Heater (Cummins Diesel) | |||
| F64 25 Amp Natural Fuel Injectors / Powertrain | |||
| F65 10 Amp Red | USB interface | ||
| F66 10 Amp Red | Sunroof / Passenger Window Switches / Rain Sensor | ||
| F67 10 Amp Red | CD / DVD / Bluetooth Hands-free Mod-ule – If Equipped | ||
| CavityCartridge | FuseMicroFuseDescription | ||
| F69 15 Amp | Blue Mod SCR 12V (Cummins Diesel) – If | Equipped | |
| F70 30 Amp | Green Fuel Pump Motor | ||
| F71 25 Amp | Natural Amplifier | ||
| F72 10 Amp | Red Voltage Stabilizer Modules – If Equipped | ||
| F74 20 Amp | Yellow | (Gas Engine & 1500 LD Diesel) / 10 Amp Red (Cummins Diesel Engine) | Brake Vacuum Pump Gas/Diesel – If Equipped |
| F75 10 Amp | Red Coolant Temperature Valve Actuator | ||
| F76 10 Amp | Red Antilock Brakes/Electronic Stability Con- | trol | |
| F77 10 Amp | Red Drivetrain | Control Module/Front Axle | Disconnect Module |
| CavityCartridgeFuseMicroFuseDescription | |||
| F78 10 Amp Red Engine Control Module / Electric Power | Steering | ||
| F79 15 Amp Blue Clearance Lights | |||
| F80 10 Amp Red Universal Garage Door Opener / Compass | |||
| F81 20 Amp Yellow Trailer Tow Right Turn/Stop Lights | |||
| F82 10 Amp Red Steering Column Control Module/ Cruise | Control | ||
| F84 15 Amp Blue Switch Bank/Instrument Cluster | |||
| F85 10 Amp Red Airbag Module | |||
| F86 10 Amp Red Airbag Module | |||
| F87 10 Amp Red Air Suspension-If Equipped / Trailer Tow | / Steering Column Control Module | ||
| F88 15 Amp Blue Instrument Panel Cluster | |||
| F90/F91 | 20 Amp Yellow | Power Outlet (Rear seats) Customer Select-able | |
742 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
| CavityCartridgeFuseMicroFuseDescription | |||
| F93 20 Amp Yellow Cigar Lighter | |||
| F94 10 Amp Red Shifter / Transfer Case Module | |||
| F95 10 Amp Red Rear Camera / Park Assist | |||
| F96 10 Amp Red Rear Seat Heater Switch | |||
| F97 25 Amp Natural Rear Heated Seats & Heated Steering | Wheel – If Equipped | ||
| F98 25 Amp Natural Front Heated Seats – If Equipped | |||
| F99 10 Amp Red Climate Control | |||
| F101 | 15 Amp Blue | Electrochromatic Mirror / Smart High Beams – If Equipped | |
| F104 | 20 Amp Yellow | Power Outlets (Instrument Panel/Center Console) | |
CAUTION!
- Wheninstallingthepowerdistributioncenter cover,itisimportanttoensurethecoverisproperly positionedandfullylatched.Failuretodosomay allowwatertogetintothepowerdistribution centerandpossiblyresultinanelectricalsystem failure.
- Whenreplacingablownfuse,itisimportanttouse onlyafusehavingthecorrectamperagerating.The useofafusewitharatingotherthanindicatedmay resultinadangerouselectricalsystemoverload.If aproperlyratedfusecontinuestoblow,itindicates aprobleminthecircuitthatmustbecorrected.
VEHICLE STORAGE
If you are storing your vehicle for more than 21 days, we recommend that you take the following steps to minimize the drain on your vehicle's battery:
- Disconnect the negative cable from battery.
- Any time you store your vehicle or keep it out of service (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility of compressor damage when the system is started again.
REPLACEMENT BULBS
All of the inside bulbs are brass or glass-wedge base. Aluminum base bulbs are not approved.

744 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Interior Bulbs
| BulbNumber | |
| Overhead Console Lamps | TS 212-9 |
| Dome Lamp 7679 | |
| For lighted switches, see your authorized dealer for replacement instructions. | |
Exterior Bulbs
| BulbNumber | |
| Base Quad Headlamp – Low Beam | H11 |
| Base Quad Headlamp – High Beam | 9005 |
| Front Turn Signal Lamp(Base Quad Headlamp) | 3157NA |
| BulbNumber | |
| Premium Bi Halogen Projector Headlamp - Low Beam | HIR2 |
| Premium Bi Halogen Projector Headlamp - High Beam | 9005 |
| Front Turn Signal Lamp (Premium Headlamp) | LED (Serviced at Autho- rized Dealer) |
| Fog Lamp (Horizontal shape) | 9145 |
| Fog Lamp (Vertical shape) | 9006 |
| Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) | 921 |
| Rear Cargo Lamp 921 | |
| LED Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)/Cargo Lamp | LED (Serviced at Autho- rized Dealer) |
| Cab Roof Marker Lamps 194 | NA |
| Base Rear Tail/Turn and Stop Lamp | 3157K |
| Premium Rear Tail/Turn and Stop Lamp | LED (Serviced at Autho- rized Dealer) |
| Premium Backup Lamp T20 | |
| Rear Lamp Bar ID Marker Lamp | 194 |
| Side Marker Lamps (Dual Rear Wheels) | 194 |
| Backup Lamp 921 | |
| Rear License Plate Lamp 194 |
BULB REPLACEMENT
NOTE:Lens fogging can occur under certain atmospheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric conditions change to allow the condensation to change back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually accelerate the clearing process.
Base Quad / Premium Bi-Halogen: Low Beam Headlamp, High Beam Headlamp, Front Park And Turn — If Equipped
- Open the hood.
- Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
- Remove the six plastic push-in fasteners that secure the upper radiator seal to the grille support and both fender ledges.
- Remove the two plastic push-in rivets that secure the upper radiator seal to the radiator.
746 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
- Remove the upper radiator seal from the vehicle.
- Remove the two headlamp assembly attachment screws.

natural_image
Close-up of a mechanical component with two arrows pointing to a highlighted section, no visible text or symbols.HeadlampAssemblyAttachmentScrewLocations
- Reach into the front wheel house ahead of the front wheel, remove the fastener, and lift the cover over the access hole in the front of the wheel house splash shield. Access to the rear of the lamp can be gained through this access hole.
- Reach through the access hole of the wheel house splash shield and lift the slide lock upward far enough to disengage it from the lock post on the back of the front lamp unit housing.

Information Provided by: DEALER

natural_image
Mechanical component diagram showing a piston and clamping mechanism with bidirectional arrow (no text or symbols)SlideLock
-
Remove the headlamp assembly. Grasp the outboard edge of the lamp and pull it straight forward to disengage the ball stud from the plastic grommet.
-
Disconnect the wiring harness connectors from the bulb socket.
-
Replace bulb(s) as necessary.
CAUTION!
- Donotcontaminatethebulbglassbytouchingit withyourfingersorbyallowingittocontactother oilysurfaces.Shortenedbulblifewillresult.
- Alwaysusethecorrectbulbsizeandtypefor replacement.Anincorrectbulbsizeortypemay overheatandcausedamagetothelamp,thebulb socket,orthelampwiring.
NOTE: There are access covers over both headlamp bulb access holes in the quad front lamp unit housing (if equipped). These covers MUST be reinstalled after the bulb has been replaced.
748 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Fog Lamps — If Equipped
- Reach under and behind the front bumper to access the back of the front fog lamp housing.
- Disconnect the fog lamp wiring harness connector from the fog lamp bulb.
- Rotate the bulb counterclockwise 14 turn to unlock the bulb from the housing.
- Pull the bulb straight out from the housing.
CAUTION!
Donotcontaminate the bulb glass by touching it with your fingers or by allowing it to contact other oilysurfaces. Shortened bulblifewill result.
Rear Tail/Stop, Turn Signal And Backup Lamps
- Remove the two screws that pass through the bed sheetmetal.

natural_image
Close-up of a car door panel with a cable and two arrows pointing to the lock (no text or symbols visible)TailLampScrewLocations
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 749
- Pull the outboard side of the lamp rearward far enough to unsnap the two receptacles on the outboard side of the lamp housing from the two plastic snap post retainers in the outer box side panel.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's side panel with a black arrow pointing to a component, no visible text or symbolsPullingOutTheTailLamp
-
Disconnect the wiring harness connectors from the bulb socket.
-
Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise 1/4 turn to unlock it from the housing.
- Pull the bulb straight out of the socket.
CAUTION!
Donotcontaminatethebulbglassbytouchingit withyourfingersorbyallowingittocontactother oilysurfaces.Shortenedbulblifewillresult.
- Reverse the procedure to install the bulb and housing.

750 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) With Cargo Lamp
- Remove the two screws holding the housing/lens to the body as shown.

natural_image
Hand using a screwdriver to adjust or install a car interior panel (no text or symbols visible)CHMSLMountingScrewLocations
- Separate the connector holding the housing and wiring harness to the body.

natural_image
Close-up of hands installing or adjusting a mechanical component with a cable and arrow indicator (no text or symbols present)CHMSLConnectorLocation
- Turn the desired bulb socket 14 turn and remove the socket and bulb from housing.

Information Provided by: DEALER
- Pull the desired bulb straight from the socket.

natural_image
Close-up of hands installing or adjusting a mechanical component with wires (no visible text or symbols)CHMSLBulbAndSocket
CAUTION!
Donotcontaminatethebulbglassbytouchingit withyourfingersorbyallowingittocontactother oilysurfaces.Shortenedbulblifewillresult.
• Outside Bulbs: Cargo Lamps
•Inside Bulb: Center High-Mounted Stop Lamp
- Reverse the procedure for installation of bulbs and housing.

Information Provider Syc. DEALER
752 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cab Top Clearance Lamps — If Equipped
- Remove the two screws from the top of the lamp.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand holding a pipette over a surface with two small stones, no text or symbols presentRemovingRearScrewFromClearanceLamp
- Rotate the bulb socket 14 turn and pull it from the lamp assembly.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand using a tool to insert or install a component into a car (no text or symbols visible)RemovingBulbSocketFromClearanceLamp
- Pull the bulb straight from it's socket and replace.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 753

natural_image
Illustration of a hand holding a wrench and eraser, with a small object nearby (no text or symbols)RemovingTheBulbFromTheBulbSocket
Rear Lamp Bar ID Marker (Dual Rear Wheels) — If Equipped
- Loosen the two screws and the housing to gain access to the bulb sockets.

natural_image
Close-up of a car's rear bumper with two arrows pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)ScrewLocations
- Turn the socket 14 turn counterclockwise to access the bulb.
- Pull the bulb straight out from the socket.
- Reverse the procedure for installation of the bulbs and housing.

Information Provided by: DEALER
754 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Side Marker Lamps (Dual Rear Wheels) — If Equipped

natural_image
Side view of a car's front wheel and side bumper, showing two black arrows pointing to the rear rim (no text or symbols present)SideMarkerLampLocations
- Push rearward on the side marker lamp assembly.
- Pull the entire assembly from the fender.
- Turn the socket 14 turn counterclockwise and remove from assembly to access the bulb.
- Pull the bulb straight out from socket.
- Reverse the procedure for installation of the bulbs and housing.

Information Provided by: DEALER
FLUID CAPACITIES
| U.S.Metric | ||
| Fuel(Approximate) | ||
| 1500 Regular Cab Shortbed/Crew Quad Cab Models 26 Gallons 98 Liters | ||
| 1500 Regular Cab Longbed/Crew Quad Cab Models (Optional) 32 Gallons 121 Liters | ||
| 2500/3500 Shortbed Models 31 Gallons 117 Liters | ||
| 2500/3500 Longbed Models 32 Gallons 121 Liters | ||
| EngineOilWithFilter | ||
| 3.6L Engine (We recommend you use SAE 5W-20, API Certified) 6 Quarts 5.6 Liters | ||
| 5.7L Engines (We recommend you use SAE 5W-20, API Certified) 7 Quarts 6.6 Liters | ||
| 5.7L Engine (We recommend you use SAE 5W-30, API Certified), for 2500/3500 trucks operating under a gross combined weight rating greater than 14,000 lbs (6 350 kg). | 7 Quarts 6.6 Liters |
756 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
| U.S.Metric | ||
| 6.4L Engines (We recommend you use SAE 0W-40 engine oil meeting the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12633 for use in all operating temperatures.) | 7 Quarts 6.6 Liters | |
| CoolingSystem | ||
| 3.6L Engine (We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106.) | 14 Quarts 13 Liters | |
| 5.7L Engine – 1500 Models (We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106.) | 16 Quarts 15 Liters | |
| 5.7L Engine – 2500/3500 Models (We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106.) | 18.7 Quarts 17.7 Liters |
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 757
| U.S.Metric | ||
| 5.7L Engine – 2500/3500 Models w/Heavy Duty (We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106.) | 19.2 Quarts 18.2 | Liters |
| 6.4 Liter Engine – MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106. | 18.7 Quarts 17.7 | Liters |
| 6.4 Liter Engine – 2500/3500 Models w/Heavy Duty ( We recommend yo use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106. | 19.2 Quarts 18.2 | Liters |
758 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
| ComponentFluid,Lubricant,orGenuinePart | |
| Engine Coolant We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology). | |
| Engine Oil – 5.7 We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as MOPAR®, Pennzoil®, and Shell Helix®. Refer to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade. | |
| Engine Oil – 5.7L Engine For 2500/3500 trucks operating under a gross combined weight rating greaterthan 14,000 lbs/(6,350 kg.) | We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-30 Engine Oil, meeting the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as MOPAR®, Pennzoil®, Shell Helix® or equivalent. Refer to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade. |
| Engine Oil - 6.4L | For best performance and maximum protection under all types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only recommends full synthetic engine oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute (API) categories of SN. The manufacturer recommends the use of Pennzoil UltraTM 0W-40 or equivalent MOPAR® engine oil meeting the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12633 for use in all operating temperatures. |
| Engine Oil Filter We recommend you use MOPAR® brand Engine Oil Filters. | |
| Spark Plugs - 3.6L Engine We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.043 in [1.1 mm]) | |
| Spark Plugs - 5.7L Engine We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.043 in [1.1 mm]) | |
| Spark Plugs - 6.4L Engine We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.043 in [1.1 mm]) | |
| Fuel Selection - 3.6L Engine 87 Octane | |
| Fuel Selection - 5.7L Engines 87 Octane Acceptable - 89 Octane Recommended | |
| Fuel Selection - 6.4L Engines 87 Octane | |
Chassis
| ComponentFluid,Lubricant,orGenuinePart | |
| Automatic Transmission – Eight-Speed Automatic Use only | MOPAR® ZF 8&9 Speed ATFTM Automatic Transmission Fluid, or equivalent. Failure to use the correct fluid may affect the function or performance of your transmission. |
| Automatic Transmission – Six-Speed Automatic with Gasoline Engine (For Diesel Engine see Diesel Supplement) | We recommend you use only ATF+4® Automatic Transmission Fluid. Failure to use ATF+4® fluid may affect the function or performance of your transmission. We recommend MOPAR® ATF+4® fluid. |
| Transfer Case We recommend you use MOPAR® BW44-44 TransferCase Fluid. | |
| Front Axle – 1500 Four-Wheel Drive Models We recommend | you use MOPAR® GL-5 Synthetic Axle Lubricant SAE 75W-85. |
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 761
| ComponentFluid,Lubricant,orGenuinePart | |
| Rear Axle – 1500 Models We recommend you use MOPAR® Synthetic Gear Lubricant SAE 75W-140 (MS-8985). Limited-Slip Rear Axles require the addition of 5 oz. (148 ml) MOPAR® Limited Slip Additive (MS-10111). | |
| Front and Rear Axle – 2500/3500 Models We recommend you use Synthetic, GL-5 SAE, 75W-90.Limited slip additive is not required for Limited-Slip Rear Axles. | |
| Brake Master Cylinder We recommend you use MOPAR® DOT 3. If DOT 3brake fluid is not available, then DOT 4 is acceptable. | |
| Power Steering Reservoir – 2500/3500 Models | We recommend you use MOPAR® Power Steering Fluid +4 or MOPAR® ATF+4® Automatic Transmission Fluid. |

Information Provided by
DEALER
电子邮箱:@zzb.com
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
■ MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE .....764 □ Maintenance Chart .....767
764 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change indicator system. The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
Based on engine operation conditions, the oil change indicator message will illuminate. This means that service is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will influence when the “Oil Change Required” message is displayed. Severe Operating Conditions can cause the change oil message to illuminate as early as 3,500 miles (5,600 km) since last reset. Have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible, within the next 500 miles (805 km).
Your authorized dealer will reset the oil change indicator message after completing the scheduled oil change. If a scheduled oil change is performed by someone other than your authorized dealer, the message can be reset by referring to the steps described under “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE:
•1500ModelsOnly
- Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months on 1500 trucks, whichever comes first.

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 765
•2500-3500Models
- Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or twelve months on 2500 – 3500 trucks, whichever comes first.
- SevereDutyAllModels
- Change Engine Oil at 4000 miles (6,500 km) if the vehicle is operated in a dusty and off road environment. This type of vehicle use is considered Severe Duty
OnceAMonthOrBeforeALongTrip:
- Check engine oil level
- Check windshield washer fluid level
- Check tire pressure and look for unusual wear or damage. Rotate tires at the first sign of irregular wear, even if it occurs before the oil indicator system turns on.
- Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir, brake master cylinder, power steering (2500/3500 Models Only) and automatic transmission (six-speed only) as needed
- Check function of all interior and exterior lights
766 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
RequiredMaintenance
Refer to the Maintenance Schedules on the following pages for required maintenance.
AtEveryOilChangeIntervalAsIndicatedByOil ChangeIndicatorSystem:
- Change oil and filter.
- Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregularwear, even if it occurs before the oil indicator system turnson.
- Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as required.
- Inspect automatic transmission fluid if equipped with dipstick.
- Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, hoses and park brake.
AtEveryOilChangeIntervalAsIndicatedByOil ChangeIndicatorSystem:
- Inspect engine cooling system protection and hoses.
- Inspect exhaust system.
- Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or off-road conditions.
- Lube the front drive shaft fitting (2500/3500 (4x4) models only).
Maintenance Chart
| Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first) | 20,000 | 30,000 | 40,000 | 50,000 | 60,000 | 70,000 | 80,000 | 90,000 | 100,000 | 110,000 | 120,000 | 130,000 | 140,000 | 150,000 |
| Or Years: | 2 3 4 | 5 6 7 8 | 9 10 | 11 12 | 13 14 | 15 | ||||||||
| Or Kilometers: | 32,000 | 48,000 | 64,000 | 80,000 | 96,000 | 112,000 | 128,000 | 144,000 | 160,000 | 176,000 | 192,000 | 208,000 | 224,000 | 240,000 |
| Additional Inspections | ||||||||||||||
| InspecttheCV/Universaljoints.XXXX | X | |||||||||||||
| Inspectfrontsuspension,tierod ends,andreplaceifnecessary. | X | X | X | X | X | X | X | |||||||
| Inspectthefrontandrearaxle surfaces.Ifgearoilleakageis suspected,checkthefluidlevel. Ifusingyourvehicleforpolice, taxi,fleet,off-roadorfrequent trailertowing,changeaxlefluid. | X | X | X | X | X | X | X | |||||||
768 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
| Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first) | 20,000 | 30,000 | 40,000 | 50,000 | 60,000 | 70,000 | 80,000 | 90,000 | 100,000 | 110,000 | 120,000 | 130,000 | 140,000 | 150,000 |
| Or Years: | 2 3 4 | 5 6 7 8 | 9 10 | 11 12 | 13 14 | 15 | ||||||||
| Or Kilometers: | 32,000 | 48,000 | 64,000 | 80,000 | 96,000 | 112,000 | 128,000 | 144,000 | 160,000 | 176,000 | 192,000 | 208,000 | 224,000 | 240,000 |
| Inspectthebrakelinings,replace asnecessary. | X | X | X | X | X | |||||||||
| Adjustparkingbrakeasneces-sary. | X | X | X | X | X | |||||||||
| Inspecttransfercasefluid.X | X | X | ||||||||||||
| Additional Maintenance | ||||||||||||||
| Replace engine air filter. | X | X | X | X | X | |||||||||
| Replacesparkplugs (3.6L engine).** | X | |||||||||||||
| Replacesparkplugs (5.7L engine).** | X | |||||||||||||
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 769
| Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first) | 20,000 | 30,000 | 40,000 | 50,000 | 60,000 | 70,000 | 80,000 | 90,000 | 100,000 | 110,000 | 120,000 | 130,000 | 140,000 | 150,000 |
| Or Years: | 2 3 4 | 5 6 7 8 | 9 10 | 11 12 | 13 14 | 15 | ||||||||
| Or Kilometers: | 32,000 | 48,000 | 64,000 | 80,000 | 96,000 | 112,000 | 128,000 | 144,000 | 160,000 | 176,000 | 192,000 | 208,000 | 224,000 | 240,000 |
| Replacesparkplugs (6.4Lengine).** | X | |||||||||||||
| Flushandreplacetheengine coolantat10yearsor150,000 miles(240,000km)whichever comesfirst. | X | X | ||||||||||||
| Changeautomatictransmission fluidandfilter(s)(six-speedauto-matically),ifusingyourvehicle forpolice,taxi,fleet,orfrequent trailertowing. | X |
770 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
| Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first) | 20,000 | 30,000 | 40,000 | 50,000 | 60,000 | 70,000 | 80,000 | 90,000 | 100,000 | 110,000 | 120,000 | 130,000 | 140,000 | 150,000 |
| Or Years: | 2 3 4 | 5 6 7 8 | 9 10 | 11 12 | 13 14 | 15 | ||||||||
| Or Kilometers: | 32,000 | 48,000 | 64,000 | 80,000 | 96,000 | 112,000 | 128,000 | 144,000 | 160,000 | 176,000 | 192,000 | 208,000 | 224,000 | 240,000 |
| Changeautomatictransmission fluidandfilter(six-speedautomaticonly). | X | |||||||||||||
| Inspectthetransfercasefluid, changeforanyofthefollowing: police,taxi,fleet,orfrequent trailertowing. | X | |||||||||||||
| Changethetransfercasefluid.X | ||||||||||||||
| InspectandreplacePCVvalveif necessary. | X |
** The spark plug change interval is mileage based only, yearly intervals do not apply.
WARNING!
- Youcanbebadlyinjuredworkingonorarounda motorvehicle.Doonlyserviceworkforwhichyou havetheknowledgeandtherightequipment.If youhaveanydoubtaboutyourabilitytoperforma servicejob,takeyourvehicletoacompetentmechanic.
- Failuretoproperlyinspectandmaintainyourvehiclecouldresultinacomponentmalfunctionandeffectvehiclehandlingandperformance.This couldcauseanaccident.

Information Provided by
DEALER
电(开) 01 二、结算
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
■SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR YOUR VEHICLE....775
□Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 775
□Prepare A List....775
□Be Reasonable With Requests....775
■IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE....775
□Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center. . . . . . .776
□Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center .....776
□In Mexico Contact:....777
□Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech Impaired (TDD/TTY). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 777
□Service Contract....777
■WARRANTY INFORMATION....778
■MOPAR®PARTS....779
■REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS....779
□In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 779
□In Canada. .779
■PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS .....780
774 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
■DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADES....781
□Treadwear....781
□Traction Grades....781
□Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 782
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All work to be performed may not be covered by the warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle's service history. This can often provide a clue to the current problem.
Prepare A List
Make a written list of your vehicle's problems or the specific work you want done. If you've had an accident or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the service advisor know.
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with the service advisor and list the items in order of priority. At many authorized dealers, you may obtain a rental vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it is advisable to make these arrangements when you call for an appointment.
IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy with our products and services.
Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer. We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality service. The manufacturer's authorized dealer have the

776 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed correctly and in a timely manner.
This is why you should always talk to an authorized dealer service manager first. Most matters can be resolved with this process.
- If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the general manager or owner of the authorized dealer. They want to know if you need assistance.
- If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the concern, you may contact the manufacturer's customer center.
Any communication to the manufacturer's customer center should include the following information:
- Owner's name and address
-
Owner's telephone number (home and office)
-
Authorized dealer name
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center
P.O. Box 21-8004
Auburn Hills, MI 48321-8004
Phone: (866) 726-4636
Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center
P.O. Box 1621
Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6
Phone: (800) 465-2001 English / (800) 387-9983 French

In Mexico Contact:
In Mexico City: 5081-7568
Outside Mexico City: 1-800-505-1300
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech Impaired (TDD/TTY)
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter (TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 777
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require assistance can use the special needs relay service offered by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711 and for Voice callers, dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with a Bell Relay Service operator.
Service Contract
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected repairs after the manufacturer's New Vehicle Limited Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only the manufacturer's service contracts. If you purchased a manufacturer's service contract, you will receive Plan Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you have any questions about the service contract, call the manufacturer's Service Contract National Customer Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800) 465-2001 English / (800) 387-9983 French).

778 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service contract that is not the manufacturer's service contract. It is not responsible for any service contract other than the manufacturer's service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer's service contract, and you require service after the manufacturer's New Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the contract documents, and contact the person listed in those documents.
We appreciate that you have made a major investment when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related concerns.
WARNING!
Engineexhaust, some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain, oremit, chemicals known to the State of Californiatocause cancer and birth defects, or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain product of component wear contain, oremit, chemicals known to the State of Californiatocause cancer and birth defects, or other reproductive harm.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the DVD, for the terms and provisions of Chrysler Group LLC warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
MOPAR® PARTS
MOPAR® fluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories are available from an authorized dealer. They are recommended for your vehicle in order to help keep the vehicle operating at its best.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the manufacturer.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your authorized dealer, and the manufacturer.
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline toll free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., West Building, Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you should contact the Customer Service Department immediately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety defect to the Canadian government should contact Transport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/

780 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
To order the following manuals, you may use either the website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call for an order form.
NOTE:A street address is required when ordering manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
ServiceManuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the information that students and professional technicians need in diagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintaining, servicing, and repairing Chrysler Group LLC vehicles. A complete working knowledge of the vehicle, system, and/or components is written in straightforward language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
DiagnosticProcedureManuals
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams, charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and features. They show exactly how to find and correct problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshooting and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
Owner's Manuals
These Owner's Manuals have been prepared with the assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with specific Chrysler Group LLC vehicles. Included are starting, operating, emergency and maintenance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities and safety tips.

Call toll free at:
•1-800-890-4038(U.S.)
•1-800-387-1143(Canada)
Or
Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
• www.techauthority.com
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADES
The following tire grading categories were established by the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The specific grade rating assigned by the tire's manufacturer in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on your vehicle.
All passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety requirements in addition to these grades.
Treadwear
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction Grades
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

782 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
WARNING!
Thetractiongradeassignedtothistireisbasedon straight-aheadbrakingtractiontests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel, than the minimum required by law.
WARNING!
Thetemperaturegradeforthistireisestablished for atirethatisproperlyinflatedandnotoverloaded. Excessivespeed,under-inflation,orexcessiveloading,eitherseparatelyorincombination,cancause heatbuildupandpossibletirefailure.
INDEX

Information Provided by. DEALER
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze)....7 1 1 Alarm, Panic....2 8
Adding Fuel .586 Alarm (Security Alarm) 2 2
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580 Alarm System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 2
Adjustable Pedals....187 Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle....7
Airbag. 6 8 Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) .710
Airbag Deployment....79 Disposal....713
Airbag Light....7 6 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)....527
Airbag Maintenance....8 1 Anti-Lock Warning Light....284
Airbag, Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Airbag, Window (Side Curtain)....7 2 Ashtray....231
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .701 Auto Down Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 7
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 702 Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 9
Air Conditioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Automatic Headlights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Automatic High Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 702 Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
Air Pressure, Tires. .552 Fluid and Filter Changes .724
Air Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459 Fluid Change. 724
Alarm Light .289 Fluid Level Check .721
INDEX 785
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 721
Shifting....412
Special Additives....721
Axle Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 719
Axle Lubrication (Axle Fluid). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 719
Back-Up Camera. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Bar, Stabilizer/Sway System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Battery. .701
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) ..... 3 0
Belts, Seat 54
Body Builders Guide....6
Body Mechanism Lubrication .....704
B-Pillar Location....545
Brake Assist System....528
Brake Control System, Electronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526
Brake Fluid 717
Brake System....524
Anti-Lock (ABS) .....524
Fluid Check....717
Master Cylinder....717
Parking....521
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Brake/Transmission Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Bulb Replacement....743
Bulbs, Light .....124
Cab Top Clearance Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
Camera, Rear .....210
Camper....264
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
Caps, Filler Oil (Engine)....699
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520
Radiator (Coolant Pressure) .....712
Carbon Monoxide Warning....121
Cargo Light....178
Car Washes .726

786 INDEX
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Center High Mounted Stop Light .....750
Center Seat Storage Compartment .....239
Certification Label. 588
Chart, Tire Sizing .....540
Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator Light) . .284
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety .....120
Checks, Safety .....120
Child Restraint 83
Child Restraints
Child Seat Installation .....108
Install A LATCH-compatible Child Restraint ....102
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt.
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children ..... 9 2
Cigar Lighter....231
Clean Air Gasoline....578
Cleaning
Wheels....727
Climate Control....360
Cold Weather Operation....393
Compact Disc (CD) Maintenance .....359
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 556
Console, Overhead .....212
Contract, Service....777
Coolant Pressure Cap (Radiator Cap) .....712
Cooling System. 709
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze)....7 11
Coolant Capacity .755
Coolant Level....709
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 713
Drain, Flush, and Refill .....710
Inspection....713
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 712
Radiator Cap 712
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) .....710
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
INDEX 787
Cupholders....233
Customer Assistance....775
Data Recorder, Event 82
Daytime Running Lights....172
Dealer Service. .695
Defroster, Rear Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Defroster, Windshield .....122
Delay (Intermittent) Wipers .....181
Differential, Limited-Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
Dipsticks Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520
Disabled Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682
Disposal Antifreeze (Engine Coolant)....713
Door Locks Door Locks 37
Key Fob....
Remote .37
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) 37
Door Locks, Automatic 39
Door Opener, Garage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Driving Off-Pavement....474
Off-Road 474
Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow Standing Water....494
Dual Rear Wheels....565
E-85 Fuel....582
Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Electric Rear Window Defrost. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Electronically Shifted Transfer Case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
Electronic Brake Control System .....526
Anti-Lock Brake System .527
Brake Assist System 528
3 Traction Control System .....527
Electronic Range Select (ERS) .....410

788 INDEX
Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) .....189
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) .....532
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)....210
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) . . . 297
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Setup
Menu. 297
EVIC Messages....297
Selectable Menu Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Emergency Brake....521
Emergency, In Case of
Freeing Vehicle When Stuck....675
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
Jump Starting.671
Tow Hooks....677
Emission Control System Maintenance .....694
Engine.691
Air Cleaner....701
Block Heater....399
Break-In Recommendations .....119
Compartment....690
Compartment Identification....690
Coolant (Antifreeze)....758
Exhaust Gas Caution....121
Flooded, Starting .....393
Fuel Requirements....577
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 671
O il....697
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699
Oil Selection....698
Oil Synthetic....700
Overheating....629
Engine Oil Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699
Engine Oil Viscosity Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699
Enhanced Accident Response Feature ..... 7 9
Entry System, Illuminated .....23
Ethanol....578
Event Data Recorder....82
Exhaust Gas Caution....121

INDEX 789
Exhaust System. 121
Exterior Lighting. 170
Exterior Lights....124
Filters
Air Cleaner....701
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
Engine Oil Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
Flashers Turn Signal .....124
Flat Tire Stowage....646
Flexible Fuel Vehicles Cruising Range....585
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
Fuel Requirements....582
Maintenance....586
Replacement Parts....586
Starting .585
Flooded Engine Starting .393
Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 760
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
Fluid Leaks....124
Fluid Level Checks Brake....717
Power Steering....520
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts .....758
Fog Lights....174
Fold Flat Load Floor .....246
Four-Way Hazard Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
Four Wheel Drive....436
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
Front Axle (Differential). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 719
Fuel. 577
Adding....586
Additives....580
Clean Air. 578
Ethanol....578
Filler Cap (Gas Cap) .588
790 INDEX
Gasoline....577
Materials Added . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580
Methanol....578
Octane Rating....577
Requirements....577
Tank Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
Fuel, Flexible .582
Fuel System Caution....587
Fuses....733
Garage Door Opener (HomeLink®) .....214
Gas Cap (Fuel Filler Cap)....588
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
Gasoline (Fuel)....577
Gasoline, Reformulated .....578
Gauges Speedometer....289
Tachometer.284
Gear Ranges....413
Gear Select Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 678
General Information 3 3
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 730
Grocery Bag Retainer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Gross Axle Weight Rating....592
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 591
Guide, Body Builders 6
GVWR....589
Hazard
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
Headlights....745
Automatic....170
Cleaning....729
High Beam....180
High Beam/Low Beam Select Switch .....180
Passing....180

INDEX 791
Switch....170
Head Restraints....160
Heated Mirrors....144
Heater....361
Heater, Engine Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
High Beam/Low Beam Select (Dimmer) Switch . . . .180
Hitches Trailer Towing .594
Hoisting. .671
HomeLink® (Garage Door Opener) .....214
Hood Release....168
Hub Caps. .669
Inflation Pressure Tires .....561
Information Center, Vehicle .....297
Inside Rearview Mirror .....132
Instrument Cluster .....284
Instrument Panel and Controls .....281
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning .....730
Integrated Trailer Brake Controls .....604
Interior Appearance Care. 728
Interior Lights....175
Intermittent Wipers (Delay Wipers). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Introduction 4
Inverter Outlet (115V) .....232
Ignition....1
Key
Ignition Key Removal 16
Illuminated Entry 23 Key Fob
Immobilizer (Sentry Key) 19
Infant Restraint .83
Programming Additional Key Fobs 21
Programming Additional Transmitters .....21

Key-In Reminder 19
Keyless Enter-N-Go 42
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ Lock The Vehicle's Doors....348 Passive Entry Programming....42
Keyless Enter-N-Go ^TMTM Keyless Enter-N-Go ^TMTM ..... 4 2
Passive Entry ..... 4 2
Keyless Entry System 24
Key, Replacement 20
Keys....12
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer)....19
Lane Change and Turn Signals .....179
Lane Change Assist. 180
Lap/Shoulder Belts. 5 4
Latches....124
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 577
Leaks, Fluid .....124
Life of Tires....559
Light Bulbs. 124
Lights....124
Airbag....76
Alarm....289
Anti-Lock....284
Anti-Lock Warning....525
Automatic Headlights .....170
Brake Assist Warning .536
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Bulb Replacement....745
Cap Top Clearance .752
Cargo 178
Center Mounted Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 750
Check Engine (Malfunction Indicator) .....284
Courtesy/Reading .....176
Daytime Running .....172
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Indicator . . . . .536
Exterior....124
INDEX 793
Fog .174 Turn Signal .124
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator .....439
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629
Headlights....170
High Beam....180
High Beam Indicator....288
High Beam/Low Beam Select....180
Illuminated Entry 23
Instrument Cluster .....284
Interior....175
Oil Pressure....289
Passing....180
Seat Belt Reminder....288
Security Alarm....289
Service....743
Side Marker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 754
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) .....290
Traction Control....536
Transfer Case 439
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) .....284
Limited-Slip Differential .....492
Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
Ti res .545
Locks 37
Automatic Door 39
Child Protection 40
Door 37
Power Door 39
Low Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
Lubrication, Body .704
Lug Nuts....630
Maintenance Free Battery....701
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 696
Maintenance Schedule....764
Malfunction Indicator Light (Check Engine). . . . . . .694
Manual, Service .780

794 INDEX
Manual Transmission
Fluid Level Check....720
Lubricant Selection .....760
Memory Seat....162
Methanol....578
Mirrors....132
Electric Powered....142
Heated....144
Memory....162
Outside....139
Rearview....132
Trailer Towing....146
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle ..... 7
Monitor, Tire Pressure System .....567
Mopar Parts....695
MTBE/ETBE....578
Multi-Function Control Lever. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Navigation System (Uconnect® gps) .....210
New Vehicle Break-In Period ..... 1 1 9
Occupant Restraints 50
Occupant Restraints (Sedan) 7 2
Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) .....577
Off-Pavement Driving (Off-Road)....474
Off-Road Driving (Off-Pavement) .....474
Oil, Engine....697
Capacity 755
Change Interval .698
Dipstick....697
Disposal....700
Filter....700
Filter Disposal....700
Identification Logo 698
Recommendation.698
Synthetic 700
Viscosity .699
Oil Filter, Selection .700
INDEX 795
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
Operating Precautions....693
Operator Manual (Owner's Manual) ..... 4
Outside Rearview Mirrors....139
Overdrive. 422
Overdrive OFF Switch....422
Overhead Console. 212
Overheating, Engine....293
Owner's Manual (Operator Manual) ..... 4
Paint Care....725
Panic Alarm. 28
Parking Brake. 521
ParkSense® System, Rear. 193
Passing Light....180
Passive Entry 4
Pedals, Adjustable....187
Personal Settings. 327
Pets....119
Pets, Transporting....1 1 9
Pickup Box. 248
Placard, Tire and Loading Information .....546
Power
Distribution Center (Fuses) .....734
Door Locks 39
Mirrors....142
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) .....227
Seats....147
Sliding Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Steering....518
Sunroof .224
Windows....46
Power Steering Fluid. 760
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts 68
Pretensioners
Seat Belts 6 6
Programmable Electronic Features .....327

796 INDEX
Programming Transmitters (Remote Keyless Entry) . .24
Radial Ply Tires .....553
Radiator Cap (Coolant Pressure Cap) .....709
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Rain Sensitive Wiper System....183
Ramp Travel Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
Rear Axle (Differential)....719
Rear Cargo Area Utility Rails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Rear ParkSense System....193
Rear Seat, Folding .....157
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Rear Window, Sliding .....246
Reclining Rear Seats....156
Recorder, Event Data 82
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617
Shifting into Transfer Case Neutral (N) .....620
Shifting out of Transfer Case Neutral (N) .....623
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
Refrigerant....703
Reminder, Seat Belt. 67
Remote Control Starting System 3 3
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) 2 4
Programming Additional Key Fobs 21
Programming Additional Transmitters ..... 2 1
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls .....358
Remote Starting Uconnect® Customer Programmable Features . . .350 Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Starting System. 3 3
Replacement Bulbs....743
Replacement Keys 20
Replacement Parts....695
Replacement Tires....560
Reporting Safety Defects....779
Restraint, Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Restraints, Child 83

INDEX 797
Restraints, Occupant 50 Pretensioners 66
Rotation, Tires....564 Reminder....288
Untwisting Procedure....6 2
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle....122 Seats....147
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 779 Easy Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Safety, Exhaust Gas .121 Folding Floor .246
Safety Information, Tire .539 Memory .162
Safety Tips....120 Power....147
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 764 Rear Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 730 Reclining Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Seat Belt Reminder 67 Security Alarm 22
Seat Belts 50 Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze).758
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage ..... 6 3 SENTRY KEY®
And Pregnant Women....68 FCC General Information....21
Child Restraint 83 Key Programming 21
Extender 68 Sentry Key (Immobilizer) 19
Front Seat 54 Sentry Key Replacement 20
Inspection .122 Service Assistance.775
798 INDEX
Service Contract....777
Service Manuals....780
Settings, Personal .....327
Shifting.400
Automatic Transmission....403
Transfer Case....438
Transfer Case, Shifting into Transfer Case Neutral (N) .....620
Transfer Case, Shifting out of Transfer Case Neutral (N)....623
Shift Lever Override....678
Shoulder Belts 54
Shoulder Belt Upper Anchorage 63
Side Airbag 77
Signals, Turn....124
Sliding Rear Window Power....245
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) .....562
Snow Plow....612
Snow Tires....555
Spare Tire. .556
Spark Plugs....758
Speed Control (Cruise Control). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Speedometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Stabilizer/Sway Bar System....472
Starting 3 3
Automatic Transmission....391
Cold Weather....393
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Remote 3 3
Starting Procedures (Gas Engines) .....390
Steering
Power....518
Wheel, Heated .....185
Wheel, Tilt .....184
Steering Wheel Audio Controls .....358
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .358
Storage Compartment, Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239

Information Provided by.
DEALER
INDEX 799
Storage, Vehicle. 379
Storing Your Vehicle....743
Sun Roof....224
Supplemental Tire Pressure Information .....561
Suspension, Air. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Sway Control, Trailer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
System, Remote Starting 3 3
Tachometer. 284
Tailgate....265
Tilt Steering Column....184
Tip Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Tire and Loading Information Placard .....545
Tire Markings....539
Tires ....
Aging (Life of Tires)....559
Air Pressure....550
Chains .562
Compact Spare ....556
Dual 565
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
High Speed 553
Inflation Pressures....552
Life of Tires ....559
Load Capacity 545
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) .....567
Pressure Warning Light....290
Quality Grading .781
Radial 553
Replacement....560
Rotation....564
Safety .539
Sizes....540
124Snow Tires....555
Spinning 558
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559
Tire Safety Information ....539

Tongue Weight/Trailer Weight .....599
Tonneau Cover....731
Tonneau Cover Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 731
Torque Converter Clutch .....424
Tow Hooks, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 677
Towing....591
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682
Guide....595
Recreational....617
Weight....595
Towing Vehicle Behind a Motorhome .....617
Traction....493
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527
Trailer Sway Control (TSC)....538
Trailer Towing....591
Cooling System Tips....6 1
Hitches....594
Minimum Requirements....600
Mirrors....146
Trailer and Tongue Weight....599
Wiring....608
Trailer Towing Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
Trailer Weight. .595
Transfer Case....720
Electronically Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 760
Transmission....403
Automatic....403
Fluid....760
Maintenance....721
Shifting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Transmitter Battery Service (Remote Keyless Entry) . .30
Transmitter Programming (Remote Keyless Entry) . . .24
Transmitter, Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) ..... 2 4
Tread Wear Indicators....559
Turn Signals....179
INDEX 801
Uconnect®
Customer Programmable Features .....350
Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
Uconnect® Settings
Customer Programmable Features ..... 4 2
Passive Entry Programming....42
Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Uniform Tire Quality Grades .....781
Universal Garage Door Opener (HomeLink®)
Programming HomeLink®.215
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 577
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 2
Utility Rails, Rear Cargo Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) 6
Vehicle Loading....546
Vehicle Modifications/Alterations 7
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
Viscosity, Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 699
Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .284
Warnings and Cautions. 6
Warranty Information....778
Washers, Windshield .....181
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 726
Water
Driving Through. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 727
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 727
Wheel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 669
Winch....498
Accessories....503
Operation.504
Rigging Techniques .....516
Usage....498
Wind Buffeting. 50
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
Windows....46
Power . 46

Information Provided by: DEALER
802 INDEX
Rear Sliding....246 Windshield Wiper Blades....705
Reset Auto-Up 48 Windshield Wipers 180
Wind Buffeting 50 Wiper Blade Replacement .705
Windshield Defroster. .122 Wipers, Intermittent .181
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Wipers, Rain Sensitive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Fluid....180
INSTALLATIONOFRADIOTRANSMITTINGEQUIPMENT
Specialdesignconsiderationsareincorporatedinto this vehicle'selectronicsystemtoprovideimmunitytoradio frequencysignals.Mobiletwo-wayradiosandtelephone equipmentmustbeinstalledproperlybytrainedpersonnel. The followingmustbeobservedduringinstallation.
The positive power connections should be made directly to the battery and fused as close to the battery as possible. Then negative power connections should be made to body sheet metal adjacent to the negative battery connection. This connections should not be infused.
Antennasfortwo-wayradiosshouldbemountedontheroof ortherearareaofthevehicle.Careshouldbeusedin mountingantennaswithmagnetbases.Magnetsmayaffect theaccuracyoroperationofthecompassonvehiclesso equipped.
Theantennacableshouldbeasshortaspracticaland routedawayfromthevehiclewiringwhenpossible.Use onlyfullyshieldedcoaxialcable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to other radioto ensure low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobileradioequipmentwithoutoutputpowergreaterthan normalmayrequirespecialprecautions.
All installation should be checked for possible interference between the communication equipment and the vehicle's electronics systems.


RAM
SERVICE
STICK WITH THE SPECIALISTS
Chrysler Group LLC
14D241-126ADA

Fourth Edition
Printed in U.S.A.



